xref: /NextBSD/contrib/gcc/dwarf2out.c (revision 95f7c2f56c7268d6ed9c2a56d357aeeac260363b)
1 /* Output Dwarf2 format symbol table information from GCC.
2    Copyright (C) 1992, 1993, 1995, 1996, 1997, 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002,
3    2003, 2004, 2005, 2006 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
4    Contributed by Gary Funck (gary@intrepid.com).
5    Derived from DWARF 1 implementation of Ron Guilmette (rfg@monkeys.com).
6    Extensively modified by Jason Merrill (jason@cygnus.com).
7 
8 This file is part of GCC.
9 
10 GCC is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it under
11 the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by the Free
12 Software Foundation; either version 2, or (at your option) any later
13 version.
14 
15 GCC is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, but WITHOUT ANY
16 WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of MERCHANTABILITY or
17 FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE.  See the GNU General Public License
18 for more details.
19 
20 You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
21 along with GCC; see the file COPYING.  If not, write to the Free
22 Software Foundation, 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor, Boston, MA
23 02110-1301, USA.  */
24 
25 /* TODO: Emit .debug_line header even when there are no functions, since
26 	   the file numbers are used by .debug_info.  Alternately, leave
27 	   out locations for types and decls.
28 	 Avoid talking about ctors and op= for PODs.
29 	 Factor out common prologue sequences into multiple CIEs.  */
30 
31 /* The first part of this file deals with the DWARF 2 frame unwind
32    information, which is also used by the GCC efficient exception handling
33    mechanism.  The second part, controlled only by an #ifdef
34    DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO, deals with the other DWARF 2 debugging
35    information.  */
36 
37 #include "config.h"
38 #include "system.h"
39 #include "coretypes.h"
40 #include "tm.h"
41 #include "tree.h"
42 #include "version.h"
43 #include "flags.h"
44 #include "real.h"
45 #include "rtl.h"
46 #include "hard-reg-set.h"
47 #include "regs.h"
48 #include "insn-config.h"
49 #include "reload.h"
50 #include "function.h"
51 #include "output.h"
52 #include "expr.h"
53 #include "libfuncs.h"
54 #include "except.h"
55 #include "dwarf2.h"
56 #include "dwarf2out.h"
57 #include "dwarf2asm.h"
58 #include "toplev.h"
59 #include "varray.h"
60 #include "ggc.h"
61 #include "md5.h"
62 #include "tm_p.h"
63 #include "diagnostic.h"
64 #include "debug.h"
65 #include "target.h"
66 #include "langhooks.h"
67 #include "hashtab.h"
68 #include "cgraph.h"
69 #include "input.h"
70 
71 #ifdef DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO
72 static void dwarf2out_source_line (unsigned int, const char *);
73 #endif
74 
75 /* DWARF2 Abbreviation Glossary:
76    CFA = Canonical Frame Address
77 	   a fixed address on the stack which identifies a call frame.
78 	   We define it to be the value of SP just before the call insn.
79 	   The CFA register and offset, which may change during the course
80 	   of the function, are used to calculate its value at runtime.
81    CFI = Call Frame Instruction
82 	   an instruction for the DWARF2 abstract machine
83    CIE = Common Information Entry
84 	   information describing information common to one or more FDEs
85    DIE = Debugging Information Entry
86    FDE = Frame Description Entry
87 	   information describing the stack call frame, in particular,
88 	   how to restore registers
89 
90    DW_CFA_... = DWARF2 CFA call frame instruction
91    DW_TAG_... = DWARF2 DIE tag */
92 
93 #ifndef DWARF2_FRAME_INFO
94 # ifdef DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO
95 #  define DWARF2_FRAME_INFO \
96   (write_symbols == DWARF2_DEBUG || write_symbols == VMS_AND_DWARF2_DEBUG)
97 # else
98 #  define DWARF2_FRAME_INFO 0
99 # endif
100 #endif
101 
102 /* Map register numbers held in the call frame info that gcc has
103    collected using DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM to those that should be output in
104    .debug_frame and .eh_frame.  */
105 #ifndef DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT
106 #define DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT(REGNO, FOR_EH) (REGNO)
107 #endif
108 
109 /* Decide whether we want to emit frame unwind information for the current
110    translation unit.  */
111 
112 int
dwarf2out_do_frame(void)113 dwarf2out_do_frame (void)
114 {
115   /* We want to emit correct CFA location expressions or lists, so we
116      have to return true if we're going to output debug info, even if
117      we're not going to output frame or unwind info.  */
118   return (write_symbols == DWARF2_DEBUG
119 	  || write_symbols == VMS_AND_DWARF2_DEBUG
120 	  || DWARF2_FRAME_INFO
121 #ifdef DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO
122 	  || (DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO
123 	      && (flag_unwind_tables
124 		  || (flag_exceptions && ! USING_SJLJ_EXCEPTIONS)))
125 #endif
126 	  );
127 }
128 
129 /* The size of the target's pointer type.  */
130 #ifndef PTR_SIZE
131 #define PTR_SIZE (POINTER_SIZE / BITS_PER_UNIT)
132 #endif
133 
134 /* Array of RTXes referenced by the debugging information, which therefore
135    must be kept around forever.  */
136 static GTY(()) VEC(rtx,gc) *used_rtx_array;
137 
138 /* A pointer to the base of a list of incomplete types which might be
139    completed at some later time.  incomplete_types_list needs to be a
140    VEC(tree,gc) because we want to tell the garbage collector about
141    it.  */
142 static GTY(()) VEC(tree,gc) *incomplete_types;
143 
144 /* A pointer to the base of a table of references to declaration
145    scopes.  This table is a display which tracks the nesting
146    of declaration scopes at the current scope and containing
147    scopes.  This table is used to find the proper place to
148    define type declaration DIE's.  */
149 static GTY(()) VEC(tree,gc) *decl_scope_table;
150 
151 /* Pointers to various DWARF2 sections.  */
152 static GTY(()) section *debug_info_section;
153 static GTY(()) section *debug_abbrev_section;
154 static GTY(()) section *debug_aranges_section;
155 static GTY(()) section *debug_macinfo_section;
156 static GTY(()) section *debug_line_section;
157 static GTY(()) section *debug_loc_section;
158 static GTY(()) section *debug_pubnames_section;
159 static GTY(()) section *debug_pubtypes_section;
160 static GTY(()) section *debug_str_section;
161 static GTY(()) section *debug_ranges_section;
162 static GTY(()) section *debug_frame_section;
163 
164 /* How to start an assembler comment.  */
165 #ifndef ASM_COMMENT_START
166 #define ASM_COMMENT_START ";#"
167 #endif
168 
169 typedef struct dw_cfi_struct *dw_cfi_ref;
170 typedef struct dw_fde_struct *dw_fde_ref;
171 typedef union  dw_cfi_oprnd_struct *dw_cfi_oprnd_ref;
172 
173 /* Call frames are described using a sequence of Call Frame
174    Information instructions.  The register number, offset
175    and address fields are provided as possible operands;
176    their use is selected by the opcode field.  */
177 
178 enum dw_cfi_oprnd_type {
179   dw_cfi_oprnd_unused,
180   dw_cfi_oprnd_reg_num,
181   dw_cfi_oprnd_offset,
182   dw_cfi_oprnd_addr,
183   dw_cfi_oprnd_loc
184 };
185 
186 typedef union dw_cfi_oprnd_struct GTY(())
187 {
188   unsigned int GTY ((tag ("dw_cfi_oprnd_reg_num"))) dw_cfi_reg_num;
189   HOST_WIDE_INT GTY ((tag ("dw_cfi_oprnd_offset"))) dw_cfi_offset;
190   const char * GTY ((tag ("dw_cfi_oprnd_addr"))) dw_cfi_addr;
191   struct dw_loc_descr_struct * GTY ((tag ("dw_cfi_oprnd_loc"))) dw_cfi_loc;
192 }
193 dw_cfi_oprnd;
194 
195 typedef struct dw_cfi_struct GTY(())
196 {
197   dw_cfi_ref dw_cfi_next;
198   enum dwarf_call_frame_info dw_cfi_opc;
199   dw_cfi_oprnd GTY ((desc ("dw_cfi_oprnd1_desc (%1.dw_cfi_opc)")))
200     dw_cfi_oprnd1;
201   dw_cfi_oprnd GTY ((desc ("dw_cfi_oprnd2_desc (%1.dw_cfi_opc)")))
202     dw_cfi_oprnd2;
203 }
204 dw_cfi_node;
205 
206 /* This is how we define the location of the CFA. We use to handle it
207    as REG + OFFSET all the time,  but now it can be more complex.
208    It can now be either REG + CFA_OFFSET or *(REG + BASE_OFFSET) + CFA_OFFSET.
209    Instead of passing around REG and OFFSET, we pass a copy
210    of this structure.  */
211 typedef struct cfa_loc GTY(())
212 {
213   HOST_WIDE_INT offset;
214   HOST_WIDE_INT base_offset;
215   unsigned int reg;
216   int indirect;            /* 1 if CFA is accessed via a dereference.  */
217 } dw_cfa_location;
218 
219 /* All call frame descriptions (FDE's) in the GCC generated DWARF
220    refer to a single Common Information Entry (CIE), defined at
221    the beginning of the .debug_frame section.  This use of a single
222    CIE obviates the need to keep track of multiple CIE's
223    in the DWARF generation routines below.  */
224 
225 typedef struct dw_fde_struct GTY(())
226 {
227   tree decl;
228   const char *dw_fde_begin;
229   const char *dw_fde_current_label;
230   const char *dw_fde_end;
231   const char *dw_fde_hot_section_label;
232   const char *dw_fde_hot_section_end_label;
233   const char *dw_fde_unlikely_section_label;
234   const char *dw_fde_unlikely_section_end_label;
235   bool dw_fde_switched_sections;
236   dw_cfi_ref dw_fde_cfi;
237   unsigned funcdef_number;
238   unsigned all_throwers_are_sibcalls : 1;
239   unsigned nothrow : 1;
240   unsigned uses_eh_lsda : 1;
241 }
242 dw_fde_node;
243 
244 /* Maximum size (in bytes) of an artificially generated label.  */
245 #define MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES	30
246 
247 /* The size of addresses as they appear in the Dwarf 2 data.
248    Some architectures use word addresses to refer to code locations,
249    but Dwarf 2 info always uses byte addresses.  On such machines,
250    Dwarf 2 addresses need to be larger than the architecture's
251    pointers.  */
252 #ifndef DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE
253 #define DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE (POINTER_SIZE / BITS_PER_UNIT)
254 #endif
255 
256 /* The size in bytes of a DWARF field indicating an offset or length
257    relative to a debug info section, specified to be 4 bytes in the
258    DWARF-2 specification.  The SGI/MIPS ABI defines it to be the same
259    as PTR_SIZE.  */
260 
261 #ifndef DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE
262 #define DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE 4
263 #endif
264 
265 /* According to the (draft) DWARF 3 specification, the initial length
266    should either be 4 or 12 bytes.  When it's 12 bytes, the first 4
267    bytes are 0xffffffff, followed by the length stored in the next 8
268    bytes.
269 
270    However, the SGI/MIPS ABI uses an initial length which is equal to
271    DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE.  It is defined (elsewhere) accordingly.  */
272 
273 #ifndef DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE
274 #define DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 4 ? 4 : 12)
275 #endif
276 
277 #define DWARF_VERSION 2
278 
279 /* Round SIZE up to the nearest BOUNDARY.  */
280 #define DWARF_ROUND(SIZE,BOUNDARY) \
281   ((((SIZE) + (BOUNDARY) - 1) / (BOUNDARY)) * (BOUNDARY))
282 
283 /* Offsets recorded in opcodes are a multiple of this alignment factor.  */
284 #ifndef DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT
285 #ifdef STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD
286 #define DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT (-((int) UNITS_PER_WORD))
287 #else
288 #define DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT ((int) UNITS_PER_WORD)
289 #endif
290 #endif
291 
292 /* CIE identifier.  */
293 #if HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT >= 64
294 #define DWARF_CIE_ID \
295   (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 4 ? DW_CIE_ID : DW64_CIE_ID)
296 #else
297 #define DWARF_CIE_ID DW_CIE_ID
298 #endif
299 
300 /* A pointer to the base of a table that contains frame description
301    information for each routine.  */
302 static GTY((length ("fde_table_allocated"))) dw_fde_ref fde_table;
303 
304 /* Number of elements currently allocated for fde_table.  */
305 static GTY(()) unsigned fde_table_allocated;
306 
307 /* Number of elements in fde_table currently in use.  */
308 static GTY(()) unsigned fde_table_in_use;
309 
310 /* Size (in elements) of increments by which we may expand the
311    fde_table.  */
312 #define FDE_TABLE_INCREMENT 256
313 
314 /* A list of call frame insns for the CIE.  */
315 static GTY(()) dw_cfi_ref cie_cfi_head;
316 
317 #if defined (DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO) || defined (DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO)
318 /* Some DWARF extensions (e.g., MIPS/SGI) implement a subprogram
319    attribute that accelerates the lookup of the FDE associated
320    with the subprogram.  This variable holds the table index of the FDE
321    associated with the current function (body) definition.  */
322 static unsigned current_funcdef_fde;
323 #endif
324 
325 struct indirect_string_node GTY(())
326 {
327   const char *str;
328   unsigned int refcount;
329   unsigned int form;
330   char *label;
331 };
332 
333 static GTY ((param_is (struct indirect_string_node))) htab_t debug_str_hash;
334 
335 static GTY(()) int dw2_string_counter;
336 static GTY(()) unsigned long dwarf2out_cfi_label_num;
337 
338 #if defined (DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO) || defined (DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO)
339 
340 /* Forward declarations for functions defined in this file.  */
341 
342 static char *stripattributes (const char *);
343 static const char *dwarf_cfi_name (unsigned);
344 static dw_cfi_ref new_cfi (void);
345 static void add_cfi (dw_cfi_ref *, dw_cfi_ref);
346 static void add_fde_cfi (const char *, dw_cfi_ref);
347 static void lookup_cfa_1 (dw_cfi_ref, dw_cfa_location *);
348 static void lookup_cfa (dw_cfa_location *);
349 static void reg_save (const char *, unsigned, unsigned, HOST_WIDE_INT);
350 static void initial_return_save (rtx);
351 static HOST_WIDE_INT stack_adjust_offset (rtx);
352 static void output_cfi (dw_cfi_ref, dw_fde_ref, int);
353 static void output_call_frame_info (int);
354 static void dwarf2out_stack_adjust (rtx, bool);
355 static void flush_queued_reg_saves (void);
356 static bool clobbers_queued_reg_save (rtx);
357 static void dwarf2out_frame_debug_expr (rtx, const char *);
358 
359 /* Support for complex CFA locations.  */
360 static void output_cfa_loc (dw_cfi_ref);
361 static void get_cfa_from_loc_descr (dw_cfa_location *,
362 				    struct dw_loc_descr_struct *);
363 static struct dw_loc_descr_struct *build_cfa_loc
364   (dw_cfa_location *, HOST_WIDE_INT);
365 static void def_cfa_1 (const char *, dw_cfa_location *);
366 
367 /* How to start an assembler comment.  */
368 #ifndef ASM_COMMENT_START
369 #define ASM_COMMENT_START ";#"
370 #endif
371 
372 /* Data and reference forms for relocatable data.  */
373 #define DW_FORM_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 8 ? DW_FORM_data8 : DW_FORM_data4)
374 #define DW_FORM_ref (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 8 ? DW_FORM_ref8 : DW_FORM_ref4)
375 
376 #ifndef DEBUG_FRAME_SECTION
377 #define DEBUG_FRAME_SECTION	".debug_frame"
378 #endif
379 
380 #ifndef FUNC_BEGIN_LABEL
381 #define FUNC_BEGIN_LABEL	"LFB"
382 #endif
383 
384 #ifndef FUNC_END_LABEL
385 #define FUNC_END_LABEL		"LFE"
386 #endif
387 
388 #ifndef FRAME_BEGIN_LABEL
389 #define FRAME_BEGIN_LABEL	"Lframe"
390 #endif
391 #define CIE_AFTER_SIZE_LABEL	"LSCIE"
392 #define CIE_END_LABEL		"LECIE"
393 #define FDE_LABEL		"LSFDE"
394 #define FDE_AFTER_SIZE_LABEL	"LASFDE"
395 #define FDE_END_LABEL		"LEFDE"
396 #define LINE_NUMBER_BEGIN_LABEL	"LSLT"
397 #define LINE_NUMBER_END_LABEL	"LELT"
398 #define LN_PROLOG_AS_LABEL	"LASLTP"
399 #define LN_PROLOG_END_LABEL	"LELTP"
400 #define DIE_LABEL_PREFIX	"DW"
401 
402 /* The DWARF 2 CFA column which tracks the return address.  Normally this
403    is the column for PC, or the first column after all of the hard
404    registers.  */
405 #ifndef DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN
406 #ifdef PC_REGNUM
407 #define DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN	DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (PC_REGNUM)
408 #else
409 #define DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN	DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS
410 #endif
411 #endif
412 
413 /* The mapping from gcc register number to DWARF 2 CFA column number.  By
414    default, we just provide columns for all registers.  */
415 #ifndef DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM
416 #define DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM(REG) DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER (REG)
417 #endif
418 
419 /* Hook used by __throw.  */
420 
421 rtx
expand_builtin_dwarf_sp_column(void)422 expand_builtin_dwarf_sp_column (void)
423 {
424   unsigned int dwarf_regnum = DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (STACK_POINTER_REGNUM);
425   return GEN_INT (DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (dwarf_regnum, 1));
426 }
427 
428 /* Return a pointer to a copy of the section string name S with all
429    attributes stripped off, and an asterisk prepended (for assemble_name).  */
430 
431 static inline char *
stripattributes(const char * s)432 stripattributes (const char *s)
433 {
434   char *stripped = XNEWVEC (char, strlen (s) + 2);
435   char *p = stripped;
436 
437   *p++ = '*';
438 
439   while (*s && *s != ',')
440     *p++ = *s++;
441 
442   *p = '\0';
443   return stripped;
444 }
445 
446 /* Generate code to initialize the register size table.  */
447 
448 void
expand_builtin_init_dwarf_reg_sizes(tree address)449 expand_builtin_init_dwarf_reg_sizes (tree address)
450 {
451   unsigned int i;
452   enum machine_mode mode = TYPE_MODE (char_type_node);
453   rtx addr = expand_normal (address);
454   rtx mem = gen_rtx_MEM (BLKmode, addr);
455   bool wrote_return_column = false;
456 
457   for (i = 0; i < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER; i++)
458     {
459       int rnum = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (i), 1);
460 
461       if (rnum < DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS)
462 	{
463 	  HOST_WIDE_INT offset = rnum * GET_MODE_SIZE (mode);
464 	  enum machine_mode save_mode = reg_raw_mode[i];
465 	  HOST_WIDE_INT size;
466 
467 	  if (HARD_REGNO_CALL_PART_CLOBBERED (i, save_mode))
468 	    save_mode = choose_hard_reg_mode (i, 1, true);
469 	  if (DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (i) == DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN)
470 	    {
471 	      if (save_mode == VOIDmode)
472 		continue;
473 	      wrote_return_column = true;
474 	    }
475 	  size = GET_MODE_SIZE (save_mode);
476 	  if (offset < 0)
477 	    continue;
478 
479 	  emit_move_insn (adjust_address (mem, mode, offset),
480 			  gen_int_mode (size, mode));
481 	}
482     }
483 
484 #ifdef DWARF_ALT_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN
485   gcc_assert (wrote_return_column);
486   i = DWARF_ALT_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN;
487   wrote_return_column = false;
488 #else
489   i = DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN;
490 #endif
491 
492   if (! wrote_return_column)
493     {
494       enum machine_mode save_mode = Pmode;
495       HOST_WIDE_INT offset = i * GET_MODE_SIZE (mode);
496       HOST_WIDE_INT size = GET_MODE_SIZE (save_mode);
497       emit_move_insn (adjust_address (mem, mode, offset), GEN_INT (size));
498     }
499 }
500 
501 /* Convert a DWARF call frame info. operation to its string name */
502 
503 static const char *
dwarf_cfi_name(unsigned int cfi_opc)504 dwarf_cfi_name (unsigned int cfi_opc)
505 {
506   switch (cfi_opc)
507     {
508     case DW_CFA_advance_loc:
509       return "DW_CFA_advance_loc";
510     case DW_CFA_offset:
511       return "DW_CFA_offset";
512     case DW_CFA_restore:
513       return "DW_CFA_restore";
514     case DW_CFA_nop:
515       return "DW_CFA_nop";
516     case DW_CFA_set_loc:
517       return "DW_CFA_set_loc";
518     case DW_CFA_advance_loc1:
519       return "DW_CFA_advance_loc1";
520     case DW_CFA_advance_loc2:
521       return "DW_CFA_advance_loc2";
522     case DW_CFA_advance_loc4:
523       return "DW_CFA_advance_loc4";
524     case DW_CFA_offset_extended:
525       return "DW_CFA_offset_extended";
526     case DW_CFA_restore_extended:
527       return "DW_CFA_restore_extended";
528     case DW_CFA_undefined:
529       return "DW_CFA_undefined";
530     case DW_CFA_same_value:
531       return "DW_CFA_same_value";
532     case DW_CFA_register:
533       return "DW_CFA_register";
534     case DW_CFA_remember_state:
535       return "DW_CFA_remember_state";
536     case DW_CFA_restore_state:
537       return "DW_CFA_restore_state";
538     case DW_CFA_def_cfa:
539       return "DW_CFA_def_cfa";
540     case DW_CFA_def_cfa_register:
541       return "DW_CFA_def_cfa_register";
542     case DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset:
543       return "DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset";
544 
545     /* DWARF 3 */
546     case DW_CFA_def_cfa_expression:
547       return "DW_CFA_def_cfa_expression";
548     case DW_CFA_expression:
549       return "DW_CFA_expression";
550     case DW_CFA_offset_extended_sf:
551       return "DW_CFA_offset_extended_sf";
552     case DW_CFA_def_cfa_sf:
553       return "DW_CFA_def_cfa_sf";
554     case DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset_sf:
555       return "DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset_sf";
556 
557     /* SGI/MIPS specific */
558     case DW_CFA_MIPS_advance_loc8:
559       return "DW_CFA_MIPS_advance_loc8";
560 
561     /* GNU extensions */
562     case DW_CFA_GNU_window_save:
563       return "DW_CFA_GNU_window_save";
564     case DW_CFA_GNU_args_size:
565       return "DW_CFA_GNU_args_size";
566     case DW_CFA_GNU_negative_offset_extended:
567       return "DW_CFA_GNU_negative_offset_extended";
568 
569     default:
570       return "DW_CFA_<unknown>";
571     }
572 }
573 
574 /* Return a pointer to a newly allocated Call Frame Instruction.  */
575 
576 static inline dw_cfi_ref
new_cfi(void)577 new_cfi (void)
578 {
579   dw_cfi_ref cfi = ggc_alloc (sizeof (dw_cfi_node));
580 
581   cfi->dw_cfi_next = NULL;
582   cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num = 0;
583   cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd2.dw_cfi_reg_num = 0;
584 
585   return cfi;
586 }
587 
588 /* Add a Call Frame Instruction to list of instructions.  */
589 
590 static inline void
add_cfi(dw_cfi_ref * list_head,dw_cfi_ref cfi)591 add_cfi (dw_cfi_ref *list_head, dw_cfi_ref cfi)
592 {
593   dw_cfi_ref *p;
594 
595   /* Find the end of the chain.  */
596   for (p = list_head; (*p) != NULL; p = &(*p)->dw_cfi_next)
597     ;
598 
599   *p = cfi;
600 }
601 
602 /* Generate a new label for the CFI info to refer to.  */
603 
604 char *
dwarf2out_cfi_label(void)605 dwarf2out_cfi_label (void)
606 {
607   static char label[20];
608 
609   ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, "LCFI", dwarf2out_cfi_label_num++);
610   ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, label);
611   return label;
612 }
613 
614 /* Add CFI to the current fde at the PC value indicated by LABEL if specified,
615    or to the CIE if LABEL is NULL.  */
616 
617 static void
add_fde_cfi(const char * label,dw_cfi_ref cfi)618 add_fde_cfi (const char *label, dw_cfi_ref cfi)
619 {
620   if (label)
621     {
622       dw_fde_ref fde = &fde_table[fde_table_in_use - 1];
623 
624       if (*label == 0)
625 	label = dwarf2out_cfi_label ();
626 
627       if (fde->dw_fde_current_label == NULL
628 	  || strcmp (label, fde->dw_fde_current_label) != 0)
629 	{
630 	  dw_cfi_ref xcfi;
631 
632 	  label = xstrdup (label);
633 
634 	  /* Set the location counter to the new label.  */
635 	  xcfi = new_cfi ();
636 	  /* If we have a current label, advance from there, otherwise
637 	     set the location directly using set_loc.  */
638 	  xcfi->dw_cfi_opc = fde->dw_fde_current_label
639 			     ? DW_CFA_advance_loc4
640 			     : DW_CFA_set_loc;
641 	  xcfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_addr = label;
642 	  add_cfi (&fde->dw_fde_cfi, xcfi);
643 
644 	  fde->dw_fde_current_label = label;
645 	}
646 
647       add_cfi (&fde->dw_fde_cfi, cfi);
648     }
649 
650   else
651     add_cfi (&cie_cfi_head, cfi);
652 }
653 
654 /* Subroutine of lookup_cfa.  */
655 
656 static void
lookup_cfa_1(dw_cfi_ref cfi,dw_cfa_location * loc)657 lookup_cfa_1 (dw_cfi_ref cfi, dw_cfa_location *loc)
658 {
659   switch (cfi->dw_cfi_opc)
660     {
661     case DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset:
662       loc->offset = cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_offset;
663       break;
664     case DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset_sf:
665       loc->offset
666 	= cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_offset * DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT;
667       break;
668     case DW_CFA_def_cfa_register:
669       loc->reg = cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num;
670       break;
671     case DW_CFA_def_cfa:
672       loc->reg = cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num;
673       loc->offset = cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd2.dw_cfi_offset;
674       break;
675     case DW_CFA_def_cfa_sf:
676       loc->reg = cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num;
677       loc->offset
678 	= cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd2.dw_cfi_offset * DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT;
679       break;
680     case DW_CFA_def_cfa_expression:
681       get_cfa_from_loc_descr (loc, cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_loc);
682       break;
683     default:
684       break;
685     }
686 }
687 
688 /* Find the previous value for the CFA.  */
689 
690 static void
lookup_cfa(dw_cfa_location * loc)691 lookup_cfa (dw_cfa_location *loc)
692 {
693   dw_cfi_ref cfi;
694 
695   loc->reg = INVALID_REGNUM;
696   loc->offset = 0;
697   loc->indirect = 0;
698   loc->base_offset = 0;
699 
700   for (cfi = cie_cfi_head; cfi; cfi = cfi->dw_cfi_next)
701     lookup_cfa_1 (cfi, loc);
702 
703   if (fde_table_in_use)
704     {
705       dw_fde_ref fde = &fde_table[fde_table_in_use - 1];
706       for (cfi = fde->dw_fde_cfi; cfi; cfi = cfi->dw_cfi_next)
707 	lookup_cfa_1 (cfi, loc);
708     }
709 }
710 
711 /* The current rule for calculating the DWARF2 canonical frame address.  */
712 static dw_cfa_location cfa;
713 
714 /* The register used for saving registers to the stack, and its offset
715    from the CFA.  */
716 static dw_cfa_location cfa_store;
717 
718 /* The running total of the size of arguments pushed onto the stack.  */
719 static HOST_WIDE_INT args_size;
720 
721 /* The last args_size we actually output.  */
722 static HOST_WIDE_INT old_args_size;
723 
724 /* Entry point to update the canonical frame address (CFA).
725    LABEL is passed to add_fde_cfi.  The value of CFA is now to be
726    calculated from REG+OFFSET.  */
727 
728 void
dwarf2out_def_cfa(const char * label,unsigned int reg,HOST_WIDE_INT offset)729 dwarf2out_def_cfa (const char *label, unsigned int reg, HOST_WIDE_INT offset)
730 {
731   dw_cfa_location loc;
732   loc.indirect = 0;
733   loc.base_offset = 0;
734   loc.reg = reg;
735   loc.offset = offset;
736   def_cfa_1 (label, &loc);
737 }
738 
739 /* Determine if two dw_cfa_location structures define the same data.  */
740 
741 static bool
cfa_equal_p(const dw_cfa_location * loc1,const dw_cfa_location * loc2)742 cfa_equal_p (const dw_cfa_location *loc1, const dw_cfa_location *loc2)
743 {
744   return (loc1->reg == loc2->reg
745 	  && loc1->offset == loc2->offset
746 	  && loc1->indirect == loc2->indirect
747 	  && (loc1->indirect == 0
748 	      || loc1->base_offset == loc2->base_offset));
749 }
750 
751 /* This routine does the actual work.  The CFA is now calculated from
752    the dw_cfa_location structure.  */
753 
754 static void
def_cfa_1(const char * label,dw_cfa_location * loc_p)755 def_cfa_1 (const char *label, dw_cfa_location *loc_p)
756 {
757   dw_cfi_ref cfi;
758   dw_cfa_location old_cfa, loc;
759 
760   cfa = *loc_p;
761   loc = *loc_p;
762 
763   if (cfa_store.reg == loc.reg && loc.indirect == 0)
764     cfa_store.offset = loc.offset;
765 
766   loc.reg = DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (loc.reg);
767   lookup_cfa (&old_cfa);
768 
769   /* If nothing changed, no need to issue any call frame instructions.  */
770   if (cfa_equal_p (&loc, &old_cfa))
771     return;
772 
773   cfi = new_cfi ();
774 
775   if (loc.reg == old_cfa.reg && !loc.indirect)
776     {
777       /* Construct a "DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset <offset>" instruction, indicating
778 	 the CFA register did not change but the offset did.  */
779       if (loc.offset < 0)
780 	{
781 	  HOST_WIDE_INT f_offset = loc.offset / DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT;
782 	  gcc_assert (f_offset * DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT == loc.offset);
783 
784 	  cfi->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset_sf;
785 	  cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_offset = f_offset;
786 	}
787       else
788 	{
789 	  cfi->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset;
790 	  cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_offset = loc.offset;
791 	}
792     }
793 
794 #ifndef MIPS_DEBUGGING_INFO  /* SGI dbx thinks this means no offset.  */
795   else if (loc.offset == old_cfa.offset
796 	   && old_cfa.reg != INVALID_REGNUM
797 	   && !loc.indirect)
798     {
799       /* Construct a "DW_CFA_def_cfa_register <register>" instruction,
800 	 indicating the CFA register has changed to <register> but the
801 	 offset has not changed.  */
802       cfi->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_def_cfa_register;
803       cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num = loc.reg;
804     }
805 #endif
806 
807   else if (loc.indirect == 0)
808     {
809       /* Construct a "DW_CFA_def_cfa <register> <offset>" instruction,
810 	 indicating the CFA register has changed to <register> with
811 	 the specified offset.  */
812       if (loc.offset < 0)
813 	{
814 	  HOST_WIDE_INT f_offset = loc.offset / DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT;
815 	  gcc_assert (f_offset * DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT == loc.offset);
816 
817 	  cfi->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_def_cfa_sf;
818 	  cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num = loc.reg;
819 	  cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd2.dw_cfi_offset = f_offset;
820 	}
821       else
822 	{
823 	  cfi->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_def_cfa;
824 	  cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num = loc.reg;
825 	  cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd2.dw_cfi_offset = loc.offset;
826 	}
827     }
828   else
829     {
830       /* Construct a DW_CFA_def_cfa_expression instruction to
831 	 calculate the CFA using a full location expression since no
832 	 register-offset pair is available.  */
833       struct dw_loc_descr_struct *loc_list;
834 
835       cfi->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_def_cfa_expression;
836       loc_list = build_cfa_loc (&loc, 0);
837       cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_loc = loc_list;
838     }
839 
840   add_fde_cfi (label, cfi);
841 }
842 
843 /* Add the CFI for saving a register.  REG is the CFA column number.
844    LABEL is passed to add_fde_cfi.
845    If SREG is -1, the register is saved at OFFSET from the CFA;
846    otherwise it is saved in SREG.  */
847 
848 static void
reg_save(const char * label,unsigned int reg,unsigned int sreg,HOST_WIDE_INT offset)849 reg_save (const char *label, unsigned int reg, unsigned int sreg, HOST_WIDE_INT offset)
850 {
851   dw_cfi_ref cfi = new_cfi ();
852 
853   cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num = reg;
854 
855   if (sreg == INVALID_REGNUM)
856     {
857       if (reg & ~0x3f)
858 	/* The register number won't fit in 6 bits, so we have to use
859 	   the long form.  */
860 	cfi->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_offset_extended;
861       else
862 	cfi->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_offset;
863 
864 #ifdef ENABLE_CHECKING
865       {
866 	/* If we get an offset that is not a multiple of
867 	   DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT, there is either a bug in the
868 	   definition of DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT, or a bug in the machine
869 	   description.  */
870 	HOST_WIDE_INT check_offset = offset / DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT;
871 
872 	gcc_assert (check_offset * DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT == offset);
873       }
874 #endif
875       offset /= DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT;
876       if (offset < 0)
877 	cfi->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_offset_extended_sf;
878 
879       cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd2.dw_cfi_offset = offset;
880     }
881   else if (sreg == reg)
882     cfi->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_same_value;
883   else
884     {
885       cfi->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_register;
886       cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd2.dw_cfi_reg_num = sreg;
887     }
888 
889   add_fde_cfi (label, cfi);
890 }
891 
892 /* Add the CFI for saving a register window.  LABEL is passed to reg_save.
893    This CFI tells the unwinder that it needs to restore the window registers
894    from the previous frame's window save area.
895 
896    ??? Perhaps we should note in the CIE where windows are saved (instead of
897    assuming 0(cfa)) and what registers are in the window.  */
898 
899 void
dwarf2out_window_save(const char * label)900 dwarf2out_window_save (const char *label)
901 {
902   dw_cfi_ref cfi = new_cfi ();
903 
904   cfi->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_GNU_window_save;
905   add_fde_cfi (label, cfi);
906 }
907 
908 /* Add a CFI to update the running total of the size of arguments
909    pushed onto the stack.  */
910 
911 void
dwarf2out_args_size(const char * label,HOST_WIDE_INT size)912 dwarf2out_args_size (const char *label, HOST_WIDE_INT size)
913 {
914   dw_cfi_ref cfi;
915 
916   if (size == old_args_size)
917     return;
918 
919   old_args_size = size;
920 
921   cfi = new_cfi ();
922   cfi->dw_cfi_opc = DW_CFA_GNU_args_size;
923   cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_offset = size;
924   add_fde_cfi (label, cfi);
925 }
926 
927 /* Entry point for saving a register to the stack.  REG is the GCC register
928    number.  LABEL and OFFSET are passed to reg_save.  */
929 
930 void
dwarf2out_reg_save(const char * label,unsigned int reg,HOST_WIDE_INT offset)931 dwarf2out_reg_save (const char *label, unsigned int reg, HOST_WIDE_INT offset)
932 {
933   reg_save (label, DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (reg), INVALID_REGNUM, offset);
934 }
935 
936 /* Entry point for saving the return address in the stack.
937    LABEL and OFFSET are passed to reg_save.  */
938 
939 void
dwarf2out_return_save(const char * label,HOST_WIDE_INT offset)940 dwarf2out_return_save (const char *label, HOST_WIDE_INT offset)
941 {
942   reg_save (label, DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN, INVALID_REGNUM, offset);
943 }
944 
945 /* Entry point for saving the return address in a register.
946    LABEL and SREG are passed to reg_save.  */
947 
948 void
dwarf2out_return_reg(const char * label,unsigned int sreg)949 dwarf2out_return_reg (const char *label, unsigned int sreg)
950 {
951   reg_save (label, DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN, DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (sreg), 0);
952 }
953 
954 /* Record the initial position of the return address.  RTL is
955    INCOMING_RETURN_ADDR_RTX.  */
956 
957 static void
initial_return_save(rtx rtl)958 initial_return_save (rtx rtl)
959 {
960   unsigned int reg = INVALID_REGNUM;
961   HOST_WIDE_INT offset = 0;
962 
963   switch (GET_CODE (rtl))
964     {
965     case REG:
966       /* RA is in a register.  */
967       reg = DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (REGNO (rtl));
968       break;
969 
970     case MEM:
971       /* RA is on the stack.  */
972       rtl = XEXP (rtl, 0);
973       switch (GET_CODE (rtl))
974 	{
975 	case REG:
976 	  gcc_assert (REGNO (rtl) == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM);
977 	  offset = 0;
978 	  break;
979 
980 	case PLUS:
981 	  gcc_assert (REGNO (XEXP (rtl, 0)) == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM);
982 	  offset = INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 1));
983 	  break;
984 
985 	case MINUS:
986 	  gcc_assert (REGNO (XEXP (rtl, 0)) == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM);
987 	  offset = -INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 1));
988 	  break;
989 
990 	default:
991 	  gcc_unreachable ();
992 	}
993 
994       break;
995 
996     case PLUS:
997       /* The return address is at some offset from any value we can
998 	 actually load.  For instance, on the SPARC it is in %i7+8. Just
999 	 ignore the offset for now; it doesn't matter for unwinding frames.  */
1000       gcc_assert (GET_CODE (XEXP (rtl, 1)) == CONST_INT);
1001       initial_return_save (XEXP (rtl, 0));
1002       return;
1003 
1004     default:
1005       gcc_unreachable ();
1006     }
1007 
1008   if (reg != DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN)
1009     reg_save (NULL, DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN, reg, offset - cfa.offset);
1010 }
1011 
1012 /* Given a SET, calculate the amount of stack adjustment it
1013    contains.  */
1014 
1015 static HOST_WIDE_INT
stack_adjust_offset(rtx pattern)1016 stack_adjust_offset (rtx pattern)
1017 {
1018   rtx src = SET_SRC (pattern);
1019   rtx dest = SET_DEST (pattern);
1020   HOST_WIDE_INT offset = 0;
1021   enum rtx_code code;
1022 
1023   if (dest == stack_pointer_rtx)
1024     {
1025       /* (set (reg sp) (plus (reg sp) (const_int))) */
1026       code = GET_CODE (src);
1027       if (! (code == PLUS || code == MINUS)
1028 	  || XEXP (src, 0) != stack_pointer_rtx
1029 	  || GET_CODE (XEXP (src, 1)) != CONST_INT)
1030 	return 0;
1031 
1032       offset = INTVAL (XEXP (src, 1));
1033       if (code == PLUS)
1034 	offset = -offset;
1035     }
1036   else if (MEM_P (dest))
1037     {
1038       /* (set (mem (pre_dec (reg sp))) (foo)) */
1039       src = XEXP (dest, 0);
1040       code = GET_CODE (src);
1041 
1042       switch (code)
1043 	{
1044 	case PRE_MODIFY:
1045 	case POST_MODIFY:
1046 	  if (XEXP (src, 0) == stack_pointer_rtx)
1047 	    {
1048 	      rtx val = XEXP (XEXP (src, 1), 1);
1049 	      /* We handle only adjustments by constant amount.  */
1050 	      gcc_assert (GET_CODE (XEXP (src, 1)) == PLUS
1051 			  && GET_CODE (val) == CONST_INT);
1052 	      offset = -INTVAL (val);
1053 	      break;
1054 	    }
1055 	  return 0;
1056 
1057 	case PRE_DEC:
1058 	case POST_DEC:
1059 	  if (XEXP (src, 0) == stack_pointer_rtx)
1060 	    {
1061 	      offset = GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (dest));
1062 	      break;
1063 	    }
1064 	  return 0;
1065 
1066 	case PRE_INC:
1067 	case POST_INC:
1068 	  if (XEXP (src, 0) == stack_pointer_rtx)
1069 	    {
1070 	      offset = -GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (dest));
1071 	      break;
1072 	    }
1073 	  return 0;
1074 
1075 	default:
1076 	  return 0;
1077 	}
1078     }
1079   else
1080     return 0;
1081 
1082   return offset;
1083 }
1084 
1085 /* Check INSN to see if it looks like a push or a stack adjustment, and
1086    make a note of it if it does.  EH uses this information to find out how
1087    much extra space it needs to pop off the stack.  */
1088 
1089 static void
dwarf2out_stack_adjust(rtx insn,bool after_p)1090 dwarf2out_stack_adjust (rtx insn, bool after_p)
1091 {
1092   HOST_WIDE_INT offset;
1093   const char *label;
1094   int i;
1095 
1096   /* Don't handle epilogues at all.  Certainly it would be wrong to do so
1097      with this function.  Proper support would require all frame-related
1098      insns to be marked, and to be able to handle saving state around
1099      epilogues textually in the middle of the function.  */
1100   if (prologue_epilogue_contains (insn) || sibcall_epilogue_contains (insn))
1101     return;
1102 
1103   /* If only calls can throw, and we have a frame pointer,
1104      save up adjustments until we see the CALL_INSN.  */
1105   if (!flag_asynchronous_unwind_tables && cfa.reg != STACK_POINTER_REGNUM)
1106     {
1107       if (CALL_P (insn) && !after_p)
1108 	{
1109 	  /* Extract the size of the args from the CALL rtx itself.  */
1110 	  insn = PATTERN (insn);
1111 	  if (GET_CODE (insn) == PARALLEL)
1112 	    insn = XVECEXP (insn, 0, 0);
1113 	  if (GET_CODE (insn) == SET)
1114 	    insn = SET_SRC (insn);
1115 	  gcc_assert (GET_CODE (insn) == CALL);
1116 	  dwarf2out_args_size ("", INTVAL (XEXP (insn, 1)));
1117 	}
1118       return;
1119     }
1120 
1121   if (CALL_P (insn) && !after_p)
1122     {
1123       if (!flag_asynchronous_unwind_tables)
1124 	dwarf2out_args_size ("", args_size);
1125       return;
1126     }
1127   else if (BARRIER_P (insn))
1128     {
1129       /* When we see a BARRIER, we know to reset args_size to 0.  Usually
1130 	 the compiler will have already emitted a stack adjustment, but
1131 	 doesn't bother for calls to noreturn functions.  */
1132 #ifdef STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD
1133       offset = -args_size;
1134 #else
1135       offset = args_size;
1136 #endif
1137     }
1138   else if (GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) == SET)
1139     offset = stack_adjust_offset (PATTERN (insn));
1140   else if (GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) == PARALLEL
1141 	   || GET_CODE (PATTERN (insn)) == SEQUENCE)
1142     {
1143       /* There may be stack adjustments inside compound insns.  Search
1144 	 for them.  */
1145       for (offset = 0, i = XVECLEN (PATTERN (insn), 0) - 1; i >= 0; i--)
1146 	if (GET_CODE (XVECEXP (PATTERN (insn), 0, i)) == SET)
1147 	  offset += stack_adjust_offset (XVECEXP (PATTERN (insn), 0, i));
1148     }
1149   else
1150     return;
1151 
1152   if (offset == 0)
1153     return;
1154 
1155   if (cfa.reg == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM)
1156     cfa.offset += offset;
1157 
1158 #ifndef STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD
1159   offset = -offset;
1160 #endif
1161 
1162   args_size += offset;
1163   if (args_size < 0)
1164     args_size = 0;
1165 
1166   label = dwarf2out_cfi_label ();
1167   def_cfa_1 (label, &cfa);
1168   if (flag_asynchronous_unwind_tables)
1169     dwarf2out_args_size (label, args_size);
1170 }
1171 
1172 #endif
1173 
1174 /* We delay emitting a register save until either (a) we reach the end
1175    of the prologue or (b) the register is clobbered.  This clusters
1176    register saves so that there are fewer pc advances.  */
1177 
1178 struct queued_reg_save GTY(())
1179 {
1180   struct queued_reg_save *next;
1181   rtx reg;
1182   HOST_WIDE_INT cfa_offset;
1183   rtx saved_reg;
1184 };
1185 
1186 static GTY(()) struct queued_reg_save *queued_reg_saves;
1187 
1188 /* The caller's ORIG_REG is saved in SAVED_IN_REG.  */
1189 struct reg_saved_in_data GTY(()) {
1190   rtx orig_reg;
1191   rtx saved_in_reg;
1192 };
1193 
1194 /* A list of registers saved in other registers.
1195    The list intentionally has a small maximum capacity of 4; if your
1196    port needs more than that, you might consider implementing a
1197    more efficient data structure.  */
1198 static GTY(()) struct reg_saved_in_data regs_saved_in_regs[4];
1199 static GTY(()) size_t num_regs_saved_in_regs;
1200 
1201 #if defined (DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO) || defined (DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO)
1202 static const char *last_reg_save_label;
1203 
1204 /* Add an entry to QUEUED_REG_SAVES saying that REG is now saved at
1205    SREG, or if SREG is NULL then it is saved at OFFSET to the CFA.  */
1206 
1207 static void
queue_reg_save(const char * label,rtx reg,rtx sreg,HOST_WIDE_INT offset)1208 queue_reg_save (const char *label, rtx reg, rtx sreg, HOST_WIDE_INT offset)
1209 {
1210   struct queued_reg_save *q;
1211 
1212   /* Duplicates waste space, but it's also necessary to remove them
1213      for correctness, since the queue gets output in reverse
1214      order.  */
1215   for (q = queued_reg_saves; q != NULL; q = q->next)
1216     if (REGNO (q->reg) == REGNO (reg))
1217       break;
1218 
1219   if (q == NULL)
1220     {
1221       q = ggc_alloc (sizeof (*q));
1222       q->next = queued_reg_saves;
1223       queued_reg_saves = q;
1224     }
1225 
1226   q->reg = reg;
1227   q->cfa_offset = offset;
1228   q->saved_reg = sreg;
1229 
1230   last_reg_save_label = label;
1231 }
1232 
1233 /* Output all the entries in QUEUED_REG_SAVES.  */
1234 
1235 static void
flush_queued_reg_saves(void)1236 flush_queued_reg_saves (void)
1237 {
1238   struct queued_reg_save *q;
1239 
1240   for (q = queued_reg_saves; q; q = q->next)
1241     {
1242       size_t i;
1243       unsigned int reg, sreg;
1244 
1245       for (i = 0; i < num_regs_saved_in_regs; i++)
1246 	if (REGNO (regs_saved_in_regs[i].orig_reg) == REGNO (q->reg))
1247 	  break;
1248       if (q->saved_reg && i == num_regs_saved_in_regs)
1249 	{
1250 	  gcc_assert (i != ARRAY_SIZE (regs_saved_in_regs));
1251 	  num_regs_saved_in_regs++;
1252 	}
1253       if (i != num_regs_saved_in_regs)
1254 	{
1255 	  regs_saved_in_regs[i].orig_reg = q->reg;
1256 	  regs_saved_in_regs[i].saved_in_reg = q->saved_reg;
1257 	}
1258 
1259       reg = DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (REGNO (q->reg));
1260       if (q->saved_reg)
1261 	sreg = DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (REGNO (q->saved_reg));
1262       else
1263 	sreg = INVALID_REGNUM;
1264       reg_save (last_reg_save_label, reg, sreg, q->cfa_offset);
1265     }
1266 
1267   queued_reg_saves = NULL;
1268   last_reg_save_label = NULL;
1269 }
1270 
1271 /* Does INSN clobber any register which QUEUED_REG_SAVES lists a saved
1272    location for?  Or, does it clobber a register which we've previously
1273    said that some other register is saved in, and for which we now
1274    have a new location for?  */
1275 
1276 static bool
clobbers_queued_reg_save(rtx insn)1277 clobbers_queued_reg_save (rtx insn)
1278 {
1279   struct queued_reg_save *q;
1280 
1281   for (q = queued_reg_saves; q; q = q->next)
1282     {
1283       size_t i;
1284       if (modified_in_p (q->reg, insn))
1285 	return true;
1286       for (i = 0; i < num_regs_saved_in_regs; i++)
1287 	if (REGNO (q->reg) == REGNO (regs_saved_in_regs[i].orig_reg)
1288 	    && modified_in_p (regs_saved_in_regs[i].saved_in_reg, insn))
1289 	  return true;
1290     }
1291 
1292   return false;
1293 }
1294 
1295 /* Entry point for saving the first register into the second.  */
1296 
1297 void
dwarf2out_reg_save_reg(const char * label,rtx reg,rtx sreg)1298 dwarf2out_reg_save_reg (const char *label, rtx reg, rtx sreg)
1299 {
1300   size_t i;
1301   unsigned int regno, sregno;
1302 
1303   for (i = 0; i < num_regs_saved_in_regs; i++)
1304     if (REGNO (regs_saved_in_regs[i].orig_reg) == REGNO (reg))
1305       break;
1306   if (i == num_regs_saved_in_regs)
1307     {
1308       gcc_assert (i != ARRAY_SIZE (regs_saved_in_regs));
1309       num_regs_saved_in_regs++;
1310     }
1311   regs_saved_in_regs[i].orig_reg = reg;
1312   regs_saved_in_regs[i].saved_in_reg = sreg;
1313 
1314   regno = DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (REGNO (reg));
1315   sregno = DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (REGNO (sreg));
1316   reg_save (label, regno, sregno, 0);
1317 }
1318 
1319 /* What register, if any, is currently saved in REG?  */
1320 
1321 static rtx
reg_saved_in(rtx reg)1322 reg_saved_in (rtx reg)
1323 {
1324   unsigned int regn = REGNO (reg);
1325   size_t i;
1326   struct queued_reg_save *q;
1327 
1328   for (q = queued_reg_saves; q; q = q->next)
1329     if (q->saved_reg && regn == REGNO (q->saved_reg))
1330       return q->reg;
1331 
1332   for (i = 0; i < num_regs_saved_in_regs; i++)
1333     if (regs_saved_in_regs[i].saved_in_reg
1334 	&& regn == REGNO (regs_saved_in_regs[i].saved_in_reg))
1335       return regs_saved_in_regs[i].orig_reg;
1336 
1337   return NULL_RTX;
1338 }
1339 
1340 
1341 /* A temporary register holding an integral value used in adjusting SP
1342    or setting up the store_reg.  The "offset" field holds the integer
1343    value, not an offset.  */
1344 static dw_cfa_location cfa_temp;
1345 
1346 /* Record call frame debugging information for an expression EXPR,
1347    which either sets SP or FP (adjusting how we calculate the frame
1348    address) or saves a register to the stack or another register.
1349    LABEL indicates the address of EXPR.
1350 
1351    This function encodes a state machine mapping rtxes to actions on
1352    cfa, cfa_store, and cfa_temp.reg.  We describe these rules so
1353    users need not read the source code.
1354 
1355   The High-Level Picture
1356 
1357   Changes in the register we use to calculate the CFA: Currently we
1358   assume that if you copy the CFA register into another register, we
1359   should take the other one as the new CFA register; this seems to
1360   work pretty well.  If it's wrong for some target, it's simple
1361   enough not to set RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P on the insn in question.
1362 
1363   Changes in the register we use for saving registers to the stack:
1364   This is usually SP, but not always.  Again, we deduce that if you
1365   copy SP into another register (and SP is not the CFA register),
1366   then the new register is the one we will be using for register
1367   saves.  This also seems to work.
1368 
1369   Register saves: There's not much guesswork about this one; if
1370   RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P is set on an insn which modifies memory, it's a
1371   register save, and the register used to calculate the destination
1372   had better be the one we think we're using for this purpose.
1373   It's also assumed that a copy from a call-saved register to another
1374   register is saving that register if RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P is set on
1375   that instruction.  If the copy is from a call-saved register to
1376   the *same* register, that means that the register is now the same
1377   value as in the caller.
1378 
1379   Except: If the register being saved is the CFA register, and the
1380   offset is nonzero, we are saving the CFA, so we assume we have to
1381   use DW_CFA_def_cfa_expression.  If the offset is 0, we assume that
1382   the intent is to save the value of SP from the previous frame.
1383 
1384   In addition, if a register has previously been saved to a different
1385   register,
1386 
1387   Invariants / Summaries of Rules
1388 
1389   cfa	       current rule for calculating the CFA.  It usually
1390 	       consists of a register and an offset.
1391   cfa_store    register used by prologue code to save things to the stack
1392 	       cfa_store.offset is the offset from the value of
1393 	       cfa_store.reg to the actual CFA
1394   cfa_temp     register holding an integral value.  cfa_temp.offset
1395 	       stores the value, which will be used to adjust the
1396 	       stack pointer.  cfa_temp is also used like cfa_store,
1397 	       to track stores to the stack via fp or a temp reg.
1398 
1399   Rules  1- 4: Setting a register's value to cfa.reg or an expression
1400 	       with cfa.reg as the first operand changes the cfa.reg and its
1401 	       cfa.offset.  Rule 1 and 4 also set cfa_temp.reg and
1402 	       cfa_temp.offset.
1403 
1404   Rules  6- 9: Set a non-cfa.reg register value to a constant or an
1405 	       expression yielding a constant.  This sets cfa_temp.reg
1406 	       and cfa_temp.offset.
1407 
1408   Rule 5:      Create a new register cfa_store used to save items to the
1409 	       stack.
1410 
1411   Rules 10-14: Save a register to the stack.  Define offset as the
1412 	       difference of the original location and cfa_store's
1413 	       location (or cfa_temp's location if cfa_temp is used).
1414 
1415   The Rules
1416 
1417   "{a,b}" indicates a choice of a xor b.
1418   "<reg>:cfa.reg" indicates that <reg> must equal cfa.reg.
1419 
1420   Rule 1:
1421   (set <reg1> <reg2>:cfa.reg)
1422   effects: cfa.reg = <reg1>
1423 	   cfa.offset unchanged
1424 	   cfa_temp.reg = <reg1>
1425 	   cfa_temp.offset = cfa.offset
1426 
1427   Rule 2:
1428   (set sp ({minus,plus,losum} {sp,fp}:cfa.reg
1429 			      {<const_int>,<reg>:cfa_temp.reg}))
1430   effects: cfa.reg = sp if fp used
1431 	   cfa.offset += {+/- <const_int>, cfa_temp.offset} if cfa.reg==sp
1432 	   cfa_store.offset += {+/- <const_int>, cfa_temp.offset}
1433 	     if cfa_store.reg==sp
1434 
1435   Rule 3:
1436   (set fp ({minus,plus,losum} <reg>:cfa.reg <const_int>))
1437   effects: cfa.reg = fp
1438 	   cfa_offset += +/- <const_int>
1439 
1440   Rule 4:
1441   (set <reg1> ({plus,losum} <reg2>:cfa.reg <const_int>))
1442   constraints: <reg1> != fp
1443 	       <reg1> != sp
1444   effects: cfa.reg = <reg1>
1445 	   cfa_temp.reg = <reg1>
1446 	   cfa_temp.offset = cfa.offset
1447 
1448   Rule 5:
1449   (set <reg1> (plus <reg2>:cfa_temp.reg sp:cfa.reg))
1450   constraints: <reg1> != fp
1451 	       <reg1> != sp
1452   effects: cfa_store.reg = <reg1>
1453 	   cfa_store.offset = cfa.offset - cfa_temp.offset
1454 
1455   Rule 6:
1456   (set <reg> <const_int>)
1457   effects: cfa_temp.reg = <reg>
1458 	   cfa_temp.offset = <const_int>
1459 
1460   Rule 7:
1461   (set <reg1>:cfa_temp.reg (ior <reg2>:cfa_temp.reg <const_int>))
1462   effects: cfa_temp.reg = <reg1>
1463 	   cfa_temp.offset |= <const_int>
1464 
1465   Rule 8:
1466   (set <reg> (high <exp>))
1467   effects: none
1468 
1469   Rule 9:
1470   (set <reg> (lo_sum <exp> <const_int>))
1471   effects: cfa_temp.reg = <reg>
1472 	   cfa_temp.offset = <const_int>
1473 
1474   Rule 10:
1475   (set (mem (pre_modify sp:cfa_store (???? <reg1> <const_int>))) <reg2>)
1476   effects: cfa_store.offset -= <const_int>
1477 	   cfa.offset = cfa_store.offset if cfa.reg == sp
1478 	   cfa.reg = sp
1479 	   cfa.base_offset = -cfa_store.offset
1480 
1481   Rule 11:
1482   (set (mem ({pre_inc,pre_dec} sp:cfa_store.reg)) <reg>)
1483   effects: cfa_store.offset += -/+ mode_size(mem)
1484 	   cfa.offset = cfa_store.offset if cfa.reg == sp
1485 	   cfa.reg = sp
1486 	   cfa.base_offset = -cfa_store.offset
1487 
1488   Rule 12:
1489   (set (mem ({minus,plus,losum} <reg1>:{cfa_store,cfa_temp} <const_int>))
1490 
1491        <reg2>)
1492   effects: cfa.reg = <reg1>
1493 	   cfa.base_offset = -/+ <const_int> - {cfa_store,cfa_temp}.offset
1494 
1495   Rule 13:
1496   (set (mem <reg1>:{cfa_store,cfa_temp}) <reg2>)
1497   effects: cfa.reg = <reg1>
1498 	   cfa.base_offset = -{cfa_store,cfa_temp}.offset
1499 
1500   Rule 14:
1501   (set (mem (postinc <reg1>:cfa_temp <const_int>)) <reg2>)
1502   effects: cfa.reg = <reg1>
1503 	   cfa.base_offset = -cfa_temp.offset
1504 	   cfa_temp.offset -= mode_size(mem)
1505 
1506   Rule 15:
1507   (set <reg> {unspec, unspec_volatile})
1508   effects: target-dependent  */
1509 
1510 static void
dwarf2out_frame_debug_expr(rtx expr,const char * label)1511 dwarf2out_frame_debug_expr (rtx expr, const char *label)
1512 {
1513   rtx src, dest;
1514   HOST_WIDE_INT offset;
1515 
1516   /* If RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P is set on a PARALLEL, process each member of
1517      the PARALLEL independently. The first element is always processed if
1518      it is a SET. This is for backward compatibility.   Other elements
1519      are processed only if they are SETs and the RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P
1520      flag is set in them.  */
1521   if (GET_CODE (expr) == PARALLEL || GET_CODE (expr) == SEQUENCE)
1522     {
1523       int par_index;
1524       int limit = XVECLEN (expr, 0);
1525 
1526       for (par_index = 0; par_index < limit; par_index++)
1527 	if (GET_CODE (XVECEXP (expr, 0, par_index)) == SET
1528 	    && (RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P (XVECEXP (expr, 0, par_index))
1529 		|| par_index == 0))
1530 	  dwarf2out_frame_debug_expr (XVECEXP (expr, 0, par_index), label);
1531 
1532       return;
1533     }
1534 
1535   gcc_assert (GET_CODE (expr) == SET);
1536 
1537   src = SET_SRC (expr);
1538   dest = SET_DEST (expr);
1539 
1540   if (REG_P (src))
1541     {
1542       rtx rsi = reg_saved_in (src);
1543       if (rsi)
1544 	src = rsi;
1545     }
1546 
1547   switch (GET_CODE (dest))
1548     {
1549     case REG:
1550       switch (GET_CODE (src))
1551 	{
1552 	  /* Setting FP from SP.  */
1553 	case REG:
1554 	  if (cfa.reg == (unsigned) REGNO (src))
1555 	    {
1556 	      /* Rule 1 */
1557 	      /* Update the CFA rule wrt SP or FP.  Make sure src is
1558 		 relative to the current CFA register.
1559 
1560 		 We used to require that dest be either SP or FP, but the
1561 		 ARM copies SP to a temporary register, and from there to
1562 		 FP.  So we just rely on the backends to only set
1563 		 RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P on appropriate insns.  */
1564 	      cfa.reg = REGNO (dest);
1565 	      cfa_temp.reg = cfa.reg;
1566 	      cfa_temp.offset = cfa.offset;
1567 	    }
1568 	  else
1569 	    {
1570 	      /* Saving a register in a register.  */
1571 	      gcc_assert (!fixed_regs [REGNO (dest)]
1572 			  /* For the SPARC and its register window.  */
1573 			  || (DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (REGNO (src))
1574 			      == DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN));
1575 	      queue_reg_save (label, src, dest, 0);
1576 	    }
1577 	  break;
1578 
1579 	case PLUS:
1580 	case MINUS:
1581 	case LO_SUM:
1582 	  if (dest == stack_pointer_rtx)
1583 	    {
1584 	      /* Rule 2 */
1585 	      /* Adjusting SP.  */
1586 	      switch (GET_CODE (XEXP (src, 1)))
1587 		{
1588 		case CONST_INT:
1589 		  offset = INTVAL (XEXP (src, 1));
1590 		  break;
1591 		case REG:
1592 		  gcc_assert ((unsigned) REGNO (XEXP (src, 1))
1593 			      == cfa_temp.reg);
1594 		  offset = cfa_temp.offset;
1595 		  break;
1596 		default:
1597 		  gcc_unreachable ();
1598 		}
1599 
1600 	      if (XEXP (src, 0) == hard_frame_pointer_rtx)
1601 		{
1602 		  /* Restoring SP from FP in the epilogue.  */
1603 		  gcc_assert (cfa.reg == (unsigned) HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM);
1604 		  cfa.reg = STACK_POINTER_REGNUM;
1605 		}
1606 	      else if (GET_CODE (src) == LO_SUM)
1607 		/* Assume we've set the source reg of the LO_SUM from sp.  */
1608 		;
1609 	      else
1610 		gcc_assert (XEXP (src, 0) == stack_pointer_rtx);
1611 
1612 	      if (GET_CODE (src) != MINUS)
1613 		offset = -offset;
1614 	      if (cfa.reg == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM)
1615 		cfa.offset += offset;
1616 	      if (cfa_store.reg == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM)
1617 		cfa_store.offset += offset;
1618 	    }
1619 	  else if (dest == hard_frame_pointer_rtx)
1620 	    {
1621 	      /* Rule 3 */
1622 	      /* Either setting the FP from an offset of the SP,
1623 		 or adjusting the FP */
1624 	      gcc_assert (frame_pointer_needed);
1625 
1626 	      gcc_assert (REG_P (XEXP (src, 0))
1627 			  && (unsigned) REGNO (XEXP (src, 0)) == cfa.reg
1628 			  && GET_CODE (XEXP (src, 1)) == CONST_INT);
1629 	      offset = INTVAL (XEXP (src, 1));
1630 	      if (GET_CODE (src) != MINUS)
1631 		offset = -offset;
1632 	      cfa.offset += offset;
1633 	      cfa.reg = HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM;
1634 	    }
1635 	  else
1636 	    {
1637 	      gcc_assert (GET_CODE (src) != MINUS);
1638 
1639 	      /* Rule 4 */
1640 	      if (REG_P (XEXP (src, 0))
1641 		  && REGNO (XEXP (src, 0)) == cfa.reg
1642 		  && GET_CODE (XEXP (src, 1)) == CONST_INT)
1643 		{
1644 		  /* Setting a temporary CFA register that will be copied
1645 		     into the FP later on.  */
1646 		  offset = - INTVAL (XEXP (src, 1));
1647 		  cfa.offset += offset;
1648 		  cfa.reg = REGNO (dest);
1649 		  /* Or used to save regs to the stack.  */
1650 		  cfa_temp.reg = cfa.reg;
1651 		  cfa_temp.offset = cfa.offset;
1652 		}
1653 
1654 	      /* Rule 5 */
1655 	      else if (REG_P (XEXP (src, 0))
1656 		       && REGNO (XEXP (src, 0)) == cfa_temp.reg
1657 		       && XEXP (src, 1) == stack_pointer_rtx)
1658 		{
1659 		  /* Setting a scratch register that we will use instead
1660 		     of SP for saving registers to the stack.  */
1661 		  gcc_assert (cfa.reg == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM);
1662 		  cfa_store.reg = REGNO (dest);
1663 		  cfa_store.offset = cfa.offset - cfa_temp.offset;
1664 		}
1665 
1666 	      /* Rule 9 */
1667 	      else if (GET_CODE (src) == LO_SUM
1668 		       && GET_CODE (XEXP (src, 1)) == CONST_INT)
1669 		{
1670 		  cfa_temp.reg = REGNO (dest);
1671 		  cfa_temp.offset = INTVAL (XEXP (src, 1));
1672 		}
1673 	      else
1674 		gcc_unreachable ();
1675 	    }
1676 	  break;
1677 
1678 	  /* Rule 6 */
1679 	case CONST_INT:
1680 	  cfa_temp.reg = REGNO (dest);
1681 	  cfa_temp.offset = INTVAL (src);
1682 	  break;
1683 
1684 	  /* Rule 7 */
1685 	case IOR:
1686 	  gcc_assert (REG_P (XEXP (src, 0))
1687 		      && (unsigned) REGNO (XEXP (src, 0)) == cfa_temp.reg
1688 		      && GET_CODE (XEXP (src, 1)) == CONST_INT);
1689 
1690 	  if ((unsigned) REGNO (dest) != cfa_temp.reg)
1691 	    cfa_temp.reg = REGNO (dest);
1692 	  cfa_temp.offset |= INTVAL (XEXP (src, 1));
1693 	  break;
1694 
1695 	  /* Skip over HIGH, assuming it will be followed by a LO_SUM,
1696 	     which will fill in all of the bits.  */
1697 	  /* Rule 8 */
1698 	case HIGH:
1699 	  break;
1700 
1701 	  /* Rule 15 */
1702 	case UNSPEC:
1703 	case UNSPEC_VOLATILE:
1704 	  gcc_assert (targetm.dwarf_handle_frame_unspec);
1705 	  targetm.dwarf_handle_frame_unspec (label, expr, XINT (src, 1));
1706 	  return;
1707 
1708 	default:
1709 	  gcc_unreachable ();
1710 	}
1711 
1712       def_cfa_1 (label, &cfa);
1713       break;
1714 
1715     case MEM:
1716       gcc_assert (REG_P (src));
1717 
1718       /* Saving a register to the stack.  Make sure dest is relative to the
1719 	 CFA register.  */
1720       switch (GET_CODE (XEXP (dest, 0)))
1721 	{
1722 	  /* Rule 10 */
1723 	  /* With a push.  */
1724 	case PRE_MODIFY:
1725 	  /* We can't handle variable size modifications.  */
1726 	  gcc_assert (GET_CODE (XEXP (XEXP (XEXP (dest, 0), 1), 1))
1727 		      == CONST_INT);
1728 	  offset = -INTVAL (XEXP (XEXP (XEXP (dest, 0), 1), 1));
1729 
1730 	  gcc_assert (REGNO (XEXP (XEXP (dest, 0), 0)) == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM
1731 		      && cfa_store.reg == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM);
1732 
1733 	  cfa_store.offset += offset;
1734 	  if (cfa.reg == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM)
1735 	    cfa.offset = cfa_store.offset;
1736 
1737 	  offset = -cfa_store.offset;
1738 	  break;
1739 
1740 	  /* Rule 11 */
1741 	case PRE_INC:
1742 	case PRE_DEC:
1743 	  offset = GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (dest));
1744 	  if (GET_CODE (XEXP (dest, 0)) == PRE_INC)
1745 	    offset = -offset;
1746 
1747 	  gcc_assert (REGNO (XEXP (XEXP (dest, 0), 0)) == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM
1748 		      && cfa_store.reg == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM);
1749 
1750 	  cfa_store.offset += offset;
1751 	  if (cfa.reg == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM)
1752 	    cfa.offset = cfa_store.offset;
1753 
1754 	  offset = -cfa_store.offset;
1755 	  break;
1756 
1757 	  /* Rule 12 */
1758 	  /* With an offset.  */
1759 	case PLUS:
1760 	case MINUS:
1761 	case LO_SUM:
1762 	  {
1763 	    int regno;
1764 
1765 	    gcc_assert (GET_CODE (XEXP (XEXP (dest, 0), 1)) == CONST_INT
1766 			&& REG_P (XEXP (XEXP (dest, 0), 0)));
1767 	    offset = INTVAL (XEXP (XEXP (dest, 0), 1));
1768 	    if (GET_CODE (XEXP (dest, 0)) == MINUS)
1769 	      offset = -offset;
1770 
1771 	    regno = REGNO (XEXP (XEXP (dest, 0), 0));
1772 
1773 	    if (cfa_store.reg == (unsigned) regno)
1774 	      offset -= cfa_store.offset;
1775 	    else
1776 	      {
1777 		gcc_assert (cfa_temp.reg == (unsigned) regno);
1778 		offset -= cfa_temp.offset;
1779 	      }
1780 	  }
1781 	  break;
1782 
1783 	  /* Rule 13 */
1784 	  /* Without an offset.  */
1785 	case REG:
1786 	  {
1787 	    int regno = REGNO (XEXP (dest, 0));
1788 
1789 	    if (cfa_store.reg == (unsigned) regno)
1790 	      offset = -cfa_store.offset;
1791 	    else
1792 	      {
1793 		gcc_assert (cfa_temp.reg == (unsigned) regno);
1794 		offset = -cfa_temp.offset;
1795 	      }
1796 	  }
1797 	  break;
1798 
1799 	  /* Rule 14 */
1800 	case POST_INC:
1801 	  gcc_assert (cfa_temp.reg
1802 		      == (unsigned) REGNO (XEXP (XEXP (dest, 0), 0)));
1803 	  offset = -cfa_temp.offset;
1804 	  cfa_temp.offset -= GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (dest));
1805 	  break;
1806 
1807 	default:
1808 	  gcc_unreachable ();
1809 	}
1810 
1811       if (REGNO (src) != STACK_POINTER_REGNUM
1812 	  && REGNO (src) != HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
1813 	  && (unsigned) REGNO (src) == cfa.reg)
1814 	{
1815 	  /* We're storing the current CFA reg into the stack.  */
1816 
1817 	  if (cfa.offset == 0)
1818 	    {
1819 	      /* If the source register is exactly the CFA, assume
1820 		 we're saving SP like any other register; this happens
1821 		 on the ARM.  */
1822 	      def_cfa_1 (label, &cfa);
1823 	      queue_reg_save (label, stack_pointer_rtx, NULL_RTX, offset);
1824 	      break;
1825 	    }
1826 	  else
1827 	    {
1828 	      /* Otherwise, we'll need to look in the stack to
1829 		 calculate the CFA.  */
1830 	      rtx x = XEXP (dest, 0);
1831 
1832 	      if (!REG_P (x))
1833 		x = XEXP (x, 0);
1834 	      gcc_assert (REG_P (x));
1835 
1836 	      cfa.reg = REGNO (x);
1837 	      cfa.base_offset = offset;
1838 	      cfa.indirect = 1;
1839 	      def_cfa_1 (label, &cfa);
1840 	      break;
1841 	    }
1842 	}
1843 
1844       def_cfa_1 (label, &cfa);
1845       queue_reg_save (label, src, NULL_RTX, offset);
1846       break;
1847 
1848     default:
1849       gcc_unreachable ();
1850     }
1851 }
1852 
1853 /* Record call frame debugging information for INSN, which either
1854    sets SP or FP (adjusting how we calculate the frame address) or saves a
1855    register to the stack.  If INSN is NULL_RTX, initialize our state.
1856 
1857    If AFTER_P is false, we're being called before the insn is emitted,
1858    otherwise after.  Call instructions get invoked twice.  */
1859 
1860 void
dwarf2out_frame_debug(rtx insn,bool after_p)1861 dwarf2out_frame_debug (rtx insn, bool after_p)
1862 {
1863   const char *label;
1864   rtx src;
1865 
1866   if (insn == NULL_RTX)
1867     {
1868       size_t i;
1869 
1870       /* Flush any queued register saves.  */
1871       flush_queued_reg_saves ();
1872 
1873       /* Set up state for generating call frame debug info.  */
1874       lookup_cfa (&cfa);
1875       gcc_assert (cfa.reg
1876 		  == (unsigned long)DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (STACK_POINTER_REGNUM));
1877 
1878       cfa.reg = STACK_POINTER_REGNUM;
1879       cfa_store = cfa;
1880       cfa_temp.reg = -1;
1881       cfa_temp.offset = 0;
1882 
1883       for (i = 0; i < num_regs_saved_in_regs; i++)
1884 	{
1885 	  regs_saved_in_regs[i].orig_reg = NULL_RTX;
1886 	  regs_saved_in_regs[i].saved_in_reg = NULL_RTX;
1887 	}
1888       num_regs_saved_in_regs = 0;
1889       return;
1890     }
1891 
1892   if (!NONJUMP_INSN_P (insn) || clobbers_queued_reg_save (insn))
1893     flush_queued_reg_saves ();
1894 
1895   if (! RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P (insn))
1896     {
1897       if (!ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS)
1898 	dwarf2out_stack_adjust (insn, after_p);
1899       return;
1900     }
1901 
1902   label = dwarf2out_cfi_label ();
1903   src = find_reg_note (insn, REG_FRAME_RELATED_EXPR, NULL_RTX);
1904   if (src)
1905     insn = XEXP (src, 0);
1906   else
1907     insn = PATTERN (insn);
1908 
1909   dwarf2out_frame_debug_expr (insn, label);
1910 }
1911 
1912 #endif
1913 
1914 /* Describe for the GTY machinery what parts of dw_cfi_oprnd1 are used.  */
1915 static enum dw_cfi_oprnd_type dw_cfi_oprnd1_desc
1916  (enum dwarf_call_frame_info cfi);
1917 
1918 static enum dw_cfi_oprnd_type
dw_cfi_oprnd1_desc(enum dwarf_call_frame_info cfi)1919 dw_cfi_oprnd1_desc (enum dwarf_call_frame_info cfi)
1920 {
1921   switch (cfi)
1922     {
1923     case DW_CFA_nop:
1924     case DW_CFA_GNU_window_save:
1925       return dw_cfi_oprnd_unused;
1926 
1927     case DW_CFA_set_loc:
1928     case DW_CFA_advance_loc1:
1929     case DW_CFA_advance_loc2:
1930     case DW_CFA_advance_loc4:
1931     case DW_CFA_MIPS_advance_loc8:
1932       return dw_cfi_oprnd_addr;
1933 
1934     case DW_CFA_offset:
1935     case DW_CFA_offset_extended:
1936     case DW_CFA_def_cfa:
1937     case DW_CFA_offset_extended_sf:
1938     case DW_CFA_def_cfa_sf:
1939     case DW_CFA_restore_extended:
1940     case DW_CFA_undefined:
1941     case DW_CFA_same_value:
1942     case DW_CFA_def_cfa_register:
1943     case DW_CFA_register:
1944       return dw_cfi_oprnd_reg_num;
1945 
1946     case DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset:
1947     case DW_CFA_GNU_args_size:
1948     case DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset_sf:
1949       return dw_cfi_oprnd_offset;
1950 
1951     case DW_CFA_def_cfa_expression:
1952     case DW_CFA_expression:
1953       return dw_cfi_oprnd_loc;
1954 
1955     default:
1956       gcc_unreachable ();
1957     }
1958 }
1959 
1960 /* Describe for the GTY machinery what parts of dw_cfi_oprnd2 are used.  */
1961 static enum dw_cfi_oprnd_type dw_cfi_oprnd2_desc
1962  (enum dwarf_call_frame_info cfi);
1963 
1964 static enum dw_cfi_oprnd_type
dw_cfi_oprnd2_desc(enum dwarf_call_frame_info cfi)1965 dw_cfi_oprnd2_desc (enum dwarf_call_frame_info cfi)
1966 {
1967   switch (cfi)
1968     {
1969     case DW_CFA_def_cfa:
1970     case DW_CFA_def_cfa_sf:
1971     case DW_CFA_offset:
1972     case DW_CFA_offset_extended_sf:
1973     case DW_CFA_offset_extended:
1974       return dw_cfi_oprnd_offset;
1975 
1976     case DW_CFA_register:
1977       return dw_cfi_oprnd_reg_num;
1978 
1979     default:
1980       return dw_cfi_oprnd_unused;
1981     }
1982 }
1983 
1984 #if defined (DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO) || defined (DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO)
1985 
1986 /* Switch to eh_frame_section.  If we don't have an eh_frame_section,
1987    switch to the data section instead, and write out a synthetic label
1988    for collect2.  */
1989 
1990 static void
switch_to_eh_frame_section(void)1991 switch_to_eh_frame_section (void)
1992 {
1993   tree label;
1994 
1995 #ifdef EH_FRAME_SECTION_NAME
1996   if (eh_frame_section == 0)
1997     {
1998       int flags;
1999 
2000       if (EH_TABLES_CAN_BE_READ_ONLY)
2001 	{
2002 	  int fde_encoding;
2003 	  int per_encoding;
2004 	  int lsda_encoding;
2005 
2006 	  fde_encoding = ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (/*code=*/1,
2007 						       /*global=*/0);
2008 	  per_encoding = ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (/*code=*/2,
2009 						       /*global=*/1);
2010 	  lsda_encoding = ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (/*code=*/0,
2011 							/*global=*/0);
2012 	  flags = ((! flag_pic
2013 		    || ((fde_encoding & 0x70) != DW_EH_PE_absptr
2014 			&& (fde_encoding & 0x70) != DW_EH_PE_aligned
2015 			&& (per_encoding & 0x70) != DW_EH_PE_absptr
2016 			&& (per_encoding & 0x70) != DW_EH_PE_aligned
2017 			&& (lsda_encoding & 0x70) != DW_EH_PE_absptr
2018 			&& (lsda_encoding & 0x70) != DW_EH_PE_aligned))
2019 		   ? 0 : SECTION_WRITE);
2020 	}
2021       else
2022 	flags = SECTION_WRITE;
2023       eh_frame_section = get_section (EH_FRAME_SECTION_NAME, flags, NULL);
2024     }
2025 #endif
2026 
2027   if (eh_frame_section)
2028     switch_to_section (eh_frame_section);
2029   else
2030     {
2031       /* We have no special eh_frame section.  Put the information in
2032 	 the data section and emit special labels to guide collect2.  */
2033       switch_to_section (data_section);
2034       label = get_file_function_name ("F");
2035       ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN (asm_out_file, floor_log2 (PTR_SIZE));
2036       targetm.asm_out.globalize_label (asm_out_file,
2037 				       IDENTIFIER_POINTER (label));
2038       ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, IDENTIFIER_POINTER (label));
2039     }
2040 }
2041 
2042 /* Output a Call Frame Information opcode and its operand(s).  */
2043 
2044 static void
output_cfi(dw_cfi_ref cfi,dw_fde_ref fde,int for_eh)2045 output_cfi (dw_cfi_ref cfi, dw_fde_ref fde, int for_eh)
2046 {
2047   unsigned long r;
2048   if (cfi->dw_cfi_opc == DW_CFA_advance_loc)
2049     dw2_asm_output_data (1, (cfi->dw_cfi_opc
2050 			     | (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_offset & 0x3f)),
2051 			 "DW_CFA_advance_loc " HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_HEX,
2052 			 cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_offset);
2053   else if (cfi->dw_cfi_opc == DW_CFA_offset)
2054     {
2055       r = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num, for_eh);
2056       dw2_asm_output_data (1, (cfi->dw_cfi_opc | (r & 0x3f)),
2057 			   "DW_CFA_offset, column 0x%lx", r);
2058       dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd2.dw_cfi_offset, NULL);
2059     }
2060   else if (cfi->dw_cfi_opc == DW_CFA_restore)
2061     {
2062       r = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num, for_eh);
2063       dw2_asm_output_data (1, (cfi->dw_cfi_opc | (r & 0x3f)),
2064 			   "DW_CFA_restore, column 0x%lx", r);
2065     }
2066   else
2067     {
2068       dw2_asm_output_data (1, cfi->dw_cfi_opc,
2069 			   "%s", dwarf_cfi_name (cfi->dw_cfi_opc));
2070 
2071       switch (cfi->dw_cfi_opc)
2072 	{
2073 	case DW_CFA_set_loc:
2074 	  if (for_eh)
2075 	    dw2_asm_output_encoded_addr_rtx (
2076 		ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (/*code=*/1, /*global=*/0),
2077 		gen_rtx_SYMBOL_REF (Pmode, cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_addr),
2078 		false, NULL);
2079 	  else
2080 	    dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE,
2081 				 cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_addr, NULL);
2082 	  fde->dw_fde_current_label = cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_addr;
2083 	  break;
2084 
2085 	case DW_CFA_advance_loc1:
2086 	  dw2_asm_output_delta (1, cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_addr,
2087 				fde->dw_fde_current_label, NULL);
2088 	  fde->dw_fde_current_label = cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_addr;
2089 	  break;
2090 
2091 	case DW_CFA_advance_loc2:
2092 	  dw2_asm_output_delta (2, cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_addr,
2093 				fde->dw_fde_current_label, NULL);
2094 	  fde->dw_fde_current_label = cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_addr;
2095 	  break;
2096 
2097 	case DW_CFA_advance_loc4:
2098 	  dw2_asm_output_delta (4, cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_addr,
2099 				fde->dw_fde_current_label, NULL);
2100 	  fde->dw_fde_current_label = cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_addr;
2101 	  break;
2102 
2103 	case DW_CFA_MIPS_advance_loc8:
2104 	  dw2_asm_output_delta (8, cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_addr,
2105 				fde->dw_fde_current_label, NULL);
2106 	  fde->dw_fde_current_label = cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_addr;
2107 	  break;
2108 
2109 	case DW_CFA_offset_extended:
2110 	case DW_CFA_def_cfa:
2111 	  r = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num, for_eh);
2112 	  dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (r, NULL);
2113 	  dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd2.dw_cfi_offset, NULL);
2114 	  break;
2115 
2116 	case DW_CFA_offset_extended_sf:
2117 	case DW_CFA_def_cfa_sf:
2118 	  r = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num, for_eh);
2119 	  dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (r, NULL);
2120 	  dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd2.dw_cfi_offset, NULL);
2121 	  break;
2122 
2123 	case DW_CFA_restore_extended:
2124 	case DW_CFA_undefined:
2125 	case DW_CFA_same_value:
2126 	case DW_CFA_def_cfa_register:
2127 	  r = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num, for_eh);
2128 	  dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (r, NULL);
2129 	  break;
2130 
2131 	case DW_CFA_register:
2132 	  r = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_reg_num, for_eh);
2133 	  dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (r, NULL);
2134 	  r = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd2.dw_cfi_reg_num, for_eh);
2135 	  dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (r, NULL);
2136 	  break;
2137 
2138 	case DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset:
2139 	case DW_CFA_GNU_args_size:
2140 	  dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_offset, NULL);
2141 	  break;
2142 
2143 	case DW_CFA_def_cfa_offset_sf:
2144 	  dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_offset, NULL);
2145 	  break;
2146 
2147 	case DW_CFA_GNU_window_save:
2148 	  break;
2149 
2150 	case DW_CFA_def_cfa_expression:
2151 	case DW_CFA_expression:
2152 	  output_cfa_loc (cfi);
2153 	  break;
2154 
2155 	case DW_CFA_GNU_negative_offset_extended:
2156 	  /* Obsoleted by DW_CFA_offset_extended_sf.  */
2157 	  gcc_unreachable ();
2158 
2159 	default:
2160 	  break;
2161 	}
2162     }
2163 }
2164 
2165 /* Output the call frame information used to record information
2166    that relates to calculating the frame pointer, and records the
2167    location of saved registers.  */
2168 
2169 static void
output_call_frame_info(int for_eh)2170 output_call_frame_info (int for_eh)
2171 {
2172   unsigned int i;
2173   dw_fde_ref fde;
2174   dw_cfi_ref cfi;
2175   char l1[20], l2[20], section_start_label[20];
2176   bool any_lsda_needed = false;
2177   char augmentation[6];
2178   int augmentation_size;
2179   int fde_encoding = DW_EH_PE_absptr;
2180   int per_encoding = DW_EH_PE_absptr;
2181   int lsda_encoding = DW_EH_PE_absptr;
2182   int return_reg;
2183 
2184   /* Don't emit a CIE if there won't be any FDEs.  */
2185   if (fde_table_in_use == 0)
2186     return;
2187 
2188   /* If we make FDEs linkonce, we may have to emit an empty label for
2189      an FDE that wouldn't otherwise be emitted.  We want to avoid
2190      having an FDE kept around when the function it refers to is
2191      discarded.  Example where this matters: a primary function
2192      template in C++ requires EH information, but an explicit
2193      specialization doesn't.  */
2194   if (TARGET_USES_WEAK_UNWIND_INFO
2195       && ! flag_asynchronous_unwind_tables
2196 /* APPLE LOCAL begin for-fsf-4_4 5480287 */ \
2197       && flag_exceptions
2198 /* APPLE LOCAL end for-fsf-4_4 5480287 */ \
2199       && for_eh)
2200     for (i = 0; i < fde_table_in_use; i++)
2201       if ((fde_table[i].nothrow || fde_table[i].all_throwers_are_sibcalls)
2202           && !fde_table[i].uses_eh_lsda
2203 	  && ! DECL_WEAK (fde_table[i].decl))
2204 	targetm.asm_out.unwind_label (asm_out_file, fde_table[i].decl,
2205 				      for_eh, /* empty */ 1);
2206 
2207   /* If we don't have any functions we'll want to unwind out of, don't
2208      emit any EH unwind information.  Note that if exceptions aren't
2209      enabled, we won't have collected nothrow information, and if we
2210      asked for asynchronous tables, we always want this info.  */
2211   if (for_eh)
2212     {
2213       bool any_eh_needed = !flag_exceptions || flag_asynchronous_unwind_tables;
2214 
2215       for (i = 0; i < fde_table_in_use; i++)
2216 	if (fde_table[i].uses_eh_lsda)
2217 	  any_eh_needed = any_lsda_needed = true;
2218         else if (TARGET_USES_WEAK_UNWIND_INFO && DECL_WEAK (fde_table[i].decl))
2219 	  any_eh_needed = true;
2220 	else if (! fde_table[i].nothrow
2221 		 && ! fde_table[i].all_throwers_are_sibcalls)
2222 	  any_eh_needed = true;
2223 
2224       if (! any_eh_needed)
2225 	return;
2226     }
2227 
2228   /* We're going to be generating comments, so turn on app.  */
2229   if (flag_debug_asm)
2230     app_enable ();
2231 
2232   if (for_eh)
2233     switch_to_eh_frame_section ();
2234   else
2235     {
2236       if (!debug_frame_section)
2237 	debug_frame_section = get_section (DEBUG_FRAME_SECTION,
2238 					   SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
2239       switch_to_section (debug_frame_section);
2240     }
2241 
2242   ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (section_start_label, FRAME_BEGIN_LABEL, for_eh);
2243   ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, section_start_label);
2244 
2245   /* Output the CIE.  */
2246   ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (l1, CIE_AFTER_SIZE_LABEL, for_eh);
2247   ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (l2, CIE_END_LABEL, for_eh);
2248   if (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE - DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 4 && !for_eh)
2249     dw2_asm_output_data (4, 0xffffffff,
2250       "Initial length escape value indicating 64-bit DWARF extension");
2251   dw2_asm_output_delta (for_eh ? 4 : DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, l2, l1,
2252 			"Length of Common Information Entry");
2253   ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, l1);
2254 
2255   /* Now that the CIE pointer is PC-relative for EH,
2256      use 0 to identify the CIE.  */
2257   dw2_asm_output_data ((for_eh ? 4 : DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE),
2258 		       (for_eh ? 0 : DWARF_CIE_ID),
2259 		       "CIE Identifier Tag");
2260 
2261   dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_CIE_VERSION, "CIE Version");
2262 
2263   augmentation[0] = 0;
2264   augmentation_size = 0;
2265   if (for_eh)
2266     {
2267       char *p;
2268 
2269       /* Augmentation:
2270 	 z	Indicates that a uleb128 is present to size the
2271 		augmentation section.
2272 	 L	Indicates the encoding (and thus presence) of
2273 		an LSDA pointer in the FDE augmentation.
2274 	 R	Indicates a non-default pointer encoding for
2275 		FDE code pointers.
2276 	 P	Indicates the presence of an encoding + language
2277 		personality routine in the CIE augmentation.  */
2278 
2279       fde_encoding = ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (/*code=*/1, /*global=*/0);
2280       per_encoding = ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (/*code=*/2, /*global=*/1);
2281       lsda_encoding = ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (/*code=*/0, /*global=*/0);
2282 
2283       p = augmentation + 1;
2284       if (eh_personality_libfunc)
2285 	{
2286 	  *p++ = 'P';
2287 	  augmentation_size += 1 + size_of_encoded_value (per_encoding);
2288 	}
2289       if (any_lsda_needed)
2290 	{
2291 	  *p++ = 'L';
2292 	  augmentation_size += 1;
2293 	}
2294       if (fde_encoding != DW_EH_PE_absptr)
2295 	{
2296 	  *p++ = 'R';
2297 	  augmentation_size += 1;
2298 	}
2299       if (p > augmentation + 1)
2300 	{
2301 	  augmentation[0] = 'z';
2302 	  *p = '\0';
2303 	}
2304 
2305       /* Ug.  Some platforms can't do unaligned dynamic relocations at all.  */
2306       if (eh_personality_libfunc && per_encoding == DW_EH_PE_aligned)
2307 	{
2308 	  int offset = (  4		/* Length */
2309 			+ 4		/* CIE Id */
2310 			+ 1		/* CIE version */
2311 			+ strlen (augmentation) + 1	/* Augmentation */
2312 			+ size_of_uleb128 (1)		/* Code alignment */
2313 			+ size_of_sleb128 (DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT)
2314 			+ 1		/* RA column */
2315 			+ 1		/* Augmentation size */
2316 			+ 1		/* Personality encoding */ );
2317 	  int pad = -offset & (PTR_SIZE - 1);
2318 
2319 	  augmentation_size += pad;
2320 
2321 	  /* Augmentations should be small, so there's scarce need to
2322 	     iterate for a solution.  Die if we exceed one uleb128 byte.  */
2323 	  gcc_assert (size_of_uleb128 (augmentation_size) == 1);
2324 	}
2325     }
2326 
2327   dw2_asm_output_nstring (augmentation, -1, "CIE Augmentation");
2328   dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (1, "CIE Code Alignment Factor");
2329   dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT,
2330 			       "CIE Data Alignment Factor");
2331 
2332   return_reg = DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN, for_eh);
2333   if (DW_CIE_VERSION == 1)
2334     dw2_asm_output_data (1, return_reg, "CIE RA Column");
2335   else
2336     dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (return_reg, "CIE RA Column");
2337 
2338   if (augmentation[0])
2339     {
2340       dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (augmentation_size, "Augmentation size");
2341       if (eh_personality_libfunc)
2342 	{
2343 	  dw2_asm_output_data (1, per_encoding, "Personality (%s)",
2344 			       eh_data_format_name (per_encoding));
2345 	  dw2_asm_output_encoded_addr_rtx (per_encoding,
2346 					   eh_personality_libfunc,
2347 					   true, NULL);
2348 	}
2349 
2350       if (any_lsda_needed)
2351 	dw2_asm_output_data (1, lsda_encoding, "LSDA Encoding (%s)",
2352 			     eh_data_format_name (lsda_encoding));
2353 
2354       if (fde_encoding != DW_EH_PE_absptr)
2355 	dw2_asm_output_data (1, fde_encoding, "FDE Encoding (%s)",
2356 			     eh_data_format_name (fde_encoding));
2357     }
2358 
2359   for (cfi = cie_cfi_head; cfi != NULL; cfi = cfi->dw_cfi_next)
2360     output_cfi (cfi, NULL, for_eh);
2361 
2362   /* Pad the CIE out to an address sized boundary.  */
2363   ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN (asm_out_file,
2364 		    floor_log2 (for_eh ? PTR_SIZE : DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE));
2365   ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, l2);
2366 
2367   /* Loop through all of the FDE's.  */
2368   for (i = 0; i < fde_table_in_use; i++)
2369     {
2370       fde = &fde_table[i];
2371 
2372       /* Don't emit EH unwind info for leaf functions that don't need it.  */
2373       if (for_eh && !flag_asynchronous_unwind_tables && flag_exceptions
2374 	  && (fde->nothrow || fde->all_throwers_are_sibcalls)
2375 	  && ! (TARGET_USES_WEAK_UNWIND_INFO && DECL_WEAK (fde_table[i].decl))
2376 	  && !fde->uses_eh_lsda)
2377 	continue;
2378 
2379       targetm.asm_out.unwind_label (asm_out_file, fde->decl, for_eh, /* empty */ 0);
2380       targetm.asm_out.internal_label (asm_out_file, FDE_LABEL, for_eh + i * 2);
2381       ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (l1, FDE_AFTER_SIZE_LABEL, for_eh + i * 2);
2382       ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (l2, FDE_END_LABEL, for_eh + i * 2);
2383       if (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE - DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 4 && !for_eh)
2384 	dw2_asm_output_data (4, 0xffffffff,
2385 			     "Initial length escape value indicating 64-bit DWARF extension");
2386       dw2_asm_output_delta (for_eh ? 4 : DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, l2, l1,
2387 			    "FDE Length");
2388       ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, l1);
2389 
2390       if (for_eh)
2391 	dw2_asm_output_delta (4, l1, section_start_label, "FDE CIE offset");
2392       else
2393 	dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, section_start_label,
2394 			       debug_frame_section, "FDE CIE offset");
2395 
2396       if (for_eh)
2397 	{
2398 	  rtx sym_ref = gen_rtx_SYMBOL_REF (Pmode, fde->dw_fde_begin);
2399 	  SYMBOL_REF_FLAGS (sym_ref) |= SYMBOL_FLAG_LOCAL;
2400 	  dw2_asm_output_encoded_addr_rtx (fde_encoding,
2401 					   sym_ref,
2402 					   false,
2403 					   "FDE initial location");
2404 	  if (fde->dw_fde_switched_sections)
2405 	    {
2406 	      rtx sym_ref2 = gen_rtx_SYMBOL_REF (Pmode,
2407 				      fde->dw_fde_unlikely_section_label);
2408 	      rtx sym_ref3= gen_rtx_SYMBOL_REF (Pmode,
2409 				      fde->dw_fde_hot_section_label);
2410 	      SYMBOL_REF_FLAGS (sym_ref2) |= SYMBOL_FLAG_LOCAL;
2411 	      SYMBOL_REF_FLAGS (sym_ref3) |= SYMBOL_FLAG_LOCAL;
2412 	      dw2_asm_output_encoded_addr_rtx (fde_encoding, sym_ref3, false,
2413 					       "FDE initial location");
2414 	      dw2_asm_output_delta (size_of_encoded_value (fde_encoding),
2415 				    fde->dw_fde_hot_section_end_label,
2416 				    fde->dw_fde_hot_section_label,
2417 				    "FDE address range");
2418 	      dw2_asm_output_encoded_addr_rtx (fde_encoding, sym_ref2, false,
2419 					       "FDE initial location");
2420 	      dw2_asm_output_delta (size_of_encoded_value (fde_encoding),
2421 				    fde->dw_fde_unlikely_section_end_label,
2422 				    fde->dw_fde_unlikely_section_label,
2423 				    "FDE address range");
2424 	    }
2425 	  else
2426 	    dw2_asm_output_delta (size_of_encoded_value (fde_encoding),
2427 				  fde->dw_fde_end, fde->dw_fde_begin,
2428 				  "FDE address range");
2429 	}
2430       else
2431 	{
2432 	  dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, fde->dw_fde_begin,
2433 			       "FDE initial location");
2434 	  if (fde->dw_fde_switched_sections)
2435 	    {
2436 	      dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE,
2437 				   fde->dw_fde_hot_section_label,
2438 				   "FDE initial location");
2439 	      dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE,
2440 				    fde->dw_fde_hot_section_end_label,
2441 				    fde->dw_fde_hot_section_label,
2442 				    "FDE address range");
2443 	      dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE,
2444 				   fde->dw_fde_unlikely_section_label,
2445 				   "FDE initial location");
2446 	      dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE,
2447 				    fde->dw_fde_unlikely_section_end_label,
2448 				    fde->dw_fde_unlikely_section_label,
2449 				    "FDE address range");
2450 	    }
2451 	  else
2452 	    dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE,
2453 				  fde->dw_fde_end, fde->dw_fde_begin,
2454 				  "FDE address range");
2455 	}
2456 
2457       if (augmentation[0])
2458 	{
2459 	  if (any_lsda_needed)
2460 	    {
2461 	      int size = size_of_encoded_value (lsda_encoding);
2462 
2463 	      if (lsda_encoding == DW_EH_PE_aligned)
2464 		{
2465 		  int offset = (  4		/* Length */
2466 				+ 4		/* CIE offset */
2467 				+ 2 * size_of_encoded_value (fde_encoding)
2468 				+ 1		/* Augmentation size */ );
2469 		  int pad = -offset & (PTR_SIZE - 1);
2470 
2471 		  size += pad;
2472 		  gcc_assert (size_of_uleb128 (size) == 1);
2473 		}
2474 
2475 	      dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (size, "Augmentation size");
2476 
2477 	      if (fde->uses_eh_lsda)
2478 		{
2479 		  ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (l1, "LLSDA",
2480 					       fde->funcdef_number);
2481 		  dw2_asm_output_encoded_addr_rtx (
2482 			lsda_encoding, gen_rtx_SYMBOL_REF (Pmode, l1),
2483 			false, "Language Specific Data Area");
2484 		}
2485 	      else
2486 		{
2487 		  if (lsda_encoding == DW_EH_PE_aligned)
2488 		    ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN (asm_out_file, floor_log2 (PTR_SIZE));
2489 		  dw2_asm_output_data
2490 		    (size_of_encoded_value (lsda_encoding), 0,
2491 		     "Language Specific Data Area (none)");
2492 		}
2493 	    }
2494 	  else
2495 	    dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (0, "Augmentation size");
2496 	}
2497 
2498       /* Loop through the Call Frame Instructions associated with
2499 	 this FDE.  */
2500       fde->dw_fde_current_label = fde->dw_fde_begin;
2501       for (cfi = fde->dw_fde_cfi; cfi != NULL; cfi = cfi->dw_cfi_next)
2502 	output_cfi (cfi, fde, for_eh);
2503 
2504       /* Pad the FDE out to an address sized boundary.  */
2505       ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN (asm_out_file,
2506 			floor_log2 ((for_eh ? PTR_SIZE : DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)));
2507       ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, l2);
2508     }
2509 
2510   if (for_eh && targetm.terminate_dw2_eh_frame_info)
2511     dw2_asm_output_data (4, 0, "End of Table");
2512 #ifdef MIPS_DEBUGGING_INFO
2513   /* Work around Irix 6 assembler bug whereby labels at the end of a section
2514      get a value of 0.  Putting .align 0 after the label fixes it.  */
2515   ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN (asm_out_file, 0);
2516 #endif
2517 
2518   /* Turn off app to make assembly quicker.  */
2519   if (flag_debug_asm)
2520     app_disable ();
2521 }
2522 
2523 /* Output a marker (i.e. a label) for the beginning of a function, before
2524    the prologue.  */
2525 
2526 void
dwarf2out_begin_prologue(unsigned int line ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,const char * file ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)2527 dwarf2out_begin_prologue (unsigned int line ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
2528 			  const char *file ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
2529 {
2530   char label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
2531   char * dup_label;
2532   dw_fde_ref fde;
2533 
2534   current_function_func_begin_label = NULL;
2535 
2536 #ifdef TARGET_UNWIND_INFO
2537   /* ??? current_function_func_begin_label is also used by except.c
2538      for call-site information.  We must emit this label if it might
2539      be used.  */
2540   if ((! flag_exceptions || USING_SJLJ_EXCEPTIONS)
2541       && ! dwarf2out_do_frame ())
2542     return;
2543 #else
2544   if (! dwarf2out_do_frame ())
2545     return;
2546 #endif
2547 
2548   switch_to_section (function_section (current_function_decl));
2549   ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, FUNC_BEGIN_LABEL,
2550 			       current_function_funcdef_no);
2551   ASM_OUTPUT_DEBUG_LABEL (asm_out_file, FUNC_BEGIN_LABEL,
2552 			  current_function_funcdef_no);
2553   dup_label = xstrdup (label);
2554   current_function_func_begin_label = dup_label;
2555 
2556 #ifdef TARGET_UNWIND_INFO
2557   /* We can elide the fde allocation if we're not emitting debug info.  */
2558   if (! dwarf2out_do_frame ())
2559     return;
2560 #endif
2561 
2562   /* Expand the fde table if necessary.  */
2563   if (fde_table_in_use == fde_table_allocated)
2564     {
2565       fde_table_allocated += FDE_TABLE_INCREMENT;
2566       fde_table = ggc_realloc (fde_table,
2567 			       fde_table_allocated * sizeof (dw_fde_node));
2568       memset (fde_table + fde_table_in_use, 0,
2569 	      FDE_TABLE_INCREMENT * sizeof (dw_fde_node));
2570     }
2571 
2572   /* Record the FDE associated with this function.  */
2573   current_funcdef_fde = fde_table_in_use;
2574 
2575   /* Add the new FDE at the end of the fde_table.  */
2576   fde = &fde_table[fde_table_in_use++];
2577   fde->decl = current_function_decl;
2578   fde->dw_fde_begin = dup_label;
2579   fde->dw_fde_current_label = dup_label;
2580   fde->dw_fde_hot_section_label = NULL;
2581   fde->dw_fde_hot_section_end_label = NULL;
2582   fde->dw_fde_unlikely_section_label = NULL;
2583   fde->dw_fde_unlikely_section_end_label = NULL;
2584   fde->dw_fde_switched_sections = false;
2585   fde->dw_fde_end = NULL;
2586   fde->dw_fde_cfi = NULL;
2587   fde->funcdef_number = current_function_funcdef_no;
2588   fde->nothrow = TREE_NOTHROW (current_function_decl);
2589   fde->uses_eh_lsda = cfun->uses_eh_lsda;
2590   fde->all_throwers_are_sibcalls = cfun->all_throwers_are_sibcalls;
2591 
2592   args_size = old_args_size = 0;
2593 
2594   /* We only want to output line number information for the genuine dwarf2
2595      prologue case, not the eh frame case.  */
2596 #ifdef DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO
2597   if (file)
2598     dwarf2out_source_line (line, file);
2599 #endif
2600 }
2601 
2602 /* Output a marker (i.e. a label) for the absolute end of the generated code
2603    for a function definition.  This gets called *after* the epilogue code has
2604    been generated.  */
2605 
2606 void
dwarf2out_end_epilogue(unsigned int line ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,const char * file ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)2607 dwarf2out_end_epilogue (unsigned int line ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
2608 			const char *file ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
2609 {
2610   dw_fde_ref fde;
2611   char label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
2612 
2613   /* Output a label to mark the endpoint of the code generated for this
2614      function.  */
2615   ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, FUNC_END_LABEL,
2616 			       current_function_funcdef_no);
2617   ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, label);
2618   fde = &fde_table[fde_table_in_use - 1];
2619   fde->dw_fde_end = xstrdup (label);
2620 }
2621 
2622 void
dwarf2out_frame_init(void)2623 dwarf2out_frame_init (void)
2624 {
2625   /* Allocate the initial hunk of the fde_table.  */
2626   fde_table = ggc_alloc_cleared (FDE_TABLE_INCREMENT * sizeof (dw_fde_node));
2627   fde_table_allocated = FDE_TABLE_INCREMENT;
2628   fde_table_in_use = 0;
2629 
2630   /* Generate the CFA instructions common to all FDE's.  Do it now for the
2631      sake of lookup_cfa.  */
2632 
2633   /* On entry, the Canonical Frame Address is at SP.  */
2634   dwarf2out_def_cfa (NULL, STACK_POINTER_REGNUM, INCOMING_FRAME_SP_OFFSET);
2635 
2636 #ifdef DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO
2637   if (DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO)
2638     initial_return_save (INCOMING_RETURN_ADDR_RTX);
2639 #endif
2640 }
2641 
2642 void
dwarf2out_frame_finish(void)2643 dwarf2out_frame_finish (void)
2644 {
2645   /* Output call frame information.  */
2646   if (DWARF2_FRAME_INFO)
2647     output_call_frame_info (0);
2648 
2649 #ifndef TARGET_UNWIND_INFO
2650   /* Output another copy for the unwinder.  */
2651   if (! USING_SJLJ_EXCEPTIONS && (flag_unwind_tables || flag_exceptions))
2652     output_call_frame_info (1);
2653 #endif
2654 }
2655 #endif
2656 
2657 /* And now, the subset of the debugging information support code necessary
2658    for emitting location expressions.  */
2659 
2660 /* Data about a single source file.  */
2661 struct dwarf_file_data GTY(())
2662 {
2663   const char * filename;
2664   int emitted_number;
2665 };
2666 
2667 /* We need some way to distinguish DW_OP_addr with a direct symbol
2668    relocation from DW_OP_addr with a dtp-relative symbol relocation.  */
2669 #define INTERNAL_DW_OP_tls_addr		(0x100 + DW_OP_addr)
2670 
2671 
2672 typedef struct dw_val_struct *dw_val_ref;
2673 typedef struct die_struct *dw_die_ref;
2674 typedef struct dw_loc_descr_struct *dw_loc_descr_ref;
2675 typedef struct dw_loc_list_struct *dw_loc_list_ref;
2676 
2677 /* Each DIE may have a series of attribute/value pairs.  Values
2678    can take on several forms.  The forms that are used in this
2679    implementation are listed below.  */
2680 
2681 enum dw_val_class
2682 {
2683   dw_val_class_addr,
2684   dw_val_class_offset,
2685   dw_val_class_loc,
2686   dw_val_class_loc_list,
2687   dw_val_class_range_list,
2688   dw_val_class_const,
2689   dw_val_class_unsigned_const,
2690   dw_val_class_long_long,
2691   dw_val_class_vec,
2692   dw_val_class_flag,
2693   dw_val_class_die_ref,
2694   dw_val_class_fde_ref,
2695   dw_val_class_lbl_id,
2696   dw_val_class_lineptr,
2697   dw_val_class_str,
2698   dw_val_class_macptr,
2699   dw_val_class_file
2700 };
2701 
2702 /* Describe a double word constant value.  */
2703 /* ??? Every instance of long_long in the code really means CONST_DOUBLE.  */
2704 
2705 typedef struct dw_long_long_struct GTY(())
2706 {
2707   unsigned long hi;
2708   unsigned long low;
2709 }
2710 dw_long_long_const;
2711 
2712 /* Describe a floating point constant value, or a vector constant value.  */
2713 
2714 typedef struct dw_vec_struct GTY(())
2715 {
2716   unsigned char * GTY((length ("%h.length"))) array;
2717   unsigned length;
2718   unsigned elt_size;
2719 }
2720 dw_vec_const;
2721 
2722 /* The dw_val_node describes an attribute's value, as it is
2723    represented internally.  */
2724 
2725 typedef struct dw_val_struct GTY(())
2726 {
2727   enum dw_val_class val_class;
2728   union dw_val_struct_union
2729     {
2730       rtx GTY ((tag ("dw_val_class_addr"))) val_addr;
2731       unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT GTY ((tag ("dw_val_class_offset"))) val_offset;
2732       dw_loc_list_ref GTY ((tag ("dw_val_class_loc_list"))) val_loc_list;
2733       dw_loc_descr_ref GTY ((tag ("dw_val_class_loc"))) val_loc;
2734       HOST_WIDE_INT GTY ((default)) val_int;
2735       unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT GTY ((tag ("dw_val_class_unsigned_const"))) val_unsigned;
2736       dw_long_long_const GTY ((tag ("dw_val_class_long_long"))) val_long_long;
2737       dw_vec_const GTY ((tag ("dw_val_class_vec"))) val_vec;
2738       struct dw_val_die_union
2739 	{
2740 	  dw_die_ref die;
2741 	  int external;
2742 	} GTY ((tag ("dw_val_class_die_ref"))) val_die_ref;
2743       unsigned GTY ((tag ("dw_val_class_fde_ref"))) val_fde_index;
2744       struct indirect_string_node * GTY ((tag ("dw_val_class_str"))) val_str;
2745       char * GTY ((tag ("dw_val_class_lbl_id"))) val_lbl_id;
2746       unsigned char GTY ((tag ("dw_val_class_flag"))) val_flag;
2747       struct dwarf_file_data * GTY ((tag ("dw_val_class_file"))) val_file;
2748     }
2749   GTY ((desc ("%1.val_class"))) v;
2750 }
2751 dw_val_node;
2752 
2753 /* Locations in memory are described using a sequence of stack machine
2754    operations.  */
2755 
2756 typedef struct dw_loc_descr_struct GTY(())
2757 {
2758   dw_loc_descr_ref dw_loc_next;
2759   enum dwarf_location_atom dw_loc_opc;
2760   dw_val_node dw_loc_oprnd1;
2761   dw_val_node dw_loc_oprnd2;
2762   int dw_loc_addr;
2763 }
2764 dw_loc_descr_node;
2765 
2766 /* Location lists are ranges + location descriptions for that range,
2767    so you can track variables that are in different places over
2768    their entire life.  */
2769 typedef struct dw_loc_list_struct GTY(())
2770 {
2771   dw_loc_list_ref dw_loc_next;
2772   const char *begin; /* Label for begin address of range */
2773   const char *end;  /* Label for end address of range */
2774   char *ll_symbol; /* Label for beginning of location list.
2775 		      Only on head of list */
2776   const char *section; /* Section this loclist is relative to */
2777   dw_loc_descr_ref expr;
2778 } dw_loc_list_node;
2779 
2780 #if defined (DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO) || defined (DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO)
2781 
2782 static const char *dwarf_stack_op_name (unsigned);
2783 static dw_loc_descr_ref new_loc_descr (enum dwarf_location_atom,
2784 				       unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT);
2785 static void add_loc_descr (dw_loc_descr_ref *, dw_loc_descr_ref);
2786 static unsigned long size_of_loc_descr (dw_loc_descr_ref);
2787 static unsigned long size_of_locs (dw_loc_descr_ref);
2788 static void output_loc_operands (dw_loc_descr_ref);
2789 static void output_loc_sequence (dw_loc_descr_ref);
2790 
2791 /* Convert a DWARF stack opcode into its string name.  */
2792 
2793 static const char *
dwarf_stack_op_name(unsigned int op)2794 dwarf_stack_op_name (unsigned int op)
2795 {
2796   switch (op)
2797     {
2798     case DW_OP_addr:
2799     case INTERNAL_DW_OP_tls_addr:
2800       return "DW_OP_addr";
2801     case DW_OP_deref:
2802       return "DW_OP_deref";
2803     case DW_OP_const1u:
2804       return "DW_OP_const1u";
2805     case DW_OP_const1s:
2806       return "DW_OP_const1s";
2807     case DW_OP_const2u:
2808       return "DW_OP_const2u";
2809     case DW_OP_const2s:
2810       return "DW_OP_const2s";
2811     case DW_OP_const4u:
2812       return "DW_OP_const4u";
2813     case DW_OP_const4s:
2814       return "DW_OP_const4s";
2815     case DW_OP_const8u:
2816       return "DW_OP_const8u";
2817     case DW_OP_const8s:
2818       return "DW_OP_const8s";
2819     case DW_OP_constu:
2820       return "DW_OP_constu";
2821     case DW_OP_consts:
2822       return "DW_OP_consts";
2823     case DW_OP_dup:
2824       return "DW_OP_dup";
2825     case DW_OP_drop:
2826       return "DW_OP_drop";
2827     case DW_OP_over:
2828       return "DW_OP_over";
2829     case DW_OP_pick:
2830       return "DW_OP_pick";
2831     case DW_OP_swap:
2832       return "DW_OP_swap";
2833     case DW_OP_rot:
2834       return "DW_OP_rot";
2835     case DW_OP_xderef:
2836       return "DW_OP_xderef";
2837     case DW_OP_abs:
2838       return "DW_OP_abs";
2839     case DW_OP_and:
2840       return "DW_OP_and";
2841     case DW_OP_div:
2842       return "DW_OP_div";
2843     case DW_OP_minus:
2844       return "DW_OP_minus";
2845     case DW_OP_mod:
2846       return "DW_OP_mod";
2847     case DW_OP_mul:
2848       return "DW_OP_mul";
2849     case DW_OP_neg:
2850       return "DW_OP_neg";
2851     case DW_OP_not:
2852       return "DW_OP_not";
2853     case DW_OP_or:
2854       return "DW_OP_or";
2855     case DW_OP_plus:
2856       return "DW_OP_plus";
2857     case DW_OP_plus_uconst:
2858       return "DW_OP_plus_uconst";
2859     case DW_OP_shl:
2860       return "DW_OP_shl";
2861     case DW_OP_shr:
2862       return "DW_OP_shr";
2863     case DW_OP_shra:
2864       return "DW_OP_shra";
2865     case DW_OP_xor:
2866       return "DW_OP_xor";
2867     case DW_OP_bra:
2868       return "DW_OP_bra";
2869     case DW_OP_eq:
2870       return "DW_OP_eq";
2871     case DW_OP_ge:
2872       return "DW_OP_ge";
2873     case DW_OP_gt:
2874       return "DW_OP_gt";
2875     case DW_OP_le:
2876       return "DW_OP_le";
2877     case DW_OP_lt:
2878       return "DW_OP_lt";
2879     case DW_OP_ne:
2880       return "DW_OP_ne";
2881     case DW_OP_skip:
2882       return "DW_OP_skip";
2883     case DW_OP_lit0:
2884       return "DW_OP_lit0";
2885     case DW_OP_lit1:
2886       return "DW_OP_lit1";
2887     case DW_OP_lit2:
2888       return "DW_OP_lit2";
2889     case DW_OP_lit3:
2890       return "DW_OP_lit3";
2891     case DW_OP_lit4:
2892       return "DW_OP_lit4";
2893     case DW_OP_lit5:
2894       return "DW_OP_lit5";
2895     case DW_OP_lit6:
2896       return "DW_OP_lit6";
2897     case DW_OP_lit7:
2898       return "DW_OP_lit7";
2899     case DW_OP_lit8:
2900       return "DW_OP_lit8";
2901     case DW_OP_lit9:
2902       return "DW_OP_lit9";
2903     case DW_OP_lit10:
2904       return "DW_OP_lit10";
2905     case DW_OP_lit11:
2906       return "DW_OP_lit11";
2907     case DW_OP_lit12:
2908       return "DW_OP_lit12";
2909     case DW_OP_lit13:
2910       return "DW_OP_lit13";
2911     case DW_OP_lit14:
2912       return "DW_OP_lit14";
2913     case DW_OP_lit15:
2914       return "DW_OP_lit15";
2915     case DW_OP_lit16:
2916       return "DW_OP_lit16";
2917     case DW_OP_lit17:
2918       return "DW_OP_lit17";
2919     case DW_OP_lit18:
2920       return "DW_OP_lit18";
2921     case DW_OP_lit19:
2922       return "DW_OP_lit19";
2923     case DW_OP_lit20:
2924       return "DW_OP_lit20";
2925     case DW_OP_lit21:
2926       return "DW_OP_lit21";
2927     case DW_OP_lit22:
2928       return "DW_OP_lit22";
2929     case DW_OP_lit23:
2930       return "DW_OP_lit23";
2931     case DW_OP_lit24:
2932       return "DW_OP_lit24";
2933     case DW_OP_lit25:
2934       return "DW_OP_lit25";
2935     case DW_OP_lit26:
2936       return "DW_OP_lit26";
2937     case DW_OP_lit27:
2938       return "DW_OP_lit27";
2939     case DW_OP_lit28:
2940       return "DW_OP_lit28";
2941     case DW_OP_lit29:
2942       return "DW_OP_lit29";
2943     case DW_OP_lit30:
2944       return "DW_OP_lit30";
2945     case DW_OP_lit31:
2946       return "DW_OP_lit31";
2947     case DW_OP_reg0:
2948       return "DW_OP_reg0";
2949     case DW_OP_reg1:
2950       return "DW_OP_reg1";
2951     case DW_OP_reg2:
2952       return "DW_OP_reg2";
2953     case DW_OP_reg3:
2954       return "DW_OP_reg3";
2955     case DW_OP_reg4:
2956       return "DW_OP_reg4";
2957     case DW_OP_reg5:
2958       return "DW_OP_reg5";
2959     case DW_OP_reg6:
2960       return "DW_OP_reg6";
2961     case DW_OP_reg7:
2962       return "DW_OP_reg7";
2963     case DW_OP_reg8:
2964       return "DW_OP_reg8";
2965     case DW_OP_reg9:
2966       return "DW_OP_reg9";
2967     case DW_OP_reg10:
2968       return "DW_OP_reg10";
2969     case DW_OP_reg11:
2970       return "DW_OP_reg11";
2971     case DW_OP_reg12:
2972       return "DW_OP_reg12";
2973     case DW_OP_reg13:
2974       return "DW_OP_reg13";
2975     case DW_OP_reg14:
2976       return "DW_OP_reg14";
2977     case DW_OP_reg15:
2978       return "DW_OP_reg15";
2979     case DW_OP_reg16:
2980       return "DW_OP_reg16";
2981     case DW_OP_reg17:
2982       return "DW_OP_reg17";
2983     case DW_OP_reg18:
2984       return "DW_OP_reg18";
2985     case DW_OP_reg19:
2986       return "DW_OP_reg19";
2987     case DW_OP_reg20:
2988       return "DW_OP_reg20";
2989     case DW_OP_reg21:
2990       return "DW_OP_reg21";
2991     case DW_OP_reg22:
2992       return "DW_OP_reg22";
2993     case DW_OP_reg23:
2994       return "DW_OP_reg23";
2995     case DW_OP_reg24:
2996       return "DW_OP_reg24";
2997     case DW_OP_reg25:
2998       return "DW_OP_reg25";
2999     case DW_OP_reg26:
3000       return "DW_OP_reg26";
3001     case DW_OP_reg27:
3002       return "DW_OP_reg27";
3003     case DW_OP_reg28:
3004       return "DW_OP_reg28";
3005     case DW_OP_reg29:
3006       return "DW_OP_reg29";
3007     case DW_OP_reg30:
3008       return "DW_OP_reg30";
3009     case DW_OP_reg31:
3010       return "DW_OP_reg31";
3011     case DW_OP_breg0:
3012       return "DW_OP_breg0";
3013     case DW_OP_breg1:
3014       return "DW_OP_breg1";
3015     case DW_OP_breg2:
3016       return "DW_OP_breg2";
3017     case DW_OP_breg3:
3018       return "DW_OP_breg3";
3019     case DW_OP_breg4:
3020       return "DW_OP_breg4";
3021     case DW_OP_breg5:
3022       return "DW_OP_breg5";
3023     case DW_OP_breg6:
3024       return "DW_OP_breg6";
3025     case DW_OP_breg7:
3026       return "DW_OP_breg7";
3027     case DW_OP_breg8:
3028       return "DW_OP_breg8";
3029     case DW_OP_breg9:
3030       return "DW_OP_breg9";
3031     case DW_OP_breg10:
3032       return "DW_OP_breg10";
3033     case DW_OP_breg11:
3034       return "DW_OP_breg11";
3035     case DW_OP_breg12:
3036       return "DW_OP_breg12";
3037     case DW_OP_breg13:
3038       return "DW_OP_breg13";
3039     case DW_OP_breg14:
3040       return "DW_OP_breg14";
3041     case DW_OP_breg15:
3042       return "DW_OP_breg15";
3043     case DW_OP_breg16:
3044       return "DW_OP_breg16";
3045     case DW_OP_breg17:
3046       return "DW_OP_breg17";
3047     case DW_OP_breg18:
3048       return "DW_OP_breg18";
3049     case DW_OP_breg19:
3050       return "DW_OP_breg19";
3051     case DW_OP_breg20:
3052       return "DW_OP_breg20";
3053     case DW_OP_breg21:
3054       return "DW_OP_breg21";
3055     case DW_OP_breg22:
3056       return "DW_OP_breg22";
3057     case DW_OP_breg23:
3058       return "DW_OP_breg23";
3059     case DW_OP_breg24:
3060       return "DW_OP_breg24";
3061     case DW_OP_breg25:
3062       return "DW_OP_breg25";
3063     case DW_OP_breg26:
3064       return "DW_OP_breg26";
3065     case DW_OP_breg27:
3066       return "DW_OP_breg27";
3067     case DW_OP_breg28:
3068       return "DW_OP_breg28";
3069     case DW_OP_breg29:
3070       return "DW_OP_breg29";
3071     case DW_OP_breg30:
3072       return "DW_OP_breg30";
3073     case DW_OP_breg31:
3074       return "DW_OP_breg31";
3075     case DW_OP_regx:
3076       return "DW_OP_regx";
3077     case DW_OP_fbreg:
3078       return "DW_OP_fbreg";
3079     case DW_OP_bregx:
3080       return "DW_OP_bregx";
3081     case DW_OP_piece:
3082       return "DW_OP_piece";
3083     case DW_OP_deref_size:
3084       return "DW_OP_deref_size";
3085     case DW_OP_xderef_size:
3086       return "DW_OP_xderef_size";
3087     case DW_OP_nop:
3088       return "DW_OP_nop";
3089     case DW_OP_push_object_address:
3090       return "DW_OP_push_object_address";
3091     case DW_OP_call2:
3092       return "DW_OP_call2";
3093     case DW_OP_call4:
3094       return "DW_OP_call4";
3095     case DW_OP_call_ref:
3096       return "DW_OP_call_ref";
3097     case DW_OP_GNU_push_tls_address:
3098       return "DW_OP_GNU_push_tls_address";
3099     default:
3100       return "OP_<unknown>";
3101     }
3102 }
3103 
3104 /* Return a pointer to a newly allocated location description.  Location
3105    descriptions are simple expression terms that can be strung
3106    together to form more complicated location (address) descriptions.  */
3107 
3108 static inline dw_loc_descr_ref
new_loc_descr(enum dwarf_location_atom op,unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT oprnd1,unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT oprnd2)3109 new_loc_descr (enum dwarf_location_atom op, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT oprnd1,
3110 	       unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT oprnd2)
3111 {
3112   dw_loc_descr_ref descr = ggc_alloc_cleared (sizeof (dw_loc_descr_node));
3113 
3114   descr->dw_loc_opc = op;
3115   descr->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_unsigned_const;
3116   descr->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned = oprnd1;
3117   descr->dw_loc_oprnd2.val_class = dw_val_class_unsigned_const;
3118   descr->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_unsigned = oprnd2;
3119 
3120   return descr;
3121 }
3122 
3123 /* Add a location description term to a location description expression.  */
3124 
3125 static inline void
add_loc_descr(dw_loc_descr_ref * list_head,dw_loc_descr_ref descr)3126 add_loc_descr (dw_loc_descr_ref *list_head, dw_loc_descr_ref descr)
3127 {
3128   dw_loc_descr_ref *d;
3129 
3130   /* Find the end of the chain.  */
3131   for (d = list_head; (*d) != NULL; d = &(*d)->dw_loc_next)
3132     ;
3133 
3134   *d = descr;
3135 }
3136 
3137 /* Return the size of a location descriptor.  */
3138 
3139 static unsigned long
size_of_loc_descr(dw_loc_descr_ref loc)3140 size_of_loc_descr (dw_loc_descr_ref loc)
3141 {
3142   unsigned long size = 1;
3143 
3144   switch (loc->dw_loc_opc)
3145     {
3146     case DW_OP_addr:
3147     case INTERNAL_DW_OP_tls_addr:
3148       size += DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
3149       break;
3150     case DW_OP_const1u:
3151     case DW_OP_const1s:
3152       size += 1;
3153       break;
3154     case DW_OP_const2u:
3155     case DW_OP_const2s:
3156       size += 2;
3157       break;
3158     case DW_OP_const4u:
3159     case DW_OP_const4s:
3160       size += 4;
3161       break;
3162     case DW_OP_const8u:
3163     case DW_OP_const8s:
3164       size += 8;
3165       break;
3166     case DW_OP_constu:
3167       size += size_of_uleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned);
3168       break;
3169     case DW_OP_consts:
3170       size += size_of_sleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_int);
3171       break;
3172     case DW_OP_pick:
3173       size += 1;
3174       break;
3175     case DW_OP_plus_uconst:
3176       size += size_of_uleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned);
3177       break;
3178     case DW_OP_skip:
3179     case DW_OP_bra:
3180       size += 2;
3181       break;
3182     case DW_OP_breg0:
3183     case DW_OP_breg1:
3184     case DW_OP_breg2:
3185     case DW_OP_breg3:
3186     case DW_OP_breg4:
3187     case DW_OP_breg5:
3188     case DW_OP_breg6:
3189     case DW_OP_breg7:
3190     case DW_OP_breg8:
3191     case DW_OP_breg9:
3192     case DW_OP_breg10:
3193     case DW_OP_breg11:
3194     case DW_OP_breg12:
3195     case DW_OP_breg13:
3196     case DW_OP_breg14:
3197     case DW_OP_breg15:
3198     case DW_OP_breg16:
3199     case DW_OP_breg17:
3200     case DW_OP_breg18:
3201     case DW_OP_breg19:
3202     case DW_OP_breg20:
3203     case DW_OP_breg21:
3204     case DW_OP_breg22:
3205     case DW_OP_breg23:
3206     case DW_OP_breg24:
3207     case DW_OP_breg25:
3208     case DW_OP_breg26:
3209     case DW_OP_breg27:
3210     case DW_OP_breg28:
3211     case DW_OP_breg29:
3212     case DW_OP_breg30:
3213     case DW_OP_breg31:
3214       size += size_of_sleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_int);
3215       break;
3216     case DW_OP_regx:
3217       size += size_of_uleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned);
3218       break;
3219     case DW_OP_fbreg:
3220       size += size_of_sleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_int);
3221       break;
3222     case DW_OP_bregx:
3223       size += size_of_uleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned);
3224       size += size_of_sleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_int);
3225       break;
3226     case DW_OP_piece:
3227       size += size_of_uleb128 (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned);
3228       break;
3229     case DW_OP_deref_size:
3230     case DW_OP_xderef_size:
3231       size += 1;
3232       break;
3233     case DW_OP_call2:
3234       size += 2;
3235       break;
3236     case DW_OP_call4:
3237       size += 4;
3238       break;
3239     case DW_OP_call_ref:
3240       size += DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
3241       break;
3242     default:
3243       break;
3244     }
3245 
3246   return size;
3247 }
3248 
3249 /* Return the size of a series of location descriptors.  */
3250 
3251 static unsigned long
size_of_locs(dw_loc_descr_ref loc)3252 size_of_locs (dw_loc_descr_ref loc)
3253 {
3254   dw_loc_descr_ref l;
3255   unsigned long size;
3256 
3257   /* If there are no skip or bra opcodes, don't fill in the dw_loc_addr
3258      field, to avoid writing to a PCH file.  */
3259   for (size = 0, l = loc; l != NULL; l = l->dw_loc_next)
3260     {
3261       if (l->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_skip || l->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_bra)
3262 	break;
3263       size += size_of_loc_descr (l);
3264     }
3265   if (! l)
3266     return size;
3267 
3268   for (size = 0, l = loc; l != NULL; l = l->dw_loc_next)
3269     {
3270       l->dw_loc_addr = size;
3271       size += size_of_loc_descr (l);
3272     }
3273 
3274   return size;
3275 }
3276 
3277 /* Output location description stack opcode's operands (if any).  */
3278 
3279 static void
output_loc_operands(dw_loc_descr_ref loc)3280 output_loc_operands (dw_loc_descr_ref loc)
3281 {
3282   dw_val_ref val1 = &loc->dw_loc_oprnd1;
3283   dw_val_ref val2 = &loc->dw_loc_oprnd2;
3284 
3285   switch (loc->dw_loc_opc)
3286     {
3287 #ifdef DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO
3288     case DW_OP_addr:
3289       dw2_asm_output_addr_rtx (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, val1->v.val_addr, NULL);
3290       break;
3291     case DW_OP_const2u:
3292     case DW_OP_const2s:
3293       dw2_asm_output_data (2, val1->v.val_int, NULL);
3294       break;
3295     case DW_OP_const4u:
3296     case DW_OP_const4s:
3297       dw2_asm_output_data (4, val1->v.val_int, NULL);
3298       break;
3299     case DW_OP_const8u:
3300     case DW_OP_const8s:
3301       gcc_assert (HOST_BITS_PER_LONG >= 64);
3302       dw2_asm_output_data (8, val1->v.val_int, NULL);
3303       break;
3304     case DW_OP_skip:
3305     case DW_OP_bra:
3306       {
3307 	int offset;
3308 
3309 	gcc_assert (val1->val_class == dw_val_class_loc);
3310 	offset = val1->v.val_loc->dw_loc_addr - (loc->dw_loc_addr + 3);
3311 
3312 	dw2_asm_output_data (2, offset, NULL);
3313       }
3314       break;
3315 #else
3316     case DW_OP_addr:
3317     case DW_OP_const2u:
3318     case DW_OP_const2s:
3319     case DW_OP_const4u:
3320     case DW_OP_const4s:
3321     case DW_OP_const8u:
3322     case DW_OP_const8s:
3323     case DW_OP_skip:
3324     case DW_OP_bra:
3325       /* We currently don't make any attempt to make sure these are
3326 	 aligned properly like we do for the main unwind info, so
3327 	 don't support emitting things larger than a byte if we're
3328 	 only doing unwinding.  */
3329       gcc_unreachable ();
3330 #endif
3331     case DW_OP_const1u:
3332     case DW_OP_const1s:
3333       dw2_asm_output_data (1, val1->v.val_int, NULL);
3334       break;
3335     case DW_OP_constu:
3336       dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (val1->v.val_unsigned, NULL);
3337       break;
3338     case DW_OP_consts:
3339       dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (val1->v.val_int, NULL);
3340       break;
3341     case DW_OP_pick:
3342       dw2_asm_output_data (1, val1->v.val_int, NULL);
3343       break;
3344     case DW_OP_plus_uconst:
3345       dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (val1->v.val_unsigned, NULL);
3346       break;
3347     case DW_OP_breg0:
3348     case DW_OP_breg1:
3349     case DW_OP_breg2:
3350     case DW_OP_breg3:
3351     case DW_OP_breg4:
3352     case DW_OP_breg5:
3353     case DW_OP_breg6:
3354     case DW_OP_breg7:
3355     case DW_OP_breg8:
3356     case DW_OP_breg9:
3357     case DW_OP_breg10:
3358     case DW_OP_breg11:
3359     case DW_OP_breg12:
3360     case DW_OP_breg13:
3361     case DW_OP_breg14:
3362     case DW_OP_breg15:
3363     case DW_OP_breg16:
3364     case DW_OP_breg17:
3365     case DW_OP_breg18:
3366     case DW_OP_breg19:
3367     case DW_OP_breg20:
3368     case DW_OP_breg21:
3369     case DW_OP_breg22:
3370     case DW_OP_breg23:
3371     case DW_OP_breg24:
3372     case DW_OP_breg25:
3373     case DW_OP_breg26:
3374     case DW_OP_breg27:
3375     case DW_OP_breg28:
3376     case DW_OP_breg29:
3377     case DW_OP_breg30:
3378     case DW_OP_breg31:
3379       dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (val1->v.val_int, NULL);
3380       break;
3381     case DW_OP_regx:
3382       dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (val1->v.val_unsigned, NULL);
3383       break;
3384     case DW_OP_fbreg:
3385       dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (val1->v.val_int, NULL);
3386       break;
3387     case DW_OP_bregx:
3388       dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (val1->v.val_unsigned, NULL);
3389       dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (val2->v.val_int, NULL);
3390       break;
3391     case DW_OP_piece:
3392       dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (val1->v.val_unsigned, NULL);
3393       break;
3394     case DW_OP_deref_size:
3395     case DW_OP_xderef_size:
3396       dw2_asm_output_data (1, val1->v.val_int, NULL);
3397       break;
3398 
3399     case INTERNAL_DW_OP_tls_addr:
3400       if (targetm.asm_out.output_dwarf_dtprel)
3401 	{
3402 	  targetm.asm_out.output_dwarf_dtprel (asm_out_file,
3403 					       DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE,
3404 					       val1->v.val_addr);
3405 	  fputc ('\n', asm_out_file);
3406 	}
3407       else
3408 	gcc_unreachable ();
3409       break;
3410 
3411     default:
3412       /* Other codes have no operands.  */
3413       break;
3414     }
3415 }
3416 
3417 /* Output a sequence of location operations.  */
3418 
3419 static void
output_loc_sequence(dw_loc_descr_ref loc)3420 output_loc_sequence (dw_loc_descr_ref loc)
3421 {
3422   for (; loc != NULL; loc = loc->dw_loc_next)
3423     {
3424       /* Output the opcode.  */
3425       dw2_asm_output_data (1, loc->dw_loc_opc,
3426 			   "%s", dwarf_stack_op_name (loc->dw_loc_opc));
3427 
3428       /* Output the operand(s) (if any).  */
3429       output_loc_operands (loc);
3430     }
3431 }
3432 
3433 /* This routine will generate the correct assembly data for a location
3434    description based on a cfi entry with a complex address.  */
3435 
3436 static void
output_cfa_loc(dw_cfi_ref cfi)3437 output_cfa_loc (dw_cfi_ref cfi)
3438 {
3439   dw_loc_descr_ref loc;
3440   unsigned long size;
3441 
3442   /* Output the size of the block.  */
3443   loc = cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_loc;
3444   size = size_of_locs (loc);
3445   dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (size, NULL);
3446 
3447   /* Now output the operations themselves.  */
3448   output_loc_sequence (loc);
3449 }
3450 
3451 /* This function builds a dwarf location descriptor sequence from a
3452    dw_cfa_location, adding the given OFFSET to the result of the
3453    expression.  */
3454 
3455 static struct dw_loc_descr_struct *
build_cfa_loc(dw_cfa_location * cfa,HOST_WIDE_INT offset)3456 build_cfa_loc (dw_cfa_location *cfa, HOST_WIDE_INT offset)
3457 {
3458   struct dw_loc_descr_struct *head, *tmp;
3459 
3460   offset += cfa->offset;
3461 
3462   if (cfa->indirect)
3463     {
3464       if (cfa->base_offset)
3465 	{
3466 	  if (cfa->reg <= 31)
3467 	    head = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_breg0 + cfa->reg, cfa->base_offset, 0);
3468 	  else
3469 	    head = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_bregx, cfa->reg, cfa->base_offset);
3470 	}
3471       else if (cfa->reg <= 31)
3472 	head = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_reg0 + cfa->reg, 0, 0);
3473       else
3474 	head = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_regx, cfa->reg, 0);
3475 
3476       head->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_const;
3477       tmp = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_deref, 0, 0);
3478       add_loc_descr (&head, tmp);
3479       if (offset != 0)
3480 	{
3481 	  tmp = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus_uconst, offset, 0);
3482 	  add_loc_descr (&head, tmp);
3483 	}
3484     }
3485   else
3486     {
3487       if (offset == 0)
3488 	if (cfa->reg <= 31)
3489 	  head = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_reg0 + cfa->reg, 0, 0);
3490 	else
3491 	  head = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_regx, cfa->reg, 0);
3492       else if (cfa->reg <= 31)
3493 	head = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_breg0 + cfa->reg, offset, 0);
3494       else
3495 	head = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_bregx, cfa->reg, offset);
3496     }
3497 
3498   return head;
3499 }
3500 
3501 /* This function fills in aa dw_cfa_location structure from a dwarf location
3502    descriptor sequence.  */
3503 
3504 static void
get_cfa_from_loc_descr(dw_cfa_location * cfa,struct dw_loc_descr_struct * loc)3505 get_cfa_from_loc_descr (dw_cfa_location *cfa, struct dw_loc_descr_struct *loc)
3506 {
3507   struct dw_loc_descr_struct *ptr;
3508   cfa->offset = 0;
3509   cfa->base_offset = 0;
3510   cfa->indirect = 0;
3511   cfa->reg = -1;
3512 
3513   for (ptr = loc; ptr != NULL; ptr = ptr->dw_loc_next)
3514     {
3515       enum dwarf_location_atom op = ptr->dw_loc_opc;
3516 
3517       switch (op)
3518 	{
3519 	case DW_OP_reg0:
3520 	case DW_OP_reg1:
3521 	case DW_OP_reg2:
3522 	case DW_OP_reg3:
3523 	case DW_OP_reg4:
3524 	case DW_OP_reg5:
3525 	case DW_OP_reg6:
3526 	case DW_OP_reg7:
3527 	case DW_OP_reg8:
3528 	case DW_OP_reg9:
3529 	case DW_OP_reg10:
3530 	case DW_OP_reg11:
3531 	case DW_OP_reg12:
3532 	case DW_OP_reg13:
3533 	case DW_OP_reg14:
3534 	case DW_OP_reg15:
3535 	case DW_OP_reg16:
3536 	case DW_OP_reg17:
3537 	case DW_OP_reg18:
3538 	case DW_OP_reg19:
3539 	case DW_OP_reg20:
3540 	case DW_OP_reg21:
3541 	case DW_OP_reg22:
3542 	case DW_OP_reg23:
3543 	case DW_OP_reg24:
3544 	case DW_OP_reg25:
3545 	case DW_OP_reg26:
3546 	case DW_OP_reg27:
3547 	case DW_OP_reg28:
3548 	case DW_OP_reg29:
3549 	case DW_OP_reg30:
3550 	case DW_OP_reg31:
3551 	  cfa->reg = op - DW_OP_reg0;
3552 	  break;
3553 	case DW_OP_regx:
3554 	  cfa->reg = ptr->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_int;
3555 	  break;
3556 	case DW_OP_breg0:
3557 	case DW_OP_breg1:
3558 	case DW_OP_breg2:
3559 	case DW_OP_breg3:
3560 	case DW_OP_breg4:
3561 	case DW_OP_breg5:
3562 	case DW_OP_breg6:
3563 	case DW_OP_breg7:
3564 	case DW_OP_breg8:
3565 	case DW_OP_breg9:
3566 	case DW_OP_breg10:
3567 	case DW_OP_breg11:
3568 	case DW_OP_breg12:
3569 	case DW_OP_breg13:
3570 	case DW_OP_breg14:
3571 	case DW_OP_breg15:
3572 	case DW_OP_breg16:
3573 	case DW_OP_breg17:
3574 	case DW_OP_breg18:
3575 	case DW_OP_breg19:
3576 	case DW_OP_breg20:
3577 	case DW_OP_breg21:
3578 	case DW_OP_breg22:
3579 	case DW_OP_breg23:
3580 	case DW_OP_breg24:
3581 	case DW_OP_breg25:
3582 	case DW_OP_breg26:
3583 	case DW_OP_breg27:
3584 	case DW_OP_breg28:
3585 	case DW_OP_breg29:
3586 	case DW_OP_breg30:
3587 	case DW_OP_breg31:
3588 	  cfa->reg = op - DW_OP_breg0;
3589 	  cfa->base_offset = ptr->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_int;
3590 	  break;
3591 	case DW_OP_bregx:
3592 	  cfa->reg = ptr->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_int;
3593 	  cfa->base_offset = ptr->dw_loc_oprnd2.v.val_int;
3594 	  break;
3595 	case DW_OP_deref:
3596 	  cfa->indirect = 1;
3597 	  break;
3598 	case DW_OP_plus_uconst:
3599 	  cfa->offset = ptr->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_unsigned;
3600 	  break;
3601 	default:
3602 	  internal_error ("DW_LOC_OP %s not implemented",
3603 			  dwarf_stack_op_name (ptr->dw_loc_opc));
3604 	}
3605     }
3606 }
3607 #endif /* .debug_frame support */
3608 
3609 /* And now, the support for symbolic debugging information.  */
3610 #ifdef DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO
3611 
3612 /* .debug_str support.  */
3613 static int output_indirect_string (void **, void *);
3614 
3615 static void dwarf2out_init (const char *);
3616 static void dwarf2out_finish (const char *);
3617 static void dwarf2out_define (unsigned int, const char *);
3618 static void dwarf2out_undef (unsigned int, const char *);
3619 static void dwarf2out_start_source_file (unsigned, const char *);
3620 static void dwarf2out_end_source_file (unsigned);
3621 static void dwarf2out_begin_block (unsigned, unsigned);
3622 static void dwarf2out_end_block (unsigned, unsigned);
3623 static bool dwarf2out_ignore_block (tree);
3624 static void dwarf2out_global_decl (tree);
3625 static void dwarf2out_type_decl (tree, int);
3626 static void dwarf2out_imported_module_or_decl (tree, tree);
3627 static void dwarf2out_abstract_function (tree);
3628 static void dwarf2out_var_location (rtx);
3629 static void dwarf2out_begin_function (tree);
3630 static void dwarf2out_switch_text_section (void);
3631 
3632 /* The debug hooks structure.  */
3633 
3634 const struct gcc_debug_hooks dwarf2_debug_hooks =
3635 {
3636   dwarf2out_init,
3637   dwarf2out_finish,
3638   dwarf2out_define,
3639   dwarf2out_undef,
3640   dwarf2out_start_source_file,
3641   dwarf2out_end_source_file,
3642   dwarf2out_begin_block,
3643   dwarf2out_end_block,
3644   dwarf2out_ignore_block,
3645   dwarf2out_source_line,
3646   dwarf2out_begin_prologue,
3647   debug_nothing_int_charstar,	/* end_prologue */
3648   dwarf2out_end_epilogue,
3649   dwarf2out_begin_function,
3650   debug_nothing_int,		/* end_function */
3651   dwarf2out_decl,		/* function_decl */
3652   dwarf2out_global_decl,
3653   dwarf2out_type_decl,		/* type_decl */
3654   dwarf2out_imported_module_or_decl,
3655   debug_nothing_tree,		/* deferred_inline_function */
3656   /* The DWARF 2 backend tries to reduce debugging bloat by not
3657      emitting the abstract description of inline functions until
3658      something tries to reference them.  */
3659   dwarf2out_abstract_function,	/* outlining_inline_function */
3660   debug_nothing_rtx,		/* label */
3661   debug_nothing_int,		/* handle_pch */
3662   dwarf2out_var_location,
3663   dwarf2out_switch_text_section,
3664   1                             /* start_end_main_source_file */
3665 };
3666 #endif
3667 
3668 /* NOTE: In the comments in this file, many references are made to
3669    "Debugging Information Entries".  This term is abbreviated as `DIE'
3670    throughout the remainder of this file.  */
3671 
3672 /* An internal representation of the DWARF output is built, and then
3673    walked to generate the DWARF debugging info.  The walk of the internal
3674    representation is done after the entire program has been compiled.
3675    The types below are used to describe the internal representation.  */
3676 
3677 /* Various DIE's use offsets relative to the beginning of the
3678    .debug_info section to refer to each other.  */
3679 
3680 typedef long int dw_offset;
3681 
3682 /* Define typedefs here to avoid circular dependencies.  */
3683 
3684 typedef struct dw_attr_struct *dw_attr_ref;
3685 typedef struct dw_line_info_struct *dw_line_info_ref;
3686 typedef struct dw_separate_line_info_struct *dw_separate_line_info_ref;
3687 typedef struct pubname_struct *pubname_ref;
3688 typedef struct dw_ranges_struct *dw_ranges_ref;
3689 
3690 /* Each entry in the line_info_table maintains the file and
3691    line number associated with the label generated for that
3692    entry.  The label gives the PC value associated with
3693    the line number entry.  */
3694 
3695 typedef struct dw_line_info_struct GTY(())
3696 {
3697   unsigned long dw_file_num;
3698   unsigned long dw_line_num;
3699 }
3700 dw_line_info_entry;
3701 
3702 /* Line information for functions in separate sections; each one gets its
3703    own sequence.  */
3704 typedef struct dw_separate_line_info_struct GTY(())
3705 {
3706   unsigned long dw_file_num;
3707   unsigned long dw_line_num;
3708   unsigned long function;
3709 }
3710 dw_separate_line_info_entry;
3711 
3712 /* Each DIE attribute has a field specifying the attribute kind,
3713    a link to the next attribute in the chain, and an attribute value.
3714    Attributes are typically linked below the DIE they modify.  */
3715 
3716 typedef struct dw_attr_struct GTY(())
3717 {
3718   enum dwarf_attribute dw_attr;
3719   dw_val_node dw_attr_val;
3720 }
3721 dw_attr_node;
3722 
3723 DEF_VEC_O(dw_attr_node);
3724 DEF_VEC_ALLOC_O(dw_attr_node,gc);
3725 
3726 /* The Debugging Information Entry (DIE) structure.  DIEs form a tree.
3727    The children of each node form a circular list linked by
3728    die_sib.  die_child points to the node *before* the "first" child node.  */
3729 
3730 typedef struct die_struct GTY(())
3731 {
3732   enum dwarf_tag die_tag;
3733   char *die_symbol;
3734   VEC(dw_attr_node,gc) * die_attr;
3735   dw_die_ref die_parent;
3736   dw_die_ref die_child;
3737   dw_die_ref die_sib;
3738   dw_die_ref die_definition; /* ref from a specification to its definition */
3739   dw_offset die_offset;
3740   unsigned long die_abbrev;
3741   int die_mark;
3742   /* Die is used and must not be pruned as unused.  */
3743   int die_perennial_p;
3744   unsigned int decl_id;
3745 }
3746 die_node;
3747 
3748 /* Evaluate 'expr' while 'c' is set to each child of DIE in order.  */
3749 #define FOR_EACH_CHILD(die, c, expr) do {	\
3750   c = die->die_child;				\
3751   if (c) do {					\
3752     c = c->die_sib;				\
3753     expr;					\
3754   } while (c != die->die_child);		\
3755 } while (0)
3756 
3757 /* The pubname structure */
3758 
3759 typedef struct pubname_struct GTY(())
3760 {
3761   dw_die_ref die;
3762   char *name;
3763 }
3764 pubname_entry;
3765 
3766 DEF_VEC_O(pubname_entry);
3767 DEF_VEC_ALLOC_O(pubname_entry, gc);
3768 
3769 struct dw_ranges_struct GTY(())
3770 {
3771   int block_num;
3772 };
3773 
3774 /* The limbo die list structure.  */
3775 typedef struct limbo_die_struct GTY(())
3776 {
3777   dw_die_ref die;
3778   tree created_for;
3779   struct limbo_die_struct *next;
3780 }
3781 limbo_die_node;
3782 
3783 /* How to start an assembler comment.  */
3784 #ifndef ASM_COMMENT_START
3785 #define ASM_COMMENT_START ";#"
3786 #endif
3787 
3788 /* Define a macro which returns nonzero for a TYPE_DECL which was
3789    implicitly generated for a tagged type.
3790 
3791    Note that unlike the gcc front end (which generates a NULL named
3792    TYPE_DECL node for each complete tagged type, each array type, and
3793    each function type node created) the g++ front end generates a
3794    _named_ TYPE_DECL node for each tagged type node created.
3795    These TYPE_DECLs have DECL_ARTIFICIAL set, so we know not to
3796    generate a DW_TAG_typedef DIE for them.  */
3797 
3798 #define TYPE_DECL_IS_STUB(decl)				\
3799   (DECL_NAME (decl) == NULL_TREE			\
3800    || (DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl)				\
3801        && is_tagged_type (TREE_TYPE (decl))		\
3802        && ((decl == TYPE_STUB_DECL (TREE_TYPE (decl)))	\
3803 	   /* This is necessary for stub decls that	\
3804 	      appear in nested inline functions.  */	\
3805 	   || (DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (decl) != NULL_TREE	\
3806 	       && (decl_ultimate_origin (decl)		\
3807 		   == TYPE_STUB_DECL (TREE_TYPE (decl)))))))
3808 
3809 /* Information concerning the compilation unit's programming
3810    language, and compiler version.  */
3811 
3812 /* Fixed size portion of the DWARF compilation unit header.  */
3813 #define DWARF_COMPILE_UNIT_HEADER_SIZE \
3814   (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE + DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE + 3)
3815 
3816 /* Fixed size portion of public names info.  */
3817 #define DWARF_PUBNAMES_HEADER_SIZE (2 * DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE + 2)
3818 
3819 /* Fixed size portion of the address range info.  */
3820 #define DWARF_ARANGES_HEADER_SIZE					\
3821   (DWARF_ROUND (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE + DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE + 4,	\
3822                 DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE * 2)					\
3823    - DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE)
3824 
3825 /* Size of padding portion in the address range info.  It must be
3826    aligned to twice the pointer size.  */
3827 #define DWARF_ARANGES_PAD_SIZE \
3828   (DWARF_ROUND (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE + DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE + 4, \
3829                 DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE * 2) \
3830    - (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE + DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE + 4))
3831 
3832 /* Use assembler line directives if available.  */
3833 #ifndef DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO
3834 #ifdef HAVE_AS_DWARF2_DEBUG_LINE
3835 #define DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO 1
3836 #else
3837 #define DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO 0
3838 #endif
3839 #endif
3840 
3841 /* Minimum line offset in a special line info. opcode.
3842    This value was chosen to give a reasonable range of values.  */
3843 #define DWARF_LINE_BASE  -10
3844 
3845 /* First special line opcode - leave room for the standard opcodes.  */
3846 #define DWARF_LINE_OPCODE_BASE  10
3847 
3848 /* Range of line offsets in a special line info. opcode.  */
3849 #define DWARF_LINE_RANGE  (254-DWARF_LINE_OPCODE_BASE+1)
3850 
3851 /* Flag that indicates the initial value of the is_stmt_start flag.
3852    In the present implementation, we do not mark any lines as
3853    the beginning of a source statement, because that information
3854    is not made available by the GCC front-end.  */
3855 #define	DWARF_LINE_DEFAULT_IS_STMT_START 1
3856 
3857 #ifdef DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO
3858 /* This location is used by calc_die_sizes() to keep track
3859    the offset of each DIE within the .debug_info section.  */
3860 static unsigned long next_die_offset;
3861 #endif
3862 
3863 /* Record the root of the DIE's built for the current compilation unit.  */
3864 static GTY(()) dw_die_ref comp_unit_die;
3865 
3866 /* A list of DIEs with a NULL parent waiting to be relocated.  */
3867 static GTY(()) limbo_die_node *limbo_die_list;
3868 
3869 /* Filenames referenced by this compilation unit.  */
3870 static GTY((param_is (struct dwarf_file_data))) htab_t file_table;
3871 
3872 /* A hash table of references to DIE's that describe declarations.
3873    The key is a DECL_UID() which is a unique number identifying each decl.  */
3874 static GTY ((param_is (struct die_struct))) htab_t decl_die_table;
3875 
3876 /* Node of the variable location list.  */
3877 struct var_loc_node GTY ((chain_next ("%h.next")))
3878 {
3879   rtx GTY (()) var_loc_note;
3880   const char * GTY (()) label;
3881   const char * GTY (()) section_label;
3882   struct var_loc_node * GTY (()) next;
3883 };
3884 
3885 /* Variable location list.  */
3886 struct var_loc_list_def GTY (())
3887 {
3888   struct var_loc_node * GTY (()) first;
3889 
3890   /* Do not mark the last element of the chained list because
3891      it is marked through the chain.  */
3892   struct var_loc_node * GTY ((skip ("%h"))) last;
3893 
3894   /* DECL_UID of the variable decl.  */
3895   unsigned int decl_id;
3896 };
3897 typedef struct var_loc_list_def var_loc_list;
3898 
3899 
3900 /* Table of decl location linked lists.  */
3901 static GTY ((param_is (var_loc_list))) htab_t decl_loc_table;
3902 
3903 /* A pointer to the base of a list of references to DIE's that
3904    are uniquely identified by their tag, presence/absence of
3905    children DIE's, and list of attribute/value pairs.  */
3906 static GTY((length ("abbrev_die_table_allocated")))
3907   dw_die_ref *abbrev_die_table;
3908 
3909 /* Number of elements currently allocated for abbrev_die_table.  */
3910 static GTY(()) unsigned abbrev_die_table_allocated;
3911 
3912 /* Number of elements in type_die_table currently in use.  */
3913 static GTY(()) unsigned abbrev_die_table_in_use;
3914 
3915 /* Size (in elements) of increments by which we may expand the
3916    abbrev_die_table.  */
3917 #define ABBREV_DIE_TABLE_INCREMENT 256
3918 
3919 /* A pointer to the base of a table that contains line information
3920    for each source code line in .text in the compilation unit.  */
3921 static GTY((length ("line_info_table_allocated")))
3922      dw_line_info_ref line_info_table;
3923 
3924 /* Number of elements currently allocated for line_info_table.  */
3925 static GTY(()) unsigned line_info_table_allocated;
3926 
3927 /* Number of elements in line_info_table currently in use.  */
3928 static GTY(()) unsigned line_info_table_in_use;
3929 
3930 /* True if the compilation unit places functions in more than one section.  */
3931 static GTY(()) bool have_multiple_function_sections = false;
3932 
3933 /* A pointer to the base of a table that contains line information
3934    for each source code line outside of .text in the compilation unit.  */
3935 static GTY ((length ("separate_line_info_table_allocated")))
3936      dw_separate_line_info_ref separate_line_info_table;
3937 
3938 /* Number of elements currently allocated for separate_line_info_table.  */
3939 static GTY(()) unsigned separate_line_info_table_allocated;
3940 
3941 /* Number of elements in separate_line_info_table currently in use.  */
3942 static GTY(()) unsigned separate_line_info_table_in_use;
3943 
3944 /* Size (in elements) of increments by which we may expand the
3945    line_info_table.  */
3946 #define LINE_INFO_TABLE_INCREMENT 1024
3947 
3948 /* A pointer to the base of a table that contains a list of publicly
3949    accessible names.  */
3950 static GTY (()) VEC (pubname_entry, gc) *  pubname_table;
3951 
3952 /* A pointer to the base of a table that contains a list of publicly
3953    accessible types.  */
3954 static GTY (()) VEC (pubname_entry, gc) * pubtype_table;
3955 
3956 /* Array of dies for which we should generate .debug_arange info.  */
3957 static GTY((length ("arange_table_allocated"))) dw_die_ref *arange_table;
3958 
3959 /* Number of elements currently allocated for arange_table.  */
3960 static GTY(()) unsigned arange_table_allocated;
3961 
3962 /* Number of elements in arange_table currently in use.  */
3963 static GTY(()) unsigned arange_table_in_use;
3964 
3965 /* Size (in elements) of increments by which we may expand the
3966    arange_table.  */
3967 #define ARANGE_TABLE_INCREMENT 64
3968 
3969 /* Array of dies for which we should generate .debug_ranges info.  */
3970 static GTY ((length ("ranges_table_allocated"))) dw_ranges_ref ranges_table;
3971 
3972 /* Number of elements currently allocated for ranges_table.  */
3973 static GTY(()) unsigned ranges_table_allocated;
3974 
3975 /* Number of elements in ranges_table currently in use.  */
3976 static GTY(()) unsigned ranges_table_in_use;
3977 
3978 /* Size (in elements) of increments by which we may expand the
3979    ranges_table.  */
3980 #define RANGES_TABLE_INCREMENT 64
3981 
3982 /* Whether we have location lists that need outputting */
3983 static GTY(()) bool have_location_lists;
3984 
3985 /* Unique label counter.  */
3986 static GTY(()) unsigned int loclabel_num;
3987 
3988 #ifdef DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO
3989 /* Record whether the function being analyzed contains inlined functions.  */
3990 static int current_function_has_inlines;
3991 #endif
3992 #if 0 && defined (MIPS_DEBUGGING_INFO)
3993 static int comp_unit_has_inlines;
3994 #endif
3995 
3996 /* The last file entry emitted by maybe_emit_file().  */
3997 static GTY(()) struct dwarf_file_data * last_emitted_file;
3998 
3999 /* Number of internal labels generated by gen_internal_sym().  */
4000 static GTY(()) int label_num;
4001 
4002 /* Cached result of previous call to lookup_filename.  */
4003 static GTY(()) struct dwarf_file_data * file_table_last_lookup;
4004 
4005 #ifdef DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO
4006 
4007 /* Offset from the "steady-state frame pointer" to the frame base,
4008    within the current function.  */
4009 static HOST_WIDE_INT frame_pointer_fb_offset;
4010 
4011 /* Forward declarations for functions defined in this file.  */
4012 
4013 static int is_pseudo_reg (rtx);
4014 static tree type_main_variant (tree);
4015 static int is_tagged_type (tree);
4016 static const char *dwarf_tag_name (unsigned);
4017 static const char *dwarf_attr_name (unsigned);
4018 static const char *dwarf_form_name (unsigned);
4019 static tree decl_ultimate_origin (tree);
4020 static tree block_ultimate_origin (tree);
4021 static tree decl_class_context (tree);
4022 static void add_dwarf_attr (dw_die_ref, dw_attr_ref);
4023 static inline enum dw_val_class AT_class (dw_attr_ref);
4024 static void add_AT_flag (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, unsigned);
4025 static inline unsigned AT_flag (dw_attr_ref);
4026 static void add_AT_int (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, HOST_WIDE_INT);
4027 static inline HOST_WIDE_INT AT_int (dw_attr_ref);
4028 static void add_AT_unsigned (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT);
4029 static inline unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT AT_unsigned (dw_attr_ref);
4030 static void add_AT_long_long (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, unsigned long,
4031 			      unsigned long);
4032 static inline void add_AT_vec (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, unsigned int,
4033 			       unsigned int, unsigned char *);
4034 static hashval_t debug_str_do_hash (const void *);
4035 static int debug_str_eq (const void *, const void *);
4036 static void add_AT_string (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, const char *);
4037 static inline const char *AT_string (dw_attr_ref);
4038 static int AT_string_form (dw_attr_ref);
4039 static void add_AT_die_ref (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, dw_die_ref);
4040 static void add_AT_specification (dw_die_ref, dw_die_ref);
4041 static inline dw_die_ref AT_ref (dw_attr_ref);
4042 static inline int AT_ref_external (dw_attr_ref);
4043 static inline void set_AT_ref_external (dw_attr_ref, int);
4044 static void add_AT_fde_ref (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, unsigned);
4045 static void add_AT_loc (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, dw_loc_descr_ref);
4046 static inline dw_loc_descr_ref AT_loc (dw_attr_ref);
4047 static void add_AT_loc_list (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute,
4048 			     dw_loc_list_ref);
4049 static inline dw_loc_list_ref AT_loc_list (dw_attr_ref);
4050 static void add_AT_addr (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, rtx);
4051 static inline rtx AT_addr (dw_attr_ref);
4052 static void add_AT_lbl_id (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, const char *);
4053 static void add_AT_lineptr (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, const char *);
4054 static void add_AT_macptr (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, const char *);
4055 static void add_AT_offset (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute,
4056 			   unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT);
4057 static void add_AT_range_list (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute,
4058 			       unsigned long);
4059 static inline const char *AT_lbl (dw_attr_ref);
4060 static dw_attr_ref get_AT (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute);
4061 static const char *get_AT_low_pc (dw_die_ref);
4062 static const char *get_AT_hi_pc (dw_die_ref);
4063 static const char *get_AT_string (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute);
4064 static int get_AT_flag (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute);
4065 static unsigned get_AT_unsigned (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute);
4066 static inline dw_die_ref get_AT_ref (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute);
4067 static bool is_c_family (void);
4068 static bool is_cxx (void);
4069 static bool is_java (void);
4070 static bool is_fortran (void);
4071 static bool is_ada (void);
4072 static void remove_AT (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute);
4073 static void remove_child_TAG (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_tag);
4074 static void add_child_die (dw_die_ref, dw_die_ref);
4075 static dw_die_ref new_die (enum dwarf_tag, dw_die_ref, tree);
4076 static dw_die_ref lookup_type_die (tree);
4077 static void equate_type_number_to_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
4078 static hashval_t decl_die_table_hash (const void *);
4079 static int decl_die_table_eq (const void *, const void *);
4080 static dw_die_ref lookup_decl_die (tree);
4081 static hashval_t decl_loc_table_hash (const void *);
4082 static int decl_loc_table_eq (const void *, const void *);
4083 static var_loc_list *lookup_decl_loc (tree);
4084 static void equate_decl_number_to_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
4085 static void add_var_loc_to_decl (tree, struct var_loc_node *);
4086 static void print_spaces (FILE *);
4087 static void print_die (dw_die_ref, FILE *);
4088 static void print_dwarf_line_table (FILE *);
4089 static dw_die_ref push_new_compile_unit (dw_die_ref, dw_die_ref);
4090 static dw_die_ref pop_compile_unit (dw_die_ref);
4091 static void loc_checksum (dw_loc_descr_ref, struct md5_ctx *);
4092 static void attr_checksum (dw_attr_ref, struct md5_ctx *, int *);
4093 static void die_checksum (dw_die_ref, struct md5_ctx *, int *);
4094 static int same_loc_p (dw_loc_descr_ref, dw_loc_descr_ref, int *);
4095 static int same_dw_val_p (dw_val_node *, dw_val_node *, int *);
4096 static int same_attr_p (dw_attr_ref, dw_attr_ref, int *);
4097 static int same_die_p (dw_die_ref, dw_die_ref, int *);
4098 static int same_die_p_wrap (dw_die_ref, dw_die_ref);
4099 static void compute_section_prefix (dw_die_ref);
4100 static int is_type_die (dw_die_ref);
4101 static int is_comdat_die (dw_die_ref);
4102 static int is_symbol_die (dw_die_ref);
4103 static void assign_symbol_names (dw_die_ref);
4104 static void break_out_includes (dw_die_ref);
4105 static hashval_t htab_cu_hash (const void *);
4106 static int htab_cu_eq (const void *, const void *);
4107 static void htab_cu_del (void *);
4108 static int check_duplicate_cu (dw_die_ref, htab_t, unsigned *);
4109 static void record_comdat_symbol_number (dw_die_ref, htab_t, unsigned);
4110 static void add_sibling_attributes (dw_die_ref);
4111 static void build_abbrev_table (dw_die_ref);
4112 static void output_location_lists (dw_die_ref);
4113 static int constant_size (long unsigned);
4114 static unsigned long size_of_die (dw_die_ref);
4115 static void calc_die_sizes (dw_die_ref);
4116 static void mark_dies (dw_die_ref);
4117 static void unmark_dies (dw_die_ref);
4118 static void unmark_all_dies (dw_die_ref);
4119 static unsigned long size_of_pubnames (VEC (pubname_entry,gc) *);
4120 static unsigned long size_of_aranges (void);
4121 static enum dwarf_form value_format (dw_attr_ref);
4122 static void output_value_format (dw_attr_ref);
4123 static void output_abbrev_section (void);
4124 static void output_die_symbol (dw_die_ref);
4125 static void output_die (dw_die_ref);
4126 static void output_compilation_unit_header (void);
4127 static void output_comp_unit (dw_die_ref, int);
4128 static const char *dwarf2_name (tree, int);
4129 static void add_pubname (tree, dw_die_ref);
4130 static void add_pubtype (tree, dw_die_ref);
4131 static void output_pubnames (VEC (pubname_entry,gc) *);
4132 static void add_arange (tree, dw_die_ref);
4133 static void output_aranges (void);
4134 static unsigned int add_ranges (tree);
4135 static void output_ranges (void);
4136 static void output_line_info (void);
4137 static void output_file_names (void);
4138 static dw_die_ref base_type_die (tree);
4139 static tree root_type (tree);
4140 static int is_base_type (tree);
4141 static bool is_subrange_type (tree);
4142 static dw_die_ref subrange_type_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
4143 static dw_die_ref modified_type_die (tree, int, int, dw_die_ref);
4144 static int type_is_enum (tree);
4145 static unsigned int dbx_reg_number (rtx);
4146 static void add_loc_descr_op_piece (dw_loc_descr_ref *, int);
4147 static dw_loc_descr_ref reg_loc_descriptor (rtx);
4148 static dw_loc_descr_ref one_reg_loc_descriptor (unsigned int);
4149 static dw_loc_descr_ref multiple_reg_loc_descriptor (rtx, rtx);
4150 static dw_loc_descr_ref int_loc_descriptor (HOST_WIDE_INT);
4151 static dw_loc_descr_ref based_loc_descr (rtx, HOST_WIDE_INT);
4152 static int is_based_loc (rtx);
4153 static dw_loc_descr_ref mem_loc_descriptor (rtx, enum machine_mode mode);
4154 static dw_loc_descr_ref concat_loc_descriptor (rtx, rtx);
4155 static dw_loc_descr_ref loc_descriptor (rtx);
4156 static dw_loc_descr_ref loc_descriptor_from_tree_1 (tree, int);
4157 static dw_loc_descr_ref loc_descriptor_from_tree (tree);
4158 static HOST_WIDE_INT ceiling (HOST_WIDE_INT, unsigned int);
4159 static tree field_type (tree);
4160 static unsigned int simple_type_align_in_bits (tree);
4161 static unsigned int simple_decl_align_in_bits (tree);
4162 static unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT simple_type_size_in_bits (tree);
4163 static HOST_WIDE_INT field_byte_offset (tree);
4164 static void add_AT_location_description	(dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute,
4165 					 dw_loc_descr_ref);
4166 static void add_data_member_location_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree);
4167 static void add_const_value_attribute (dw_die_ref, rtx);
4168 static void insert_int (HOST_WIDE_INT, unsigned, unsigned char *);
4169 static HOST_WIDE_INT extract_int (const unsigned char *, unsigned);
4170 static void insert_float (rtx, unsigned char *);
4171 static rtx rtl_for_decl_location (tree);
4172 static void add_location_or_const_value_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree,
4173 						   enum dwarf_attribute);
4174 static void tree_add_const_value_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree);
4175 static void add_name_attribute (dw_die_ref, const char *);
4176 static void add_comp_dir_attribute (dw_die_ref);
4177 static void add_bound_info (dw_die_ref, enum dwarf_attribute, tree);
4178 static void add_subscript_info (dw_die_ref, tree);
4179 static void add_byte_size_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree);
4180 static void add_bit_offset_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree);
4181 static void add_bit_size_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree);
4182 static void add_prototyped_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree);
4183 static void add_abstract_origin_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree);
4184 static void add_pure_or_virtual_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree);
4185 static void add_src_coords_attributes (dw_die_ref, tree);
4186 static void add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (dw_die_ref, tree);
4187 static void push_decl_scope (tree);
4188 static void pop_decl_scope (void);
4189 static dw_die_ref scope_die_for (tree, dw_die_ref);
4190 static inline int local_scope_p (dw_die_ref);
4191 static inline int class_or_namespace_scope_p (dw_die_ref);
4192 static void add_type_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree, int, int, dw_die_ref);
4193 static void add_calling_convention_attribute (dw_die_ref, tree);
4194 static const char *type_tag (tree);
4195 static tree member_declared_type (tree);
4196 #if 0
4197 static const char *decl_start_label (tree);
4198 #endif
4199 static void gen_array_type_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
4200 #if 0
4201 static void gen_entry_point_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
4202 #endif
4203 static void gen_inlined_enumeration_type_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
4204 static void gen_inlined_structure_type_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
4205 static void gen_inlined_union_type_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
4206 static dw_die_ref gen_enumeration_type_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
4207 static dw_die_ref gen_formal_parameter_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
4208 static void gen_unspecified_parameters_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
4209 static void gen_formal_types_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
4210 static void gen_subprogram_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
4211 static void gen_variable_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
4212 static void gen_label_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
4213 static void gen_lexical_block_die (tree, dw_die_ref, int);
4214 static void gen_inlined_subroutine_die (tree, dw_die_ref, int);
4215 static void gen_field_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
4216 static void gen_ptr_to_mbr_type_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
4217 static dw_die_ref gen_compile_unit_die (const char *);
4218 static void gen_inheritance_die (tree, tree, dw_die_ref);
4219 static void gen_member_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
4220 static void gen_struct_or_union_type_die (tree, dw_die_ref,
4221 						enum debug_info_usage);
4222 static void gen_subroutine_type_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
4223 static void gen_typedef_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
4224 static void gen_type_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
4225 static void gen_tagged_type_instantiation_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
4226 static void gen_block_die (tree, dw_die_ref, int);
4227 static void decls_for_scope (tree, dw_die_ref, int);
4228 static int is_redundant_typedef (tree);
4229 static void gen_namespace_die (tree);
4230 static void gen_decl_die (tree, dw_die_ref);
4231 static dw_die_ref force_decl_die (tree);
4232 static dw_die_ref force_type_die (tree);
4233 static dw_die_ref setup_namespace_context (tree, dw_die_ref);
4234 static void declare_in_namespace (tree, dw_die_ref);
4235 static struct dwarf_file_data * lookup_filename (const char *);
4236 static void retry_incomplete_types (void);
4237 static void gen_type_die_for_member (tree, tree, dw_die_ref);
4238 static void splice_child_die (dw_die_ref, dw_die_ref);
4239 static int file_info_cmp (const void *, const void *);
4240 static dw_loc_list_ref new_loc_list (dw_loc_descr_ref, const char *,
4241 				     const char *, const char *, unsigned);
4242 static void add_loc_descr_to_loc_list (dw_loc_list_ref *, dw_loc_descr_ref,
4243 				       const char *, const char *,
4244 				       const char *);
4245 static void output_loc_list (dw_loc_list_ref);
4246 static char *gen_internal_sym (const char *);
4247 
4248 static void prune_unmark_dies (dw_die_ref);
4249 static void prune_unused_types_mark (dw_die_ref, int);
4250 static void prune_unused_types_walk (dw_die_ref);
4251 static void prune_unused_types_walk_attribs (dw_die_ref);
4252 static void prune_unused_types_prune (dw_die_ref);
4253 static void prune_unused_types (void);
4254 static int maybe_emit_file (struct dwarf_file_data *fd);
4255 
4256 /* Section names used to hold DWARF debugging information.  */
4257 #ifndef DEBUG_INFO_SECTION
4258 #define DEBUG_INFO_SECTION	".debug_info"
4259 #endif
4260 #ifndef DEBUG_ABBREV_SECTION
4261 #define DEBUG_ABBREV_SECTION	".debug_abbrev"
4262 #endif
4263 #ifndef DEBUG_ARANGES_SECTION
4264 #define DEBUG_ARANGES_SECTION	".debug_aranges"
4265 #endif
4266 #ifndef DEBUG_MACINFO_SECTION
4267 #define DEBUG_MACINFO_SECTION	".debug_macinfo"
4268 #endif
4269 #ifndef DEBUG_LINE_SECTION
4270 #define DEBUG_LINE_SECTION	".debug_line"
4271 #endif
4272 #ifndef DEBUG_LOC_SECTION
4273 #define DEBUG_LOC_SECTION	".debug_loc"
4274 #endif
4275 #ifndef DEBUG_PUBNAMES_SECTION
4276 #define DEBUG_PUBNAMES_SECTION	".debug_pubnames"
4277 #endif
4278 #ifndef DEBUG_STR_SECTION
4279 #define DEBUG_STR_SECTION	".debug_str"
4280 #endif
4281 #ifndef DEBUG_RANGES_SECTION
4282 #define DEBUG_RANGES_SECTION	".debug_ranges"
4283 #endif
4284 
4285 /* Standard ELF section names for compiled code and data.  */
4286 #ifndef TEXT_SECTION_NAME
4287 #define TEXT_SECTION_NAME	".text"
4288 #endif
4289 
4290 /* Section flags for .debug_str section.  */
4291 #define DEBUG_STR_SECTION_FLAGS \
4292   (HAVE_GAS_SHF_MERGE && flag_merge_constants			\
4293    ? SECTION_DEBUG | SECTION_MERGE | SECTION_STRINGS | 1	\
4294    : SECTION_DEBUG)
4295 
4296 /* Labels we insert at beginning sections we can reference instead of
4297    the section names themselves.  */
4298 
4299 #ifndef TEXT_SECTION_LABEL
4300 #define TEXT_SECTION_LABEL		"Ltext"
4301 #endif
4302 #ifndef COLD_TEXT_SECTION_LABEL
4303 #define COLD_TEXT_SECTION_LABEL         "Ltext_cold"
4304 #endif
4305 #ifndef DEBUG_LINE_SECTION_LABEL
4306 #define DEBUG_LINE_SECTION_LABEL	"Ldebug_line"
4307 #endif
4308 #ifndef DEBUG_INFO_SECTION_LABEL
4309 #define DEBUG_INFO_SECTION_LABEL	"Ldebug_info"
4310 #endif
4311 #ifndef DEBUG_ABBREV_SECTION_LABEL
4312 #define DEBUG_ABBREV_SECTION_LABEL	"Ldebug_abbrev"
4313 #endif
4314 #ifndef DEBUG_LOC_SECTION_LABEL
4315 #define DEBUG_LOC_SECTION_LABEL		"Ldebug_loc"
4316 #endif
4317 #ifndef DEBUG_RANGES_SECTION_LABEL
4318 #define DEBUG_RANGES_SECTION_LABEL	"Ldebug_ranges"
4319 #endif
4320 #ifndef DEBUG_MACINFO_SECTION_LABEL
4321 #define DEBUG_MACINFO_SECTION_LABEL     "Ldebug_macinfo"
4322 #endif
4323 
4324 /* Definitions of defaults for formats and names of various special
4325    (artificial) labels which may be generated within this file (when the -g
4326    options is used and DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO is in effect.
4327    If necessary, these may be overridden from within the tm.h file, but
4328    typically, overriding these defaults is unnecessary.  */
4329 
4330 static char text_end_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
4331 static char text_section_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
4332 static char cold_text_section_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
4333 static char cold_end_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
4334 static char abbrev_section_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
4335 static char debug_info_section_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
4336 static char debug_line_section_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
4337 static char macinfo_section_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
4338 static char loc_section_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
4339 static char ranges_section_label[2 * MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
4340 
4341 #ifndef TEXT_END_LABEL
4342 #define TEXT_END_LABEL		"Letext"
4343 #endif
4344 #ifndef COLD_END_LABEL
4345 #define COLD_END_LABEL          "Letext_cold"
4346 #endif
4347 #ifndef BLOCK_BEGIN_LABEL
4348 #define BLOCK_BEGIN_LABEL	"LBB"
4349 #endif
4350 #ifndef BLOCK_END_LABEL
4351 #define BLOCK_END_LABEL		"LBE"
4352 #endif
4353 #ifndef LINE_CODE_LABEL
4354 #define LINE_CODE_LABEL		"LM"
4355 #endif
4356 #ifndef SEPARATE_LINE_CODE_LABEL
4357 #define SEPARATE_LINE_CODE_LABEL	"LSM"
4358 #endif
4359 
4360 /* We allow a language front-end to designate a function that is to be
4361    called to "demangle" any name before it is put into a DIE.  */
4362 
4363 static const char *(*demangle_name_func) (const char *);
4364 
4365 void
dwarf2out_set_demangle_name_func(const char * (* func)(const char *))4366 dwarf2out_set_demangle_name_func (const char *(*func) (const char *))
4367 {
4368   demangle_name_func = func;
4369 }
4370 
4371 /* Test if rtl node points to a pseudo register.  */
4372 
4373 static inline int
is_pseudo_reg(rtx rtl)4374 is_pseudo_reg (rtx rtl)
4375 {
4376   return ((REG_P (rtl) && REGNO (rtl) >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
4377 	  || (GET_CODE (rtl) == SUBREG
4378 	      && REGNO (SUBREG_REG (rtl)) >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER));
4379 }
4380 
4381 /* Return a reference to a type, with its const and volatile qualifiers
4382    removed.  */
4383 
4384 static inline tree
type_main_variant(tree type)4385 type_main_variant (tree type)
4386 {
4387   type = TYPE_MAIN_VARIANT (type);
4388 
4389   /* ??? There really should be only one main variant among any group of
4390      variants of a given type (and all of the MAIN_VARIANT values for all
4391      members of the group should point to that one type) but sometimes the C
4392      front-end messes this up for array types, so we work around that bug
4393      here.  */
4394   if (TREE_CODE (type) == ARRAY_TYPE)
4395     while (type != TYPE_MAIN_VARIANT (type))
4396       type = TYPE_MAIN_VARIANT (type);
4397 
4398   return type;
4399 }
4400 
4401 /* Return nonzero if the given type node represents a tagged type.  */
4402 
4403 static inline int
is_tagged_type(tree type)4404 is_tagged_type (tree type)
4405 {
4406   enum tree_code code = TREE_CODE (type);
4407 
4408   return (code == RECORD_TYPE || code == UNION_TYPE
4409 	  || code == QUAL_UNION_TYPE || code == ENUMERAL_TYPE);
4410 }
4411 
4412 /* Convert a DIE tag into its string name.  */
4413 
4414 static const char *
dwarf_tag_name(unsigned int tag)4415 dwarf_tag_name (unsigned int tag)
4416 {
4417   switch (tag)
4418     {
4419     case DW_TAG_padding:
4420       return "DW_TAG_padding";
4421     case DW_TAG_array_type:
4422       return "DW_TAG_array_type";
4423     case DW_TAG_class_type:
4424       return "DW_TAG_class_type";
4425     case DW_TAG_entry_point:
4426       return "DW_TAG_entry_point";
4427     case DW_TAG_enumeration_type:
4428       return "DW_TAG_enumeration_type";
4429     case DW_TAG_formal_parameter:
4430       return "DW_TAG_formal_parameter";
4431     case DW_TAG_imported_declaration:
4432       return "DW_TAG_imported_declaration";
4433     case DW_TAG_label:
4434       return "DW_TAG_label";
4435     case DW_TAG_lexical_block:
4436       return "DW_TAG_lexical_block";
4437     case DW_TAG_member:
4438       return "DW_TAG_member";
4439     case DW_TAG_pointer_type:
4440       return "DW_TAG_pointer_type";
4441     case DW_TAG_reference_type:
4442       return "DW_TAG_reference_type";
4443     case DW_TAG_compile_unit:
4444       return "DW_TAG_compile_unit";
4445     case DW_TAG_string_type:
4446       return "DW_TAG_string_type";
4447     case DW_TAG_structure_type:
4448       return "DW_TAG_structure_type";
4449     case DW_TAG_subroutine_type:
4450       return "DW_TAG_subroutine_type";
4451     case DW_TAG_typedef:
4452       return "DW_TAG_typedef";
4453     case DW_TAG_union_type:
4454       return "DW_TAG_union_type";
4455     case DW_TAG_unspecified_parameters:
4456       return "DW_TAG_unspecified_parameters";
4457     case DW_TAG_variant:
4458       return "DW_TAG_variant";
4459     case DW_TAG_common_block:
4460       return "DW_TAG_common_block";
4461     case DW_TAG_common_inclusion:
4462       return "DW_TAG_common_inclusion";
4463     case DW_TAG_inheritance:
4464       return "DW_TAG_inheritance";
4465     case DW_TAG_inlined_subroutine:
4466       return "DW_TAG_inlined_subroutine";
4467     case DW_TAG_module:
4468       return "DW_TAG_module";
4469     case DW_TAG_ptr_to_member_type:
4470       return "DW_TAG_ptr_to_member_type";
4471     case DW_TAG_set_type:
4472       return "DW_TAG_set_type";
4473     case DW_TAG_subrange_type:
4474       return "DW_TAG_subrange_type";
4475     case DW_TAG_with_stmt:
4476       return "DW_TAG_with_stmt";
4477     case DW_TAG_access_declaration:
4478       return "DW_TAG_access_declaration";
4479     case DW_TAG_base_type:
4480       return "DW_TAG_base_type";
4481     case DW_TAG_catch_block:
4482       return "DW_TAG_catch_block";
4483     case DW_TAG_const_type:
4484       return "DW_TAG_const_type";
4485     case DW_TAG_constant:
4486       return "DW_TAG_constant";
4487     case DW_TAG_enumerator:
4488       return "DW_TAG_enumerator";
4489     case DW_TAG_file_type:
4490       return "DW_TAG_file_type";
4491     case DW_TAG_friend:
4492       return "DW_TAG_friend";
4493     case DW_TAG_namelist:
4494       return "DW_TAG_namelist";
4495     case DW_TAG_namelist_item:
4496       return "DW_TAG_namelist_item";
4497     case DW_TAG_namespace:
4498       return "DW_TAG_namespace";
4499     case DW_TAG_packed_type:
4500       return "DW_TAG_packed_type";
4501     case DW_TAG_subprogram:
4502       return "DW_TAG_subprogram";
4503     case DW_TAG_template_type_param:
4504       return "DW_TAG_template_type_param";
4505     case DW_TAG_template_value_param:
4506       return "DW_TAG_template_value_param";
4507     case DW_TAG_thrown_type:
4508       return "DW_TAG_thrown_type";
4509     case DW_TAG_try_block:
4510       return "DW_TAG_try_block";
4511     case DW_TAG_variant_part:
4512       return "DW_TAG_variant_part";
4513     case DW_TAG_variable:
4514       return "DW_TAG_variable";
4515     case DW_TAG_volatile_type:
4516       return "DW_TAG_volatile_type";
4517     case DW_TAG_imported_module:
4518       return "DW_TAG_imported_module";
4519     case DW_TAG_MIPS_loop:
4520       return "DW_TAG_MIPS_loop";
4521     case DW_TAG_format_label:
4522       return "DW_TAG_format_label";
4523     case DW_TAG_function_template:
4524       return "DW_TAG_function_template";
4525     case DW_TAG_class_template:
4526       return "DW_TAG_class_template";
4527     case DW_TAG_GNU_BINCL:
4528       return "DW_TAG_GNU_BINCL";
4529     case DW_TAG_GNU_EINCL:
4530       return "DW_TAG_GNU_EINCL";
4531     default:
4532       return "DW_TAG_<unknown>";
4533     }
4534 }
4535 
4536 /* Convert a DWARF attribute code into its string name.  */
4537 
4538 static const char *
dwarf_attr_name(unsigned int attr)4539 dwarf_attr_name (unsigned int attr)
4540 {
4541   switch (attr)
4542     {
4543     case DW_AT_sibling:
4544       return "DW_AT_sibling";
4545     case DW_AT_location:
4546       return "DW_AT_location";
4547     case DW_AT_name:
4548       return "DW_AT_name";
4549     case DW_AT_ordering:
4550       return "DW_AT_ordering";
4551     case DW_AT_subscr_data:
4552       return "DW_AT_subscr_data";
4553     case DW_AT_byte_size:
4554       return "DW_AT_byte_size";
4555     case DW_AT_bit_offset:
4556       return "DW_AT_bit_offset";
4557     case DW_AT_bit_size:
4558       return "DW_AT_bit_size";
4559     case DW_AT_element_list:
4560       return "DW_AT_element_list";
4561     case DW_AT_stmt_list:
4562       return "DW_AT_stmt_list";
4563     case DW_AT_low_pc:
4564       return "DW_AT_low_pc";
4565     case DW_AT_high_pc:
4566       return "DW_AT_high_pc";
4567     case DW_AT_language:
4568       return "DW_AT_language";
4569     case DW_AT_member:
4570       return "DW_AT_member";
4571     case DW_AT_discr:
4572       return "DW_AT_discr";
4573     case DW_AT_discr_value:
4574       return "DW_AT_discr_value";
4575     case DW_AT_visibility:
4576       return "DW_AT_visibility";
4577     case DW_AT_import:
4578       return "DW_AT_import";
4579     case DW_AT_string_length:
4580       return "DW_AT_string_length";
4581     case DW_AT_common_reference:
4582       return "DW_AT_common_reference";
4583     case DW_AT_comp_dir:
4584       return "DW_AT_comp_dir";
4585     case DW_AT_const_value:
4586       return "DW_AT_const_value";
4587     case DW_AT_containing_type:
4588       return "DW_AT_containing_type";
4589     case DW_AT_default_value:
4590       return "DW_AT_default_value";
4591     case DW_AT_inline:
4592       return "DW_AT_inline";
4593     case DW_AT_is_optional:
4594       return "DW_AT_is_optional";
4595     case DW_AT_lower_bound:
4596       return "DW_AT_lower_bound";
4597     case DW_AT_producer:
4598       return "DW_AT_producer";
4599     case DW_AT_prototyped:
4600       return "DW_AT_prototyped";
4601     case DW_AT_return_addr:
4602       return "DW_AT_return_addr";
4603     case DW_AT_start_scope:
4604       return "DW_AT_start_scope";
4605     case DW_AT_stride_size:
4606       return "DW_AT_stride_size";
4607     case DW_AT_upper_bound:
4608       return "DW_AT_upper_bound";
4609     case DW_AT_abstract_origin:
4610       return "DW_AT_abstract_origin";
4611     case DW_AT_accessibility:
4612       return "DW_AT_accessibility";
4613     case DW_AT_address_class:
4614       return "DW_AT_address_class";
4615     case DW_AT_artificial:
4616       return "DW_AT_artificial";
4617     case DW_AT_base_types:
4618       return "DW_AT_base_types";
4619     case DW_AT_calling_convention:
4620       return "DW_AT_calling_convention";
4621     case DW_AT_count:
4622       return "DW_AT_count";
4623     case DW_AT_data_member_location:
4624       return "DW_AT_data_member_location";
4625     case DW_AT_decl_column:
4626       return "DW_AT_decl_column";
4627     case DW_AT_decl_file:
4628       return "DW_AT_decl_file";
4629     case DW_AT_decl_line:
4630       return "DW_AT_decl_line";
4631     case DW_AT_declaration:
4632       return "DW_AT_declaration";
4633     case DW_AT_discr_list:
4634       return "DW_AT_discr_list";
4635     case DW_AT_encoding:
4636       return "DW_AT_encoding";
4637     case DW_AT_external:
4638       return "DW_AT_external";
4639     case DW_AT_frame_base:
4640       return "DW_AT_frame_base";
4641     case DW_AT_friend:
4642       return "DW_AT_friend";
4643     case DW_AT_identifier_case:
4644       return "DW_AT_identifier_case";
4645     case DW_AT_macro_info:
4646       return "DW_AT_macro_info";
4647     case DW_AT_namelist_items:
4648       return "DW_AT_namelist_items";
4649     case DW_AT_priority:
4650       return "DW_AT_priority";
4651     case DW_AT_segment:
4652       return "DW_AT_segment";
4653     case DW_AT_specification:
4654       return "DW_AT_specification";
4655     case DW_AT_static_link:
4656       return "DW_AT_static_link";
4657     case DW_AT_type:
4658       return "DW_AT_type";
4659     case DW_AT_use_location:
4660       return "DW_AT_use_location";
4661     case DW_AT_variable_parameter:
4662       return "DW_AT_variable_parameter";
4663     case DW_AT_virtuality:
4664       return "DW_AT_virtuality";
4665     case DW_AT_vtable_elem_location:
4666       return "DW_AT_vtable_elem_location";
4667 
4668     case DW_AT_allocated:
4669       return "DW_AT_allocated";
4670     case DW_AT_associated:
4671       return "DW_AT_associated";
4672     case DW_AT_data_location:
4673       return "DW_AT_data_location";
4674     case DW_AT_stride:
4675       return "DW_AT_stride";
4676     case DW_AT_entry_pc:
4677       return "DW_AT_entry_pc";
4678     case DW_AT_use_UTF8:
4679       return "DW_AT_use_UTF8";
4680     case DW_AT_extension:
4681       return "DW_AT_extension";
4682     case DW_AT_ranges:
4683       return "DW_AT_ranges";
4684     case DW_AT_trampoline:
4685       return "DW_AT_trampoline";
4686     case DW_AT_call_column:
4687       return "DW_AT_call_column";
4688     case DW_AT_call_file:
4689       return "DW_AT_call_file";
4690     case DW_AT_call_line:
4691       return "DW_AT_call_line";
4692 
4693     case DW_AT_MIPS_fde:
4694       return "DW_AT_MIPS_fde";
4695     case DW_AT_MIPS_loop_begin:
4696       return "DW_AT_MIPS_loop_begin";
4697     case DW_AT_MIPS_tail_loop_begin:
4698       return "DW_AT_MIPS_tail_loop_begin";
4699     case DW_AT_MIPS_epilog_begin:
4700       return "DW_AT_MIPS_epilog_begin";
4701     case DW_AT_MIPS_loop_unroll_factor:
4702       return "DW_AT_MIPS_loop_unroll_factor";
4703     case DW_AT_MIPS_software_pipeline_depth:
4704       return "DW_AT_MIPS_software_pipeline_depth";
4705     case DW_AT_MIPS_linkage_name:
4706       return "DW_AT_MIPS_linkage_name";
4707     case DW_AT_MIPS_stride:
4708       return "DW_AT_MIPS_stride";
4709     case DW_AT_MIPS_abstract_name:
4710       return "DW_AT_MIPS_abstract_name";
4711     case DW_AT_MIPS_clone_origin:
4712       return "DW_AT_MIPS_clone_origin";
4713     case DW_AT_MIPS_has_inlines:
4714       return "DW_AT_MIPS_has_inlines";
4715 
4716     case DW_AT_sf_names:
4717       return "DW_AT_sf_names";
4718     case DW_AT_src_info:
4719       return "DW_AT_src_info";
4720     case DW_AT_mac_info:
4721       return "DW_AT_mac_info";
4722     case DW_AT_src_coords:
4723       return "DW_AT_src_coords";
4724     case DW_AT_body_begin:
4725       return "DW_AT_body_begin";
4726     case DW_AT_body_end:
4727       return "DW_AT_body_end";
4728     case DW_AT_GNU_vector:
4729       return "DW_AT_GNU_vector";
4730 
4731     case DW_AT_VMS_rtnbeg_pd_address:
4732       return "DW_AT_VMS_rtnbeg_pd_address";
4733 
4734     /* APPLE LOCAL begin radar 5811943 - Fix type of pointers to Blocks  */
4735     case DW_AT_APPLE_block:
4736       return "DW_AT_APPLE_block";
4737     /* APPLE LOCAL end radar 5811943 - Fix type of pointers to Blocks  */
4738 
4739     default:
4740       return "DW_AT_<unknown>";
4741     }
4742 }
4743 
4744 /* Convert a DWARF value form code into its string name.  */
4745 
4746 static const char *
dwarf_form_name(unsigned int form)4747 dwarf_form_name (unsigned int form)
4748 {
4749   switch (form)
4750     {
4751     case DW_FORM_addr:
4752       return "DW_FORM_addr";
4753     case DW_FORM_block2:
4754       return "DW_FORM_block2";
4755     case DW_FORM_block4:
4756       return "DW_FORM_block4";
4757     case DW_FORM_data2:
4758       return "DW_FORM_data2";
4759     case DW_FORM_data4:
4760       return "DW_FORM_data4";
4761     case DW_FORM_data8:
4762       return "DW_FORM_data8";
4763     case DW_FORM_string:
4764       return "DW_FORM_string";
4765     case DW_FORM_block:
4766       return "DW_FORM_block";
4767     case DW_FORM_block1:
4768       return "DW_FORM_block1";
4769     case DW_FORM_data1:
4770       return "DW_FORM_data1";
4771     case DW_FORM_flag:
4772       return "DW_FORM_flag";
4773     case DW_FORM_sdata:
4774       return "DW_FORM_sdata";
4775     case DW_FORM_strp:
4776       return "DW_FORM_strp";
4777     case DW_FORM_udata:
4778       return "DW_FORM_udata";
4779     case DW_FORM_ref_addr:
4780       return "DW_FORM_ref_addr";
4781     case DW_FORM_ref1:
4782       return "DW_FORM_ref1";
4783     case DW_FORM_ref2:
4784       return "DW_FORM_ref2";
4785     case DW_FORM_ref4:
4786       return "DW_FORM_ref4";
4787     case DW_FORM_ref8:
4788       return "DW_FORM_ref8";
4789     case DW_FORM_ref_udata:
4790       return "DW_FORM_ref_udata";
4791     case DW_FORM_indirect:
4792       return "DW_FORM_indirect";
4793     default:
4794       return "DW_FORM_<unknown>";
4795     }
4796 }
4797 
4798 /* Determine the "ultimate origin" of a decl.  The decl may be an inlined
4799    instance of an inlined instance of a decl which is local to an inline
4800    function, so we have to trace all of the way back through the origin chain
4801    to find out what sort of node actually served as the original seed for the
4802    given block.  */
4803 
4804 static tree
decl_ultimate_origin(tree decl)4805 decl_ultimate_origin (tree decl)
4806 {
4807   if (!CODE_CONTAINS_STRUCT (TREE_CODE (decl), TS_DECL_COMMON))
4808     return NULL_TREE;
4809 
4810   /* output_inline_function sets DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN for all the
4811      nodes in the function to point to themselves; ignore that if
4812      we're trying to output the abstract instance of this function.  */
4813   if (DECL_ABSTRACT (decl) && DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (decl) == decl)
4814     return NULL_TREE;
4815 
4816   /* Since the DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN for a DECL is supposed to be the
4817      most distant ancestor, this should never happen.  */
4818   gcc_assert (!DECL_FROM_INLINE (DECL_ORIGIN (decl)));
4819 
4820   return DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (decl);
4821 }
4822 
4823 /* Determine the "ultimate origin" of a block.  The block may be an inlined
4824    instance of an inlined instance of a block which is local to an inline
4825    function, so we have to trace all of the way back through the origin chain
4826    to find out what sort of node actually served as the original seed for the
4827    given block.  */
4828 
4829 static tree
block_ultimate_origin(tree block)4830 block_ultimate_origin (tree block)
4831 {
4832   tree immediate_origin = BLOCK_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (block);
4833 
4834   /* output_inline_function sets BLOCK_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN for all the
4835      nodes in the function to point to themselves; ignore that if
4836      we're trying to output the abstract instance of this function.  */
4837   if (BLOCK_ABSTRACT (block) && immediate_origin == block)
4838     return NULL_TREE;
4839 
4840   if (immediate_origin == NULL_TREE)
4841     return NULL_TREE;
4842   else
4843     {
4844       tree ret_val;
4845       tree lookahead = immediate_origin;
4846 
4847       do
4848 	{
4849 	  ret_val = lookahead;
4850 	  lookahead = (TREE_CODE (ret_val) == BLOCK
4851 		       ? BLOCK_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (ret_val) : NULL);
4852 	}
4853       while (lookahead != NULL && lookahead != ret_val);
4854 
4855       /* The block's abstract origin chain may not be the *ultimate* origin of
4856 	 the block. It could lead to a DECL that has an abstract origin set.
4857 	 If so, we want that DECL's abstract origin (which is what DECL_ORIGIN
4858 	 will give us if it has one).  Note that DECL's abstract origins are
4859 	 supposed to be the most distant ancestor (or so decl_ultimate_origin
4860 	 claims), so we don't need to loop following the DECL origins.  */
4861       if (DECL_P (ret_val))
4862 	return DECL_ORIGIN (ret_val);
4863 
4864       return ret_val;
4865     }
4866 }
4867 
4868 /* Get the class to which DECL belongs, if any.  In g++, the DECL_CONTEXT
4869    of a virtual function may refer to a base class, so we check the 'this'
4870    parameter.  */
4871 
4872 static tree
decl_class_context(tree decl)4873 decl_class_context (tree decl)
4874 {
4875   tree context = NULL_TREE;
4876 
4877   if (TREE_CODE (decl) != FUNCTION_DECL || ! DECL_VINDEX (decl))
4878     context = DECL_CONTEXT (decl);
4879   else
4880     context = TYPE_MAIN_VARIANT
4881       (TREE_TYPE (TREE_VALUE (TYPE_ARG_TYPES (TREE_TYPE (decl)))));
4882 
4883   if (context && !TYPE_P (context))
4884     context = NULL_TREE;
4885 
4886   return context;
4887 }
4888 
4889 /* Add an attribute/value pair to a DIE.  */
4890 
4891 static inline void
add_dwarf_attr(dw_die_ref die,dw_attr_ref attr)4892 add_dwarf_attr (dw_die_ref die, dw_attr_ref attr)
4893 {
4894   /* Maybe this should be an assert?  */
4895   if (die == NULL)
4896     return;
4897 
4898   if (die->die_attr == NULL)
4899     die->die_attr = VEC_alloc (dw_attr_node, gc, 1);
4900   VEC_safe_push (dw_attr_node, gc, die->die_attr, attr);
4901 }
4902 
4903 static inline enum dw_val_class
AT_class(dw_attr_ref a)4904 AT_class (dw_attr_ref a)
4905 {
4906   return a->dw_attr_val.val_class;
4907 }
4908 
4909 /* Add a flag value attribute to a DIE.  */
4910 
4911 static inline void
add_AT_flag(dw_die_ref die,enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,unsigned int flag)4912 add_AT_flag (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind, unsigned int flag)
4913 {
4914   dw_attr_node attr;
4915 
4916   attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
4917   attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_flag;
4918   attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_flag = flag;
4919   add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
4920 }
4921 
4922 static inline unsigned
AT_flag(dw_attr_ref a)4923 AT_flag (dw_attr_ref a)
4924 {
4925   gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_flag);
4926   return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_flag;
4927 }
4928 
4929 /* Add a signed integer attribute value to a DIE.  */
4930 
4931 static inline void
add_AT_int(dw_die_ref die,enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,HOST_WIDE_INT int_val)4932 add_AT_int (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind, HOST_WIDE_INT int_val)
4933 {
4934   dw_attr_node attr;
4935 
4936   attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
4937   attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_const;
4938   attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_int = int_val;
4939   add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
4940 }
4941 
4942 static inline HOST_WIDE_INT
AT_int(dw_attr_ref a)4943 AT_int (dw_attr_ref a)
4944 {
4945   gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_const);
4946   return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_int;
4947 }
4948 
4949 /* Add an unsigned integer attribute value to a DIE.  */
4950 
4951 static inline void
add_AT_unsigned(dw_die_ref die,enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT unsigned_val)4952 add_AT_unsigned (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
4953 		 unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT unsigned_val)
4954 {
4955   dw_attr_node attr;
4956 
4957   attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
4958   attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_unsigned_const;
4959   attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_unsigned = unsigned_val;
4960   add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
4961 }
4962 
4963 static inline unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT
AT_unsigned(dw_attr_ref a)4964 AT_unsigned (dw_attr_ref a)
4965 {
4966   gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_unsigned_const);
4967   return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_unsigned;
4968 }
4969 
4970 /* Add an unsigned double integer attribute value to a DIE.  */
4971 
4972 static inline void
add_AT_long_long(dw_die_ref die,enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,long unsigned int val_hi,long unsigned int val_low)4973 add_AT_long_long (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
4974 		  long unsigned int val_hi, long unsigned int val_low)
4975 {
4976   dw_attr_node attr;
4977 
4978   attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
4979   attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_long_long;
4980   attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_long_long.hi = val_hi;
4981   attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_long_long.low = val_low;
4982   add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
4983 }
4984 
4985 /* Add a floating point attribute value to a DIE and return it.  */
4986 
4987 static inline void
add_AT_vec(dw_die_ref die,enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,unsigned int length,unsigned int elt_size,unsigned char * array)4988 add_AT_vec (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
4989 	    unsigned int length, unsigned int elt_size, unsigned char *array)
4990 {
4991   dw_attr_node attr;
4992 
4993   attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
4994   attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_vec;
4995   attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.length = length;
4996   attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.elt_size = elt_size;
4997   attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.array = array;
4998   add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
4999 }
5000 
5001 /* Hash and equality functions for debug_str_hash.  */
5002 
5003 static hashval_t
debug_str_do_hash(const void * x)5004 debug_str_do_hash (const void *x)
5005 {
5006   return htab_hash_string (((const struct indirect_string_node *)x)->str);
5007 }
5008 
5009 static int
debug_str_eq(const void * x1,const void * x2)5010 debug_str_eq (const void *x1, const void *x2)
5011 {
5012   return strcmp ((((const struct indirect_string_node *)x1)->str),
5013 		 (const char *)x2) == 0;
5014 }
5015 
5016 /* Add a string attribute value to a DIE.  */
5017 
5018 static inline void
add_AT_string(dw_die_ref die,enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,const char * str)5019 add_AT_string (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind, const char *str)
5020 {
5021   dw_attr_node attr;
5022   struct indirect_string_node *node;
5023   void **slot;
5024 
5025   if (! debug_str_hash)
5026     debug_str_hash = htab_create_ggc (10, debug_str_do_hash,
5027 				      debug_str_eq, NULL);
5028 
5029   slot = htab_find_slot_with_hash (debug_str_hash, str,
5030 				   htab_hash_string (str), INSERT);
5031   if (*slot == NULL)
5032     *slot = ggc_alloc_cleared (sizeof (struct indirect_string_node));
5033   node = (struct indirect_string_node *) *slot;
5034   node->str = ggc_strdup (str);
5035   node->refcount++;
5036 
5037   attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
5038   attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_str;
5039   attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_str = node;
5040   add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
5041 }
5042 
5043 static inline const char *
AT_string(dw_attr_ref a)5044 AT_string (dw_attr_ref a)
5045 {
5046   gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_str);
5047   return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_str->str;
5048 }
5049 
5050 /* Find out whether a string should be output inline in DIE
5051    or out-of-line in .debug_str section.  */
5052 
5053 static int
AT_string_form(dw_attr_ref a)5054 AT_string_form (dw_attr_ref a)
5055 {
5056   struct indirect_string_node *node;
5057   unsigned int len;
5058   char label[32];
5059 
5060   gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_str);
5061 
5062   node = a->dw_attr_val.v.val_str;
5063   if (node->form)
5064     return node->form;
5065 
5066   len = strlen (node->str) + 1;
5067 
5068   /* If the string is shorter or equal to the size of the reference, it is
5069      always better to put it inline.  */
5070   if (len <= DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE || node->refcount == 0)
5071     return node->form = DW_FORM_string;
5072 
5073   /* If we cannot expect the linker to merge strings in .debug_str
5074      section, only put it into .debug_str if it is worth even in this
5075      single module.  */
5076   if ((debug_str_section->common.flags & SECTION_MERGE) == 0
5077       && (len - DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE) * node->refcount <= len)
5078     return node->form = DW_FORM_string;
5079 
5080   ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, "LASF", dw2_string_counter);
5081   ++dw2_string_counter;
5082   node->label = xstrdup (label);
5083 
5084   return node->form = DW_FORM_strp;
5085 }
5086 
5087 /* Add a DIE reference attribute value to a DIE.  */
5088 
5089 static inline void
add_AT_die_ref(dw_die_ref die,enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,dw_die_ref targ_die)5090 add_AT_die_ref (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind, dw_die_ref targ_die)
5091 {
5092   dw_attr_node attr;
5093 
5094   attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
5095   attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_die_ref;
5096   attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_die_ref.die = targ_die;
5097   attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_die_ref.external = 0;
5098   add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
5099 }
5100 
5101 /* Add an AT_specification attribute to a DIE, and also make the back
5102    pointer from the specification to the definition.  */
5103 
5104 static inline void
add_AT_specification(dw_die_ref die,dw_die_ref targ_die)5105 add_AT_specification (dw_die_ref die, dw_die_ref targ_die)
5106 {
5107   add_AT_die_ref (die, DW_AT_specification, targ_die);
5108   gcc_assert (!targ_die->die_definition);
5109   targ_die->die_definition = die;
5110 }
5111 
5112 static inline dw_die_ref
AT_ref(dw_attr_ref a)5113 AT_ref (dw_attr_ref a)
5114 {
5115   gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_die_ref);
5116   return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_die_ref.die;
5117 }
5118 
5119 static inline int
AT_ref_external(dw_attr_ref a)5120 AT_ref_external (dw_attr_ref a)
5121 {
5122   if (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_die_ref)
5123     return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_die_ref.external;
5124 
5125   return 0;
5126 }
5127 
5128 static inline void
set_AT_ref_external(dw_attr_ref a,int i)5129 set_AT_ref_external (dw_attr_ref a, int i)
5130 {
5131   gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_die_ref);
5132   a->dw_attr_val.v.val_die_ref.external = i;
5133 }
5134 
5135 /* Add an FDE reference attribute value to a DIE.  */
5136 
5137 static inline void
add_AT_fde_ref(dw_die_ref die,enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,unsigned int targ_fde)5138 add_AT_fde_ref (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind, unsigned int targ_fde)
5139 {
5140   dw_attr_node attr;
5141 
5142   attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
5143   attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_fde_ref;
5144   attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_fde_index = targ_fde;
5145   add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
5146 }
5147 
5148 /* Add a location description attribute value to a DIE.  */
5149 
5150 static inline void
add_AT_loc(dw_die_ref die,enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,dw_loc_descr_ref loc)5151 add_AT_loc (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind, dw_loc_descr_ref loc)
5152 {
5153   dw_attr_node attr;
5154 
5155   attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
5156   attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_loc;
5157   attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_loc = loc;
5158   add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
5159 }
5160 
5161 static inline dw_loc_descr_ref
AT_loc(dw_attr_ref a)5162 AT_loc (dw_attr_ref a)
5163 {
5164   gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_loc);
5165   return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_loc;
5166 }
5167 
5168 static inline void
add_AT_loc_list(dw_die_ref die,enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,dw_loc_list_ref loc_list)5169 add_AT_loc_list (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind, dw_loc_list_ref loc_list)
5170 {
5171   dw_attr_node attr;
5172 
5173   attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
5174   attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_loc_list;
5175   attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_loc_list = loc_list;
5176   add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
5177   have_location_lists = true;
5178 }
5179 
5180 static inline dw_loc_list_ref
AT_loc_list(dw_attr_ref a)5181 AT_loc_list (dw_attr_ref a)
5182 {
5183   gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_loc_list);
5184   return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_loc_list;
5185 }
5186 
5187 /* Add an address constant attribute value to a DIE.  */
5188 
5189 static inline void
add_AT_addr(dw_die_ref die,enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,rtx addr)5190 add_AT_addr (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind, rtx addr)
5191 {
5192   dw_attr_node attr;
5193 
5194   attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
5195   attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_addr;
5196   attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_addr = addr;
5197   add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
5198 }
5199 
5200 /* Get the RTX from to an address DIE attribute.  */
5201 
5202 static inline rtx
AT_addr(dw_attr_ref a)5203 AT_addr (dw_attr_ref a)
5204 {
5205   gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_addr);
5206   return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_addr;
5207 }
5208 
5209 /* Add a file attribute value to a DIE.  */
5210 
5211 static inline void
add_AT_file(dw_die_ref die,enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,struct dwarf_file_data * fd)5212 add_AT_file (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
5213 	     struct dwarf_file_data *fd)
5214 {
5215   dw_attr_node attr;
5216 
5217   attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
5218   attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_file;
5219   attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_file = fd;
5220   add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
5221 }
5222 
5223 /* Get the dwarf_file_data from a file DIE attribute.  */
5224 
5225 static inline struct dwarf_file_data *
AT_file(dw_attr_ref a)5226 AT_file (dw_attr_ref a)
5227 {
5228   gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_file);
5229   return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_file;
5230 }
5231 
5232 /* Add a label identifier attribute value to a DIE.  */
5233 
5234 static inline void
add_AT_lbl_id(dw_die_ref die,enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,const char * lbl_id)5235 add_AT_lbl_id (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind, const char *lbl_id)
5236 {
5237   dw_attr_node attr;
5238 
5239   attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
5240   attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_lbl_id;
5241   attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_lbl_id = xstrdup (lbl_id);
5242   add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
5243 }
5244 
5245 /* Add a section offset attribute value to a DIE, an offset into the
5246    debug_line section.  */
5247 
5248 static inline void
add_AT_lineptr(dw_die_ref die,enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,const char * label)5249 add_AT_lineptr (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
5250 		const char *label)
5251 {
5252   dw_attr_node attr;
5253 
5254   attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
5255   attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_lineptr;
5256   attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_lbl_id = xstrdup (label);
5257   add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
5258 }
5259 
5260 /* Add a section offset attribute value to a DIE, an offset into the
5261    debug_macinfo section.  */
5262 
5263 static inline void
add_AT_macptr(dw_die_ref die,enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,const char * label)5264 add_AT_macptr (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
5265 	       const char *label)
5266 {
5267   dw_attr_node attr;
5268 
5269   attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
5270   attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_macptr;
5271   attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_lbl_id = xstrdup (label);
5272   add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
5273 }
5274 
5275 /* Add an offset attribute value to a DIE.  */
5276 
5277 static inline void
add_AT_offset(dw_die_ref die,enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT offset)5278 add_AT_offset (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
5279 	       unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT offset)
5280 {
5281   dw_attr_node attr;
5282 
5283   attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
5284   attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_offset;
5285   attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_offset = offset;
5286   add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
5287 }
5288 
5289 /* Add an range_list attribute value to a DIE.  */
5290 
5291 static void
add_AT_range_list(dw_die_ref die,enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,long unsigned int offset)5292 add_AT_range_list (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
5293 		   long unsigned int offset)
5294 {
5295   dw_attr_node attr;
5296 
5297   attr.dw_attr = attr_kind;
5298   attr.dw_attr_val.val_class = dw_val_class_range_list;
5299   attr.dw_attr_val.v.val_offset = offset;
5300   add_dwarf_attr (die, &attr);
5301 }
5302 
5303 static inline const char *
AT_lbl(dw_attr_ref a)5304 AT_lbl (dw_attr_ref a)
5305 {
5306   gcc_assert (a && (AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_lbl_id
5307 		    || AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_lineptr
5308 		    || AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_macptr));
5309   return a->dw_attr_val.v.val_lbl_id;
5310 }
5311 
5312 /* Get the attribute of type attr_kind.  */
5313 
5314 static dw_attr_ref
get_AT(dw_die_ref die,enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind)5315 get_AT (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind)
5316 {
5317   dw_attr_ref a;
5318   unsigned ix;
5319   dw_die_ref spec = NULL;
5320 
5321   if (! die)
5322     return NULL;
5323 
5324   for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (dw_attr_node, die->die_attr, ix, a); ix++)
5325     if (a->dw_attr == attr_kind)
5326       return a;
5327     else if (a->dw_attr == DW_AT_specification
5328 	     || a->dw_attr == DW_AT_abstract_origin)
5329       spec = AT_ref (a);
5330 
5331   if (spec)
5332     return get_AT (spec, attr_kind);
5333 
5334   return NULL;
5335 }
5336 
5337 /* Return the "low pc" attribute value, typically associated with a subprogram
5338    DIE.  Return null if the "low pc" attribute is either not present, or if it
5339    cannot be represented as an assembler label identifier.  */
5340 
5341 static inline const char *
get_AT_low_pc(dw_die_ref die)5342 get_AT_low_pc (dw_die_ref die)
5343 {
5344   dw_attr_ref a = get_AT (die, DW_AT_low_pc);
5345 
5346   return a ? AT_lbl (a) : NULL;
5347 }
5348 
5349 /* Return the "high pc" attribute value, typically associated with a subprogram
5350    DIE.  Return null if the "high pc" attribute is either not present, or if it
5351    cannot be represented as an assembler label identifier.  */
5352 
5353 static inline const char *
get_AT_hi_pc(dw_die_ref die)5354 get_AT_hi_pc (dw_die_ref die)
5355 {
5356   dw_attr_ref a = get_AT (die, DW_AT_high_pc);
5357 
5358   return a ? AT_lbl (a) : NULL;
5359 }
5360 
5361 /* Return the value of the string attribute designated by ATTR_KIND, or
5362    NULL if it is not present.  */
5363 
5364 static inline const char *
get_AT_string(dw_die_ref die,enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind)5365 get_AT_string (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind)
5366 {
5367   dw_attr_ref a = get_AT (die, attr_kind);
5368 
5369   return a ? AT_string (a) : NULL;
5370 }
5371 
5372 /* Return the value of the flag attribute designated by ATTR_KIND, or -1
5373    if it is not present.  */
5374 
5375 static inline int
get_AT_flag(dw_die_ref die,enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind)5376 get_AT_flag (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind)
5377 {
5378   dw_attr_ref a = get_AT (die, attr_kind);
5379 
5380   return a ? AT_flag (a) : 0;
5381 }
5382 
5383 /* Return the value of the unsigned attribute designated by ATTR_KIND, or 0
5384    if it is not present.  */
5385 
5386 static inline unsigned
get_AT_unsigned(dw_die_ref die,enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind)5387 get_AT_unsigned (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind)
5388 {
5389   dw_attr_ref a = get_AT (die, attr_kind);
5390 
5391   return a ? AT_unsigned (a) : 0;
5392 }
5393 
5394 static inline dw_die_ref
get_AT_ref(dw_die_ref die,enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind)5395 get_AT_ref (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind)
5396 {
5397   dw_attr_ref a = get_AT (die, attr_kind);
5398 
5399   return a ? AT_ref (a) : NULL;
5400 }
5401 
5402 static inline struct dwarf_file_data *
get_AT_file(dw_die_ref die,enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind)5403 get_AT_file (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind)
5404 {
5405   dw_attr_ref a = get_AT (die, attr_kind);
5406 
5407   return a ? AT_file (a) : NULL;
5408 }
5409 
5410 /* Return TRUE if the language is C or C++.  */
5411 
5412 static inline bool
is_c_family(void)5413 is_c_family (void)
5414 {
5415   unsigned int lang = get_AT_unsigned (comp_unit_die, DW_AT_language);
5416 
5417   return (lang == DW_LANG_C || lang == DW_LANG_C89 || lang == DW_LANG_ObjC
5418 	  || lang == DW_LANG_C99
5419 	  || lang == DW_LANG_C_plus_plus || lang == DW_LANG_ObjC_plus_plus);
5420 }
5421 
5422 /* Return TRUE if the language is C++.  */
5423 
5424 static inline bool
is_cxx(void)5425 is_cxx (void)
5426 {
5427   unsigned int lang = get_AT_unsigned (comp_unit_die, DW_AT_language);
5428 
5429   return lang == DW_LANG_C_plus_plus || lang == DW_LANG_ObjC_plus_plus;
5430 }
5431 
5432 /* Return TRUE if the language is Fortran.  */
5433 
5434 static inline bool
is_fortran(void)5435 is_fortran (void)
5436 {
5437   unsigned int lang = get_AT_unsigned (comp_unit_die, DW_AT_language);
5438 
5439   return (lang == DW_LANG_Fortran77
5440 	  || lang == DW_LANG_Fortran90
5441 	  || lang == DW_LANG_Fortran95);
5442 }
5443 
5444 /* Return TRUE if the language is Java.  */
5445 
5446 static inline bool
is_java(void)5447 is_java (void)
5448 {
5449   unsigned int lang = get_AT_unsigned (comp_unit_die, DW_AT_language);
5450 
5451   return lang == DW_LANG_Java;
5452 }
5453 
5454 /* Return TRUE if the language is Ada.  */
5455 
5456 static inline bool
is_ada(void)5457 is_ada (void)
5458 {
5459   unsigned int lang = get_AT_unsigned (comp_unit_die, DW_AT_language);
5460 
5461   return lang == DW_LANG_Ada95 || lang == DW_LANG_Ada83;
5462 }
5463 
5464 /* Remove the specified attribute if present.  */
5465 
5466 static void
remove_AT(dw_die_ref die,enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind)5467 remove_AT (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind)
5468 {
5469   dw_attr_ref a;
5470   unsigned ix;
5471 
5472   if (! die)
5473     return;
5474 
5475   for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (dw_attr_node, die->die_attr, ix, a); ix++)
5476     if (a->dw_attr == attr_kind)
5477       {
5478 	if (AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_str)
5479 	  if (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_str->refcount)
5480 	    a->dw_attr_val.v.val_str->refcount--;
5481 
5482 	/* VEC_ordered_remove should help reduce the number of abbrevs
5483 	   that are needed.  */
5484 	VEC_ordered_remove (dw_attr_node, die->die_attr, ix);
5485 	return;
5486       }
5487 }
5488 
5489 /* Remove CHILD from its parent.  PREV must have the property that
5490    PREV->DIE_SIB == CHILD.  Does not alter CHILD.  */
5491 
5492 static void
remove_child_with_prev(dw_die_ref child,dw_die_ref prev)5493 remove_child_with_prev (dw_die_ref child, dw_die_ref prev)
5494 {
5495   gcc_assert (child->die_parent == prev->die_parent);
5496   gcc_assert (prev->die_sib == child);
5497   if (prev == child)
5498     {
5499       gcc_assert (child->die_parent->die_child == child);
5500       prev = NULL;
5501     }
5502   else
5503     prev->die_sib = child->die_sib;
5504   if (child->die_parent->die_child == child)
5505     child->die_parent->die_child = prev;
5506 }
5507 
5508 /* Remove child DIE whose die_tag is TAG.  Do nothing if no child
5509    matches TAG.  */
5510 
5511 static void
remove_child_TAG(dw_die_ref die,enum dwarf_tag tag)5512 remove_child_TAG (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_tag tag)
5513 {
5514   dw_die_ref c;
5515 
5516   c = die->die_child;
5517   if (c) do {
5518     dw_die_ref prev = c;
5519     c = c->die_sib;
5520     while (c->die_tag == tag)
5521       {
5522 	remove_child_with_prev (c, prev);
5523 	/* Might have removed every child.  */
5524 	if (c == c->die_sib)
5525 	  return;
5526 	c = c->die_sib;
5527       }
5528   } while (c != die->die_child);
5529 }
5530 
5531 /* Add a CHILD_DIE as the last child of DIE.  */
5532 
5533 static void
add_child_die(dw_die_ref die,dw_die_ref child_die)5534 add_child_die (dw_die_ref die, dw_die_ref child_die)
5535 {
5536   /* FIXME this should probably be an assert.  */
5537   if (! die || ! child_die)
5538     return;
5539   gcc_assert (die != child_die);
5540 
5541   child_die->die_parent = die;
5542   if (die->die_child)
5543     {
5544       child_die->die_sib = die->die_child->die_sib;
5545       die->die_child->die_sib = child_die;
5546     }
5547   else
5548     child_die->die_sib = child_die;
5549   die->die_child = child_die;
5550 }
5551 
5552 /* Move CHILD, which must be a child of PARENT or the DIE for which PARENT
5553    is the specification, to the end of PARENT's list of children.
5554    This is done by removing and re-adding it.  */
5555 
5556 static void
splice_child_die(dw_die_ref parent,dw_die_ref child)5557 splice_child_die (dw_die_ref parent, dw_die_ref child)
5558 {
5559   dw_die_ref p;
5560 
5561   /* We want the declaration DIE from inside the class, not the
5562      specification DIE at toplevel.  */
5563   if (child->die_parent != parent)
5564     {
5565       dw_die_ref tmp = get_AT_ref (child, DW_AT_specification);
5566 
5567       if (tmp)
5568 	child = tmp;
5569     }
5570 
5571   gcc_assert (child->die_parent == parent
5572 	      || (child->die_parent
5573 		  == get_AT_ref (parent, DW_AT_specification)));
5574 
5575   for (p = child->die_parent->die_child; ; p = p->die_sib)
5576     if (p->die_sib == child)
5577       {
5578 	remove_child_with_prev (child, p);
5579 	break;
5580       }
5581 
5582   add_child_die (parent, child);
5583 }
5584 
5585 /* Return a pointer to a newly created DIE node.  */
5586 
5587 static inline dw_die_ref
new_die(enum dwarf_tag tag_value,dw_die_ref parent_die,tree t)5588 new_die (enum dwarf_tag tag_value, dw_die_ref parent_die, tree t)
5589 {
5590   dw_die_ref die = ggc_alloc_cleared (sizeof (die_node));
5591 
5592   die->die_tag = tag_value;
5593 
5594   if (parent_die != NULL)
5595     add_child_die (parent_die, die);
5596   else
5597     {
5598       limbo_die_node *limbo_node;
5599 
5600       limbo_node = ggc_alloc_cleared (sizeof (limbo_die_node));
5601       limbo_node->die = die;
5602       limbo_node->created_for = t;
5603       limbo_node->next = limbo_die_list;
5604       limbo_die_list = limbo_node;
5605     }
5606 
5607   return die;
5608 }
5609 
5610 /* Return the DIE associated with the given type specifier.  */
5611 
5612 static inline dw_die_ref
lookup_type_die(tree type)5613 lookup_type_die (tree type)
5614 {
5615   return TYPE_SYMTAB_DIE (type);
5616 }
5617 
5618 /* Equate a DIE to a given type specifier.  */
5619 
5620 static inline void
equate_type_number_to_die(tree type,dw_die_ref type_die)5621 equate_type_number_to_die (tree type, dw_die_ref type_die)
5622 {
5623   TYPE_SYMTAB_DIE (type) = type_die;
5624 }
5625 
5626 /* Returns a hash value for X (which really is a die_struct).  */
5627 
5628 static hashval_t
decl_die_table_hash(const void * x)5629 decl_die_table_hash (const void *x)
5630 {
5631   return (hashval_t) ((const dw_die_ref) x)->decl_id;
5632 }
5633 
5634 /* Return nonzero if decl_id of die_struct X is the same as UID of decl *Y.  */
5635 
5636 static int
decl_die_table_eq(const void * x,const void * y)5637 decl_die_table_eq (const void *x, const void *y)
5638 {
5639   return (((const dw_die_ref) x)->decl_id == DECL_UID ((const tree) y));
5640 }
5641 
5642 /* Return the DIE associated with a given declaration.  */
5643 
5644 static inline dw_die_ref
lookup_decl_die(tree decl)5645 lookup_decl_die (tree decl)
5646 {
5647   return htab_find_with_hash (decl_die_table, decl, DECL_UID (decl));
5648 }
5649 
5650 /* Returns a hash value for X (which really is a var_loc_list).  */
5651 
5652 static hashval_t
decl_loc_table_hash(const void * x)5653 decl_loc_table_hash (const void *x)
5654 {
5655   return (hashval_t) ((const var_loc_list *) x)->decl_id;
5656 }
5657 
5658 /* Return nonzero if decl_id of var_loc_list X is the same as
5659    UID of decl *Y.  */
5660 
5661 static int
decl_loc_table_eq(const void * x,const void * y)5662 decl_loc_table_eq (const void *x, const void *y)
5663 {
5664   return (((const var_loc_list *) x)->decl_id == DECL_UID ((const tree) y));
5665 }
5666 
5667 /* Return the var_loc list associated with a given declaration.  */
5668 
5669 static inline var_loc_list *
lookup_decl_loc(tree decl)5670 lookup_decl_loc (tree decl)
5671 {
5672   return htab_find_with_hash (decl_loc_table, decl, DECL_UID (decl));
5673 }
5674 
5675 /* Equate a DIE to a particular declaration.  */
5676 
5677 static void
equate_decl_number_to_die(tree decl,dw_die_ref decl_die)5678 equate_decl_number_to_die (tree decl, dw_die_ref decl_die)
5679 {
5680   unsigned int decl_id = DECL_UID (decl);
5681   void **slot;
5682 
5683   slot = htab_find_slot_with_hash (decl_die_table, decl, decl_id, INSERT);
5684   *slot = decl_die;
5685   decl_die->decl_id = decl_id;
5686 }
5687 
5688 /* Add a variable location node to the linked list for DECL.  */
5689 
5690 static void
add_var_loc_to_decl(tree decl,struct var_loc_node * loc)5691 add_var_loc_to_decl (tree decl, struct var_loc_node *loc)
5692 {
5693   unsigned int decl_id = DECL_UID (decl);
5694   var_loc_list *temp;
5695   void **slot;
5696 
5697   slot = htab_find_slot_with_hash (decl_loc_table, decl, decl_id, INSERT);
5698   if (*slot == NULL)
5699     {
5700       temp = ggc_alloc_cleared (sizeof (var_loc_list));
5701       temp->decl_id = decl_id;
5702       *slot = temp;
5703     }
5704   else
5705     temp = *slot;
5706 
5707   if (temp->last)
5708     {
5709       /* If the current location is the same as the end of the list,
5710 	 we have nothing to do.  */
5711       if (!rtx_equal_p (NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (temp->last->var_loc_note),
5712 			NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (loc->var_loc_note)))
5713 	{
5714 	  /* Add LOC to the end of list and update LAST.  */
5715 	  temp->last->next = loc;
5716 	  temp->last = loc;
5717 	}
5718     }
5719   /* Do not add empty location to the beginning of the list.  */
5720   else if (NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (loc->var_loc_note) != NULL_RTX)
5721     {
5722       temp->first = loc;
5723       temp->last = loc;
5724     }
5725 }
5726 
5727 /* Keep track of the number of spaces used to indent the
5728    output of the debugging routines that print the structure of
5729    the DIE internal representation.  */
5730 static int print_indent;
5731 
5732 /* Indent the line the number of spaces given by print_indent.  */
5733 
5734 static inline void
print_spaces(FILE * outfile)5735 print_spaces (FILE *outfile)
5736 {
5737   fprintf (outfile, "%*s", print_indent, "");
5738 }
5739 
5740 /* Print the information associated with a given DIE, and its children.
5741    This routine is a debugging aid only.  */
5742 
5743 static void
print_die(dw_die_ref die,FILE * outfile)5744 print_die (dw_die_ref die, FILE *outfile)
5745 {
5746   dw_attr_ref a;
5747   dw_die_ref c;
5748   unsigned ix;
5749 
5750   print_spaces (outfile);
5751   fprintf (outfile, "DIE %4ld: %s\n",
5752 	   die->die_offset, dwarf_tag_name (die->die_tag));
5753   print_spaces (outfile);
5754   fprintf (outfile, "  abbrev id: %lu", die->die_abbrev);
5755   fprintf (outfile, " offset: %ld\n", die->die_offset);
5756 
5757   for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (dw_attr_node, die->die_attr, ix, a); ix++)
5758     {
5759       print_spaces (outfile);
5760       fprintf (outfile, "  %s: ", dwarf_attr_name (a->dw_attr));
5761 
5762       switch (AT_class (a))
5763 	{
5764 	case dw_val_class_addr:
5765 	  fprintf (outfile, "address");
5766 	  break;
5767 	case dw_val_class_offset:
5768 	  fprintf (outfile, "offset");
5769 	  break;
5770 	case dw_val_class_loc:
5771 	  fprintf (outfile, "location descriptor");
5772 	  break;
5773 	case dw_val_class_loc_list:
5774 	  fprintf (outfile, "location list -> label:%s",
5775 		   AT_loc_list (a)->ll_symbol);
5776 	  break;
5777 	case dw_val_class_range_list:
5778 	  fprintf (outfile, "range list");
5779 	  break;
5780 	case dw_val_class_const:
5781 	  fprintf (outfile, HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_DEC, AT_int (a));
5782 	  break;
5783 	case dw_val_class_unsigned_const:
5784 	  fprintf (outfile, HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_UNSIGNED, AT_unsigned (a));
5785 	  break;
5786 	case dw_val_class_long_long:
5787 	  fprintf (outfile, "constant (%lu,%lu)",
5788 		   a->dw_attr_val.v.val_long_long.hi,
5789 		   a->dw_attr_val.v.val_long_long.low);
5790 	  break;
5791 	case dw_val_class_vec:
5792 	  fprintf (outfile, "floating-point or vector constant");
5793 	  break;
5794 	case dw_val_class_flag:
5795 	  fprintf (outfile, "%u", AT_flag (a));
5796 	  break;
5797 	case dw_val_class_die_ref:
5798 	  if (AT_ref (a) != NULL)
5799 	    {
5800 	      if (AT_ref (a)->die_symbol)
5801 		fprintf (outfile, "die -> label: %s", AT_ref (a)->die_symbol);
5802 	      else
5803 		fprintf (outfile, "die -> %ld", AT_ref (a)->die_offset);
5804 	    }
5805 	  else
5806 	    fprintf (outfile, "die -> <null>");
5807 	  break;
5808 	case dw_val_class_lbl_id:
5809 	case dw_val_class_lineptr:
5810 	case dw_val_class_macptr:
5811 	  fprintf (outfile, "label: %s", AT_lbl (a));
5812 	  break;
5813 	case dw_val_class_str:
5814 	  if (AT_string (a) != NULL)
5815 	    fprintf (outfile, "\"%s\"", AT_string (a));
5816 	  else
5817 	    fprintf (outfile, "<null>");
5818 	  break;
5819 	case dw_val_class_file:
5820 	  fprintf (outfile, "\"%s\" (%d)", AT_file (a)->filename,
5821 		   AT_file (a)->emitted_number);
5822 	  break;
5823 	default:
5824 	  break;
5825 	}
5826 
5827       fprintf (outfile, "\n");
5828     }
5829 
5830   if (die->die_child != NULL)
5831     {
5832       print_indent += 4;
5833       FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, print_die (c, outfile));
5834       print_indent -= 4;
5835     }
5836   if (print_indent == 0)
5837     fprintf (outfile, "\n");
5838 }
5839 
5840 /* Print the contents of the source code line number correspondence table.
5841    This routine is a debugging aid only.  */
5842 
5843 static void
print_dwarf_line_table(FILE * outfile)5844 print_dwarf_line_table (FILE *outfile)
5845 {
5846   unsigned i;
5847   dw_line_info_ref line_info;
5848 
5849   fprintf (outfile, "\n\nDWARF source line information\n");
5850   for (i = 1; i < line_info_table_in_use; i++)
5851     {
5852       line_info = &line_info_table[i];
5853       fprintf (outfile, "%5d: %4ld %6ld\n", i,
5854 	       line_info->dw_file_num,
5855 	       line_info->dw_line_num);
5856     }
5857 
5858   fprintf (outfile, "\n\n");
5859 }
5860 
5861 /* Print the information collected for a given DIE.  */
5862 
5863 void
debug_dwarf_die(dw_die_ref die)5864 debug_dwarf_die (dw_die_ref die)
5865 {
5866   print_die (die, stderr);
5867 }
5868 
5869 /* Print all DWARF information collected for the compilation unit.
5870    This routine is a debugging aid only.  */
5871 
5872 void
debug_dwarf(void)5873 debug_dwarf (void)
5874 {
5875   print_indent = 0;
5876   print_die (comp_unit_die, stderr);
5877   if (! DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO)
5878     print_dwarf_line_table (stderr);
5879 }
5880 
5881 /* Start a new compilation unit DIE for an include file.  OLD_UNIT is the CU
5882    for the enclosing include file, if any.  BINCL_DIE is the DW_TAG_GNU_BINCL
5883    DIE that marks the start of the DIEs for this include file.  */
5884 
5885 static dw_die_ref
push_new_compile_unit(dw_die_ref old_unit,dw_die_ref bincl_die)5886 push_new_compile_unit (dw_die_ref old_unit, dw_die_ref bincl_die)
5887 {
5888   const char *filename = get_AT_string (bincl_die, DW_AT_name);
5889   dw_die_ref new_unit = gen_compile_unit_die (filename);
5890 
5891   new_unit->die_sib = old_unit;
5892   return new_unit;
5893 }
5894 
5895 /* Close an include-file CU and reopen the enclosing one.  */
5896 
5897 static dw_die_ref
pop_compile_unit(dw_die_ref old_unit)5898 pop_compile_unit (dw_die_ref old_unit)
5899 {
5900   dw_die_ref new_unit = old_unit->die_sib;
5901 
5902   old_unit->die_sib = NULL;
5903   return new_unit;
5904 }
5905 
5906 #define CHECKSUM(FOO) md5_process_bytes (&(FOO), sizeof (FOO), ctx)
5907 #define CHECKSUM_STRING(FOO) md5_process_bytes ((FOO), strlen (FOO), ctx)
5908 
5909 /* Calculate the checksum of a location expression.  */
5910 
5911 static inline void
loc_checksum(dw_loc_descr_ref loc,struct md5_ctx * ctx)5912 loc_checksum (dw_loc_descr_ref loc, struct md5_ctx *ctx)
5913 {
5914   CHECKSUM (loc->dw_loc_opc);
5915   CHECKSUM (loc->dw_loc_oprnd1);
5916   CHECKSUM (loc->dw_loc_oprnd2);
5917 }
5918 
5919 /* Calculate the checksum of an attribute.  */
5920 
5921 static void
attr_checksum(dw_attr_ref at,struct md5_ctx * ctx,int * mark)5922 attr_checksum (dw_attr_ref at, struct md5_ctx *ctx, int *mark)
5923 {
5924   dw_loc_descr_ref loc;
5925   rtx r;
5926 
5927   CHECKSUM (at->dw_attr);
5928 
5929   /* We don't care that this was compiled with a different compiler
5930      snapshot; if the output is the same, that's what matters.  */
5931   if (at->dw_attr == DW_AT_producer)
5932     return;
5933 
5934   switch (AT_class (at))
5935     {
5936     case dw_val_class_const:
5937       CHECKSUM (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_int);
5938       break;
5939     case dw_val_class_unsigned_const:
5940       CHECKSUM (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_unsigned);
5941       break;
5942     case dw_val_class_long_long:
5943       CHECKSUM (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_long_long);
5944       break;
5945     case dw_val_class_vec:
5946       CHECKSUM (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec);
5947       break;
5948     case dw_val_class_flag:
5949       CHECKSUM (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_flag);
5950       break;
5951     case dw_val_class_str:
5952       CHECKSUM_STRING (AT_string (at));
5953       break;
5954 
5955     case dw_val_class_addr:
5956       r = AT_addr (at);
5957       gcc_assert (GET_CODE (r) == SYMBOL_REF);
5958       CHECKSUM_STRING (XSTR (r, 0));
5959       break;
5960 
5961     case dw_val_class_offset:
5962       CHECKSUM (at->dw_attr_val.v.val_offset);
5963       break;
5964 
5965     case dw_val_class_loc:
5966       for (loc = AT_loc (at); loc; loc = loc->dw_loc_next)
5967 	loc_checksum (loc, ctx);
5968       break;
5969 
5970     case dw_val_class_die_ref:
5971       die_checksum (AT_ref (at), ctx, mark);
5972       break;
5973 
5974     case dw_val_class_fde_ref:
5975     case dw_val_class_lbl_id:
5976     case dw_val_class_lineptr:
5977     case dw_val_class_macptr:
5978       break;
5979 
5980     case dw_val_class_file:
5981       CHECKSUM_STRING (AT_file (at)->filename);
5982       break;
5983 
5984     default:
5985       break;
5986     }
5987 }
5988 
5989 /* Calculate the checksum of a DIE.  */
5990 
5991 static void
die_checksum(dw_die_ref die,struct md5_ctx * ctx,int * mark)5992 die_checksum (dw_die_ref die, struct md5_ctx *ctx, int *mark)
5993 {
5994   dw_die_ref c;
5995   dw_attr_ref a;
5996   unsigned ix;
5997 
5998   /* To avoid infinite recursion.  */
5999   if (die->die_mark)
6000     {
6001       CHECKSUM (die->die_mark);
6002       return;
6003     }
6004   die->die_mark = ++(*mark);
6005 
6006   CHECKSUM (die->die_tag);
6007 
6008   for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (dw_attr_node, die->die_attr, ix, a); ix++)
6009     attr_checksum (a, ctx, mark);
6010 
6011   FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, die_checksum (c, ctx, mark));
6012 }
6013 
6014 #undef CHECKSUM
6015 #undef CHECKSUM_STRING
6016 
6017 /* Do the location expressions look same?  */
6018 static inline int
same_loc_p(dw_loc_descr_ref loc1,dw_loc_descr_ref loc2,int * mark)6019 same_loc_p (dw_loc_descr_ref loc1, dw_loc_descr_ref loc2, int *mark)
6020 {
6021   return loc1->dw_loc_opc == loc2->dw_loc_opc
6022 	 && same_dw_val_p (&loc1->dw_loc_oprnd1, &loc2->dw_loc_oprnd1, mark)
6023 	 && same_dw_val_p (&loc1->dw_loc_oprnd2, &loc2->dw_loc_oprnd2, mark);
6024 }
6025 
6026 /* Do the values look the same?  */
6027 static int
same_dw_val_p(dw_val_node * v1,dw_val_node * v2,int * mark)6028 same_dw_val_p (dw_val_node *v1, dw_val_node *v2, int *mark)
6029 {
6030   dw_loc_descr_ref loc1, loc2;
6031   rtx r1, r2;
6032 
6033   if (v1->val_class != v2->val_class)
6034     return 0;
6035 
6036   switch (v1->val_class)
6037     {
6038     case dw_val_class_const:
6039       return v1->v.val_int == v2->v.val_int;
6040     case dw_val_class_unsigned_const:
6041       return v1->v.val_unsigned == v2->v.val_unsigned;
6042     case dw_val_class_long_long:
6043       return v1->v.val_long_long.hi == v2->v.val_long_long.hi
6044 	     && v1->v.val_long_long.low == v2->v.val_long_long.low;
6045     case dw_val_class_vec:
6046       if (v1->v.val_vec.length != v2->v.val_vec.length
6047 	  || v1->v.val_vec.elt_size != v2->v.val_vec.elt_size)
6048 	return 0;
6049       if (memcmp (v1->v.val_vec.array, v2->v.val_vec.array,
6050 		  v1->v.val_vec.length * v1->v.val_vec.elt_size))
6051 	return 0;
6052       return 1;
6053     case dw_val_class_flag:
6054       return v1->v.val_flag == v2->v.val_flag;
6055     case dw_val_class_str:
6056       return !strcmp(v1->v.val_str->str, v2->v.val_str->str);
6057 
6058     case dw_val_class_addr:
6059       r1 = v1->v.val_addr;
6060       r2 = v2->v.val_addr;
6061       if (GET_CODE (r1) != GET_CODE (r2))
6062 	return 0;
6063       gcc_assert (GET_CODE (r1) == SYMBOL_REF);
6064       return !strcmp (XSTR (r1, 0), XSTR (r2, 0));
6065 
6066     case dw_val_class_offset:
6067       return v1->v.val_offset == v2->v.val_offset;
6068 
6069     case dw_val_class_loc:
6070       for (loc1 = v1->v.val_loc, loc2 = v2->v.val_loc;
6071 	   loc1 && loc2;
6072 	   loc1 = loc1->dw_loc_next, loc2 = loc2->dw_loc_next)
6073 	if (!same_loc_p (loc1, loc2, mark))
6074 	  return 0;
6075       return !loc1 && !loc2;
6076 
6077     case dw_val_class_die_ref:
6078       return same_die_p (v1->v.val_die_ref.die, v2->v.val_die_ref.die, mark);
6079 
6080     case dw_val_class_fde_ref:
6081     case dw_val_class_lbl_id:
6082     case dw_val_class_lineptr:
6083     case dw_val_class_macptr:
6084       return 1;
6085 
6086     case dw_val_class_file:
6087       return v1->v.val_file == v2->v.val_file;
6088 
6089     default:
6090       return 1;
6091     }
6092 }
6093 
6094 /* Do the attributes look the same?  */
6095 
6096 static int
same_attr_p(dw_attr_ref at1,dw_attr_ref at2,int * mark)6097 same_attr_p (dw_attr_ref at1, dw_attr_ref at2, int *mark)
6098 {
6099   if (at1->dw_attr != at2->dw_attr)
6100     return 0;
6101 
6102   /* We don't care that this was compiled with a different compiler
6103      snapshot; if the output is the same, that's what matters. */
6104   if (at1->dw_attr == DW_AT_producer)
6105     return 1;
6106 
6107   return same_dw_val_p (&at1->dw_attr_val, &at2->dw_attr_val, mark);
6108 }
6109 
6110 /* Do the dies look the same?  */
6111 
6112 static int
same_die_p(dw_die_ref die1,dw_die_ref die2,int * mark)6113 same_die_p (dw_die_ref die1, dw_die_ref die2, int *mark)
6114 {
6115   dw_die_ref c1, c2;
6116   dw_attr_ref a1;
6117   unsigned ix;
6118 
6119   /* To avoid infinite recursion.  */
6120   if (die1->die_mark)
6121     return die1->die_mark == die2->die_mark;
6122   die1->die_mark = die2->die_mark = ++(*mark);
6123 
6124   if (die1->die_tag != die2->die_tag)
6125     return 0;
6126 
6127   if (VEC_length (dw_attr_node, die1->die_attr)
6128       != VEC_length (dw_attr_node, die2->die_attr))
6129     return 0;
6130 
6131   for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (dw_attr_node, die1->die_attr, ix, a1); ix++)
6132     if (!same_attr_p (a1, VEC_index (dw_attr_node, die2->die_attr, ix), mark))
6133       return 0;
6134 
6135   c1 = die1->die_child;
6136   c2 = die2->die_child;
6137   if (! c1)
6138     {
6139       if (c2)
6140 	return 0;
6141     }
6142   else
6143     for (;;)
6144       {
6145 	if (!same_die_p (c1, c2, mark))
6146 	  return 0;
6147 	c1 = c1->die_sib;
6148 	c2 = c2->die_sib;
6149 	if (c1 == die1->die_child)
6150 	  {
6151 	    if (c2 == die2->die_child)
6152 	      break;
6153 	    else
6154 	      return 0;
6155 	  }
6156     }
6157 
6158   return 1;
6159 }
6160 
6161 /* Do the dies look the same?  Wrapper around same_die_p.  */
6162 
6163 static int
same_die_p_wrap(dw_die_ref die1,dw_die_ref die2)6164 same_die_p_wrap (dw_die_ref die1, dw_die_ref die2)
6165 {
6166   int mark = 0;
6167   int ret = same_die_p (die1, die2, &mark);
6168 
6169   unmark_all_dies (die1);
6170   unmark_all_dies (die2);
6171 
6172   return ret;
6173 }
6174 
6175 /* The prefix to attach to symbols on DIEs in the current comdat debug
6176    info section.  */
6177 static char *comdat_symbol_id;
6178 
6179 /* The index of the current symbol within the current comdat CU.  */
6180 static unsigned int comdat_symbol_number;
6181 
6182 /* Calculate the MD5 checksum of the compilation unit DIE UNIT_DIE and its
6183    children, and set comdat_symbol_id accordingly.  */
6184 
6185 static void
compute_section_prefix(dw_die_ref unit_die)6186 compute_section_prefix (dw_die_ref unit_die)
6187 {
6188   const char *die_name = get_AT_string (unit_die, DW_AT_name);
6189   const char *base = die_name ? lbasename (die_name) : "anonymous";
6190   char *name = alloca (strlen (base) + 64);
6191   char *p;
6192   int i, mark;
6193   unsigned char checksum[16];
6194   struct md5_ctx ctx;
6195 
6196   /* Compute the checksum of the DIE, then append part of it as hex digits to
6197      the name filename of the unit.  */
6198 
6199   md5_init_ctx (&ctx);
6200   mark = 0;
6201   die_checksum (unit_die, &ctx, &mark);
6202   unmark_all_dies (unit_die);
6203   md5_finish_ctx (&ctx, checksum);
6204 
6205   sprintf (name, "%s.", base);
6206   clean_symbol_name (name);
6207 
6208   p = name + strlen (name);
6209   for (i = 0; i < 4; i++)
6210     {
6211       sprintf (p, "%.2x", checksum[i]);
6212       p += 2;
6213     }
6214 
6215   comdat_symbol_id = unit_die->die_symbol = xstrdup (name);
6216   comdat_symbol_number = 0;
6217 }
6218 
6219 /* Returns nonzero if DIE represents a type, in the sense of TYPE_P.  */
6220 
6221 static int
is_type_die(dw_die_ref die)6222 is_type_die (dw_die_ref die)
6223 {
6224   switch (die->die_tag)
6225     {
6226     case DW_TAG_array_type:
6227     case DW_TAG_class_type:
6228     case DW_TAG_enumeration_type:
6229     case DW_TAG_pointer_type:
6230     case DW_TAG_reference_type:
6231     case DW_TAG_string_type:
6232     case DW_TAG_structure_type:
6233     case DW_TAG_subroutine_type:
6234     case DW_TAG_union_type:
6235     case DW_TAG_ptr_to_member_type:
6236     case DW_TAG_set_type:
6237     case DW_TAG_subrange_type:
6238     case DW_TAG_base_type:
6239     case DW_TAG_const_type:
6240     case DW_TAG_file_type:
6241     case DW_TAG_packed_type:
6242     case DW_TAG_volatile_type:
6243     case DW_TAG_typedef:
6244       return 1;
6245     default:
6246       return 0;
6247     }
6248 }
6249 
6250 /* Returns 1 iff C is the sort of DIE that should go into a COMDAT CU.
6251    Basically, we want to choose the bits that are likely to be shared between
6252    compilations (types) and leave out the bits that are specific to individual
6253    compilations (functions).  */
6254 
6255 static int
is_comdat_die(dw_die_ref c)6256 is_comdat_die (dw_die_ref c)
6257 {
6258   /* I think we want to leave base types and __vtbl_ptr_type in the main CU, as
6259      we do for stabs.  The advantage is a greater likelihood of sharing between
6260      objects that don't include headers in the same order (and therefore would
6261      put the base types in a different comdat).  jason 8/28/00 */
6262 
6263   if (c->die_tag == DW_TAG_base_type)
6264     return 0;
6265 
6266   if (c->die_tag == DW_TAG_pointer_type
6267       || c->die_tag == DW_TAG_reference_type
6268       || c->die_tag == DW_TAG_const_type
6269       || c->die_tag == DW_TAG_volatile_type)
6270     {
6271       dw_die_ref t = get_AT_ref (c, DW_AT_type);
6272 
6273       return t ? is_comdat_die (t) : 0;
6274     }
6275 
6276   return is_type_die (c);
6277 }
6278 
6279 /* Returns 1 iff C is the sort of DIE that might be referred to from another
6280    compilation unit.  */
6281 
6282 static int
is_symbol_die(dw_die_ref c)6283 is_symbol_die (dw_die_ref c)
6284 {
6285   return (is_type_die (c)
6286 	  || (get_AT (c, DW_AT_declaration)
6287 	      && !get_AT (c, DW_AT_specification))
6288 	  || c->die_tag == DW_TAG_namespace);
6289 }
6290 
6291 static char *
gen_internal_sym(const char * prefix)6292 gen_internal_sym (const char *prefix)
6293 {
6294   char buf[256];
6295 
6296   ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (buf, prefix, label_num++);
6297   return xstrdup (buf);
6298 }
6299 
6300 /* Assign symbols to all worthy DIEs under DIE.  */
6301 
6302 static void
assign_symbol_names(dw_die_ref die)6303 assign_symbol_names (dw_die_ref die)
6304 {
6305   dw_die_ref c;
6306 
6307   if (is_symbol_die (die))
6308     {
6309       if (comdat_symbol_id)
6310 	{
6311 	  char *p = alloca (strlen (comdat_symbol_id) + 64);
6312 
6313 	  sprintf (p, "%s.%s.%x", DIE_LABEL_PREFIX,
6314 		   comdat_symbol_id, comdat_symbol_number++);
6315 	  die->die_symbol = xstrdup (p);
6316 	}
6317       else
6318 	die->die_symbol = gen_internal_sym ("LDIE");
6319     }
6320 
6321   FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, assign_symbol_names (c));
6322 }
6323 
6324 struct cu_hash_table_entry
6325 {
6326   dw_die_ref cu;
6327   unsigned min_comdat_num, max_comdat_num;
6328   struct cu_hash_table_entry *next;
6329 };
6330 
6331 /* Routines to manipulate hash table of CUs.  */
6332 static hashval_t
htab_cu_hash(const void * of)6333 htab_cu_hash (const void *of)
6334 {
6335   const struct cu_hash_table_entry *entry = of;
6336 
6337   return htab_hash_string (entry->cu->die_symbol);
6338 }
6339 
6340 static int
htab_cu_eq(const void * of1,const void * of2)6341 htab_cu_eq (const void *of1, const void *of2)
6342 {
6343   const struct cu_hash_table_entry *entry1 = of1;
6344   const struct die_struct *entry2 = of2;
6345 
6346   return !strcmp (entry1->cu->die_symbol, entry2->die_symbol);
6347 }
6348 
6349 static void
htab_cu_del(void * what)6350 htab_cu_del (void *what)
6351 {
6352   struct cu_hash_table_entry *next, *entry = what;
6353 
6354   while (entry)
6355     {
6356       next = entry->next;
6357       free (entry);
6358       entry = next;
6359     }
6360 }
6361 
6362 /* Check whether we have already seen this CU and set up SYM_NUM
6363    accordingly.  */
6364 static int
check_duplicate_cu(dw_die_ref cu,htab_t htable,unsigned int * sym_num)6365 check_duplicate_cu (dw_die_ref cu, htab_t htable, unsigned int *sym_num)
6366 {
6367   struct cu_hash_table_entry dummy;
6368   struct cu_hash_table_entry **slot, *entry, *last = &dummy;
6369 
6370   dummy.max_comdat_num = 0;
6371 
6372   slot = (struct cu_hash_table_entry **)
6373     htab_find_slot_with_hash (htable, cu, htab_hash_string (cu->die_symbol),
6374 	INSERT);
6375   entry = *slot;
6376 
6377   for (; entry; last = entry, entry = entry->next)
6378     {
6379       if (same_die_p_wrap (cu, entry->cu))
6380 	break;
6381     }
6382 
6383   if (entry)
6384     {
6385       *sym_num = entry->min_comdat_num;
6386       return 1;
6387     }
6388 
6389   entry = XCNEW (struct cu_hash_table_entry);
6390   entry->cu = cu;
6391   entry->min_comdat_num = *sym_num = last->max_comdat_num;
6392   entry->next = *slot;
6393   *slot = entry;
6394 
6395   return 0;
6396 }
6397 
6398 /* Record SYM_NUM to record of CU in HTABLE.  */
6399 static void
record_comdat_symbol_number(dw_die_ref cu,htab_t htable,unsigned int sym_num)6400 record_comdat_symbol_number (dw_die_ref cu, htab_t htable, unsigned int sym_num)
6401 {
6402   struct cu_hash_table_entry **slot, *entry;
6403 
6404   slot = (struct cu_hash_table_entry **)
6405     htab_find_slot_with_hash (htable, cu, htab_hash_string (cu->die_symbol),
6406 	NO_INSERT);
6407   entry = *slot;
6408 
6409   entry->max_comdat_num = sym_num;
6410 }
6411 
6412 /* Traverse the DIE (which is always comp_unit_die), and set up
6413    additional compilation units for each of the include files we see
6414    bracketed by BINCL/EINCL.  */
6415 
6416 static void
break_out_includes(dw_die_ref die)6417 break_out_includes (dw_die_ref die)
6418 {
6419   dw_die_ref c;
6420   dw_die_ref unit = NULL;
6421   limbo_die_node *node, **pnode;
6422   htab_t cu_hash_table;
6423 
6424   c = die->die_child;
6425   if (c) do {
6426     dw_die_ref prev = c;
6427     c = c->die_sib;
6428     while (c->die_tag == DW_TAG_GNU_BINCL || c->die_tag == DW_TAG_GNU_EINCL
6429 	   || (unit && is_comdat_die (c)))
6430       {
6431 	dw_die_ref next = c->die_sib;
6432 
6433 	/* This DIE is for a secondary CU; remove it from the main one.  */
6434 	remove_child_with_prev (c, prev);
6435 
6436 	if (c->die_tag == DW_TAG_GNU_BINCL)
6437 	  unit = push_new_compile_unit (unit, c);
6438 	else if (c->die_tag == DW_TAG_GNU_EINCL)
6439 	  unit = pop_compile_unit (unit);
6440 	else
6441 	  add_child_die (unit, c);
6442 	c = next;
6443 	if (c == die->die_child)
6444 	  break;
6445       }
6446   } while (c != die->die_child);
6447 
6448 #if 0
6449   /* We can only use this in debugging, since the frontend doesn't check
6450      to make sure that we leave every include file we enter.  */
6451   gcc_assert (!unit);
6452 #endif
6453 
6454   assign_symbol_names (die);
6455   cu_hash_table = htab_create (10, htab_cu_hash, htab_cu_eq, htab_cu_del);
6456   for (node = limbo_die_list, pnode = &limbo_die_list;
6457        node;
6458        node = node->next)
6459     {
6460       int is_dupl;
6461 
6462       compute_section_prefix (node->die);
6463       is_dupl = check_duplicate_cu (node->die, cu_hash_table,
6464 			&comdat_symbol_number);
6465       assign_symbol_names (node->die);
6466       if (is_dupl)
6467 	*pnode = node->next;
6468       else
6469 	{
6470 	  pnode = &node->next;
6471 	  record_comdat_symbol_number (node->die, cu_hash_table,
6472 		comdat_symbol_number);
6473 	}
6474     }
6475   htab_delete (cu_hash_table);
6476 }
6477 
6478 /* Traverse the DIE and add a sibling attribute if it may have the
6479    effect of speeding up access to siblings.  To save some space,
6480    avoid generating sibling attributes for DIE's without children.  */
6481 
6482 static void
add_sibling_attributes(dw_die_ref die)6483 add_sibling_attributes (dw_die_ref die)
6484 {
6485   dw_die_ref c;
6486 
6487   if (! die->die_child)
6488     return;
6489 
6490   if (die->die_parent && die != die->die_parent->die_child)
6491     add_AT_die_ref (die, DW_AT_sibling, die->die_sib);
6492 
6493   FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, add_sibling_attributes (c));
6494 }
6495 
6496 /* Output all location lists for the DIE and its children.  */
6497 
6498 static void
output_location_lists(dw_die_ref die)6499 output_location_lists (dw_die_ref die)
6500 {
6501   dw_die_ref c;
6502   dw_attr_ref a;
6503   unsigned ix;
6504 
6505   for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (dw_attr_node, die->die_attr, ix, a); ix++)
6506     if (AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_loc_list)
6507       output_loc_list (AT_loc_list (a));
6508 
6509   FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, output_location_lists (c));
6510 }
6511 
6512 /* The format of each DIE (and its attribute value pairs) is encoded in an
6513    abbreviation table.  This routine builds the abbreviation table and assigns
6514    a unique abbreviation id for each abbreviation entry.  The children of each
6515    die are visited recursively.  */
6516 
6517 static void
build_abbrev_table(dw_die_ref die)6518 build_abbrev_table (dw_die_ref die)
6519 {
6520   unsigned long abbrev_id;
6521   unsigned int n_alloc;
6522   dw_die_ref c;
6523   dw_attr_ref a;
6524   unsigned ix;
6525 
6526   /* Scan the DIE references, and mark as external any that refer to
6527      DIEs from other CUs (i.e. those which are not marked).  */
6528   for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (dw_attr_node, die->die_attr, ix, a); ix++)
6529     if (AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_die_ref
6530 	&& AT_ref (a)->die_mark == 0)
6531       {
6532 	gcc_assert (AT_ref (a)->die_symbol);
6533 
6534 	set_AT_ref_external (a, 1);
6535       }
6536 
6537   for (abbrev_id = 1; abbrev_id < abbrev_die_table_in_use; ++abbrev_id)
6538     {
6539       dw_die_ref abbrev = abbrev_die_table[abbrev_id];
6540       dw_attr_ref die_a, abbrev_a;
6541       unsigned ix;
6542       bool ok = true;
6543 
6544       if (abbrev->die_tag != die->die_tag)
6545 	continue;
6546       if ((abbrev->die_child != NULL) != (die->die_child != NULL))
6547 	continue;
6548 
6549       if (VEC_length (dw_attr_node, abbrev->die_attr)
6550 	  != VEC_length (dw_attr_node, die->die_attr))
6551 	continue;
6552 
6553       for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (dw_attr_node, die->die_attr, ix, die_a); ix++)
6554 	{
6555 	  abbrev_a = VEC_index (dw_attr_node, abbrev->die_attr, ix);
6556 	  if ((abbrev_a->dw_attr != die_a->dw_attr)
6557 	      || (value_format (abbrev_a) != value_format (die_a)))
6558 	    {
6559 	      ok = false;
6560 	      break;
6561 	    }
6562 	}
6563       if (ok)
6564 	break;
6565     }
6566 
6567   if (abbrev_id >= abbrev_die_table_in_use)
6568     {
6569       if (abbrev_die_table_in_use >= abbrev_die_table_allocated)
6570 	{
6571 	  n_alloc = abbrev_die_table_allocated + ABBREV_DIE_TABLE_INCREMENT;
6572 	  abbrev_die_table = ggc_realloc (abbrev_die_table,
6573 					  sizeof (dw_die_ref) * n_alloc);
6574 
6575 	  memset (&abbrev_die_table[abbrev_die_table_allocated], 0,
6576 		 (n_alloc - abbrev_die_table_allocated) * sizeof (dw_die_ref));
6577 	  abbrev_die_table_allocated = n_alloc;
6578 	}
6579 
6580       ++abbrev_die_table_in_use;
6581       abbrev_die_table[abbrev_id] = die;
6582     }
6583 
6584   die->die_abbrev = abbrev_id;
6585   FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, build_abbrev_table (c));
6586 }
6587 
6588 /* Return the power-of-two number of bytes necessary to represent VALUE.  */
6589 
6590 static int
constant_size(long unsigned int value)6591 constant_size (long unsigned int value)
6592 {
6593   int log;
6594 
6595   if (value == 0)
6596     log = 0;
6597   else
6598     log = floor_log2 (value);
6599 
6600   log = log / 8;
6601   log = 1 << (floor_log2 (log) + 1);
6602 
6603   return log;
6604 }
6605 
6606 /* Return the size of a DIE as it is represented in the
6607    .debug_info section.  */
6608 
6609 static unsigned long
size_of_die(dw_die_ref die)6610 size_of_die (dw_die_ref die)
6611 {
6612   unsigned long size = 0;
6613   dw_attr_ref a;
6614   unsigned ix;
6615 
6616   size += size_of_uleb128 (die->die_abbrev);
6617   for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (dw_attr_node, die->die_attr, ix, a); ix++)
6618     {
6619       switch (AT_class (a))
6620 	{
6621 	case dw_val_class_addr:
6622 	  size += DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
6623 	  break;
6624 	case dw_val_class_offset:
6625 	  size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
6626 	  break;
6627 	case dw_val_class_loc:
6628 	  {
6629 	    unsigned long lsize = size_of_locs (AT_loc (a));
6630 
6631 	    /* Block length.  */
6632 	    size += constant_size (lsize);
6633 	    size += lsize;
6634 	  }
6635 	  break;
6636 	case dw_val_class_loc_list:
6637 	  size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
6638 	  break;
6639 	case dw_val_class_range_list:
6640 	  size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
6641 	  break;
6642 	case dw_val_class_const:
6643 	  size += size_of_sleb128 (AT_int (a));
6644 	  break;
6645 	case dw_val_class_unsigned_const:
6646 	  size += constant_size (AT_unsigned (a));
6647 	  break;
6648 	case dw_val_class_long_long:
6649 	  size += 1 + 2*HOST_BITS_PER_LONG/HOST_BITS_PER_CHAR; /* block */
6650 	  break;
6651 	case dw_val_class_vec:
6652 	  size += 1 + (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.length
6653 		       * a->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.elt_size); /* block */
6654 	  break;
6655 	case dw_val_class_flag:
6656 	  size += 1;
6657 	  break;
6658 	case dw_val_class_die_ref:
6659 	  if (AT_ref_external (a))
6660 	    size += DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
6661 	  else
6662 	    size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
6663 	  break;
6664 	case dw_val_class_fde_ref:
6665 	  size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
6666 	  break;
6667 	case dw_val_class_lbl_id:
6668 	  size += DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
6669 	  break;
6670 	case dw_val_class_lineptr:
6671 	case dw_val_class_macptr:
6672 	  size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
6673 	  break;
6674 	case dw_val_class_str:
6675 	  if (AT_string_form (a) == DW_FORM_strp)
6676 	    size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
6677 	  else
6678 	    size += strlen (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_str->str) + 1;
6679 	  break;
6680 	case dw_val_class_file:
6681 	  size += constant_size (maybe_emit_file (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_file));
6682 	  break;
6683 	default:
6684 	  gcc_unreachable ();
6685 	}
6686     }
6687 
6688   return size;
6689 }
6690 
6691 /* Size the debugging information associated with a given DIE.  Visits the
6692    DIE's children recursively.  Updates the global variable next_die_offset, on
6693    each time through.  Uses the current value of next_die_offset to update the
6694    die_offset field in each DIE.  */
6695 
6696 static void
calc_die_sizes(dw_die_ref die)6697 calc_die_sizes (dw_die_ref die)
6698 {
6699   dw_die_ref c;
6700 
6701   die->die_offset = next_die_offset;
6702   next_die_offset += size_of_die (die);
6703 
6704   FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, calc_die_sizes (c));
6705 
6706   if (die->die_child != NULL)
6707     /* Count the null byte used to terminate sibling lists.  */
6708     next_die_offset += 1;
6709 }
6710 
6711 /* Set the marks for a die and its children.  We do this so
6712    that we know whether or not a reference needs to use FORM_ref_addr; only
6713    DIEs in the same CU will be marked.  We used to clear out the offset
6714    and use that as the flag, but ran into ordering problems.  */
6715 
6716 static void
mark_dies(dw_die_ref die)6717 mark_dies (dw_die_ref die)
6718 {
6719   dw_die_ref c;
6720 
6721   gcc_assert (!die->die_mark);
6722 
6723   die->die_mark = 1;
6724   FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, mark_dies (c));
6725 }
6726 
6727 /* Clear the marks for a die and its children.  */
6728 
6729 static void
unmark_dies(dw_die_ref die)6730 unmark_dies (dw_die_ref die)
6731 {
6732   dw_die_ref c;
6733 
6734   gcc_assert (die->die_mark);
6735 
6736   die->die_mark = 0;
6737   FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, unmark_dies (c));
6738 }
6739 
6740 /* Clear the marks for a die, its children and referred dies.  */
6741 
6742 static void
unmark_all_dies(dw_die_ref die)6743 unmark_all_dies (dw_die_ref die)
6744 {
6745   dw_die_ref c;
6746   dw_attr_ref a;
6747   unsigned ix;
6748 
6749   if (!die->die_mark)
6750     return;
6751   die->die_mark = 0;
6752 
6753   FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, unmark_all_dies (c));
6754 
6755   for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (dw_attr_node, die->die_attr, ix, a); ix++)
6756     if (AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_die_ref)
6757       unmark_all_dies (AT_ref (a));
6758 }
6759 
6760 /* Return the size of the .debug_pubnames or .debug_pubtypes table
6761    generated for the compilation unit.  */
6762 
6763 static unsigned long
size_of_pubnames(VEC (pubname_entry,gc)* names)6764 size_of_pubnames (VEC (pubname_entry, gc) * names)
6765 {
6766   unsigned long size;
6767   unsigned i;
6768   pubname_ref p;
6769 
6770   size = DWARF_PUBNAMES_HEADER_SIZE;
6771   for (i = 0; VEC_iterate (pubname_entry, names, i, p); i++)
6772     if (names != pubtype_table
6773 	|| p->die->die_offset != 0
6774 	|| !flag_eliminate_unused_debug_types)
6775       size += strlen (p->name) + DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE + 1;
6776 
6777   size += DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE;
6778   return size;
6779 }
6780 
6781 /* Return the size of the information in the .debug_aranges section.  */
6782 
6783 static unsigned long
size_of_aranges(void)6784 size_of_aranges (void)
6785 {
6786   unsigned long size;
6787 
6788   size = DWARF_ARANGES_HEADER_SIZE;
6789 
6790   /* Count the address/length pair for this compilation unit.  */
6791   size += 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
6792   size += 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE * arange_table_in_use;
6793 
6794   /* Count the two zero words used to terminated the address range table.  */
6795   size += 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
6796   return size;
6797 }
6798 
6799 /* Select the encoding of an attribute value.  */
6800 
6801 static enum dwarf_form
value_format(dw_attr_ref a)6802 value_format (dw_attr_ref a)
6803 {
6804   switch (a->dw_attr_val.val_class)
6805     {
6806     case dw_val_class_addr:
6807       return DW_FORM_addr;
6808     case dw_val_class_range_list:
6809     case dw_val_class_offset:
6810     case dw_val_class_loc_list:
6811       switch (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE)
6812 	{
6813 	case 4:
6814 	  return DW_FORM_data4;
6815 	case 8:
6816 	  return DW_FORM_data8;
6817 	default:
6818 	  gcc_unreachable ();
6819 	}
6820     case dw_val_class_loc:
6821       switch (constant_size (size_of_locs (AT_loc (a))))
6822 	{
6823 	case 1:
6824 	  return DW_FORM_block1;
6825 	case 2:
6826 	  return DW_FORM_block2;
6827 	default:
6828 	  gcc_unreachable ();
6829 	}
6830     case dw_val_class_const:
6831       return DW_FORM_sdata;
6832     case dw_val_class_unsigned_const:
6833       switch (constant_size (AT_unsigned (a)))
6834 	{
6835 	case 1:
6836 	  return DW_FORM_data1;
6837 	case 2:
6838 	  return DW_FORM_data2;
6839 	case 4:
6840 	  return DW_FORM_data4;
6841 	case 8:
6842 	  return DW_FORM_data8;
6843 	default:
6844 	  gcc_unreachable ();
6845 	}
6846     case dw_val_class_long_long:
6847       return DW_FORM_block1;
6848     case dw_val_class_vec:
6849       return DW_FORM_block1;
6850     case dw_val_class_flag:
6851       return DW_FORM_flag;
6852     case dw_val_class_die_ref:
6853       if (AT_ref_external (a))
6854 	return DW_FORM_ref_addr;
6855       else
6856 	return DW_FORM_ref;
6857     case dw_val_class_fde_ref:
6858       return DW_FORM_data;
6859     case dw_val_class_lbl_id:
6860       return DW_FORM_addr;
6861     case dw_val_class_lineptr:
6862     case dw_val_class_macptr:
6863       return DW_FORM_data;
6864     case dw_val_class_str:
6865       return AT_string_form (a);
6866     case dw_val_class_file:
6867       switch (constant_size (maybe_emit_file (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_file)))
6868 	{
6869 	case 1:
6870 	  return DW_FORM_data1;
6871 	case 2:
6872 	  return DW_FORM_data2;
6873 	case 4:
6874 	  return DW_FORM_data4;
6875 	default:
6876 	  gcc_unreachable ();
6877 	}
6878 
6879     default:
6880       gcc_unreachable ();
6881     }
6882 }
6883 
6884 /* Output the encoding of an attribute value.  */
6885 
6886 static void
output_value_format(dw_attr_ref a)6887 output_value_format (dw_attr_ref a)
6888 {
6889   enum dwarf_form form = value_format (a);
6890 
6891   dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (form, "(%s)", dwarf_form_name (form));
6892 }
6893 
6894 /* Output the .debug_abbrev section which defines the DIE abbreviation
6895    table.  */
6896 
6897 static void
output_abbrev_section(void)6898 output_abbrev_section (void)
6899 {
6900   unsigned long abbrev_id;
6901 
6902   for (abbrev_id = 1; abbrev_id < abbrev_die_table_in_use; ++abbrev_id)
6903     {
6904       dw_die_ref abbrev = abbrev_die_table[abbrev_id];
6905       unsigned ix;
6906       dw_attr_ref a_attr;
6907 
6908       dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (abbrev_id, "(abbrev code)");
6909       dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (abbrev->die_tag, "(TAG: %s)",
6910 				   dwarf_tag_name (abbrev->die_tag));
6911 
6912       if (abbrev->die_child != NULL)
6913 	dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_children_yes, "DW_children_yes");
6914       else
6915 	dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_children_no, "DW_children_no");
6916 
6917       for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (dw_attr_node, abbrev->die_attr, ix, a_attr);
6918 	   ix++)
6919 	{
6920 	  dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (a_attr->dw_attr, "(%s)",
6921 				       dwarf_attr_name (a_attr->dw_attr));
6922 	  output_value_format (a_attr);
6923 	}
6924 
6925       dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, NULL);
6926       dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, NULL);
6927     }
6928 
6929   /* Terminate the table.  */
6930   dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, NULL);
6931 }
6932 
6933 /* Output a symbol we can use to refer to this DIE from another CU.  */
6934 
6935 static inline void
output_die_symbol(dw_die_ref die)6936 output_die_symbol (dw_die_ref die)
6937 {
6938   char *sym = die->die_symbol;
6939 
6940   if (sym == 0)
6941     return;
6942 
6943   if (strncmp (sym, DIE_LABEL_PREFIX, sizeof (DIE_LABEL_PREFIX) - 1) == 0)
6944     /* We make these global, not weak; if the target doesn't support
6945        .linkonce, it doesn't support combining the sections, so debugging
6946        will break.  */
6947     targetm.asm_out.globalize_label (asm_out_file, sym);
6948 
6949   ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, sym);
6950 }
6951 
6952 /* Return a new location list, given the begin and end range, and the
6953    expression. gensym tells us whether to generate a new internal symbol for
6954    this location list node, which is done for the head of the list only.  */
6955 
6956 static inline dw_loc_list_ref
new_loc_list(dw_loc_descr_ref expr,const char * begin,const char * end,const char * section,unsigned int gensym)6957 new_loc_list (dw_loc_descr_ref expr, const char *begin, const char *end,
6958 	      const char *section, unsigned int gensym)
6959 {
6960   dw_loc_list_ref retlist = ggc_alloc_cleared (sizeof (dw_loc_list_node));
6961 
6962   retlist->begin = begin;
6963   retlist->end = end;
6964   retlist->expr = expr;
6965   retlist->section = section;
6966   if (gensym)
6967     retlist->ll_symbol = gen_internal_sym ("LLST");
6968 
6969   return retlist;
6970 }
6971 
6972 /* Add a location description expression to a location list.  */
6973 
6974 static inline void
add_loc_descr_to_loc_list(dw_loc_list_ref * list_head,dw_loc_descr_ref descr,const char * begin,const char * end,const char * section)6975 add_loc_descr_to_loc_list (dw_loc_list_ref *list_head, dw_loc_descr_ref descr,
6976 			   const char *begin, const char *end,
6977 			   const char *section)
6978 {
6979   dw_loc_list_ref *d;
6980 
6981   /* Find the end of the chain.  */
6982   for (d = list_head; (*d) != NULL; d = &(*d)->dw_loc_next)
6983     ;
6984 
6985   /* Add a new location list node to the list.  */
6986   *d = new_loc_list (descr, begin, end, section, 0);
6987 }
6988 
6989 static void
dwarf2out_switch_text_section(void)6990 dwarf2out_switch_text_section (void)
6991 {
6992   dw_fde_ref fde;
6993 
6994   gcc_assert (cfun);
6995 
6996   fde = &fde_table[fde_table_in_use - 1];
6997   fde->dw_fde_switched_sections = true;
6998   fde->dw_fde_hot_section_label = cfun->hot_section_label;
6999   fde->dw_fde_hot_section_end_label = cfun->hot_section_end_label;
7000   fde->dw_fde_unlikely_section_label = cfun->cold_section_label;
7001   fde->dw_fde_unlikely_section_end_label = cfun->cold_section_end_label;
7002   have_multiple_function_sections = true;
7003 
7004   /* Reset the current label on switching text sections, so that we
7005      don't attempt to advance_loc4 between labels in different sections.  */
7006   fde->dw_fde_current_label = NULL;
7007 }
7008 
7009 /* Output the location list given to us.  */
7010 
7011 static void
output_loc_list(dw_loc_list_ref list_head)7012 output_loc_list (dw_loc_list_ref list_head)
7013 {
7014   dw_loc_list_ref curr = list_head;
7015 
7016   ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, list_head->ll_symbol);
7017 
7018   /* Walk the location list, and output each range + expression.  */
7019   for (curr = list_head; curr != NULL; curr = curr->dw_loc_next)
7020     {
7021       unsigned long size;
7022       if (!have_multiple_function_sections)
7023 	{
7024 	  dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, curr->begin, curr->section,
7025 				"Location list begin address (%s)",
7026 				list_head->ll_symbol);
7027 	  dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, curr->end, curr->section,
7028 				"Location list end address (%s)",
7029 				list_head->ll_symbol);
7030 	}
7031       else
7032 	{
7033 	  dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, curr->begin,
7034 			       "Location list begin address (%s)",
7035 			       list_head->ll_symbol);
7036 	  dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, curr->end,
7037 			       "Location list end address (%s)",
7038 			       list_head->ll_symbol);
7039 	}
7040       size = size_of_locs (curr->expr);
7041 
7042       /* Output the block length for this list of location operations.  */
7043       gcc_assert (size <= 0xffff);
7044       dw2_asm_output_data (2, size, "%s", "Location expression size");
7045 
7046       output_loc_sequence (curr->expr);
7047     }
7048 
7049   dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, 0,
7050 		       "Location list terminator begin (%s)",
7051 		       list_head->ll_symbol);
7052   dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, 0,
7053 		       "Location list terminator end (%s)",
7054 		       list_head->ll_symbol);
7055 }
7056 
7057 /* Output the DIE and its attributes.  Called recursively to generate
7058    the definitions of each child DIE.  */
7059 
7060 static void
output_die(dw_die_ref die)7061 output_die (dw_die_ref die)
7062 {
7063   dw_attr_ref a;
7064   dw_die_ref c;
7065   unsigned long size;
7066   unsigned ix;
7067 
7068   /* If someone in another CU might refer to us, set up a symbol for
7069      them to point to.  */
7070   if (die->die_symbol)
7071     output_die_symbol (die);
7072 
7073   dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (die->die_abbrev, "(DIE (0x%lx) %s)",
7074 			       (unsigned long)die->die_offset,
7075 			       dwarf_tag_name (die->die_tag));
7076 
7077   for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (dw_attr_node, die->die_attr, ix, a); ix++)
7078     {
7079       const char *name = dwarf_attr_name (a->dw_attr);
7080 
7081       switch (AT_class (a))
7082 	{
7083 	case dw_val_class_addr:
7084 	  dw2_asm_output_addr_rtx (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, AT_addr (a), "%s", name);
7085 	  break;
7086 
7087 	case dw_val_class_offset:
7088 	  dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, a->dw_attr_val.v.val_offset,
7089 			       "%s", name);
7090 	  break;
7091 
7092 	case dw_val_class_range_list:
7093 	  {
7094 	    char *p = strchr (ranges_section_label, '\0');
7095 
7096 	    sprintf (p, "+" HOST_WIDE_INT_PRINT_HEX,
7097 		     a->dw_attr_val.v.val_offset);
7098 	    dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, ranges_section_label,
7099 				   debug_ranges_section, "%s", name);
7100 	    *p = '\0';
7101 	  }
7102 	  break;
7103 
7104 	case dw_val_class_loc:
7105 	  size = size_of_locs (AT_loc (a));
7106 
7107 	  /* Output the block length for this list of location operations.  */
7108 	  dw2_asm_output_data (constant_size (size), size, "%s", name);
7109 
7110 	  output_loc_sequence (AT_loc (a));
7111 	  break;
7112 
7113 	case dw_val_class_const:
7114 	  /* ??? It would be slightly more efficient to use a scheme like is
7115 	     used for unsigned constants below, but gdb 4.x does not sign
7116 	     extend.  Gdb 5.x does sign extend.  */
7117 	  dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (AT_int (a), "%s", name);
7118 	  break;
7119 
7120 	case dw_val_class_unsigned_const:
7121 	  dw2_asm_output_data (constant_size (AT_unsigned (a)),
7122 			       AT_unsigned (a), "%s", name);
7123 	  break;
7124 
7125 	case dw_val_class_long_long:
7126 	  {
7127 	    unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT first, second;
7128 
7129 	    dw2_asm_output_data (1,
7130 				 2 * HOST_BITS_PER_LONG / HOST_BITS_PER_CHAR,
7131 				 "%s", name);
7132 
7133 	    if (WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN)
7134 	      {
7135 		first = a->dw_attr_val.v.val_long_long.hi;
7136 		second = a->dw_attr_val.v.val_long_long.low;
7137 	      }
7138 	    else
7139 	      {
7140 		first = a->dw_attr_val.v.val_long_long.low;
7141 		second = a->dw_attr_val.v.val_long_long.hi;
7142 	      }
7143 
7144 	    dw2_asm_output_data (HOST_BITS_PER_LONG / HOST_BITS_PER_CHAR,
7145 				 first, "long long constant");
7146 	    dw2_asm_output_data (HOST_BITS_PER_LONG / HOST_BITS_PER_CHAR,
7147 				 second, NULL);
7148 	  }
7149 	  break;
7150 
7151 	case dw_val_class_vec:
7152 	  {
7153 	    unsigned int elt_size = a->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.elt_size;
7154 	    unsigned int len = a->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.length;
7155 	    unsigned int i;
7156 	    unsigned char *p;
7157 
7158 	    dw2_asm_output_data (1, len * elt_size, "%s", name);
7159 	    if (elt_size > sizeof (HOST_WIDE_INT))
7160 	      {
7161 		elt_size /= 2;
7162 		len *= 2;
7163 	      }
7164 	    for (i = 0, p = a->dw_attr_val.v.val_vec.array;
7165 		 i < len;
7166 		 i++, p += elt_size)
7167 	      dw2_asm_output_data (elt_size, extract_int (p, elt_size),
7168 				   "fp or vector constant word %u", i);
7169 	    break;
7170 	  }
7171 
7172 	case dw_val_class_flag:
7173 	  dw2_asm_output_data (1, AT_flag (a), "%s", name);
7174 	  break;
7175 
7176 	case dw_val_class_loc_list:
7177 	  {
7178 	    char *sym = AT_loc_list (a)->ll_symbol;
7179 
7180 	    gcc_assert (sym);
7181 	    dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, sym, debug_loc_section,
7182 				   "%s", name);
7183 	  }
7184 	  break;
7185 
7186 	case dw_val_class_die_ref:
7187 	  if (AT_ref_external (a))
7188 	    {
7189 	      char *sym = AT_ref (a)->die_symbol;
7190 
7191 	      gcc_assert (sym);
7192 	      dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, sym, debug_info_section,
7193 				     "%s", name);
7194 	    }
7195 	  else
7196 	    {
7197 	      gcc_assert (AT_ref (a)->die_offset);
7198 	      dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, AT_ref (a)->die_offset,
7199 				   "%s", name);
7200 	    }
7201 	  break;
7202 
7203 	case dw_val_class_fde_ref:
7204 	  {
7205 	    char l1[20];
7206 
7207 	    ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (l1, FDE_LABEL,
7208 					 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_fde_index * 2);
7209 	    dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, l1, debug_frame_section,
7210 				   "%s", name);
7211 	  }
7212 	  break;
7213 
7214 	case dw_val_class_lbl_id:
7215 	  dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, AT_lbl (a), "%s", name);
7216 	  break;
7217 
7218 	case dw_val_class_lineptr:
7219 	  dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, AT_lbl (a),
7220 				 debug_line_section, "%s", name);
7221 	  break;
7222 
7223 	case dw_val_class_macptr:
7224 	  dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, AT_lbl (a),
7225 				 debug_macinfo_section, "%s", name);
7226 	  break;
7227 
7228 	case dw_val_class_str:
7229 	  if (AT_string_form (a) == DW_FORM_strp)
7230 	    dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE,
7231 				   a->dw_attr_val.v.val_str->label,
7232 				   debug_str_section,
7233 				   "%s: \"%s\"", name, AT_string (a));
7234 	  else
7235 	    dw2_asm_output_nstring (AT_string (a), -1, "%s", name);
7236 	  break;
7237 
7238 	case dw_val_class_file:
7239 	  {
7240 	    int f = maybe_emit_file (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_file);
7241 
7242 	    dw2_asm_output_data (constant_size (f), f, "%s (%s)", name,
7243 				 a->dw_attr_val.v.val_file->filename);
7244 	    break;
7245 	  }
7246 
7247 	default:
7248 	  gcc_unreachable ();
7249 	}
7250     }
7251 
7252   FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, output_die (c));
7253 
7254   /* Add null byte to terminate sibling list.  */
7255   if (die->die_child != NULL)
7256     dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "end of children of DIE 0x%lx",
7257 			 (unsigned long) die->die_offset);
7258 }
7259 
7260 /* Output the compilation unit that appears at the beginning of the
7261    .debug_info section, and precedes the DIE descriptions.  */
7262 
7263 static void
output_compilation_unit_header(void)7264 output_compilation_unit_header (void)
7265 {
7266   if (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE - DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 4)
7267     dw2_asm_output_data (4, 0xffffffff,
7268       "Initial length escape value indicating 64-bit DWARF extension");
7269   dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE,
7270                        next_die_offset - DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE,
7271 		       "Length of Compilation Unit Info");
7272   dw2_asm_output_data (2, DWARF_VERSION, "DWARF version number");
7273   dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, abbrev_section_label,
7274 			 debug_abbrev_section,
7275 			 "Offset Into Abbrev. Section");
7276   dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, "Pointer Size (in bytes)");
7277 }
7278 
7279 /* Output the compilation unit DIE and its children.  */
7280 
7281 static void
output_comp_unit(dw_die_ref die,int output_if_empty)7282 output_comp_unit (dw_die_ref die, int output_if_empty)
7283 {
7284   const char *secname;
7285   char *oldsym, *tmp;
7286 
7287   /* Unless we are outputting main CU, we may throw away empty ones.  */
7288   if (!output_if_empty && die->die_child == NULL)
7289     return;
7290 
7291   /* Even if there are no children of this DIE, we must output the information
7292      about the compilation unit.  Otherwise, on an empty translation unit, we
7293      will generate a present, but empty, .debug_info section.  IRIX 6.5 `nm'
7294      will then complain when examining the file.  First mark all the DIEs in
7295      this CU so we know which get local refs.  */
7296   mark_dies (die);
7297 
7298   build_abbrev_table (die);
7299 
7300   /* Initialize the beginning DIE offset - and calculate sizes/offsets.  */
7301   next_die_offset = DWARF_COMPILE_UNIT_HEADER_SIZE;
7302   calc_die_sizes (die);
7303 
7304   oldsym = die->die_symbol;
7305   if (oldsym)
7306     {
7307       tmp = alloca (strlen (oldsym) + 24);
7308 
7309       sprintf (tmp, ".gnu.linkonce.wi.%s", oldsym);
7310       secname = tmp;
7311       die->die_symbol = NULL;
7312       switch_to_section (get_section (secname, SECTION_DEBUG, NULL));
7313     }
7314   else
7315     switch_to_section (debug_info_section);
7316 
7317   /* Output debugging information.  */
7318   output_compilation_unit_header ();
7319   output_die (die);
7320 
7321   /* Leave the marks on the main CU, so we can check them in
7322      output_pubnames.  */
7323   if (oldsym)
7324     {
7325       unmark_dies (die);
7326       die->die_symbol = oldsym;
7327     }
7328 }
7329 
7330 /* Return the DWARF2/3 pubname associated with a decl.  */
7331 
7332 static const char *
dwarf2_name(tree decl,int scope)7333 dwarf2_name (tree decl, int scope)
7334 {
7335   return lang_hooks.dwarf_name (decl, scope ? 1 : 0);
7336 }
7337 
7338 /* Add a new entry to .debug_pubnames if appropriate.  */
7339 
7340 static void
add_pubname(tree decl,dw_die_ref die)7341 add_pubname (tree decl, dw_die_ref die)
7342 {
7343   pubname_entry e;
7344 
7345   if (! TREE_PUBLIC (decl))
7346     return;
7347 
7348   e.die = die;
7349   e.name = xstrdup (dwarf2_name (decl, 1));
7350   VEC_safe_push (pubname_entry, gc, pubname_table, &e);
7351 }
7352 
7353 /* Add a new entry to .debug_pubtypes if appropriate.  */
7354 
7355 static void
add_pubtype(tree decl,dw_die_ref die)7356 add_pubtype (tree decl, dw_die_ref die)
7357 {
7358   pubname_entry e;
7359 
7360   e.name = NULL;
7361   if ((TREE_PUBLIC (decl)
7362        || die->die_parent == comp_unit_die)
7363       && (die->die_tag == DW_TAG_typedef || COMPLETE_TYPE_P (decl)))
7364     {
7365       e.die = die;
7366       if (TYPE_P (decl))
7367 	{
7368 	  if (TYPE_NAME (decl))
7369 	    {
7370 	      if (TREE_CODE (TYPE_NAME (decl)) == IDENTIFIER_NODE)
7371 		e.name = xstrdup ((const char *) IDENTIFIER_POINTER
7372 				                              (TYPE_NAME (decl)));
7373 	      else if (TREE_CODE (TYPE_NAME (decl)) == TYPE_DECL
7374 		       && DECL_NAME (TYPE_NAME (decl)))
7375 		e.name = xstrdup ((const char *) IDENTIFIER_POINTER
7376 				                  (DECL_NAME (TYPE_NAME (decl))));
7377              else
7378 	       e.name = xstrdup ((const char *) get_AT_string (die, DW_AT_name));
7379 	    }
7380 	}
7381       else
7382 	e.name = xstrdup (dwarf2_name (decl, 1));
7383 
7384       /* If we don't have a name for the type, there's no point in adding
7385 	 it to the table.  */
7386       if (e.name && e.name[0] != '\0')
7387 	VEC_safe_push (pubname_entry, gc, pubtype_table, &e);
7388     }
7389 }
7390 
7391 /* Output the public names table used to speed up access to externally
7392    visible names; or the public types table used to find type definitions.  */
7393 
7394 static void
output_pubnames(VEC (pubname_entry,gc)* names)7395 output_pubnames (VEC (pubname_entry, gc) * names)
7396 {
7397   unsigned i;
7398   unsigned long pubnames_length = size_of_pubnames (names);
7399   pubname_ref pub;
7400 
7401   if (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE - DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 4)
7402     dw2_asm_output_data (4, 0xffffffff,
7403       "Initial length escape value indicating 64-bit DWARF extension");
7404   if (names == pubname_table)
7405     dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, pubnames_length,
7406 			 "Length of Public Names Info");
7407   else
7408     dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, pubnames_length,
7409 			 "Length of Public Type Names Info");
7410   dw2_asm_output_data (2, DWARF_VERSION, "DWARF Version");
7411   dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, debug_info_section_label,
7412 			 debug_info_section,
7413 			 "Offset of Compilation Unit Info");
7414   dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, next_die_offset,
7415 		       "Compilation Unit Length");
7416 
7417   for (i = 0; VEC_iterate (pubname_entry, names, i, pub); i++)
7418     {
7419       /* We shouldn't see pubnames for DIEs outside of the main CU.  */
7420       if (names == pubname_table)
7421 	gcc_assert (pub->die->die_mark);
7422 
7423       if (names != pubtype_table
7424 	  || pub->die->die_offset != 0
7425 	  || !flag_eliminate_unused_debug_types)
7426 	{
7427 	  dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, pub->die->die_offset,
7428 			       "DIE offset");
7429 
7430 	  dw2_asm_output_nstring (pub->name, -1, "external name");
7431 	}
7432     }
7433 
7434   dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, 0, NULL);
7435 }
7436 
7437 /* Add a new entry to .debug_aranges if appropriate.  */
7438 
7439 static void
add_arange(tree decl,dw_die_ref die)7440 add_arange (tree decl, dw_die_ref die)
7441 {
7442   if (! DECL_SECTION_NAME (decl))
7443     return;
7444 
7445   if (arange_table_in_use == arange_table_allocated)
7446     {
7447       arange_table_allocated += ARANGE_TABLE_INCREMENT;
7448       arange_table = ggc_realloc (arange_table,
7449 				  (arange_table_allocated
7450 				   * sizeof (dw_die_ref)));
7451       memset (arange_table + arange_table_in_use, 0,
7452 	      ARANGE_TABLE_INCREMENT * sizeof (dw_die_ref));
7453     }
7454 
7455   arange_table[arange_table_in_use++] = die;
7456 }
7457 
7458 /* Output the information that goes into the .debug_aranges table.
7459    Namely, define the beginning and ending address range of the
7460    text section generated for this compilation unit.  */
7461 
7462 static void
output_aranges(void)7463 output_aranges (void)
7464 {
7465   unsigned i;
7466   unsigned long aranges_length = size_of_aranges ();
7467 
7468   if (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE - DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 4)
7469     dw2_asm_output_data (4, 0xffffffff,
7470       "Initial length escape value indicating 64-bit DWARF extension");
7471   dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, aranges_length,
7472 		       "Length of Address Ranges Info");
7473   dw2_asm_output_data (2, DWARF_VERSION, "DWARF Version");
7474   dw2_asm_output_offset (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, debug_info_section_label,
7475 			 debug_info_section,
7476 			 "Offset of Compilation Unit Info");
7477   dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, "Size of Address");
7478   dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "Size of Segment Descriptor");
7479 
7480   /* We need to align to twice the pointer size here.  */
7481   if (DWARF_ARANGES_PAD_SIZE)
7482     {
7483       /* Pad using a 2 byte words so that padding is correct for any
7484 	 pointer size.  */
7485       dw2_asm_output_data (2, 0, "Pad to %d byte boundary",
7486 			   2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE);
7487       for (i = 2; i < (unsigned) DWARF_ARANGES_PAD_SIZE; i += 2)
7488 	dw2_asm_output_data (2, 0, NULL);
7489     }
7490 
7491   dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, text_section_label, "Address");
7492   dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, text_end_label,
7493 			text_section_label, "Length");
7494   if (flag_reorder_blocks_and_partition)
7495     {
7496       dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, cold_text_section_label,
7497 			   "Address");
7498       dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, cold_end_label,
7499 			    cold_text_section_label, "Length");
7500     }
7501 
7502   for (i = 0; i < arange_table_in_use; i++)
7503     {
7504       dw_die_ref die = arange_table[i];
7505 
7506       /* We shouldn't see aranges for DIEs outside of the main CU.  */
7507       gcc_assert (die->die_mark);
7508 
7509       if (die->die_tag == DW_TAG_subprogram)
7510 	{
7511 	  dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, get_AT_low_pc (die),
7512 			       "Address");
7513 	  dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, get_AT_hi_pc (die),
7514 				get_AT_low_pc (die), "Length");
7515 	}
7516       else
7517 	{
7518 	  /* A static variable; extract the symbol from DW_AT_location.
7519 	     Note that this code isn't currently hit, as we only emit
7520 	     aranges for functions (jason 9/23/99).  */
7521 	  dw_attr_ref a = get_AT (die, DW_AT_location);
7522 	  dw_loc_descr_ref loc;
7523 
7524 	  gcc_assert (a && AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_loc);
7525 
7526 	  loc = AT_loc (a);
7527 	  gcc_assert (loc->dw_loc_opc == DW_OP_addr);
7528 
7529 	  dw2_asm_output_addr_rtx (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE,
7530 				   loc->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_addr, "Address");
7531 	  dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE,
7532 			       get_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_byte_size),
7533 			       "Length");
7534 	}
7535     }
7536 
7537   /* Output the terminator words.  */
7538   dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, 0, NULL);
7539   dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, 0, NULL);
7540 }
7541 
7542 /* Add a new entry to .debug_ranges.  Return the offset at which it
7543    was placed.  */
7544 
7545 static unsigned int
add_ranges(tree block)7546 add_ranges (tree block)
7547 {
7548   unsigned int in_use = ranges_table_in_use;
7549 
7550   if (in_use == ranges_table_allocated)
7551     {
7552       ranges_table_allocated += RANGES_TABLE_INCREMENT;
7553       ranges_table
7554 	= ggc_realloc (ranges_table, (ranges_table_allocated
7555 				      * sizeof (struct dw_ranges_struct)));
7556       memset (ranges_table + ranges_table_in_use, 0,
7557 	      RANGES_TABLE_INCREMENT * sizeof (struct dw_ranges_struct));
7558     }
7559 
7560   ranges_table[in_use].block_num = (block ? BLOCK_NUMBER (block) : 0);
7561   ranges_table_in_use = in_use + 1;
7562 
7563   return in_use * 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE;
7564 }
7565 
7566 static void
output_ranges(void)7567 output_ranges (void)
7568 {
7569   unsigned i;
7570   static const char *const start_fmt = "Offset 0x%x";
7571   const char *fmt = start_fmt;
7572 
7573   for (i = 0; i < ranges_table_in_use; i++)
7574     {
7575       int block_num = ranges_table[i].block_num;
7576 
7577       if (block_num)
7578 	{
7579 	  char blabel[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
7580 	  char elabel[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
7581 
7582 	  ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (blabel, BLOCK_BEGIN_LABEL, block_num);
7583 	  ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (elabel, BLOCK_END_LABEL, block_num);
7584 
7585 	  /* If all code is in the text section, then the compilation
7586 	     unit base address defaults to DW_AT_low_pc, which is the
7587 	     base of the text section.  */
7588 	  if (!have_multiple_function_sections)
7589 	    {
7590 	      dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, blabel,
7591 				    text_section_label,
7592 				    fmt, i * 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE);
7593 	      dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, elabel,
7594 				    text_section_label, NULL);
7595 	    }
7596 
7597 	  /* Otherwise, we add a DW_AT_entry_pc attribute to force the
7598 	     compilation unit base address to zero, which allows us to
7599 	     use absolute addresses, and not worry about whether the
7600 	     target supports cross-section arithmetic.  */
7601 	  else
7602 	    {
7603 	      dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, blabel,
7604 				   fmt, i * 2 * DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE);
7605 	      dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, elabel, NULL);
7606 	    }
7607 
7608 	  fmt = NULL;
7609 	}
7610       else
7611 	{
7612 	  dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, 0, NULL);
7613 	  dw2_asm_output_data (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, 0, NULL);
7614 	  fmt = start_fmt;
7615 	}
7616     }
7617 }
7618 
7619 /* Data structure containing information about input files.  */
7620 struct file_info
7621 {
7622   const char *path;	/* Complete file name.  */
7623   const char *fname;	/* File name part.  */
7624   int length;		/* Length of entire string.  */
7625   struct dwarf_file_data * file_idx;	/* Index in input file table.  */
7626   int dir_idx;		/* Index in directory table.  */
7627 };
7628 
7629 /* Data structure containing information about directories with source
7630    files.  */
7631 struct dir_info
7632 {
7633   const char *path;	/* Path including directory name.  */
7634   int length;		/* Path length.  */
7635   int prefix;		/* Index of directory entry which is a prefix.  */
7636   int count;		/* Number of files in this directory.  */
7637   int dir_idx;		/* Index of directory used as base.  */
7638 };
7639 
7640 /* Callback function for file_info comparison.  We sort by looking at
7641    the directories in the path.  */
7642 
7643 static int
file_info_cmp(const void * p1,const void * p2)7644 file_info_cmp (const void *p1, const void *p2)
7645 {
7646   const struct file_info *s1 = p1;
7647   const struct file_info *s2 = p2;
7648   unsigned char *cp1;
7649   unsigned char *cp2;
7650 
7651   /* Take care of file names without directories.  We need to make sure that
7652      we return consistent values to qsort since some will get confused if
7653      we return the same value when identical operands are passed in opposite
7654      orders.  So if neither has a directory, return 0 and otherwise return
7655      1 or -1 depending on which one has the directory.  */
7656   if ((s1->path == s1->fname || s2->path == s2->fname))
7657     return (s2->path == s2->fname) - (s1->path == s1->fname);
7658 
7659   cp1 = (unsigned char *) s1->path;
7660   cp2 = (unsigned char *) s2->path;
7661 
7662   while (1)
7663     {
7664       ++cp1;
7665       ++cp2;
7666       /* Reached the end of the first path?  If so, handle like above.  */
7667       if ((cp1 == (unsigned char *) s1->fname)
7668 	  || (cp2 == (unsigned char *) s2->fname))
7669 	return ((cp2 == (unsigned char *) s2->fname)
7670 		- (cp1 == (unsigned char *) s1->fname));
7671 
7672       /* Character of current path component the same?  */
7673       else if (*cp1 != *cp2)
7674 	return *cp1 - *cp2;
7675     }
7676 }
7677 
7678 struct file_name_acquire_data
7679 {
7680   struct file_info *files;
7681   int used_files;
7682   int max_files;
7683 };
7684 
7685 /* Traversal function for the hash table.  */
7686 
7687 static int
file_name_acquire(void ** slot,void * data)7688 file_name_acquire (void ** slot, void *data)
7689 {
7690   struct file_name_acquire_data *fnad = data;
7691   struct dwarf_file_data *d = *slot;
7692   struct file_info *fi;
7693   const char *f;
7694 
7695   gcc_assert (fnad->max_files >= d->emitted_number);
7696 
7697   if (! d->emitted_number)
7698     return 1;
7699 
7700   gcc_assert (fnad->max_files != fnad->used_files);
7701 
7702   fi = fnad->files + fnad->used_files++;
7703 
7704   /* Skip all leading "./".  */
7705   f = d->filename;
7706   while (f[0] == '.' && f[1] == '/')
7707     f += 2;
7708 
7709   /* Create a new array entry.  */
7710   fi->path = f;
7711   fi->length = strlen (f);
7712   fi->file_idx = d;
7713 
7714   /* Search for the file name part.  */
7715   f = strrchr (f, '/');
7716   fi->fname = f == NULL ? fi->path : f + 1;
7717   return 1;
7718 }
7719 
7720 /* Output the directory table and the file name table.  We try to minimize
7721    the total amount of memory needed.  A heuristic is used to avoid large
7722    slowdowns with many input files.  */
7723 
7724 static void
output_file_names(void)7725 output_file_names (void)
7726 {
7727   struct file_name_acquire_data fnad;
7728   int numfiles;
7729   struct file_info *files;
7730   struct dir_info *dirs;
7731   int *saved;
7732   int *savehere;
7733   int *backmap;
7734   int ndirs;
7735   int idx_offset;
7736   int i;
7737   int idx;
7738 
7739   if (!last_emitted_file)
7740     {
7741       dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "End directory table");
7742       dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "End file name table");
7743       return;
7744     }
7745 
7746   numfiles = last_emitted_file->emitted_number;
7747 
7748   /* Allocate the various arrays we need.  */
7749   files = alloca (numfiles * sizeof (struct file_info));
7750   dirs = alloca (numfiles * sizeof (struct dir_info));
7751 
7752   fnad.files = files;
7753   fnad.used_files = 0;
7754   fnad.max_files = numfiles;
7755   htab_traverse (file_table, file_name_acquire, &fnad);
7756   gcc_assert (fnad.used_files == fnad.max_files);
7757 
7758   qsort (files, numfiles, sizeof (files[0]), file_info_cmp);
7759 
7760   /* Find all the different directories used.  */
7761   dirs[0].path = files[0].path;
7762   dirs[0].length = files[0].fname - files[0].path;
7763   dirs[0].prefix = -1;
7764   dirs[0].count = 1;
7765   dirs[0].dir_idx = 0;
7766   files[0].dir_idx = 0;
7767   ndirs = 1;
7768 
7769   for (i = 1; i < numfiles; i++)
7770     if (files[i].fname - files[i].path == dirs[ndirs - 1].length
7771 	&& memcmp (dirs[ndirs - 1].path, files[i].path,
7772 		   dirs[ndirs - 1].length) == 0)
7773       {
7774 	/* Same directory as last entry.  */
7775 	files[i].dir_idx = ndirs - 1;
7776 	++dirs[ndirs - 1].count;
7777       }
7778     else
7779       {
7780 	int j;
7781 
7782 	/* This is a new directory.  */
7783 	dirs[ndirs].path = files[i].path;
7784 	dirs[ndirs].length = files[i].fname - files[i].path;
7785 	dirs[ndirs].count = 1;
7786 	dirs[ndirs].dir_idx = ndirs;
7787 	files[i].dir_idx = ndirs;
7788 
7789 	/* Search for a prefix.  */
7790 	dirs[ndirs].prefix = -1;
7791 	for (j = 0; j < ndirs; j++)
7792 	  if (dirs[j].length < dirs[ndirs].length
7793 	      && dirs[j].length > 1
7794 	      && (dirs[ndirs].prefix == -1
7795 		  || dirs[j].length > dirs[dirs[ndirs].prefix].length)
7796 	      && memcmp (dirs[j].path, dirs[ndirs].path, dirs[j].length) == 0)
7797 	    dirs[ndirs].prefix = j;
7798 
7799 	++ndirs;
7800       }
7801 
7802   /* Now to the actual work.  We have to find a subset of the directories which
7803      allow expressing the file name using references to the directory table
7804      with the least amount of characters.  We do not do an exhaustive search
7805      where we would have to check out every combination of every single
7806      possible prefix.  Instead we use a heuristic which provides nearly optimal
7807      results in most cases and never is much off.  */
7808   saved = alloca (ndirs * sizeof (int));
7809   savehere = alloca (ndirs * sizeof (int));
7810 
7811   memset (saved, '\0', ndirs * sizeof (saved[0]));
7812   for (i = 0; i < ndirs; i++)
7813     {
7814       int j;
7815       int total;
7816 
7817       /* We can always save some space for the current directory.  But this
7818 	 does not mean it will be enough to justify adding the directory.  */
7819       savehere[i] = dirs[i].length;
7820       total = (savehere[i] - saved[i]) * dirs[i].count;
7821 
7822       for (j = i + 1; j < ndirs; j++)
7823 	{
7824 	  savehere[j] = 0;
7825 	  if (saved[j] < dirs[i].length)
7826 	    {
7827 	      /* Determine whether the dirs[i] path is a prefix of the
7828 		 dirs[j] path.  */
7829 	      int k;
7830 
7831 	      k = dirs[j].prefix;
7832 	      while (k != -1 && k != (int) i)
7833 		k = dirs[k].prefix;
7834 
7835 	      if (k == (int) i)
7836 		{
7837 		  /* Yes it is.  We can possibly save some memory by
7838 		     writing the filenames in dirs[j] relative to
7839 		     dirs[i].  */
7840 		  savehere[j] = dirs[i].length;
7841 		  total += (savehere[j] - saved[j]) * dirs[j].count;
7842 		}
7843 	    }
7844 	}
7845 
7846       /* Check whether we can save enough to justify adding the dirs[i]
7847 	 directory.  */
7848       if (total > dirs[i].length + 1)
7849 	{
7850 	  /* It's worthwhile adding.  */
7851 	  for (j = i; j < ndirs; j++)
7852 	    if (savehere[j] > 0)
7853 	      {
7854 		/* Remember how much we saved for this directory so far.  */
7855 		saved[j] = savehere[j];
7856 
7857 		/* Remember the prefix directory.  */
7858 		dirs[j].dir_idx = i;
7859 	      }
7860 	}
7861     }
7862 
7863   /* Emit the directory name table.  */
7864   idx = 1;
7865   idx_offset = dirs[0].length > 0 ? 1 : 0;
7866   for (i = 1 - idx_offset; i < ndirs; i++)
7867     dw2_asm_output_nstring (dirs[i].path, dirs[i].length - 1,
7868 			    "Directory Entry: 0x%x", i + idx_offset);
7869 
7870   dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "End directory table");
7871 
7872   /* We have to emit them in the order of emitted_number since that's
7873      used in the debug info generation.  To do this efficiently we
7874      generate a back-mapping of the indices first.  */
7875   backmap = alloca (numfiles * sizeof (int));
7876   for (i = 0; i < numfiles; i++)
7877     backmap[files[i].file_idx->emitted_number - 1] = i;
7878 
7879   /* Now write all the file names.  */
7880   for (i = 0; i < numfiles; i++)
7881     {
7882       int file_idx = backmap[i];
7883       int dir_idx = dirs[files[file_idx].dir_idx].dir_idx;
7884 
7885       dw2_asm_output_nstring (files[file_idx].path + dirs[dir_idx].length, -1,
7886 			      "File Entry: 0x%x", (unsigned) i + 1);
7887 
7888       /* Include directory index.  */
7889       dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (dir_idx + idx_offset, NULL);
7890 
7891       /* Modification time.  */
7892       dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (0, NULL);
7893 
7894       /* File length in bytes.  */
7895       dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (0, NULL);
7896     }
7897 
7898   dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "End file name table");
7899 }
7900 
7901 
7902 /* Output the source line number correspondence information.  This
7903    information goes into the .debug_line section.  */
7904 
7905 static void
output_line_info(void)7906 output_line_info (void)
7907 {
7908   char l1[20], l2[20], p1[20], p2[20];
7909   char line_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
7910   char prev_line_label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
7911   unsigned opc;
7912   unsigned n_op_args;
7913   unsigned long lt_index;
7914   unsigned long current_line;
7915   long line_offset;
7916   long line_delta;
7917   unsigned long current_file;
7918   unsigned long function;
7919 
7920   ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (l1, LINE_NUMBER_BEGIN_LABEL, 0);
7921   ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (l2, LINE_NUMBER_END_LABEL, 0);
7922   ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (p1, LN_PROLOG_AS_LABEL, 0);
7923   ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (p2, LN_PROLOG_END_LABEL, 0);
7924 
7925   if (DWARF_INITIAL_LENGTH_SIZE - DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE == 4)
7926     dw2_asm_output_data (4, 0xffffffff,
7927       "Initial length escape value indicating 64-bit DWARF extension");
7928   dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, l2, l1,
7929 			"Length of Source Line Info");
7930   ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, l1);
7931 
7932   dw2_asm_output_data (2, DWARF_VERSION, "DWARF Version");
7933   dw2_asm_output_delta (DWARF_OFFSET_SIZE, p2, p1, "Prolog Length");
7934   ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, p1);
7935 
7936   /* Define the architecture-dependent minimum instruction length (in
7937    bytes).  In this implementation of DWARF, this field is used for
7938    information purposes only.  Since GCC generates assembly language,
7939    we have no a priori knowledge of how many instruction bytes are
7940    generated for each source line, and therefore can use only the
7941    DW_LNE_set_address and DW_LNS_fixed_advance_pc line information
7942    commands.  Accordingly, we fix this as `1', which is "correct
7943    enough" for all architectures, and don't let the target override.  */
7944   dw2_asm_output_data (1, 1,
7945 		       "Minimum Instruction Length");
7946 
7947   dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF_LINE_DEFAULT_IS_STMT_START,
7948 		       "Default is_stmt_start flag");
7949   dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF_LINE_BASE,
7950 		       "Line Base Value (Special Opcodes)");
7951   dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF_LINE_RANGE,
7952 		       "Line Range Value (Special Opcodes)");
7953   dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF_LINE_OPCODE_BASE,
7954 		       "Special Opcode Base");
7955 
7956   for (opc = 1; opc < DWARF_LINE_OPCODE_BASE; opc++)
7957     {
7958       switch (opc)
7959 	{
7960 	case DW_LNS_advance_pc:
7961 	case DW_LNS_advance_line:
7962 	case DW_LNS_set_file:
7963 	case DW_LNS_set_column:
7964 	case DW_LNS_fixed_advance_pc:
7965 	  n_op_args = 1;
7966 	  break;
7967 	default:
7968 	  n_op_args = 0;
7969 	  break;
7970 	}
7971 
7972       dw2_asm_output_data (1, n_op_args, "opcode: 0x%x has %d args",
7973 			   opc, n_op_args);
7974     }
7975 
7976   /* Write out the information about the files we use.  */
7977   output_file_names ();
7978   ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, p2);
7979 
7980   /* We used to set the address register to the first location in the text
7981      section here, but that didn't accomplish anything since we already
7982      have a line note for the opening brace of the first function.  */
7983 
7984   /* Generate the line number to PC correspondence table, encoded as
7985      a series of state machine operations.  */
7986   current_file = 1;
7987   current_line = 1;
7988 
7989   if (cfun && in_cold_section_p)
7990     strcpy (prev_line_label, cfun->cold_section_label);
7991   else
7992     strcpy (prev_line_label, text_section_label);
7993   for (lt_index = 1; lt_index < line_info_table_in_use; ++lt_index)
7994     {
7995       dw_line_info_ref line_info = &line_info_table[lt_index];
7996 
7997 #if 0
7998       /* Disable this optimization for now; GDB wants to see two line notes
7999 	 at the beginning of a function so it can find the end of the
8000 	 prologue.  */
8001 
8002       /* Don't emit anything for redundant notes.  Just updating the
8003 	 address doesn't accomplish anything, because we already assume
8004 	 that anything after the last address is this line.  */
8005       if (line_info->dw_line_num == current_line
8006 	  && line_info->dw_file_num == current_file)
8007 	continue;
8008 #endif
8009 
8010       /* Emit debug info for the address of the current line.
8011 
8012 	 Unfortunately, we have little choice here currently, and must always
8013 	 use the most general form.  GCC does not know the address delta
8014 	 itself, so we can't use DW_LNS_advance_pc.  Many ports do have length
8015 	 attributes which will give an upper bound on the address range.  We
8016 	 could perhaps use length attributes to determine when it is safe to
8017 	 use DW_LNS_fixed_advance_pc.  */
8018 
8019       ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (line_label, LINE_CODE_LABEL, lt_index);
8020       if (0)
8021 	{
8022 	  /* This can handle deltas up to 0xffff.  This takes 3 bytes.  */
8023 	  dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_fixed_advance_pc,
8024 			       "DW_LNS_fixed_advance_pc");
8025 	  dw2_asm_output_delta (2, line_label, prev_line_label, NULL);
8026 	}
8027       else
8028 	{
8029 	  /* This can handle any delta.  This takes
8030 	     4+DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE bytes.  */
8031 	  dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "DW_LNE_set_address");
8032 	  dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (1 + DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, NULL);
8033 	  dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNE_set_address, NULL);
8034 	  dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, line_label, NULL);
8035 	}
8036 
8037       strcpy (prev_line_label, line_label);
8038 
8039       /* Emit debug info for the source file of the current line, if
8040 	 different from the previous line.  */
8041       if (line_info->dw_file_num != current_file)
8042 	{
8043 	  current_file = line_info->dw_file_num;
8044 	  dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_set_file, "DW_LNS_set_file");
8045 	  dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (current_file, "%lu", current_file);
8046 	}
8047 
8048       /* Emit debug info for the current line number, choosing the encoding
8049 	 that uses the least amount of space.  */
8050       if (line_info->dw_line_num != current_line)
8051 	{
8052 	  line_offset = line_info->dw_line_num - current_line;
8053 	  line_delta = line_offset - DWARF_LINE_BASE;
8054 	  current_line = line_info->dw_line_num;
8055 	  if (line_delta >= 0 && line_delta < (DWARF_LINE_RANGE - 1))
8056 	    /* This can handle deltas from -10 to 234, using the current
8057 	       definitions of DWARF_LINE_BASE and DWARF_LINE_RANGE.  This
8058 	       takes 1 byte.  */
8059 	    dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF_LINE_OPCODE_BASE + line_delta,
8060 				 "line %lu", current_line);
8061 	  else
8062 	    {
8063 	      /* This can handle any delta.  This takes at least 4 bytes,
8064 		 depending on the value being encoded.  */
8065 	      dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_advance_line,
8066 				   "advance to line %lu", current_line);
8067 	      dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (line_offset, NULL);
8068 	      dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_copy, "DW_LNS_copy");
8069 	    }
8070 	}
8071       else
8072 	/* We still need to start a new row, so output a copy insn.  */
8073 	dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_copy, "DW_LNS_copy");
8074     }
8075 
8076   /* Emit debug info for the address of the end of the function.  */
8077   if (0)
8078     {
8079       dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_fixed_advance_pc,
8080 			   "DW_LNS_fixed_advance_pc");
8081       dw2_asm_output_delta (2, text_end_label, prev_line_label, NULL);
8082     }
8083   else
8084     {
8085       dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "DW_LNE_set_address");
8086       dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (1 + DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, NULL);
8087       dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNE_set_address, NULL);
8088       dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, text_end_label, NULL);
8089     }
8090 
8091   dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "DW_LNE_end_sequence");
8092   dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (1, NULL);
8093   dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNE_end_sequence, NULL);
8094 
8095   function = 0;
8096   current_file = 1;
8097   current_line = 1;
8098   for (lt_index = 0; lt_index < separate_line_info_table_in_use;)
8099     {
8100       dw_separate_line_info_ref line_info
8101 	= &separate_line_info_table[lt_index];
8102 
8103 #if 0
8104       /* Don't emit anything for redundant notes.  */
8105       if (line_info->dw_line_num == current_line
8106 	  && line_info->dw_file_num == current_file
8107 	  && line_info->function == function)
8108 	goto cont;
8109 #endif
8110 
8111       /* Emit debug info for the address of the current line.  If this is
8112 	 a new function, or the first line of a function, then we need
8113 	 to handle it differently.  */
8114       ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (line_label, SEPARATE_LINE_CODE_LABEL,
8115 				   lt_index);
8116       if (function != line_info->function)
8117 	{
8118 	  function = line_info->function;
8119 
8120 	  /* Set the address register to the first line in the function.  */
8121 	  dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "DW_LNE_set_address");
8122 	  dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (1 + DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, NULL);
8123 	  dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNE_set_address, NULL);
8124 	  dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, line_label, NULL);
8125 	}
8126       else
8127 	{
8128 	  /* ??? See the DW_LNS_advance_pc comment above.  */
8129 	  if (0)
8130 	    {
8131 	      dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_fixed_advance_pc,
8132 				   "DW_LNS_fixed_advance_pc");
8133 	      dw2_asm_output_delta (2, line_label, prev_line_label, NULL);
8134 	    }
8135 	  else
8136 	    {
8137 	      dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "DW_LNE_set_address");
8138 	      dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (1 + DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, NULL);
8139 	      dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNE_set_address, NULL);
8140 	      dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, line_label, NULL);
8141 	    }
8142 	}
8143 
8144       strcpy (prev_line_label, line_label);
8145 
8146       /* Emit debug info for the source file of the current line, if
8147 	 different from the previous line.  */
8148       if (line_info->dw_file_num != current_file)
8149 	{
8150 	  current_file = line_info->dw_file_num;
8151 	  dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_set_file, "DW_LNS_set_file");
8152 	  dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (current_file, "%lu", current_file);
8153 	}
8154 
8155       /* Emit debug info for the current line number, choosing the encoding
8156 	 that uses the least amount of space.  */
8157       if (line_info->dw_line_num != current_line)
8158 	{
8159 	  line_offset = line_info->dw_line_num - current_line;
8160 	  line_delta = line_offset - DWARF_LINE_BASE;
8161 	  current_line = line_info->dw_line_num;
8162 	  if (line_delta >= 0 && line_delta < (DWARF_LINE_RANGE - 1))
8163 	    dw2_asm_output_data (1, DWARF_LINE_OPCODE_BASE + line_delta,
8164 				 "line %lu", current_line);
8165 	  else
8166 	    {
8167 	      dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_advance_line,
8168 				   "advance to line %lu", current_line);
8169 	      dw2_asm_output_data_sleb128 (line_offset, NULL);
8170 	      dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_copy, "DW_LNS_copy");
8171 	    }
8172 	}
8173       else
8174 	dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_copy, "DW_LNS_copy");
8175 
8176 #if 0
8177     cont:
8178 #endif
8179 
8180       lt_index++;
8181 
8182       /* If we're done with a function, end its sequence.  */
8183       if (lt_index == separate_line_info_table_in_use
8184 	  || separate_line_info_table[lt_index].function != function)
8185 	{
8186 	  current_file = 1;
8187 	  current_line = 1;
8188 
8189 	  /* Emit debug info for the address of the end of the function.  */
8190 	  ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (line_label, FUNC_END_LABEL, function);
8191 	  if (0)
8192 	    {
8193 	      dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNS_fixed_advance_pc,
8194 				   "DW_LNS_fixed_advance_pc");
8195 	      dw2_asm_output_delta (2, line_label, prev_line_label, NULL);
8196 	    }
8197 	  else
8198 	    {
8199 	      dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "DW_LNE_set_address");
8200 	      dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (1 + DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, NULL);
8201 	      dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNE_set_address, NULL);
8202 	      dw2_asm_output_addr (DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE, line_label, NULL);
8203 	    }
8204 
8205 	  /* Output the marker for the end of this sequence.  */
8206 	  dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "DW_LNE_end_sequence");
8207 	  dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (1, NULL);
8208 	  dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_LNE_end_sequence, NULL);
8209 	}
8210     }
8211 
8212   /* Output the marker for the end of the line number info.  */
8213   ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, l2);
8214 }
8215 
8216 /* Given a pointer to a tree node for some base type, return a pointer to
8217    a DIE that describes the given type.
8218 
8219    This routine must only be called for GCC type nodes that correspond to
8220    Dwarf base (fundamental) types.  */
8221 
8222 static dw_die_ref
base_type_die(tree type)8223 base_type_die (tree type)
8224 {
8225   dw_die_ref base_type_result;
8226   enum dwarf_type encoding;
8227 
8228   if (TREE_CODE (type) == ERROR_MARK || TREE_CODE (type) == VOID_TYPE)
8229     return 0;
8230 
8231   switch (TREE_CODE (type))
8232     {
8233     case INTEGER_TYPE:
8234       if (TYPE_STRING_FLAG (type))
8235 	{
8236 	  if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (type))
8237 	    encoding = DW_ATE_unsigned_char;
8238 	  else
8239 	    encoding = DW_ATE_signed_char;
8240 	}
8241       else if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (type))
8242 	encoding = DW_ATE_unsigned;
8243       else
8244 	encoding = DW_ATE_signed;
8245       break;
8246 
8247     case REAL_TYPE:
8248       if (DECIMAL_FLOAT_MODE_P (TYPE_MODE (type)))
8249 	encoding = DW_ATE_decimal_float;
8250       else
8251 	encoding = DW_ATE_float;
8252       break;
8253 
8254       /* Dwarf2 doesn't know anything about complex ints, so use
8255 	 a user defined type for it.  */
8256     case COMPLEX_TYPE:
8257       if (TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (type)) == REAL_TYPE)
8258 	encoding = DW_ATE_complex_float;
8259       else
8260 	encoding = DW_ATE_lo_user;
8261       break;
8262 
8263     case BOOLEAN_TYPE:
8264       /* GNU FORTRAN/Ada/C++ BOOLEAN type.  */
8265       encoding = DW_ATE_boolean;
8266       break;
8267 
8268     default:
8269       /* No other TREE_CODEs are Dwarf fundamental types.  */
8270       gcc_unreachable ();
8271     }
8272 
8273   base_type_result = new_die (DW_TAG_base_type, comp_unit_die, type);
8274 
8275   /* This probably indicates a bug.  */
8276   if (! TYPE_NAME (type))
8277     add_name_attribute (base_type_result, "__unknown__");
8278 
8279   add_AT_unsigned (base_type_result, DW_AT_byte_size,
8280 		   int_size_in_bytes (type));
8281   add_AT_unsigned (base_type_result, DW_AT_encoding, encoding);
8282 
8283   return base_type_result;
8284 }
8285 
8286 /* Given a pointer to an arbitrary ..._TYPE tree node, return a pointer to
8287    the Dwarf "root" type for the given input type.  The Dwarf "root" type of
8288    a given type is generally the same as the given type, except that if the
8289    given type is a pointer or reference type, then the root type of the given
8290    type is the root type of the "basis" type for the pointer or reference
8291    type.  (This definition of the "root" type is recursive.) Also, the root
8292    type of a `const' qualified type or a `volatile' qualified type is the
8293    root type of the given type without the qualifiers.  */
8294 
8295 static tree
root_type(tree type)8296 root_type (tree type)
8297 {
8298   if (TREE_CODE (type) == ERROR_MARK)
8299     return error_mark_node;
8300 
8301   switch (TREE_CODE (type))
8302     {
8303     case ERROR_MARK:
8304       return error_mark_node;
8305 
8306     /* APPLE LOCAL radar 5732232 - blocks */
8307     case BLOCK_POINTER_TYPE:
8308     case POINTER_TYPE:
8309     case REFERENCE_TYPE:
8310       return type_main_variant (root_type (TREE_TYPE (type)));
8311 
8312     default:
8313       return type_main_variant (type);
8314     }
8315 }
8316 
8317 /* Given a pointer to an arbitrary ..._TYPE tree node, return nonzero if the
8318    given input type is a Dwarf "fundamental" type.  Otherwise return null.  */
8319 
8320 static inline int
is_base_type(tree type)8321 is_base_type (tree type)
8322 {
8323   switch (TREE_CODE (type))
8324     {
8325     case ERROR_MARK:
8326     case VOID_TYPE:
8327     case INTEGER_TYPE:
8328     case REAL_TYPE:
8329     case COMPLEX_TYPE:
8330     case BOOLEAN_TYPE:
8331       return 1;
8332 
8333     case ARRAY_TYPE:
8334     case RECORD_TYPE:
8335     case UNION_TYPE:
8336     case QUAL_UNION_TYPE:
8337     case ENUMERAL_TYPE:
8338     case FUNCTION_TYPE:
8339     case METHOD_TYPE:
8340 	/* APPLE LOCAL radar 5732232 - blocks */
8341     case BLOCK_POINTER_TYPE:
8342     case POINTER_TYPE:
8343     case REFERENCE_TYPE:
8344     case OFFSET_TYPE:
8345     case LANG_TYPE:
8346     case VECTOR_TYPE:
8347       return 0;
8348 
8349     default:
8350       gcc_unreachable ();
8351     }
8352 
8353   return 0;
8354 }
8355 
8356 /* Given a pointer to a tree node, assumed to be some kind of a ..._TYPE
8357    node, return the size in bits for the type if it is a constant, or else
8358    return the alignment for the type if the type's size is not constant, or
8359    else return BITS_PER_WORD if the type actually turns out to be an
8360    ERROR_MARK node.  */
8361 
8362 static inline unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT
simple_type_size_in_bits(tree type)8363 simple_type_size_in_bits (tree type)
8364 {
8365   if (TREE_CODE (type) == ERROR_MARK)
8366     return BITS_PER_WORD;
8367   else if (TYPE_SIZE (type) == NULL_TREE)
8368     return 0;
8369   else if (host_integerp (TYPE_SIZE (type), 1))
8370     return tree_low_cst (TYPE_SIZE (type), 1);
8371   else
8372     return TYPE_ALIGN (type);
8373 }
8374 
8375 /* Return true if the debug information for the given type should be
8376    emitted as a subrange type.  */
8377 
8378 static inline bool
is_subrange_type(tree type)8379 is_subrange_type (tree type)
8380 {
8381   tree subtype = TREE_TYPE (type);
8382 
8383   /* Subrange types are identified by the fact that they are integer
8384      types, and that they have a subtype which is either an integer type
8385      or an enumeral type.  */
8386 
8387   if (TREE_CODE (type) != INTEGER_TYPE
8388       || subtype == NULL_TREE)
8389     return false;
8390 
8391   if (TREE_CODE (subtype) != INTEGER_TYPE
8392       && TREE_CODE (subtype) != ENUMERAL_TYPE)
8393     return false;
8394 
8395   if (TREE_CODE (type) == TREE_CODE (subtype)
8396       && int_size_in_bytes (type) == int_size_in_bytes (subtype)
8397       && TYPE_MIN_VALUE (type) != NULL
8398       && TYPE_MIN_VALUE (subtype) != NULL
8399       && tree_int_cst_equal (TYPE_MIN_VALUE (type), TYPE_MIN_VALUE (subtype))
8400       && TYPE_MAX_VALUE (type) != NULL
8401       && TYPE_MAX_VALUE (subtype) != NULL
8402       && tree_int_cst_equal (TYPE_MAX_VALUE (type), TYPE_MAX_VALUE (subtype)))
8403     {
8404       /* The type and its subtype have the same representation.  If in
8405          addition the two types also have the same name, then the given
8406          type is not a subrange type, but rather a plain base type.  */
8407       /* FIXME: brobecker/2004-03-22:
8408          Sizetype INTEGER_CSTs nodes are canonicalized.  It should
8409          therefore be sufficient to check the TYPE_SIZE node pointers
8410          rather than checking the actual size.  Unfortunately, we have
8411          found some cases, such as in the Ada "integer" type, where
8412          this is not the case.  Until this problem is solved, we need to
8413          keep checking the actual size.  */
8414       tree type_name = TYPE_NAME (type);
8415       tree subtype_name = TYPE_NAME (subtype);
8416 
8417       if (type_name != NULL && TREE_CODE (type_name) == TYPE_DECL)
8418         type_name = DECL_NAME (type_name);
8419 
8420       if (subtype_name != NULL && TREE_CODE (subtype_name) == TYPE_DECL)
8421         subtype_name = DECL_NAME (subtype_name);
8422 
8423       if (type_name == subtype_name)
8424         return false;
8425     }
8426 
8427   return true;
8428 }
8429 
8430 /*  Given a pointer to a tree node for a subrange type, return a pointer
8431     to a DIE that describes the given type.  */
8432 
8433 static dw_die_ref
subrange_type_die(tree type,dw_die_ref context_die)8434 subrange_type_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die)
8435 {
8436   dw_die_ref subrange_die;
8437   const HOST_WIDE_INT size_in_bytes = int_size_in_bytes (type);
8438 
8439   if (context_die == NULL)
8440     context_die = comp_unit_die;
8441 
8442   subrange_die = new_die (DW_TAG_subrange_type, context_die, type);
8443 
8444   if (int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (type)) != size_in_bytes)
8445     {
8446       /* The size of the subrange type and its base type do not match,
8447          so we need to generate a size attribute for the subrange type.  */
8448       add_AT_unsigned (subrange_die, DW_AT_byte_size, size_in_bytes);
8449     }
8450 
8451   if (TYPE_MIN_VALUE (type) != NULL)
8452     add_bound_info (subrange_die, DW_AT_lower_bound,
8453                     TYPE_MIN_VALUE (type));
8454   if (TYPE_MAX_VALUE (type) != NULL)
8455     add_bound_info (subrange_die, DW_AT_upper_bound,
8456                     TYPE_MAX_VALUE (type));
8457 
8458   return subrange_die;
8459 }
8460 
8461 /* Given a pointer to an arbitrary ..._TYPE tree node, return a debugging
8462    entry that chains various modifiers in front of the given type.  */
8463 
8464 static dw_die_ref
modified_type_die(tree type,int is_const_type,int is_volatile_type,dw_die_ref context_die)8465 modified_type_die (tree type, int is_const_type, int is_volatile_type,
8466 		   dw_die_ref context_die)
8467 {
8468   enum tree_code code = TREE_CODE (type);
8469   dw_die_ref mod_type_die;
8470   dw_die_ref sub_die = NULL;
8471   tree item_type = NULL;
8472   tree qualified_type;
8473   tree name;
8474 
8475   if (code == ERROR_MARK)
8476     return NULL;
8477 
8478   /* See if we already have the appropriately qualified variant of
8479      this type.  */
8480   qualified_type
8481     = get_qualified_type (type,
8482 			  ((is_const_type ? TYPE_QUAL_CONST : 0)
8483 			   | (is_volatile_type ? TYPE_QUAL_VOLATILE : 0)));
8484 
8485   /* If we do, then we can just use its DIE, if it exists.  */
8486   if (qualified_type)
8487     {
8488       mod_type_die = lookup_type_die (qualified_type);
8489       if (mod_type_die)
8490 	return mod_type_die;
8491     }
8492 
8493   name = qualified_type ? TYPE_NAME (qualified_type) : NULL;
8494 
8495   /* Handle C typedef types.  */
8496   if (name && TREE_CODE (name) == TYPE_DECL && DECL_ORIGINAL_TYPE (name))
8497     {
8498       tree dtype = TREE_TYPE (name);
8499 
8500       if (qualified_type == dtype)
8501 	{
8502 	  /* For a named type, use the typedef.  */
8503 	  gen_type_die (qualified_type, context_die);
8504 	  return lookup_type_die (qualified_type);
8505 	}
8506       else if (is_const_type < TYPE_READONLY (dtype)
8507 	       || is_volatile_type < TYPE_VOLATILE (dtype)
8508 	       || (is_const_type <= TYPE_READONLY (dtype)
8509 		   && is_volatile_type <= TYPE_VOLATILE (dtype)
8510 		   && DECL_ORIGINAL_TYPE (name) != type))
8511 	/* cv-unqualified version of named type.  Just use the unnamed
8512 	   type to which it refers.  */
8513 	return modified_type_die (DECL_ORIGINAL_TYPE (name),
8514 				  is_const_type, is_volatile_type,
8515 				  context_die);
8516       /* Else cv-qualified version of named type; fall through.  */
8517     }
8518 
8519   if (is_const_type)
8520     {
8521       mod_type_die = new_die (DW_TAG_const_type, comp_unit_die, type);
8522       sub_die = modified_type_die (type, 0, is_volatile_type, context_die);
8523     }
8524   else if (is_volatile_type)
8525     {
8526       mod_type_die = new_die (DW_TAG_volatile_type, comp_unit_die, type);
8527       sub_die = modified_type_die (type, 0, 0, context_die);
8528     }
8529   /* APPLE LOCAL radar 5732232 - blocks */
8530   else if (code == POINTER_TYPE || code == BLOCK_POINTER_TYPE)
8531     {
8532       mod_type_die = new_die (DW_TAG_pointer_type, comp_unit_die, type);
8533       add_AT_unsigned (mod_type_die, DW_AT_byte_size,
8534 		       simple_type_size_in_bits (type) / BITS_PER_UNIT);
8535       item_type = TREE_TYPE (type);
8536     }
8537   else if (code == REFERENCE_TYPE)
8538     {
8539       mod_type_die = new_die (DW_TAG_reference_type, comp_unit_die, type);
8540       add_AT_unsigned (mod_type_die, DW_AT_byte_size,
8541 		       simple_type_size_in_bits (type) / BITS_PER_UNIT);
8542       item_type = TREE_TYPE (type);
8543     }
8544   else if (is_subrange_type (type))
8545     {
8546       mod_type_die = subrange_type_die (type, context_die);
8547       item_type = TREE_TYPE (type);
8548     }
8549   else if (is_base_type (type))
8550     mod_type_die = base_type_die (type);
8551   else
8552     {
8553       gen_type_die (type, context_die);
8554 
8555       /* We have to get the type_main_variant here (and pass that to the
8556 	 `lookup_type_die' routine) because the ..._TYPE node we have
8557 	 might simply be a *copy* of some original type node (where the
8558 	 copy was created to help us keep track of typedef names) and
8559 	 that copy might have a different TYPE_UID from the original
8560 	 ..._TYPE node.  */
8561       if (TREE_CODE (type) != VECTOR_TYPE)
8562 	return lookup_type_die (type_main_variant (type));
8563       else
8564 	/* Vectors have the debugging information in the type,
8565 	   not the main variant.  */
8566 	return lookup_type_die (type);
8567     }
8568 
8569   /* Builtin types don't have a DECL_ORIGINAL_TYPE.  For those,
8570      don't output a DW_TAG_typedef, since there isn't one in the
8571      user's program; just attach a DW_AT_name to the type.  */
8572   if (name
8573       && (TREE_CODE (name) != TYPE_DECL || TREE_TYPE (name) == qualified_type))
8574     {
8575       if (TREE_CODE (name) == TYPE_DECL)
8576 	/* Could just call add_name_and_src_coords_attributes here,
8577 	   but since this is a builtin type it doesn't have any
8578 	   useful source coordinates anyway.  */
8579 	name = DECL_NAME (name);
8580       add_name_attribute (mod_type_die, IDENTIFIER_POINTER (name));
8581     }
8582 
8583   if (qualified_type)
8584     equate_type_number_to_die (qualified_type, mod_type_die);
8585 
8586   if (item_type)
8587     /* We must do this after the equate_type_number_to_die call, in case
8588        this is a recursive type.  This ensures that the modified_type_die
8589        recursion will terminate even if the type is recursive.  Recursive
8590        types are possible in Ada.  */
8591     sub_die = modified_type_die (item_type,
8592 				 TYPE_READONLY (item_type),
8593 				 TYPE_VOLATILE (item_type),
8594 				 context_die);
8595 
8596   if (sub_die != NULL)
8597     add_AT_die_ref (mod_type_die, DW_AT_type, sub_die);
8598 
8599   return mod_type_die;
8600 }
8601 
8602 /* Given a pointer to an arbitrary ..._TYPE tree node, return true if it is
8603    an enumerated type.  */
8604 
8605 static inline int
type_is_enum(tree type)8606 type_is_enum (tree type)
8607 {
8608   return TREE_CODE (type) == ENUMERAL_TYPE;
8609 }
8610 
8611 /* Return the DBX register number described by a given RTL node.  */
8612 
8613 static unsigned int
dbx_reg_number(rtx rtl)8614 dbx_reg_number (rtx rtl)
8615 {
8616   unsigned regno = REGNO (rtl);
8617 
8618   gcc_assert (regno < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER);
8619 
8620 #ifdef LEAF_REG_REMAP
8621   if (current_function_uses_only_leaf_regs)
8622     {
8623       int leaf_reg = LEAF_REG_REMAP (regno);
8624       if (leaf_reg != -1)
8625 	regno = (unsigned) leaf_reg;
8626     }
8627 #endif
8628 
8629   return DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER (regno);
8630 }
8631 
8632 /* Optionally add a DW_OP_piece term to a location description expression.
8633    DW_OP_piece is only added if the location description expression already
8634    doesn't end with DW_OP_piece.  */
8635 
8636 static void
add_loc_descr_op_piece(dw_loc_descr_ref * list_head,int size)8637 add_loc_descr_op_piece (dw_loc_descr_ref *list_head, int size)
8638 {
8639   dw_loc_descr_ref loc;
8640 
8641   if (*list_head != NULL)
8642     {
8643       /* Find the end of the chain.  */
8644       for (loc = *list_head; loc->dw_loc_next != NULL; loc = loc->dw_loc_next)
8645 	;
8646 
8647       if (loc->dw_loc_opc != DW_OP_piece)
8648 	loc->dw_loc_next = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_piece, size, 0);
8649     }
8650 }
8651 
8652 /* Return a location descriptor that designates a machine register or
8653    zero if there is none.  */
8654 
8655 static dw_loc_descr_ref
reg_loc_descriptor(rtx rtl)8656 reg_loc_descriptor (rtx rtl)
8657 {
8658   rtx regs;
8659 
8660   if (REGNO (rtl) >= FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
8661     return 0;
8662 
8663   regs = targetm.dwarf_register_span (rtl);
8664 
8665   if (hard_regno_nregs[REGNO (rtl)][GET_MODE (rtl)] > 1 || regs)
8666     return multiple_reg_loc_descriptor (rtl, regs);
8667   else
8668     return one_reg_loc_descriptor (dbx_reg_number (rtl));
8669 }
8670 
8671 /* Return a location descriptor that designates a machine register for
8672    a given hard register number.  */
8673 
8674 static dw_loc_descr_ref
one_reg_loc_descriptor(unsigned int regno)8675 one_reg_loc_descriptor (unsigned int regno)
8676 {
8677   if (regno <= 31)
8678     return new_loc_descr (DW_OP_reg0 + regno, 0, 0);
8679   else
8680     return new_loc_descr (DW_OP_regx, regno, 0);
8681 }
8682 
8683 /* Given an RTL of a register, return a location descriptor that
8684    designates a value that spans more than one register.  */
8685 
8686 static dw_loc_descr_ref
multiple_reg_loc_descriptor(rtx rtl,rtx regs)8687 multiple_reg_loc_descriptor (rtx rtl, rtx regs)
8688 {
8689   int nregs, size, i;
8690   unsigned reg;
8691   dw_loc_descr_ref loc_result = NULL;
8692 
8693   reg = REGNO (rtl);
8694 #ifdef LEAF_REG_REMAP
8695   if (current_function_uses_only_leaf_regs)
8696     {
8697       int leaf_reg = LEAF_REG_REMAP (reg);
8698       if (leaf_reg != -1)
8699 	reg = (unsigned) leaf_reg;
8700     }
8701 #endif
8702   gcc_assert ((unsigned) DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER (reg) == dbx_reg_number (rtl));
8703   nregs = hard_regno_nregs[REGNO (rtl)][GET_MODE (rtl)];
8704 
8705   /* Simple, contiguous registers.  */
8706   if (regs == NULL_RTX)
8707     {
8708       size = GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (rtl)) / nregs;
8709 
8710       loc_result = NULL;
8711       while (nregs--)
8712 	{
8713 	  dw_loc_descr_ref t;
8714 
8715 	  t = one_reg_loc_descriptor (DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER (reg));
8716 	  add_loc_descr (&loc_result, t);
8717 	  add_loc_descr_op_piece (&loc_result, size);
8718 	  ++reg;
8719 	}
8720       return loc_result;
8721     }
8722 
8723   /* Now onto stupid register sets in non contiguous locations.  */
8724 
8725   gcc_assert (GET_CODE (regs) == PARALLEL);
8726 
8727   size = GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (XVECEXP (regs, 0, 0)));
8728   loc_result = NULL;
8729 
8730   for (i = 0; i < XVECLEN (regs, 0); ++i)
8731     {
8732       dw_loc_descr_ref t;
8733 
8734       t = one_reg_loc_descriptor (REGNO (XVECEXP (regs, 0, i)));
8735       add_loc_descr (&loc_result, t);
8736       size = GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (XVECEXP (regs, 0, 0)));
8737       add_loc_descr_op_piece (&loc_result, size);
8738     }
8739   return loc_result;
8740 }
8741 
8742 /* Return a location descriptor that designates a constant.  */
8743 
8744 static dw_loc_descr_ref
int_loc_descriptor(HOST_WIDE_INT i)8745 int_loc_descriptor (HOST_WIDE_INT i)
8746 {
8747   enum dwarf_location_atom op;
8748 
8749   /* Pick the smallest representation of a constant, rather than just
8750      defaulting to the LEB encoding.  */
8751   if (i >= 0)
8752     {
8753       if (i <= 31)
8754 	op = DW_OP_lit0 + i;
8755       else if (i <= 0xff)
8756 	op = DW_OP_const1u;
8757       else if (i <= 0xffff)
8758 	op = DW_OP_const2u;
8759       else if (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT == 32
8760 	       || i <= 0xffffffff)
8761 	op = DW_OP_const4u;
8762       else
8763 	op = DW_OP_constu;
8764     }
8765   else
8766     {
8767       if (i >= -0x80)
8768 	op = DW_OP_const1s;
8769       else if (i >= -0x8000)
8770 	op = DW_OP_const2s;
8771       else if (HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT == 32
8772 	       || i >= -0x80000000)
8773 	op = DW_OP_const4s;
8774       else
8775 	op = DW_OP_consts;
8776     }
8777 
8778   return new_loc_descr (op, i, 0);
8779 }
8780 
8781 /* Return a location descriptor that designates a base+offset location.  */
8782 
8783 static dw_loc_descr_ref
based_loc_descr(rtx reg,HOST_WIDE_INT offset)8784 based_loc_descr (rtx reg, HOST_WIDE_INT offset)
8785 {
8786   unsigned int regno;
8787 
8788   /* We only use "frame base" when we're sure we're talking about the
8789      post-prologue local stack frame.  We do this by *not* running
8790      register elimination until this point, and recognizing the special
8791      argument pointer and soft frame pointer rtx's.  */
8792   if (reg == arg_pointer_rtx || reg == frame_pointer_rtx)
8793     {
8794       rtx elim = eliminate_regs (reg, VOIDmode, NULL_RTX);
8795 
8796       if (elim != reg)
8797 	{
8798 	  if (GET_CODE (elim) == PLUS)
8799 	    {
8800 	      offset += INTVAL (XEXP (elim, 1));
8801 	      elim = XEXP (elim, 0);
8802 	    }
8803 	  gcc_assert (elim == (frame_pointer_needed ? hard_frame_pointer_rtx
8804 		      : stack_pointer_rtx));
8805           offset += frame_pointer_fb_offset;
8806 
8807           return new_loc_descr (DW_OP_fbreg, offset, 0);
8808 	}
8809     }
8810 
8811   regno = dbx_reg_number (reg);
8812   if (regno <= 31)
8813     return new_loc_descr (DW_OP_breg0 + regno, offset, 0);
8814   else
8815     return new_loc_descr (DW_OP_bregx, regno, offset);
8816 }
8817 
8818 /* Return true if this RTL expression describes a base+offset calculation.  */
8819 
8820 static inline int
is_based_loc(rtx rtl)8821 is_based_loc (rtx rtl)
8822 {
8823   return (GET_CODE (rtl) == PLUS
8824 	  && ((REG_P (XEXP (rtl, 0))
8825 	       && REGNO (XEXP (rtl, 0)) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
8826 	       && GET_CODE (XEXP (rtl, 1)) == CONST_INT)));
8827 }
8828 
8829 /* The following routine converts the RTL for a variable or parameter
8830    (resident in memory) into an equivalent Dwarf representation of a
8831    mechanism for getting the address of that same variable onto the top of a
8832    hypothetical "address evaluation" stack.
8833 
8834    When creating memory location descriptors, we are effectively transforming
8835    the RTL for a memory-resident object into its Dwarf postfix expression
8836    equivalent.  This routine recursively descends an RTL tree, turning
8837    it into Dwarf postfix code as it goes.
8838 
8839    MODE is the mode of the memory reference, needed to handle some
8840    autoincrement addressing modes.
8841 
8842    CAN_USE_FBREG is a flag whether we can use DW_AT_frame_base in the
8843    location list for RTL.
8844 
8845    Return 0 if we can't represent the location.  */
8846 
8847 static dw_loc_descr_ref
mem_loc_descriptor(rtx rtl,enum machine_mode mode)8848 mem_loc_descriptor (rtx rtl, enum machine_mode mode)
8849 {
8850   dw_loc_descr_ref mem_loc_result = NULL;
8851   enum dwarf_location_atom op;
8852 
8853   /* Note that for a dynamically sized array, the location we will generate a
8854      description of here will be the lowest numbered location which is
8855      actually within the array.  That's *not* necessarily the same as the
8856      zeroth element of the array.  */
8857 
8858   rtl = targetm.delegitimize_address (rtl);
8859 
8860   switch (GET_CODE (rtl))
8861     {
8862     case POST_INC:
8863     case POST_DEC:
8864     case POST_MODIFY:
8865       /* POST_INC and POST_DEC can be handled just like a SUBREG.  So we
8866 	 just fall into the SUBREG code.  */
8867 
8868       /* ... fall through ...  */
8869 
8870     case SUBREG:
8871       /* The case of a subreg may arise when we have a local (register)
8872 	 variable or a formal (register) parameter which doesn't quite fill
8873 	 up an entire register.  For now, just assume that it is
8874 	 legitimate to make the Dwarf info refer to the whole register which
8875 	 contains the given subreg.  */
8876       rtl = XEXP (rtl, 0);
8877 
8878       /* ... fall through ...  */
8879 
8880     case REG:
8881       /* Whenever a register number forms a part of the description of the
8882 	 method for calculating the (dynamic) address of a memory resident
8883 	 object, DWARF rules require the register number be referred to as
8884 	 a "base register".  This distinction is not based in any way upon
8885 	 what category of register the hardware believes the given register
8886 	 belongs to.  This is strictly DWARF terminology we're dealing with
8887 	 here. Note that in cases where the location of a memory-resident
8888 	 data object could be expressed as: OP_ADD (OP_BASEREG (basereg),
8889 	 OP_CONST (0)) the actual DWARF location descriptor that we generate
8890 	 may just be OP_BASEREG (basereg).  This may look deceptively like
8891 	 the object in question was allocated to a register (rather than in
8892 	 memory) so DWARF consumers need to be aware of the subtle
8893 	 distinction between OP_REG and OP_BASEREG.  */
8894       if (REGNO (rtl) < FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER)
8895 	mem_loc_result = based_loc_descr (rtl, 0);
8896       break;
8897 
8898     case MEM:
8899       mem_loc_result = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), GET_MODE (rtl));
8900       if (mem_loc_result != 0)
8901 	add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_deref, 0, 0));
8902       break;
8903 
8904     case LO_SUM:
8905 	 rtl = XEXP (rtl, 1);
8906 
8907       /* ... fall through ...  */
8908 
8909     case LABEL_REF:
8910       /* Some ports can transform a symbol ref into a label ref, because
8911 	 the symbol ref is too far away and has to be dumped into a constant
8912 	 pool.  */
8913     case CONST:
8914     case SYMBOL_REF:
8915       /* Alternatively, the symbol in the constant pool might be referenced
8916 	 by a different symbol.  */
8917       if (GET_CODE (rtl) == SYMBOL_REF && CONSTANT_POOL_ADDRESS_P (rtl))
8918 	{
8919 	  bool marked;
8920 	  rtx tmp = get_pool_constant_mark (rtl, &marked);
8921 
8922 	  if (GET_CODE (tmp) == SYMBOL_REF)
8923 	    {
8924 	      rtl = tmp;
8925 	      if (CONSTANT_POOL_ADDRESS_P (tmp))
8926 		get_pool_constant_mark (tmp, &marked);
8927 	      else
8928 		marked = true;
8929 	    }
8930 
8931 	  /* If all references to this pool constant were optimized away,
8932 	     it was not output and thus we can't represent it.
8933 	     FIXME: might try to use DW_OP_const_value here, though
8934 	     DW_OP_piece complicates it.  */
8935 	  if (!marked)
8936 	    return 0;
8937 	}
8938 
8939       mem_loc_result = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_addr, 0, 0);
8940       mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_addr;
8941       mem_loc_result->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_addr = rtl;
8942       VEC_safe_push (rtx, gc, used_rtx_array, rtl);
8943       break;
8944 
8945     case PRE_MODIFY:
8946       /* Extract the PLUS expression nested inside and fall into
8947 	 PLUS code below.  */
8948       rtl = XEXP (rtl, 1);
8949       goto plus;
8950 
8951     case PRE_INC:
8952     case PRE_DEC:
8953       /* Turn these into a PLUS expression and fall into the PLUS code
8954 	 below.  */
8955       rtl = gen_rtx_PLUS (word_mode, XEXP (rtl, 0),
8956 			  GEN_INT (GET_CODE (rtl) == PRE_INC
8957 				   ? GET_MODE_UNIT_SIZE (mode)
8958 				   : -GET_MODE_UNIT_SIZE (mode)));
8959 
8960       /* ... fall through ...  */
8961 
8962     case PLUS:
8963     plus:
8964       if (is_based_loc (rtl))
8965 	mem_loc_result = based_loc_descr (XEXP (rtl, 0),
8966 					  INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 1)));
8967       else
8968 	{
8969 	  mem_loc_result = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), mode);
8970 	  if (mem_loc_result == 0)
8971 	    break;
8972 
8973 	  if (GET_CODE (XEXP (rtl, 1)) == CONST_INT
8974 	      && INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 1)) >= 0)
8975 	    add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result,
8976 			   new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus_uconst,
8977 					  INTVAL (XEXP (rtl, 1)), 0));
8978 	  else
8979 	    {
8980 	      add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result,
8981 			     mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 1), mode));
8982 	      add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result,
8983 			     new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus, 0, 0));
8984 	    }
8985 	}
8986       break;
8987 
8988     /* If a pseudo-reg is optimized away, it is possible for it to
8989        be replaced with a MEM containing a multiply or shift.  */
8990     case MULT:
8991       op = DW_OP_mul;
8992       goto do_binop;
8993 
8994     case ASHIFT:
8995       op = DW_OP_shl;
8996       goto do_binop;
8997 
8998     case ASHIFTRT:
8999       op = DW_OP_shra;
9000       goto do_binop;
9001 
9002     case LSHIFTRT:
9003       op = DW_OP_shr;
9004       goto do_binop;
9005 
9006     do_binop:
9007       {
9008 	dw_loc_descr_ref op0 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), mode);
9009 	dw_loc_descr_ref op1 = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 1), mode);
9010 
9011 	if (op0 == 0 || op1 == 0)
9012 	  break;
9013 
9014 	mem_loc_result = op0;
9015 	add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, op1);
9016 	add_loc_descr (&mem_loc_result, new_loc_descr (op, 0, 0));
9017 	break;
9018       }
9019 
9020     case CONST_INT:
9021       mem_loc_result = int_loc_descriptor (INTVAL (rtl));
9022       break;
9023 
9024     default:
9025       gcc_unreachable ();
9026     }
9027 
9028   return mem_loc_result;
9029 }
9030 
9031 /* Return a descriptor that describes the concatenation of two locations.
9032    This is typically a complex variable.  */
9033 
9034 static dw_loc_descr_ref
concat_loc_descriptor(rtx x0,rtx x1)9035 concat_loc_descriptor (rtx x0, rtx x1)
9036 {
9037   dw_loc_descr_ref cc_loc_result = NULL;
9038   dw_loc_descr_ref x0_ref = loc_descriptor (x0);
9039   dw_loc_descr_ref x1_ref = loc_descriptor (x1);
9040 
9041   if (x0_ref == 0 || x1_ref == 0)
9042     return 0;
9043 
9044   cc_loc_result = x0_ref;
9045   add_loc_descr_op_piece (&cc_loc_result, GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (x0)));
9046 
9047   add_loc_descr (&cc_loc_result, x1_ref);
9048   add_loc_descr_op_piece (&cc_loc_result, GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (x1)));
9049 
9050   return cc_loc_result;
9051 }
9052 
9053 /* Output a proper Dwarf location descriptor for a variable or parameter
9054    which is either allocated in a register or in a memory location.  For a
9055    register, we just generate an OP_REG and the register number.  For a
9056    memory location we provide a Dwarf postfix expression describing how to
9057    generate the (dynamic) address of the object onto the address stack.
9058 
9059    If we don't know how to describe it, return 0.  */
9060 
9061 static dw_loc_descr_ref
loc_descriptor(rtx rtl)9062 loc_descriptor (rtx rtl)
9063 {
9064   dw_loc_descr_ref loc_result = NULL;
9065 
9066   switch (GET_CODE (rtl))
9067     {
9068     case SUBREG:
9069       /* The case of a subreg may arise when we have a local (register)
9070 	 variable or a formal (register) parameter which doesn't quite fill
9071 	 up an entire register.  For now, just assume that it is
9072 	 legitimate to make the Dwarf info refer to the whole register which
9073 	 contains the given subreg.  */
9074       rtl = SUBREG_REG (rtl);
9075 
9076       /* ... fall through ...  */
9077 
9078     case REG:
9079       loc_result = reg_loc_descriptor (rtl);
9080       break;
9081 
9082     case MEM:
9083       loc_result = mem_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), GET_MODE (rtl));
9084       break;
9085 
9086     case CONCAT:
9087       loc_result = concat_loc_descriptor (XEXP (rtl, 0), XEXP (rtl, 1));
9088       break;
9089 
9090     case VAR_LOCATION:
9091       /* Single part.  */
9092       if (GET_CODE (XEXP (rtl, 1)) != PARALLEL)
9093 	{
9094 	  loc_result = loc_descriptor (XEXP (XEXP (rtl, 1), 0));
9095 	  break;
9096 	}
9097 
9098       rtl = XEXP (rtl, 1);
9099       /* FALLTHRU */
9100 
9101     case PARALLEL:
9102       {
9103 	rtvec par_elems = XVEC (rtl, 0);
9104 	int num_elem = GET_NUM_ELEM (par_elems);
9105 	enum machine_mode mode;
9106 	int i;
9107 
9108 	/* Create the first one, so we have something to add to.  */
9109 	loc_result = loc_descriptor (XEXP (RTVEC_ELT (par_elems, 0), 0));
9110 	mode = GET_MODE (XEXP (RTVEC_ELT (par_elems, 0), 0));
9111 	add_loc_descr_op_piece (&loc_result, GET_MODE_SIZE (mode));
9112 	for (i = 1; i < num_elem; i++)
9113 	  {
9114 	    dw_loc_descr_ref temp;
9115 
9116 	    temp = loc_descriptor (XEXP (RTVEC_ELT (par_elems, i), 0));
9117 	    add_loc_descr (&loc_result, temp);
9118 	    mode = GET_MODE (XEXP (RTVEC_ELT (par_elems, i), 0));
9119 	    add_loc_descr_op_piece (&loc_result, GET_MODE_SIZE (mode));
9120 	  }
9121       }
9122       break;
9123 
9124     default:
9125       gcc_unreachable ();
9126     }
9127 
9128   return loc_result;
9129 }
9130 
9131 /* Similar, but generate the descriptor from trees instead of rtl.  This comes
9132    up particularly with variable length arrays.  WANT_ADDRESS is 2 if this is
9133    a top-level invocation of loc_descriptor_from_tree; is 1 if this is not a
9134    top-level invocation, and we require the address of LOC; is 0 if we require
9135    the value of LOC.  */
9136 
9137 static dw_loc_descr_ref
loc_descriptor_from_tree_1(tree loc,int want_address)9138 loc_descriptor_from_tree_1 (tree loc, int want_address)
9139 {
9140   dw_loc_descr_ref ret, ret1;
9141   int have_address = 0;
9142   enum dwarf_location_atom op;
9143 
9144   /* ??? Most of the time we do not take proper care for sign/zero
9145      extending the values properly.  Hopefully this won't be a real
9146      problem...  */
9147 
9148   switch (TREE_CODE (loc))
9149     {
9150     case ERROR_MARK:
9151       return 0;
9152 
9153     case PLACEHOLDER_EXPR:
9154       /* This case involves extracting fields from an object to determine the
9155 	 position of other fields.  We don't try to encode this here.  The
9156 	 only user of this is Ada, which encodes the needed information using
9157 	 the names of types.  */
9158       return 0;
9159 
9160     case CALL_EXPR:
9161       return 0;
9162 
9163     case PREINCREMENT_EXPR:
9164     case PREDECREMENT_EXPR:
9165     case POSTINCREMENT_EXPR:
9166     case POSTDECREMENT_EXPR:
9167       /* There are no opcodes for these operations.  */
9168       return 0;
9169 
9170     case ADDR_EXPR:
9171       /* If we already want an address, there's nothing we can do.  */
9172       if (want_address)
9173 	return 0;
9174 
9175       /* Otherwise, process the argument and look for the address.  */
9176       return loc_descriptor_from_tree_1 (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0), 1);
9177 
9178     case VAR_DECL:
9179       if (DECL_THREAD_LOCAL_P (loc))
9180 	{
9181 	  rtx rtl;
9182 
9183 	  /* If this is not defined, we have no way to emit the data.  */
9184 	  if (!targetm.asm_out.output_dwarf_dtprel)
9185 	    return 0;
9186 
9187 	  /* The way DW_OP_GNU_push_tls_address is specified, we can only
9188 	     look up addresses of objects in the current module.  */
9189 	  if (DECL_EXTERNAL (loc))
9190 	    return 0;
9191 
9192 	  rtl = rtl_for_decl_location (loc);
9193 	  if (rtl == NULL_RTX)
9194 	    return 0;
9195 
9196 	  if (!MEM_P (rtl))
9197 	    return 0;
9198 	  rtl = XEXP (rtl, 0);
9199 	  if (! CONSTANT_P (rtl))
9200 	    return 0;
9201 
9202 	  ret = new_loc_descr (INTERNAL_DW_OP_tls_addr, 0, 0);
9203 	  ret->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_addr;
9204 	  ret->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_addr = rtl;
9205 
9206 	  ret1 = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_GNU_push_tls_address, 0, 0);
9207 	  add_loc_descr (&ret, ret1);
9208 
9209 	  have_address = 1;
9210 	  break;
9211 	}
9212       /* FALLTHRU */
9213 
9214     case PARM_DECL:
9215       if (DECL_HAS_VALUE_EXPR_P (loc))
9216 	return loc_descriptor_from_tree_1 (DECL_VALUE_EXPR (loc),
9217 					   want_address);
9218       /* FALLTHRU */
9219 
9220     case RESULT_DECL:
9221     case FUNCTION_DECL:
9222       {
9223 	rtx rtl = rtl_for_decl_location (loc);
9224 
9225 	if (rtl == NULL_RTX)
9226 	  return 0;
9227         else if (GET_CODE (rtl) == CONST_INT)
9228 	  {
9229 	    HOST_WIDE_INT val = INTVAL (rtl);
9230 	    if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (loc)))
9231 	      val &= GET_MODE_MASK (DECL_MODE (loc));
9232 	    ret = int_loc_descriptor (val);
9233 	  }
9234 	else if (GET_CODE (rtl) == CONST_STRING)
9235 	  return 0;
9236 	else if (CONSTANT_P (rtl))
9237 	  {
9238 	    ret = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_addr, 0, 0);
9239 	    ret->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_addr;
9240 	    ret->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_addr = rtl;
9241 	  }
9242 	else
9243 	  {
9244 	    enum machine_mode mode;
9245 
9246 	    /* Certain constructs can only be represented at top-level.  */
9247 	    if (want_address == 2)
9248 	      return loc_descriptor (rtl);
9249 
9250 	    mode = GET_MODE (rtl);
9251 	    if (MEM_P (rtl))
9252 	      {
9253 		rtl = XEXP (rtl, 0);
9254 		have_address = 1;
9255 	      }
9256 	    ret = mem_loc_descriptor (rtl, mode);
9257 	  }
9258       }
9259       break;
9260 
9261     case INDIRECT_REF:
9262       ret = loc_descriptor_from_tree_1 (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0), 0);
9263       have_address = 1;
9264       break;
9265 
9266     case COMPOUND_EXPR:
9267       return loc_descriptor_from_tree_1 (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 1), want_address);
9268 
9269     case NOP_EXPR:
9270     case CONVERT_EXPR:
9271     case NON_LVALUE_EXPR:
9272     case VIEW_CONVERT_EXPR:
9273     case SAVE_EXPR:
9274     case MODIFY_EXPR:
9275       return loc_descriptor_from_tree_1 (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0), want_address);
9276 
9277     case COMPONENT_REF:
9278     case BIT_FIELD_REF:
9279     case ARRAY_REF:
9280     case ARRAY_RANGE_REF:
9281       {
9282 	tree obj, offset;
9283 	HOST_WIDE_INT bitsize, bitpos, bytepos;
9284 	enum machine_mode mode;
9285 	int volatilep;
9286 	int unsignedp = TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (loc));
9287 
9288 	obj = get_inner_reference (loc, &bitsize, &bitpos, &offset, &mode,
9289 				   &unsignedp, &volatilep, false);
9290 
9291 	if (obj == loc)
9292 	  return 0;
9293 
9294 	ret = loc_descriptor_from_tree_1 (obj, 1);
9295 	if (ret == 0
9296 	    || bitpos % BITS_PER_UNIT != 0 || bitsize % BITS_PER_UNIT != 0)
9297 	  return 0;
9298 
9299 	if (offset != NULL_TREE)
9300 	  {
9301 	    /* Variable offset.  */
9302 	    add_loc_descr (&ret, loc_descriptor_from_tree_1 (offset, 0));
9303 	    add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus, 0, 0));
9304 	  }
9305 
9306 	bytepos = bitpos / BITS_PER_UNIT;
9307 	if (bytepos > 0)
9308 	  add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus_uconst, bytepos, 0));
9309 	else if (bytepos < 0)
9310 	  {
9311 	    add_loc_descr (&ret, int_loc_descriptor (bytepos));
9312 	    add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus, 0, 0));
9313 	  }
9314 
9315 	have_address = 1;
9316 	break;
9317       }
9318 
9319     case INTEGER_CST:
9320       if (host_integerp (loc, 0))
9321 	ret = int_loc_descriptor (tree_low_cst (loc, 0));
9322       else
9323 	return 0;
9324       break;
9325 
9326     case CONSTRUCTOR:
9327       {
9328 	/* Get an RTL for this, if something has been emitted.  */
9329 	rtx rtl = lookup_constant_def (loc);
9330 	enum machine_mode mode;
9331 
9332 	if (!rtl || !MEM_P (rtl))
9333 	  return 0;
9334 	mode = GET_MODE (rtl);
9335 	rtl = XEXP (rtl, 0);
9336 	ret = mem_loc_descriptor (rtl, mode);
9337 	have_address = 1;
9338 	break;
9339       }
9340 
9341     case TRUTH_AND_EXPR:
9342     case TRUTH_ANDIF_EXPR:
9343     case BIT_AND_EXPR:
9344       op = DW_OP_and;
9345       goto do_binop;
9346 
9347     case TRUTH_XOR_EXPR:
9348     case BIT_XOR_EXPR:
9349       op = DW_OP_xor;
9350       goto do_binop;
9351 
9352     case TRUTH_OR_EXPR:
9353     case TRUTH_ORIF_EXPR:
9354     case BIT_IOR_EXPR:
9355       op = DW_OP_or;
9356       goto do_binop;
9357 
9358     case FLOOR_DIV_EXPR:
9359     case CEIL_DIV_EXPR:
9360     case ROUND_DIV_EXPR:
9361     case TRUNC_DIV_EXPR:
9362       op = DW_OP_div;
9363       goto do_binop;
9364 
9365     case MINUS_EXPR:
9366       op = DW_OP_minus;
9367       goto do_binop;
9368 
9369     case FLOOR_MOD_EXPR:
9370     case CEIL_MOD_EXPR:
9371     case ROUND_MOD_EXPR:
9372     case TRUNC_MOD_EXPR:
9373       op = DW_OP_mod;
9374       goto do_binop;
9375 
9376     case MULT_EXPR:
9377       op = DW_OP_mul;
9378       goto do_binop;
9379 
9380     case LSHIFT_EXPR:
9381       op = DW_OP_shl;
9382       goto do_binop;
9383 
9384     case RSHIFT_EXPR:
9385       op = (TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (loc)) ? DW_OP_shr : DW_OP_shra);
9386       goto do_binop;
9387 
9388     case PLUS_EXPR:
9389       if (TREE_CODE (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 1)) == INTEGER_CST
9390 	  && host_integerp (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 1), 0))
9391 	{
9392 	  ret = loc_descriptor_from_tree_1 (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0), 0);
9393 	  if (ret == 0)
9394 	    return 0;
9395 
9396 	  add_loc_descr (&ret,
9397 			 new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus_uconst,
9398 					tree_low_cst (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 1),
9399 						      0),
9400 					0));
9401 	  break;
9402 	}
9403 
9404       op = DW_OP_plus;
9405       goto do_binop;
9406 
9407     case LE_EXPR:
9408       if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0))))
9409 	return 0;
9410 
9411       op = DW_OP_le;
9412       goto do_binop;
9413 
9414     case GE_EXPR:
9415       if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0))))
9416 	return 0;
9417 
9418       op = DW_OP_ge;
9419       goto do_binop;
9420 
9421     case LT_EXPR:
9422       if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0))))
9423 	return 0;
9424 
9425       op = DW_OP_lt;
9426       goto do_binop;
9427 
9428     case GT_EXPR:
9429       if (TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0))))
9430 	return 0;
9431 
9432       op = DW_OP_gt;
9433       goto do_binop;
9434 
9435     case EQ_EXPR:
9436       op = DW_OP_eq;
9437       goto do_binop;
9438 
9439     case NE_EXPR:
9440       op = DW_OP_ne;
9441       goto do_binop;
9442 
9443     do_binop:
9444       ret = loc_descriptor_from_tree_1 (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0), 0);
9445       ret1 = loc_descriptor_from_tree_1 (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 1), 0);
9446       if (ret == 0 || ret1 == 0)
9447 	return 0;
9448 
9449       add_loc_descr (&ret, ret1);
9450       add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (op, 0, 0));
9451       break;
9452 
9453     case TRUTH_NOT_EXPR:
9454     case BIT_NOT_EXPR:
9455       op = DW_OP_not;
9456       goto do_unop;
9457 
9458     case ABS_EXPR:
9459       op = DW_OP_abs;
9460       goto do_unop;
9461 
9462     case NEGATE_EXPR:
9463       op = DW_OP_neg;
9464       goto do_unop;
9465 
9466     do_unop:
9467       ret = loc_descriptor_from_tree_1 (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0), 0);
9468       if (ret == 0)
9469 	return 0;
9470 
9471       add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (op, 0, 0));
9472       break;
9473 
9474     case MIN_EXPR:
9475     case MAX_EXPR:
9476       {
9477         const enum tree_code code =
9478           TREE_CODE (loc) == MIN_EXPR ? GT_EXPR : LT_EXPR;
9479 
9480         loc = build3 (COND_EXPR, TREE_TYPE (loc),
9481 		      build2 (code, integer_type_node,
9482 			      TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0), TREE_OPERAND (loc, 1)),
9483                       TREE_OPERAND (loc, 1), TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0));
9484       }
9485 
9486       /* ... fall through ...  */
9487 
9488     case COND_EXPR:
9489       {
9490 	dw_loc_descr_ref lhs
9491 	  = loc_descriptor_from_tree_1 (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 1), 0);
9492 	dw_loc_descr_ref rhs
9493 	  = loc_descriptor_from_tree_1 (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 2), 0);
9494 	dw_loc_descr_ref bra_node, jump_node, tmp;
9495 
9496 	ret = loc_descriptor_from_tree_1 (TREE_OPERAND (loc, 0), 0);
9497 	if (ret == 0 || lhs == 0 || rhs == 0)
9498 	  return 0;
9499 
9500 	bra_node = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_bra, 0, 0);
9501 	add_loc_descr (&ret, bra_node);
9502 
9503 	add_loc_descr (&ret, rhs);
9504 	jump_node = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_skip, 0, 0);
9505 	add_loc_descr (&ret, jump_node);
9506 
9507 	add_loc_descr (&ret, lhs);
9508 	bra_node->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_loc;
9509 	bra_node->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_loc = lhs;
9510 
9511 	/* ??? Need a node to point the skip at.  Use a nop.  */
9512 	tmp = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_nop, 0, 0);
9513 	add_loc_descr (&ret, tmp);
9514 	jump_node->dw_loc_oprnd1.val_class = dw_val_class_loc;
9515 	jump_node->dw_loc_oprnd1.v.val_loc = tmp;
9516       }
9517       break;
9518 
9519     case FIX_TRUNC_EXPR:
9520     case FIX_CEIL_EXPR:
9521     case FIX_FLOOR_EXPR:
9522     case FIX_ROUND_EXPR:
9523       return 0;
9524 
9525     default:
9526       /* Leave front-end specific codes as simply unknown.  This comes
9527 	 up, for instance, with the C STMT_EXPR.  */
9528       if ((unsigned int) TREE_CODE (loc)
9529           >= (unsigned int) LAST_AND_UNUSED_TREE_CODE)
9530 	return 0;
9531 
9532 #ifdef ENABLE_CHECKING
9533       /* Otherwise this is a generic code; we should just lists all of
9534 	 these explicitly.  We forgot one.  */
9535       gcc_unreachable ();
9536 #else
9537       /* In a release build, we want to degrade gracefully: better to
9538 	 generate incomplete debugging information than to crash.  */
9539       return NULL;
9540 #endif
9541     }
9542 
9543   /* Show if we can't fill the request for an address.  */
9544   if (want_address && !have_address)
9545     return 0;
9546 
9547   /* If we've got an address and don't want one, dereference.  */
9548   if (!want_address && have_address && ret)
9549     {
9550       HOST_WIDE_INT size = int_size_in_bytes (TREE_TYPE (loc));
9551 
9552       if (size > DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE || size == -1)
9553 	return 0;
9554       else if (size == DWARF2_ADDR_SIZE)
9555 	op = DW_OP_deref;
9556       else
9557 	op = DW_OP_deref_size;
9558 
9559       add_loc_descr (&ret, new_loc_descr (op, size, 0));
9560     }
9561 
9562   return ret;
9563 }
9564 
9565 static inline dw_loc_descr_ref
loc_descriptor_from_tree(tree loc)9566 loc_descriptor_from_tree (tree loc)
9567 {
9568   return loc_descriptor_from_tree_1 (loc, 2);
9569 }
9570 
9571 /* Given a value, round it up to the lowest multiple of `boundary'
9572    which is not less than the value itself.  */
9573 
9574 static inline HOST_WIDE_INT
ceiling(HOST_WIDE_INT value,unsigned int boundary)9575 ceiling (HOST_WIDE_INT value, unsigned int boundary)
9576 {
9577   return (((value + boundary - 1) / boundary) * boundary);
9578 }
9579 
9580 /* Given a pointer to what is assumed to be a FIELD_DECL node, return a
9581    pointer to the declared type for the relevant field variable, or return
9582    `integer_type_node' if the given node turns out to be an
9583    ERROR_MARK node.  */
9584 
9585 static inline tree
field_type(tree decl)9586 field_type (tree decl)
9587 {
9588   tree type;
9589 
9590   if (TREE_CODE (decl) == ERROR_MARK)
9591     return integer_type_node;
9592 
9593   type = DECL_BIT_FIELD_TYPE (decl);
9594   if (type == NULL_TREE)
9595     type = TREE_TYPE (decl);
9596 
9597   return type;
9598 }
9599 
9600 /* Given a pointer to a tree node, return the alignment in bits for
9601    it, or else return BITS_PER_WORD if the node actually turns out to
9602    be an ERROR_MARK node.  */
9603 
9604 static inline unsigned
simple_type_align_in_bits(tree type)9605 simple_type_align_in_bits (tree type)
9606 {
9607   return (TREE_CODE (type) != ERROR_MARK) ? TYPE_ALIGN (type) : BITS_PER_WORD;
9608 }
9609 
9610 static inline unsigned
simple_decl_align_in_bits(tree decl)9611 simple_decl_align_in_bits (tree decl)
9612 {
9613   return (TREE_CODE (decl) != ERROR_MARK) ? DECL_ALIGN (decl) : BITS_PER_WORD;
9614 }
9615 
9616 /* Given a pointer to a FIELD_DECL, compute and return the byte offset of the
9617    lowest addressed byte of the "containing object" for the given FIELD_DECL,
9618    or return 0 if we are unable to determine what that offset is, either
9619    because the argument turns out to be a pointer to an ERROR_MARK node, or
9620    because the offset is actually variable.  (We can't handle the latter case
9621    just yet).  */
9622 
9623 static HOST_WIDE_INT
field_byte_offset(tree decl)9624 field_byte_offset (tree decl)
9625 {
9626   unsigned int type_align_in_bits;
9627   unsigned int decl_align_in_bits;
9628   unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT type_size_in_bits;
9629   HOST_WIDE_INT object_offset_in_bits;
9630   tree type;
9631   tree field_size_tree;
9632   HOST_WIDE_INT bitpos_int;
9633   HOST_WIDE_INT deepest_bitpos;
9634   unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT field_size_in_bits;
9635 
9636   if (TREE_CODE (decl) == ERROR_MARK)
9637     return 0;
9638 
9639   gcc_assert (TREE_CODE (decl) == FIELD_DECL);
9640 
9641   type = field_type (decl);
9642   field_size_tree = DECL_SIZE (decl);
9643 
9644   /* The size could be unspecified if there was an error, or for
9645      a flexible array member.  */
9646   if (! field_size_tree)
9647     field_size_tree = bitsize_zero_node;
9648 
9649   /* We cannot yet cope with fields whose positions are variable, so
9650      for now, when we see such things, we simply return 0.  Someday, we may
9651      be able to handle such cases, but it will be damn difficult.  */
9652   if (! host_integerp (bit_position (decl), 0))
9653     return 0;
9654 
9655   bitpos_int = int_bit_position (decl);
9656 
9657   /* If we don't know the size of the field, pretend it's a full word.  */
9658   if (host_integerp (field_size_tree, 1))
9659     field_size_in_bits = tree_low_cst (field_size_tree, 1);
9660   else
9661     field_size_in_bits = BITS_PER_WORD;
9662 
9663   type_size_in_bits = simple_type_size_in_bits (type);
9664   type_align_in_bits = simple_type_align_in_bits (type);
9665   decl_align_in_bits = simple_decl_align_in_bits (decl);
9666 
9667   /* The GCC front-end doesn't make any attempt to keep track of the starting
9668      bit offset (relative to the start of the containing structure type) of the
9669      hypothetical "containing object" for a bit-field.  Thus, when computing
9670      the byte offset value for the start of the "containing object" of a
9671      bit-field, we must deduce this information on our own. This can be rather
9672      tricky to do in some cases.  For example, handling the following structure
9673      type definition when compiling for an i386/i486 target (which only aligns
9674      long long's to 32-bit boundaries) can be very tricky:
9675 
9676 	 struct S { int field1; long long field2:31; };
9677 
9678      Fortunately, there is a simple rule-of-thumb which can be used in such
9679      cases.  When compiling for an i386/i486, GCC will allocate 8 bytes for the
9680      structure shown above.  It decides to do this based upon one simple rule
9681      for bit-field allocation.  GCC allocates each "containing object" for each
9682      bit-field at the first (i.e. lowest addressed) legitimate alignment
9683      boundary (based upon the required minimum alignment for the declared type
9684      of the field) which it can possibly use, subject to the condition that
9685      there is still enough available space remaining in the containing object
9686      (when allocated at the selected point) to fully accommodate all of the
9687      bits of the bit-field itself.
9688 
9689      This simple rule makes it obvious why GCC allocates 8 bytes for each
9690      object of the structure type shown above.  When looking for a place to
9691      allocate the "containing object" for `field2', the compiler simply tries
9692      to allocate a 64-bit "containing object" at each successive 32-bit
9693      boundary (starting at zero) until it finds a place to allocate that 64-
9694      bit field such that at least 31 contiguous (and previously unallocated)
9695      bits remain within that selected 64 bit field.  (As it turns out, for the
9696      example above, the compiler finds it is OK to allocate the "containing
9697      object" 64-bit field at bit-offset zero within the structure type.)
9698 
9699      Here we attempt to work backwards from the limited set of facts we're
9700      given, and we try to deduce from those facts, where GCC must have believed
9701      that the containing object started (within the structure type). The value
9702      we deduce is then used (by the callers of this routine) to generate
9703      DW_AT_location and DW_AT_bit_offset attributes for fields (both bit-fields
9704      and, in the case of DW_AT_location, regular fields as well).  */
9705 
9706   /* Figure out the bit-distance from the start of the structure to the
9707      "deepest" bit of the bit-field.  */
9708   deepest_bitpos = bitpos_int + field_size_in_bits;
9709 
9710   /* This is the tricky part.  Use some fancy footwork to deduce where the
9711      lowest addressed bit of the containing object must be.  */
9712   object_offset_in_bits = deepest_bitpos - type_size_in_bits;
9713 
9714   /* Round up to type_align by default.  This works best for bitfields.  */
9715   object_offset_in_bits += type_align_in_bits - 1;
9716   object_offset_in_bits /= type_align_in_bits;
9717   object_offset_in_bits *= type_align_in_bits;
9718 
9719   if (object_offset_in_bits > bitpos_int)
9720     {
9721       /* Sigh, the decl must be packed.  */
9722       object_offset_in_bits = deepest_bitpos - type_size_in_bits;
9723 
9724       /* Round up to decl_align instead.  */
9725       object_offset_in_bits += decl_align_in_bits - 1;
9726       object_offset_in_bits /= decl_align_in_bits;
9727       object_offset_in_bits *= decl_align_in_bits;
9728     }
9729 
9730   return object_offset_in_bits / BITS_PER_UNIT;
9731 }
9732 
9733 /* The following routines define various Dwarf attributes and any data
9734    associated with them.  */
9735 
9736 /* Add a location description attribute value to a DIE.
9737 
9738    This emits location attributes suitable for whole variables and
9739    whole parameters.  Note that the location attributes for struct fields are
9740    generated by the routine `data_member_location_attribute' below.  */
9741 
9742 static inline void
add_AT_location_description(dw_die_ref die,enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,dw_loc_descr_ref descr)9743 add_AT_location_description (dw_die_ref die, enum dwarf_attribute attr_kind,
9744 			     dw_loc_descr_ref descr)
9745 {
9746   if (descr != 0)
9747     add_AT_loc (die, attr_kind, descr);
9748 }
9749 
9750 /* Attach the specialized form of location attribute used for data members of
9751    struct and union types.  In the special case of a FIELD_DECL node which
9752    represents a bit-field, the "offset" part of this special location
9753    descriptor must indicate the distance in bytes from the lowest-addressed
9754    byte of the containing struct or union type to the lowest-addressed byte of
9755    the "containing object" for the bit-field.  (See the `field_byte_offset'
9756    function above).
9757 
9758    For any given bit-field, the "containing object" is a hypothetical object
9759    (of some integral or enum type) within which the given bit-field lives.  The
9760    type of this hypothetical "containing object" is always the same as the
9761    declared type of the individual bit-field itself (for GCC anyway... the
9762    DWARF spec doesn't actually mandate this).  Note that it is the size (in
9763    bytes) of the hypothetical "containing object" which will be given in the
9764    DW_AT_byte_size attribute for this bit-field.  (See the
9765    `byte_size_attribute' function below.)  It is also used when calculating the
9766    value of the DW_AT_bit_offset attribute.  (See the `bit_offset_attribute'
9767    function below.)  */
9768 
9769 static void
add_data_member_location_attribute(dw_die_ref die,tree decl)9770 add_data_member_location_attribute (dw_die_ref die, tree decl)
9771 {
9772   HOST_WIDE_INT offset;
9773   dw_loc_descr_ref loc_descr = 0;
9774 
9775   if (TREE_CODE (decl) == TREE_BINFO)
9776     {
9777       /* We're working on the TAG_inheritance for a base class.  */
9778       if (BINFO_VIRTUAL_P (decl) && is_cxx ())
9779 	{
9780 	  /* For C++ virtual bases we can't just use BINFO_OFFSET, as they
9781 	     aren't at a fixed offset from all (sub)objects of the same
9782 	     type.  We need to extract the appropriate offset from our
9783 	     vtable.  The following dwarf expression means
9784 
9785 	       BaseAddr = ObAddr + *((*ObAddr) - Offset)
9786 
9787 	     This is specific to the V3 ABI, of course.  */
9788 
9789 	  dw_loc_descr_ref tmp;
9790 
9791 	  /* Make a copy of the object address.  */
9792 	  tmp = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_dup, 0, 0);
9793 	  add_loc_descr (&loc_descr, tmp);
9794 
9795 	  /* Extract the vtable address.  */
9796 	  tmp = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_deref, 0, 0);
9797 	  add_loc_descr (&loc_descr, tmp);
9798 
9799 	  /* Calculate the address of the offset.  */
9800 	  offset = tree_low_cst (BINFO_VPTR_FIELD (decl), 0);
9801 	  gcc_assert (offset < 0);
9802 
9803 	  tmp = int_loc_descriptor (-offset);
9804 	  add_loc_descr (&loc_descr, tmp);
9805 	  tmp = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_minus, 0, 0);
9806 	  add_loc_descr (&loc_descr, tmp);
9807 
9808 	  /* Extract the offset.  */
9809 	  tmp = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_deref, 0, 0);
9810 	  add_loc_descr (&loc_descr, tmp);
9811 
9812 	  /* Add it to the object address.  */
9813 	  tmp = new_loc_descr (DW_OP_plus, 0, 0);
9814 	  add_loc_descr (&loc_descr, tmp);
9815 	}
9816       else
9817 	offset = tree_low_cst (BINFO_OFFSET (decl), 0);
9818     }
9819   else
9820     offset = field_byte_offset (decl);
9821 
9822   if (! loc_descr)
9823     {
9824       enum dwarf_location_atom op;
9825 
9826       /* The DWARF2 standard says that we should assume that the structure
9827 	 address is already on the stack, so we can specify a structure field
9828 	 address by using DW_OP_plus_uconst.  */
9829 
9830 #ifdef MIPS_DEBUGGING_INFO
9831       /* ??? The SGI dwarf reader does not handle the DW_OP_plus_uconst
9832 	 operator correctly.  It works only if we leave the offset on the
9833 	 stack.  */
9834       op = DW_OP_constu;
9835 #else
9836       op = DW_OP_plus_uconst;
9837 #endif
9838 
9839       loc_descr = new_loc_descr (op, offset, 0);
9840     }
9841 
9842   add_AT_loc (die, DW_AT_data_member_location, loc_descr);
9843 }
9844 
9845 /* Writes integer values to dw_vec_const array.  */
9846 
9847 static void
insert_int(HOST_WIDE_INT val,unsigned int size,unsigned char * dest)9848 insert_int (HOST_WIDE_INT val, unsigned int size, unsigned char *dest)
9849 {
9850   while (size != 0)
9851     {
9852       *dest++ = val & 0xff;
9853       val >>= 8;
9854       --size;
9855     }
9856 }
9857 
9858 /* Reads integers from dw_vec_const array.  Inverse of insert_int.  */
9859 
9860 static HOST_WIDE_INT
extract_int(const unsigned char * src,unsigned int size)9861 extract_int (const unsigned char *src, unsigned int size)
9862 {
9863   HOST_WIDE_INT val = 0;
9864 
9865   src += size;
9866   while (size != 0)
9867     {
9868       val <<= 8;
9869       val |= *--src & 0xff;
9870       --size;
9871     }
9872   return val;
9873 }
9874 
9875 /* Writes floating point values to dw_vec_const array.  */
9876 
9877 static void
insert_float(rtx rtl,unsigned char * array)9878 insert_float (rtx rtl, unsigned char *array)
9879 {
9880   REAL_VALUE_TYPE rv;
9881   long val[4];
9882   int i;
9883 
9884   REAL_VALUE_FROM_CONST_DOUBLE (rv, rtl);
9885   real_to_target (val, &rv, GET_MODE (rtl));
9886 
9887   /* real_to_target puts 32-bit pieces in each long.  Pack them.  */
9888   for (i = 0; i < GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (rtl)) / 4; i++)
9889     {
9890       insert_int (val[i], 4, array);
9891       array += 4;
9892     }
9893 }
9894 
9895 /* Attach a DW_AT_const_value attribute for a variable or a parameter which
9896    does not have a "location" either in memory or in a register.  These
9897    things can arise in GNU C when a constant is passed as an actual parameter
9898    to an inlined function.  They can also arise in C++ where declared
9899    constants do not necessarily get memory "homes".  */
9900 
9901 static void
add_const_value_attribute(dw_die_ref die,rtx rtl)9902 add_const_value_attribute (dw_die_ref die, rtx rtl)
9903 {
9904   switch (GET_CODE (rtl))
9905     {
9906     case CONST_INT:
9907       {
9908 	HOST_WIDE_INT val = INTVAL (rtl);
9909 
9910 	if (val < 0)
9911 	  add_AT_int (die, DW_AT_const_value, val);
9912 	else
9913 	  add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_const_value, (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT) val);
9914       }
9915       break;
9916 
9917     case CONST_DOUBLE:
9918       /* Note that a CONST_DOUBLE rtx could represent either an integer or a
9919 	 floating-point constant.  A CONST_DOUBLE is used whenever the
9920 	 constant requires more than one word in order to be adequately
9921 	 represented.  We output CONST_DOUBLEs as blocks.  */
9922       {
9923 	enum machine_mode mode = GET_MODE (rtl);
9924 
9925 	if (SCALAR_FLOAT_MODE_P (mode))
9926 	  {
9927 	    unsigned int length = GET_MODE_SIZE (mode);
9928 	    unsigned char *array = ggc_alloc (length);
9929 
9930 	    insert_float (rtl, array);
9931 	    add_AT_vec (die, DW_AT_const_value, length / 4, 4, array);
9932 	  }
9933 	else
9934 	  {
9935 	    /* ??? We really should be using HOST_WIDE_INT throughout.  */
9936 	    gcc_assert (HOST_BITS_PER_LONG == HOST_BITS_PER_WIDE_INT);
9937 
9938 	    add_AT_long_long (die, DW_AT_const_value,
9939 			      CONST_DOUBLE_HIGH (rtl), CONST_DOUBLE_LOW (rtl));
9940 	  }
9941       }
9942       break;
9943 
9944     case CONST_VECTOR:
9945       {
9946 	enum machine_mode mode = GET_MODE (rtl);
9947 	unsigned int elt_size = GET_MODE_UNIT_SIZE (mode);
9948 	unsigned int length = CONST_VECTOR_NUNITS (rtl);
9949 	unsigned char *array = ggc_alloc (length * elt_size);
9950 	unsigned int i;
9951 	unsigned char *p;
9952 
9953 	switch (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode))
9954 	  {
9955 	  case MODE_VECTOR_INT:
9956 	    for (i = 0, p = array; i < length; i++, p += elt_size)
9957 	      {
9958 		rtx elt = CONST_VECTOR_ELT (rtl, i);
9959 		HOST_WIDE_INT lo, hi;
9960 
9961 		switch (GET_CODE (elt))
9962 		  {
9963 		  case CONST_INT:
9964 		    lo = INTVAL (elt);
9965 		    hi = -(lo < 0);
9966 		    break;
9967 
9968 		  case CONST_DOUBLE:
9969 		    lo = CONST_DOUBLE_LOW (elt);
9970 		    hi = CONST_DOUBLE_HIGH (elt);
9971 		    break;
9972 
9973 		  default:
9974 		    gcc_unreachable ();
9975 		  }
9976 
9977 		if (elt_size <= sizeof (HOST_WIDE_INT))
9978 		  insert_int (lo, elt_size, p);
9979 		else
9980 		  {
9981 		    unsigned char *p0 = p;
9982 		    unsigned char *p1 = p + sizeof (HOST_WIDE_INT);
9983 
9984 		    gcc_assert (elt_size == 2 * sizeof (HOST_WIDE_INT));
9985 		    if (WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN)
9986 		      {
9987 			p0 = p1;
9988 			p1 = p;
9989 		      }
9990 		    insert_int (lo, sizeof (HOST_WIDE_INT), p0);
9991 		    insert_int (hi, sizeof (HOST_WIDE_INT), p1);
9992 		  }
9993 	      }
9994 	    break;
9995 
9996 	  case MODE_VECTOR_FLOAT:
9997 	    for (i = 0, p = array; i < length; i++, p += elt_size)
9998 	      {
9999 		rtx elt = CONST_VECTOR_ELT (rtl, i);
10000 		insert_float (elt, p);
10001 	      }
10002 	    break;
10003 
10004 	  default:
10005 	    gcc_unreachable ();
10006 	  }
10007 
10008 	add_AT_vec (die, DW_AT_const_value, length, elt_size, array);
10009       }
10010       break;
10011 
10012     case CONST_STRING:
10013       add_AT_string (die, DW_AT_const_value, XSTR (rtl, 0));
10014       break;
10015 
10016     case SYMBOL_REF:
10017     case LABEL_REF:
10018     case CONST:
10019       add_AT_addr (die, DW_AT_const_value, rtl);
10020       VEC_safe_push (rtx, gc, used_rtx_array, rtl);
10021       break;
10022 
10023     case PLUS:
10024       /* In cases where an inlined instance of an inline function is passed
10025 	 the address of an `auto' variable (which is local to the caller) we
10026 	 can get a situation where the DECL_RTL of the artificial local
10027 	 variable (for the inlining) which acts as a stand-in for the
10028 	 corresponding formal parameter (of the inline function) will look
10029 	 like (plus:SI (reg:SI FRAME_PTR) (const_int ...)).  This is not
10030 	 exactly a compile-time constant expression, but it isn't the address
10031 	 of the (artificial) local variable either.  Rather, it represents the
10032 	 *value* which the artificial local variable always has during its
10033 	 lifetime.  We currently have no way to represent such quasi-constant
10034 	 values in Dwarf, so for now we just punt and generate nothing.  */
10035       break;
10036 
10037     default:
10038       /* No other kinds of rtx should be possible here.  */
10039       gcc_unreachable ();
10040     }
10041 
10042 }
10043 
10044 /* Determine whether the evaluation of EXPR references any variables
10045    or functions which aren't otherwise used (and therefore may not be
10046    output).  */
10047 static tree
reference_to_unused(tree * tp,int * walk_subtrees,void * data ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)10048 reference_to_unused (tree * tp, int * walk_subtrees,
10049 		     void * data ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
10050 {
10051   if (! EXPR_P (*tp) && ! CONSTANT_CLASS_P (*tp))
10052     *walk_subtrees = 0;
10053 
10054   if (DECL_P (*tp) && ! TREE_PUBLIC (*tp) && ! TREE_USED (*tp)
10055       && ! TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (*tp))
10056     return *tp;
10057   else if (!flag_unit_at_a_time)
10058     return NULL_TREE;
10059   else if (!cgraph_global_info_ready
10060 	   && (TREE_CODE (*tp) == VAR_DECL || TREE_CODE (*tp) == FUNCTION_DECL))
10061     return *tp;
10062   else if (DECL_P (*tp) && TREE_CODE (*tp) == VAR_DECL)
10063     {
10064       struct cgraph_varpool_node *node = cgraph_varpool_node (*tp);
10065       if (!node->needed)
10066 	return *tp;
10067     }
10068    else if (DECL_P (*tp) && TREE_CODE (*tp) == FUNCTION_DECL
10069 	    && (!DECL_EXTERNAL (*tp) || DECL_DECLARED_INLINE_P (*tp)))
10070     {
10071       struct cgraph_node *node = cgraph_node (*tp);
10072       if (!node->output)
10073         return *tp;
10074     }
10075 
10076   return NULL_TREE;
10077 }
10078 
10079 /* Generate an RTL constant from a decl initializer INIT with decl type TYPE,
10080    for use in a later add_const_value_attribute call.  */
10081 
10082 static rtx
rtl_for_decl_init(tree init,tree type)10083 rtl_for_decl_init (tree init, tree type)
10084 {
10085   rtx rtl = NULL_RTX;
10086 
10087   /* If a variable is initialized with a string constant without embedded
10088      zeros, build CONST_STRING.  */
10089   if (TREE_CODE (init) == STRING_CST && TREE_CODE (type) == ARRAY_TYPE)
10090     {
10091       tree enttype = TREE_TYPE (type);
10092       tree domain = TYPE_DOMAIN (type);
10093       enum machine_mode mode = TYPE_MODE (enttype);
10094 
10095       if (GET_MODE_CLASS (mode) == MODE_INT && GET_MODE_SIZE (mode) == 1
10096 	  && domain
10097 	  && integer_zerop (TYPE_MIN_VALUE (domain))
10098 	  && compare_tree_int (TYPE_MAX_VALUE (domain),
10099 			       TREE_STRING_LENGTH (init) - 1) == 0
10100 	  && ((size_t) TREE_STRING_LENGTH (init)
10101 	      == strlen (TREE_STRING_POINTER (init)) + 1))
10102 	rtl = gen_rtx_CONST_STRING (VOIDmode,
10103 				    ggc_strdup (TREE_STRING_POINTER (init)));
10104     }
10105   /* Other aggregates, and complex values, could be represented using
10106      CONCAT: FIXME!  */
10107   else if (AGGREGATE_TYPE_P (type) || TREE_CODE (type) == COMPLEX_TYPE)
10108     ;
10109   /* Vectors only work if their mode is supported by the target.
10110      FIXME: generic vectors ought to work too.  */
10111   else if (TREE_CODE (type) == VECTOR_TYPE && TYPE_MODE (type) == BLKmode)
10112     ;
10113   /* If the initializer is something that we know will expand into an
10114      immediate RTL constant, expand it now.  We must be careful not to
10115      reference variables which won't be output.  */
10116   else if (initializer_constant_valid_p (init, type)
10117 	   && ! walk_tree (&init, reference_to_unused, NULL, NULL))
10118     {
10119       /* Convert vector CONSTRUCTOR initializers to VECTOR_CST if
10120 	 possible.  */
10121       if (TREE_CODE (type) == VECTOR_TYPE)
10122 	switch (TREE_CODE (init))
10123 	  {
10124 	  case VECTOR_CST:
10125 	    break;
10126 	  case CONSTRUCTOR:
10127 	    if (TREE_CONSTANT (init))
10128 	      {
10129 		VEC(constructor_elt,gc) *elts = CONSTRUCTOR_ELTS (init);
10130 		bool constant_p = true;
10131 		tree value;
10132 		unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT ix;
10133 
10134 		/* Even when ctor is constant, it might contain non-*_CST
10135 		   elements (e.g. { 1.0/0.0 - 1.0/0.0, 0.0 }) and those don't
10136 		   belong into VECTOR_CST nodes.  */
10137 		FOR_EACH_CONSTRUCTOR_VALUE (elts, ix, value)
10138 		  if (!CONSTANT_CLASS_P (value))
10139 		    {
10140 		      constant_p = false;
10141 		      break;
10142 		    }
10143 
10144 		if (constant_p)
10145 		  {
10146 		    init = build_vector_from_ctor (type, elts);
10147 		    break;
10148 		  }
10149 	      }
10150 	    /* FALLTHRU */
10151 
10152 	  default:
10153 	    return NULL;
10154 	  }
10155 
10156       rtl = expand_expr (init, NULL_RTX, VOIDmode, EXPAND_INITIALIZER);
10157 
10158       /* If expand_expr returns a MEM, it wasn't immediate.  */
10159       gcc_assert (!rtl || !MEM_P (rtl));
10160     }
10161 
10162   return rtl;
10163 }
10164 
10165 /* Generate RTL for the variable DECL to represent its location.  */
10166 
10167 static rtx
rtl_for_decl_location(tree decl)10168 rtl_for_decl_location (tree decl)
10169 {
10170   rtx rtl;
10171 
10172   /* Here we have to decide where we are going to say the parameter "lives"
10173      (as far as the debugger is concerned).  We only have a couple of
10174      choices.  GCC provides us with DECL_RTL and with DECL_INCOMING_RTL.
10175 
10176      DECL_RTL normally indicates where the parameter lives during most of the
10177      activation of the function.  If optimization is enabled however, this
10178      could be either NULL or else a pseudo-reg.  Both of those cases indicate
10179      that the parameter doesn't really live anywhere (as far as the code
10180      generation parts of GCC are concerned) during most of the function's
10181      activation.  That will happen (for example) if the parameter is never
10182      referenced within the function.
10183 
10184      We could just generate a location descriptor here for all non-NULL
10185      non-pseudo values of DECL_RTL and ignore all of the rest, but we can be
10186      a little nicer than that if we also consider DECL_INCOMING_RTL in cases
10187      where DECL_RTL is NULL or is a pseudo-reg.
10188 
10189      Note however that we can only get away with using DECL_INCOMING_RTL as
10190      a backup substitute for DECL_RTL in certain limited cases.  In cases
10191      where DECL_ARG_TYPE (decl) indicates the same type as TREE_TYPE (decl),
10192      we can be sure that the parameter was passed using the same type as it is
10193      declared to have within the function, and that its DECL_INCOMING_RTL
10194      points us to a place where a value of that type is passed.
10195 
10196      In cases where DECL_ARG_TYPE (decl) and TREE_TYPE (decl) are different,
10197      we cannot (in general) use DECL_INCOMING_RTL as a substitute for DECL_RTL
10198      because in these cases DECL_INCOMING_RTL points us to a value of some
10199      type which is *different* from the type of the parameter itself.  Thus,
10200      if we tried to use DECL_INCOMING_RTL to generate a location attribute in
10201      such cases, the debugger would end up (for example) trying to fetch a
10202      `float' from a place which actually contains the first part of a
10203      `double'.  That would lead to really incorrect and confusing
10204      output at debug-time.
10205 
10206      So, in general, we *do not* use DECL_INCOMING_RTL as a backup for DECL_RTL
10207      in cases where DECL_ARG_TYPE (decl) != TREE_TYPE (decl).  There
10208      are a couple of exceptions however.  On little-endian machines we can
10209      get away with using DECL_INCOMING_RTL even when DECL_ARG_TYPE (decl) is
10210      not the same as TREE_TYPE (decl), but only when DECL_ARG_TYPE (decl) is
10211      an integral type that is smaller than TREE_TYPE (decl). These cases arise
10212      when (on a little-endian machine) a non-prototyped function has a
10213      parameter declared to be of type `short' or `char'.  In such cases,
10214      TREE_TYPE (decl) will be `short' or `char', DECL_ARG_TYPE (decl) will
10215      be `int', and DECL_INCOMING_RTL will point to the lowest-order byte of the
10216      passed `int' value.  If the debugger then uses that address to fetch
10217      a `short' or a `char' (on a little-endian machine) the result will be
10218      the correct data, so we allow for such exceptional cases below.
10219 
10220      Note that our goal here is to describe the place where the given formal
10221      parameter lives during most of the function's activation (i.e. between the
10222      end of the prologue and the start of the epilogue).  We'll do that as best
10223      as we can. Note however that if the given formal parameter is modified
10224      sometime during the execution of the function, then a stack backtrace (at
10225      debug-time) will show the function as having been called with the *new*
10226      value rather than the value which was originally passed in.  This happens
10227      rarely enough that it is not a major problem, but it *is* a problem, and
10228      I'd like to fix it.
10229 
10230      A future version of dwarf2out.c may generate two additional attributes for
10231      any given DW_TAG_formal_parameter DIE which will describe the "passed
10232      type" and the "passed location" for the given formal parameter in addition
10233      to the attributes we now generate to indicate the "declared type" and the
10234      "active location" for each parameter.  This additional set of attributes
10235      could be used by debuggers for stack backtraces. Separately, note that
10236      sometimes DECL_RTL can be NULL and DECL_INCOMING_RTL can be NULL also.
10237      This happens (for example) for inlined-instances of inline function formal
10238      parameters which are never referenced.  This really shouldn't be
10239      happening.  All PARM_DECL nodes should get valid non-NULL
10240      DECL_INCOMING_RTL values.  FIXME.  */
10241 
10242   /* Use DECL_RTL as the "location" unless we find something better.  */
10243   rtl = DECL_RTL_IF_SET (decl);
10244 
10245   /* When generating abstract instances, ignore everything except
10246      constants, symbols living in memory, and symbols living in
10247      fixed registers.  */
10248   if (! reload_completed)
10249     {
10250       if (rtl
10251 	  && (CONSTANT_P (rtl)
10252 	      || (MEM_P (rtl)
10253 	          && CONSTANT_P (XEXP (rtl, 0)))
10254 	      || (REG_P (rtl)
10255 	          && TREE_CODE (decl) == VAR_DECL
10256 		  && TREE_STATIC (decl))))
10257 	{
10258 	  rtl = targetm.delegitimize_address (rtl);
10259 	  return rtl;
10260 	}
10261       rtl = NULL_RTX;
10262     }
10263   else if (TREE_CODE (decl) == PARM_DECL)
10264     {
10265       if (rtl == NULL_RTX || is_pseudo_reg (rtl))
10266 	{
10267 	  tree declared_type = TREE_TYPE (decl);
10268 	  tree passed_type = DECL_ARG_TYPE (decl);
10269 	  enum machine_mode dmode = TYPE_MODE (declared_type);
10270 	  enum machine_mode pmode = TYPE_MODE (passed_type);
10271 
10272 	  /* This decl represents a formal parameter which was optimized out.
10273 	     Note that DECL_INCOMING_RTL may be NULL in here, but we handle
10274 	     all cases where (rtl == NULL_RTX) just below.  */
10275 	  if (dmode == pmode)
10276 	    rtl = DECL_INCOMING_RTL (decl);
10277 	  else if (SCALAR_INT_MODE_P (dmode)
10278 		   && GET_MODE_SIZE (dmode) <= GET_MODE_SIZE (pmode)
10279 		   && DECL_INCOMING_RTL (decl))
10280 	    {
10281 	      rtx inc = DECL_INCOMING_RTL (decl);
10282 	      if (REG_P (inc))
10283 		rtl = inc;
10284 	      else if (MEM_P (inc))
10285 		{
10286 		  if (BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN)
10287 		    rtl = adjust_address_nv (inc, dmode,
10288 					     GET_MODE_SIZE (pmode)
10289 					     - GET_MODE_SIZE (dmode));
10290 		  else
10291 		    rtl = inc;
10292 		}
10293 	    }
10294 	}
10295 
10296       /* If the parm was passed in registers, but lives on the stack, then
10297 	 make a big endian correction if the mode of the type of the
10298 	 parameter is not the same as the mode of the rtl.  */
10299       /* ??? This is the same series of checks that are made in dbxout.c before
10300 	 we reach the big endian correction code there.  It isn't clear if all
10301 	 of these checks are necessary here, but keeping them all is the safe
10302 	 thing to do.  */
10303       else if (MEM_P (rtl)
10304 	       && XEXP (rtl, 0) != const0_rtx
10305 	       && ! CONSTANT_P (XEXP (rtl, 0))
10306 	       /* Not passed in memory.  */
10307 	       && !MEM_P (DECL_INCOMING_RTL (decl))
10308 	       /* Not passed by invisible reference.  */
10309 	       && (!REG_P (XEXP (rtl, 0))
10310 		   || REGNO (XEXP (rtl, 0)) == HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
10311 		   || REGNO (XEXP (rtl, 0)) == STACK_POINTER_REGNUM
10312 #if ARG_POINTER_REGNUM != HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
10313 		   || REGNO (XEXP (rtl, 0)) == ARG_POINTER_REGNUM
10314 #endif
10315 		     )
10316 	       /* Big endian correction check.  */
10317 	       && BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN
10318 	       && TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (decl)) != GET_MODE (rtl)
10319 	       && (GET_MODE_SIZE (TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (decl)))
10320 		   < UNITS_PER_WORD))
10321 	{
10322 	  int offset = (UNITS_PER_WORD
10323 			- GET_MODE_SIZE (TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (decl))));
10324 
10325 	  rtl = gen_rtx_MEM (TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (decl)),
10326 			     plus_constant (XEXP (rtl, 0), offset));
10327 	}
10328     }
10329   else if (TREE_CODE (decl) == VAR_DECL
10330 	   && rtl
10331 	   && MEM_P (rtl)
10332 	   && GET_MODE (rtl) != TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (decl))
10333 	   && BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN)
10334     {
10335       int rsize = GET_MODE_SIZE (GET_MODE (rtl));
10336       int dsize = GET_MODE_SIZE (TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (decl)));
10337 
10338       /* If a variable is declared "register" yet is smaller than
10339 	 a register, then if we store the variable to memory, it
10340 	 looks like we're storing a register-sized value, when in
10341 	 fact we are not.  We need to adjust the offset of the
10342 	 storage location to reflect the actual value's bytes,
10343 	 else gdb will not be able to display it.  */
10344       if (rsize > dsize)
10345 	rtl = gen_rtx_MEM (TYPE_MODE (TREE_TYPE (decl)),
10346 			   plus_constant (XEXP (rtl, 0), rsize-dsize));
10347     }
10348 
10349   /* A variable with no DECL_RTL but a DECL_INITIAL is a compile-time constant,
10350      and will have been substituted directly into all expressions that use it.
10351      C does not have such a concept, but C++ and other languages do.  */
10352   if (!rtl && TREE_CODE (decl) == VAR_DECL && DECL_INITIAL (decl))
10353     rtl = rtl_for_decl_init (DECL_INITIAL (decl), TREE_TYPE (decl));
10354 
10355   if (rtl)
10356     rtl = targetm.delegitimize_address (rtl);
10357 
10358   /* If we don't look past the constant pool, we risk emitting a
10359      reference to a constant pool entry that isn't referenced from
10360      code, and thus is not emitted.  */
10361   if (rtl)
10362     rtl = avoid_constant_pool_reference (rtl);
10363 
10364   return rtl;
10365 }
10366 
10367 /* We need to figure out what section we should use as the base for the
10368    address ranges where a given location is valid.
10369    1. If this particular DECL has a section associated with it, use that.
10370    2. If this function has a section associated with it, use that.
10371    3. Otherwise, use the text section.
10372    XXX: If you split a variable across multiple sections, we won't notice.  */
10373 
10374 static const char *
secname_for_decl(tree decl)10375 secname_for_decl (tree decl)
10376 {
10377   const char *secname;
10378 
10379   if (VAR_OR_FUNCTION_DECL_P (decl) && DECL_SECTION_NAME (decl))
10380     {
10381       tree sectree = DECL_SECTION_NAME (decl);
10382       secname = TREE_STRING_POINTER (sectree);
10383     }
10384   else if (current_function_decl && DECL_SECTION_NAME (current_function_decl))
10385     {
10386       tree sectree = DECL_SECTION_NAME (current_function_decl);
10387       secname = TREE_STRING_POINTER (sectree);
10388     }
10389   else if (cfun && in_cold_section_p)
10390     secname = cfun->cold_section_label;
10391   else
10392     secname = text_section_label;
10393 
10394   return secname;
10395 }
10396 
10397 /* Generate *either* a DW_AT_location attribute or else a DW_AT_const_value
10398    data attribute for a variable or a parameter.  We generate the
10399    DW_AT_const_value attribute only in those cases where the given variable
10400    or parameter does not have a true "location" either in memory or in a
10401    register.  This can happen (for example) when a constant is passed as an
10402    actual argument in a call to an inline function.  (It's possible that
10403    these things can crop up in other ways also.)  Note that one type of
10404    constant value which can be passed into an inlined function is a constant
10405    pointer.  This can happen for example if an actual argument in an inlined
10406    function call evaluates to a compile-time constant address.  */
10407 
10408 static void
add_location_or_const_value_attribute(dw_die_ref die,tree decl,enum dwarf_attribute attr)10409 add_location_or_const_value_attribute (dw_die_ref die, tree decl,
10410 				       enum dwarf_attribute attr)
10411 {
10412   rtx rtl;
10413   dw_loc_descr_ref descr;
10414   var_loc_list *loc_list;
10415   struct var_loc_node *node;
10416   if (TREE_CODE (decl) == ERROR_MARK)
10417     return;
10418 
10419   gcc_assert (TREE_CODE (decl) == VAR_DECL || TREE_CODE (decl) == PARM_DECL
10420 	      || TREE_CODE (decl) == RESULT_DECL);
10421 
10422   /* See if we possibly have multiple locations for this variable.  */
10423   loc_list = lookup_decl_loc (decl);
10424 
10425   /* If it truly has multiple locations, the first and last node will
10426      differ.  */
10427   if (loc_list && loc_list->first != loc_list->last)
10428     {
10429       const char *endname, *secname;
10430       dw_loc_list_ref list;
10431       rtx varloc;
10432 
10433       /* Now that we know what section we are using for a base,
10434          actually construct the list of locations.
10435 	 The first location information is what is passed to the
10436 	 function that creates the location list, and the remaining
10437 	 locations just get added on to that list.
10438 	 Note that we only know the start address for a location
10439 	 (IE location changes), so to build the range, we use
10440 	 the range [current location start, next location start].
10441 	 This means we have to special case the last node, and generate
10442 	 a range of [last location start, end of function label].  */
10443 
10444       node = loc_list->first;
10445       varloc = NOTE_VAR_LOCATION (node->var_loc_note);
10446       secname = secname_for_decl (decl);
10447 
10448       list = new_loc_list (loc_descriptor (varloc),
10449 			   node->label, node->next->label, secname, 1);
10450       node = node->next;
10451 
10452       for (; node->next; node = node->next)
10453 	if (NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (node->var_loc_note) != NULL_RTX)
10454 	  {
10455 	    /* The variable has a location between NODE->LABEL and
10456 	       NODE->NEXT->LABEL.  */
10457 	    varloc = NOTE_VAR_LOCATION (node->var_loc_note);
10458 	    add_loc_descr_to_loc_list (&list, loc_descriptor (varloc),
10459 				       node->label, node->next->label, secname);
10460 	  }
10461 
10462       /* If the variable has a location at the last label
10463 	 it keeps its location until the end of function.  */
10464       if (NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_LOC (node->var_loc_note) != NULL_RTX)
10465 	{
10466 	  char label_id[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
10467 
10468 	  varloc = NOTE_VAR_LOCATION (node->var_loc_note);
10469 	  if (!current_function_decl)
10470 	    endname = text_end_label;
10471 	  else
10472 	    {
10473 	      ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label_id, FUNC_END_LABEL,
10474 					   current_function_funcdef_no);
10475 	      endname = ggc_strdup (label_id);
10476 	    }
10477 	  add_loc_descr_to_loc_list (&list, loc_descriptor (varloc),
10478 				     node->label, endname, secname);
10479 	}
10480 
10481       /* Finally, add the location list to the DIE, and we are done.  */
10482       add_AT_loc_list (die, attr, list);
10483       return;
10484     }
10485 
10486   /* Try to get some constant RTL for this decl, and use that as the value of
10487      the location.  */
10488 
10489   rtl = rtl_for_decl_location (decl);
10490   if (rtl && (CONSTANT_P (rtl) || GET_CODE (rtl) == CONST_STRING))
10491     {
10492       add_const_value_attribute (die, rtl);
10493       return;
10494     }
10495 
10496   /* If we have tried to generate the location otherwise, and it
10497      didn't work out (we wouldn't be here if we did), and we have a one entry
10498      location list, try generating a location from that.  */
10499   if (loc_list && loc_list->first)
10500     {
10501       node = loc_list->first;
10502       descr = loc_descriptor (NOTE_VAR_LOCATION (node->var_loc_note));
10503       if (descr)
10504 	{
10505 	  add_AT_location_description (die, attr, descr);
10506 	  return;
10507 	}
10508     }
10509 
10510   /* We couldn't get any rtl, so try directly generating the location
10511      description from the tree.  */
10512   descr = loc_descriptor_from_tree (decl);
10513   if (descr)
10514     {
10515       add_AT_location_description (die, attr, descr);
10516       return;
10517     }
10518   /* None of that worked, so it must not really have a location;
10519      try adding a constant value attribute from the DECL_INITIAL.  */
10520   tree_add_const_value_attribute (die, decl);
10521 }
10522 
10523 /* If we don't have a copy of this variable in memory for some reason (such
10524    as a C++ member constant that doesn't have an out-of-line definition),
10525    we should tell the debugger about the constant value.  */
10526 
10527 static void
tree_add_const_value_attribute(dw_die_ref var_die,tree decl)10528 tree_add_const_value_attribute (dw_die_ref var_die, tree decl)
10529 {
10530   tree init = DECL_INITIAL (decl);
10531   tree type = TREE_TYPE (decl);
10532   rtx rtl;
10533 
10534   if (TREE_READONLY (decl) && ! TREE_THIS_VOLATILE (decl) && init)
10535     /* OK */;
10536   else
10537     return;
10538 
10539   rtl = rtl_for_decl_init (init, type);
10540   if (rtl)
10541     add_const_value_attribute (var_die, rtl);
10542 }
10543 
10544 /* Convert the CFI instructions for the current function into a
10545    location list.  This is used for DW_AT_frame_base when we targeting
10546    a dwarf2 consumer that does not support the dwarf3
10547    DW_OP_call_frame_cfa.  OFFSET is a constant to be added to all CFA
10548    expressions.  */
10549 
10550 static dw_loc_list_ref
convert_cfa_to_fb_loc_list(HOST_WIDE_INT offset)10551 convert_cfa_to_fb_loc_list (HOST_WIDE_INT offset)
10552 {
10553   dw_fde_ref fde;
10554   dw_loc_list_ref list, *list_tail;
10555   dw_cfi_ref cfi;
10556   dw_cfa_location last_cfa, next_cfa;
10557   const char *start_label, *last_label, *section;
10558 
10559   fde = &fde_table[fde_table_in_use - 1];
10560 
10561   section = secname_for_decl (current_function_decl);
10562   list_tail = &list;
10563   list = NULL;
10564 
10565   next_cfa.reg = INVALID_REGNUM;
10566   next_cfa.offset = 0;
10567   next_cfa.indirect = 0;
10568   next_cfa.base_offset = 0;
10569 
10570   start_label = fde->dw_fde_begin;
10571 
10572   /* ??? Bald assumption that the CIE opcode list does not contain
10573      advance opcodes.  */
10574   for (cfi = cie_cfi_head; cfi; cfi = cfi->dw_cfi_next)
10575     lookup_cfa_1 (cfi, &next_cfa);
10576 
10577   last_cfa = next_cfa;
10578   last_label = start_label;
10579 
10580   for (cfi = fde->dw_fde_cfi; cfi; cfi = cfi->dw_cfi_next)
10581     switch (cfi->dw_cfi_opc)
10582       {
10583       case DW_CFA_set_loc:
10584       case DW_CFA_advance_loc1:
10585       case DW_CFA_advance_loc2:
10586       case DW_CFA_advance_loc4:
10587 	if (!cfa_equal_p (&last_cfa, &next_cfa))
10588 	  {
10589 	    *list_tail = new_loc_list (build_cfa_loc (&last_cfa, offset),
10590 				       start_label, last_label, section,
10591 				       list == NULL);
10592 
10593 	    list_tail = &(*list_tail)->dw_loc_next;
10594 	    last_cfa = next_cfa;
10595 	    start_label = last_label;
10596 	  }
10597 	last_label = cfi->dw_cfi_oprnd1.dw_cfi_addr;
10598 	break;
10599 
10600       case DW_CFA_advance_loc:
10601 	/* The encoding is complex enough that we should never emit this.  */
10602       case DW_CFA_remember_state:
10603       case DW_CFA_restore_state:
10604 	/* We don't handle these two in this function.  It would be possible
10605 	   if it were to be required.  */
10606 	gcc_unreachable ();
10607 
10608       default:
10609 	lookup_cfa_1 (cfi, &next_cfa);
10610 	break;
10611       }
10612 
10613   if (!cfa_equal_p (&last_cfa, &next_cfa))
10614     {
10615       *list_tail = new_loc_list (build_cfa_loc (&last_cfa, offset),
10616 				 start_label, last_label, section,
10617 				 list == NULL);
10618       list_tail = &(*list_tail)->dw_loc_next;
10619       start_label = last_label;
10620     }
10621   *list_tail = new_loc_list (build_cfa_loc (&next_cfa, offset),
10622 			     start_label, fde->dw_fde_end, section,
10623 			     list == NULL);
10624 
10625   return list;
10626 }
10627 
10628 /* Compute a displacement from the "steady-state frame pointer" to the
10629    frame base (often the same as the CFA), and store it in
10630    frame_pointer_fb_offset.  OFFSET is added to the displacement
10631    before the latter is negated.  */
10632 
10633 static void
compute_frame_pointer_to_fb_displacement(HOST_WIDE_INT offset)10634 compute_frame_pointer_to_fb_displacement (HOST_WIDE_INT offset)
10635 {
10636   rtx reg, elim;
10637 
10638 #ifdef FRAME_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET
10639   reg = frame_pointer_rtx;
10640   offset += FRAME_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET (current_function_decl);
10641 #else
10642   reg = arg_pointer_rtx;
10643   offset += ARG_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET (current_function_decl);
10644 #endif
10645 
10646   elim = eliminate_regs (reg, VOIDmode, NULL_RTX);
10647   if (GET_CODE (elim) == PLUS)
10648     {
10649       offset += INTVAL (XEXP (elim, 1));
10650       elim = XEXP (elim, 0);
10651     }
10652   gcc_assert (elim == (frame_pointer_needed ? hard_frame_pointer_rtx
10653 		       : stack_pointer_rtx));
10654 
10655   frame_pointer_fb_offset = -offset;
10656 }
10657 
10658 /* Generate a DW_AT_name attribute given some string value to be included as
10659    the value of the attribute.  */
10660 
10661 static void
add_name_attribute(dw_die_ref die,const char * name_string)10662 add_name_attribute (dw_die_ref die, const char *name_string)
10663 {
10664   if (name_string != NULL && *name_string != 0)
10665     {
10666       if (demangle_name_func)
10667 	name_string = (*demangle_name_func) (name_string);
10668 
10669       add_AT_string (die, DW_AT_name, name_string);
10670     }
10671 }
10672 
10673 /* Generate a DW_AT_comp_dir attribute for DIE.  */
10674 
10675 static void
add_comp_dir_attribute(dw_die_ref die)10676 add_comp_dir_attribute (dw_die_ref die)
10677 {
10678   const char *wd = get_src_pwd ();
10679   if (wd != NULL)
10680     add_AT_string (die, DW_AT_comp_dir, wd);
10681 }
10682 
10683 /* Given a tree node describing an array bound (either lower or upper) output
10684    a representation for that bound.  */
10685 
10686 static void
add_bound_info(dw_die_ref subrange_die,enum dwarf_attribute bound_attr,tree bound)10687 add_bound_info (dw_die_ref subrange_die, enum dwarf_attribute bound_attr, tree bound)
10688 {
10689   switch (TREE_CODE (bound))
10690     {
10691     case ERROR_MARK:
10692       return;
10693 
10694     /* All fixed-bounds are represented by INTEGER_CST nodes.  */
10695     case INTEGER_CST:
10696       if (! host_integerp (bound, 0)
10697 	  || (bound_attr == DW_AT_lower_bound
10698 	      && (((is_c_family () || is_java ()) &&  integer_zerop (bound))
10699 		  || (is_fortran () && integer_onep (bound)))))
10700 	/* Use the default.  */
10701 	;
10702       else
10703 	add_AT_unsigned (subrange_die, bound_attr, tree_low_cst (bound, 0));
10704       break;
10705 
10706     case CONVERT_EXPR:
10707     case NOP_EXPR:
10708     case NON_LVALUE_EXPR:
10709     case VIEW_CONVERT_EXPR:
10710       add_bound_info (subrange_die, bound_attr, TREE_OPERAND (bound, 0));
10711       break;
10712 
10713     case SAVE_EXPR:
10714       break;
10715 
10716     case VAR_DECL:
10717     case PARM_DECL:
10718     case RESULT_DECL:
10719       {
10720 	dw_die_ref decl_die = lookup_decl_die (bound);
10721 
10722 	/* ??? Can this happen, or should the variable have been bound
10723 	   first?  Probably it can, since I imagine that we try to create
10724 	   the types of parameters in the order in which they exist in
10725 	   the list, and won't have created a forward reference to a
10726 	   later parameter.  */
10727 	if (decl_die != NULL)
10728 	  add_AT_die_ref (subrange_die, bound_attr, decl_die);
10729 	break;
10730       }
10731 
10732     default:
10733       {
10734 	/* Otherwise try to create a stack operation procedure to
10735 	   evaluate the value of the array bound.  */
10736 
10737 	dw_die_ref ctx, decl_die;
10738 	dw_loc_descr_ref loc;
10739 
10740 	loc = loc_descriptor_from_tree (bound);
10741 	if (loc == NULL)
10742 	  break;
10743 
10744 	if (current_function_decl == 0)
10745 	  ctx = comp_unit_die;
10746 	else
10747 	  ctx = lookup_decl_die (current_function_decl);
10748 
10749 	decl_die = new_die (DW_TAG_variable, ctx, bound);
10750 	add_AT_flag (decl_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
10751 	add_type_attribute (decl_die, TREE_TYPE (bound), 1, 0, ctx);
10752 	add_AT_loc (decl_die, DW_AT_location, loc);
10753 
10754 	add_AT_die_ref (subrange_die, bound_attr, decl_die);
10755 	break;
10756       }
10757     }
10758 }
10759 
10760 /* Note that the block of subscript information for an array type also
10761    includes information about the element type of type given array type.  */
10762 
10763 static void
add_subscript_info(dw_die_ref type_die,tree type)10764 add_subscript_info (dw_die_ref type_die, tree type)
10765 {
10766 #ifndef MIPS_DEBUGGING_INFO
10767   unsigned dimension_number;
10768 #endif
10769   tree lower, upper;
10770   dw_die_ref subrange_die;
10771 
10772   /* The GNU compilers represent multidimensional array types as sequences of
10773      one dimensional array types whose element types are themselves array
10774      types.  Here we squish that down, so that each multidimensional array
10775      type gets only one array_type DIE in the Dwarf debugging info. The draft
10776      Dwarf specification say that we are allowed to do this kind of
10777      compression in C (because there is no difference between an array or
10778      arrays and a multidimensional array in C) but for other source languages
10779      (e.g. Ada) we probably shouldn't do this.  */
10780 
10781   /* ??? The SGI dwarf reader fails for multidimensional arrays with a
10782      const enum type.  E.g. const enum machine_mode insn_operand_mode[2][10].
10783      We work around this by disabling this feature.  See also
10784      gen_array_type_die.  */
10785 #ifndef MIPS_DEBUGGING_INFO
10786   for (dimension_number = 0;
10787        TREE_CODE (type) == ARRAY_TYPE;
10788        type = TREE_TYPE (type), dimension_number++)
10789 #endif
10790     {
10791       tree domain = TYPE_DOMAIN (type);
10792 
10793       /* Arrays come in three flavors: Unspecified bounds, fixed bounds,
10794 	 and (in GNU C only) variable bounds.  Handle all three forms
10795 	 here.  */
10796       subrange_die = new_die (DW_TAG_subrange_type, type_die, NULL);
10797       if (domain)
10798 	{
10799 	  /* We have an array type with specified bounds.  */
10800 	  lower = TYPE_MIN_VALUE (domain);
10801 	  upper = TYPE_MAX_VALUE (domain);
10802 
10803 	  /* Define the index type.  */
10804 	  if (TREE_TYPE (domain))
10805 	    {
10806 	      /* ??? This is probably an Ada unnamed subrange type.  Ignore the
10807 		 TREE_TYPE field.  We can't emit debug info for this
10808 		 because it is an unnamed integral type.  */
10809 	      if (TREE_CODE (domain) == INTEGER_TYPE
10810 		  && TYPE_NAME (domain) == NULL_TREE
10811 		  && TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (domain)) == INTEGER_TYPE
10812 		  && TYPE_NAME (TREE_TYPE (domain)) == NULL_TREE)
10813 		;
10814 	      else
10815 		add_type_attribute (subrange_die, TREE_TYPE (domain), 0, 0,
10816 				    type_die);
10817 	    }
10818 
10819 	  /* ??? If upper is NULL, the array has unspecified length,
10820 	     but it does have a lower bound.  This happens with Fortran
10821 	       dimension arr(N:*)
10822 	     Since the debugger is definitely going to need to know N
10823 	     to produce useful results, go ahead and output the lower
10824 	     bound solo, and hope the debugger can cope.  */
10825 
10826 	  add_bound_info (subrange_die, DW_AT_lower_bound, lower);
10827 	  if (upper)
10828 	    add_bound_info (subrange_die, DW_AT_upper_bound, upper);
10829 	}
10830 
10831       /* Otherwise we have an array type with an unspecified length.  The
10832 	 DWARF-2 spec does not say how to handle this; let's just leave out the
10833 	 bounds.  */
10834     }
10835 }
10836 
10837 static void
add_byte_size_attribute(dw_die_ref die,tree tree_node)10838 add_byte_size_attribute (dw_die_ref die, tree tree_node)
10839 {
10840   unsigned size;
10841 
10842   switch (TREE_CODE (tree_node))
10843     {
10844     case ERROR_MARK:
10845       size = 0;
10846       break;
10847     case ENUMERAL_TYPE:
10848     case RECORD_TYPE:
10849     case UNION_TYPE:
10850     case QUAL_UNION_TYPE:
10851       size = int_size_in_bytes (tree_node);
10852       break;
10853     case FIELD_DECL:
10854       /* For a data member of a struct or union, the DW_AT_byte_size is
10855 	 generally given as the number of bytes normally allocated for an
10856 	 object of the *declared* type of the member itself.  This is true
10857 	 even for bit-fields.  */
10858       size = simple_type_size_in_bits (field_type (tree_node)) / BITS_PER_UNIT;
10859       break;
10860     default:
10861       gcc_unreachable ();
10862     }
10863 
10864   /* Note that `size' might be -1 when we get to this point.  If it is, that
10865      indicates that the byte size of the entity in question is variable.  We
10866      have no good way of expressing this fact in Dwarf at the present time.
10867      GCC/35998: Avoid passing negative sizes to Dtrace and gdb.  */
10868   add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_byte_size, (size != (unsigned)-1 ? size : 0));
10869 }
10870 
10871 /* For a FIELD_DECL node which represents a bit-field, output an attribute
10872    which specifies the distance in bits from the highest order bit of the
10873    "containing object" for the bit-field to the highest order bit of the
10874    bit-field itself.
10875 
10876    For any given bit-field, the "containing object" is a hypothetical object
10877    (of some integral or enum type) within which the given bit-field lives.  The
10878    type of this hypothetical "containing object" is always the same as the
10879    declared type of the individual bit-field itself.  The determination of the
10880    exact location of the "containing object" for a bit-field is rather
10881    complicated.  It's handled by the `field_byte_offset' function (above).
10882 
10883    Note that it is the size (in bytes) of the hypothetical "containing object"
10884    which will be given in the DW_AT_byte_size attribute for this bit-field.
10885    (See `byte_size_attribute' above).  */
10886 
10887 static inline void
add_bit_offset_attribute(dw_die_ref die,tree decl)10888 add_bit_offset_attribute (dw_die_ref die, tree decl)
10889 {
10890   HOST_WIDE_INT object_offset_in_bytes = field_byte_offset (decl);
10891   tree type = DECL_BIT_FIELD_TYPE (decl);
10892   HOST_WIDE_INT bitpos_int;
10893   HOST_WIDE_INT highest_order_object_bit_offset;
10894   HOST_WIDE_INT highest_order_field_bit_offset;
10895   HOST_WIDE_INT unsigned bit_offset;
10896 
10897   /* Must be a field and a bit field.  */
10898   gcc_assert (type && TREE_CODE (decl) == FIELD_DECL);
10899 
10900   /* We can't yet handle bit-fields whose offsets are variable, so if we
10901      encounter such things, just return without generating any attribute
10902      whatsoever.  Likewise for variable or too large size.  */
10903   if (! host_integerp (bit_position (decl), 0)
10904       || ! host_integerp (DECL_SIZE (decl), 1))
10905     return;
10906 
10907   bitpos_int = int_bit_position (decl);
10908 
10909   /* Note that the bit offset is always the distance (in bits) from the
10910      highest-order bit of the "containing object" to the highest-order bit of
10911      the bit-field itself.  Since the "high-order end" of any object or field
10912      is different on big-endian and little-endian machines, the computation
10913      below must take account of these differences.  */
10914   highest_order_object_bit_offset = object_offset_in_bytes * BITS_PER_UNIT;
10915   highest_order_field_bit_offset = bitpos_int;
10916 
10917   if (! BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN)
10918     {
10919       highest_order_field_bit_offset += tree_low_cst (DECL_SIZE (decl), 0);
10920       highest_order_object_bit_offset += simple_type_size_in_bits (type);
10921     }
10922 
10923   bit_offset
10924     = (! BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN
10925        ? highest_order_object_bit_offset - highest_order_field_bit_offset
10926        : highest_order_field_bit_offset - highest_order_object_bit_offset);
10927 
10928   add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_bit_offset, bit_offset);
10929 }
10930 
10931 /* For a FIELD_DECL node which represents a bit field, output an attribute
10932    which specifies the length in bits of the given field.  */
10933 
10934 static inline void
add_bit_size_attribute(dw_die_ref die,tree decl)10935 add_bit_size_attribute (dw_die_ref die, tree decl)
10936 {
10937   /* Must be a field and a bit field.  */
10938   gcc_assert (TREE_CODE (decl) == FIELD_DECL
10939 	      && DECL_BIT_FIELD_TYPE (decl));
10940 
10941   if (host_integerp (DECL_SIZE (decl), 1))
10942     add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_bit_size, tree_low_cst (DECL_SIZE (decl), 1));
10943 }
10944 
10945 /* If the compiled language is ANSI C, then add a 'prototyped'
10946    attribute, if arg types are given for the parameters of a function.  */
10947 
10948 static inline void
add_prototyped_attribute(dw_die_ref die,tree func_type)10949 add_prototyped_attribute (dw_die_ref die, tree func_type)
10950 {
10951   if (get_AT_unsigned (comp_unit_die, DW_AT_language) == DW_LANG_C89
10952       && TYPE_ARG_TYPES (func_type) != NULL)
10953     add_AT_flag (die, DW_AT_prototyped, 1);
10954 }
10955 
10956 /* Add an 'abstract_origin' attribute below a given DIE.  The DIE is found
10957    by looking in either the type declaration or object declaration
10958    equate table.  */
10959 
10960 static inline void
add_abstract_origin_attribute(dw_die_ref die,tree origin)10961 add_abstract_origin_attribute (dw_die_ref die, tree origin)
10962 {
10963   dw_die_ref origin_die = NULL;
10964 
10965   if (TREE_CODE (origin) != FUNCTION_DECL)
10966     {
10967       /* We may have gotten separated from the block for the inlined
10968 	 function, if we're in an exception handler or some such; make
10969 	 sure that the abstract function has been written out.
10970 
10971 	 Doing this for nested functions is wrong, however; functions are
10972 	 distinct units, and our context might not even be inline.  */
10973       tree fn = origin;
10974 
10975       if (TYPE_P (fn))
10976 	fn = TYPE_STUB_DECL (fn);
10977 
10978       fn = decl_function_context (fn);
10979       if (fn)
10980 	dwarf2out_abstract_function (fn);
10981     }
10982 
10983   if (DECL_P (origin))
10984     origin_die = lookup_decl_die (origin);
10985   else if (TYPE_P (origin))
10986     origin_die = lookup_type_die (origin);
10987 
10988   /* XXX: Functions that are never lowered don't always have correct block
10989      trees (in the case of java, they simply have no block tree, in some other
10990      languages).  For these functions, there is nothing we can really do to
10991      output correct debug info for inlined functions in all cases.  Rather
10992      than die, we'll just produce deficient debug info now, in that we will
10993      have variables without a proper abstract origin.  In the future, when all
10994      functions are lowered, we should re-add a gcc_assert (origin_die)
10995      here.  */
10996 
10997   if (origin_die)
10998       add_AT_die_ref (die, DW_AT_abstract_origin, origin_die);
10999 }
11000 
11001 /* We do not currently support the pure_virtual attribute.  */
11002 
11003 static inline void
add_pure_or_virtual_attribute(dw_die_ref die,tree func_decl)11004 add_pure_or_virtual_attribute (dw_die_ref die, tree func_decl)
11005 {
11006   if (DECL_VINDEX (func_decl))
11007     {
11008       add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_virtuality, DW_VIRTUALITY_virtual);
11009 
11010       if (host_integerp (DECL_VINDEX (func_decl), 0))
11011 	add_AT_loc (die, DW_AT_vtable_elem_location,
11012 		    new_loc_descr (DW_OP_constu,
11013 				   tree_low_cst (DECL_VINDEX (func_decl), 0),
11014 				   0));
11015 
11016       /* GNU extension: Record what type this method came from originally.  */
11017       if (debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
11018 	add_AT_die_ref (die, DW_AT_containing_type,
11019 			lookup_type_die (DECL_CONTEXT (func_decl)));
11020     }
11021 }
11022 
11023 /* Add source coordinate attributes for the given decl.  */
11024 
11025 static void
add_src_coords_attributes(dw_die_ref die,tree decl)11026 add_src_coords_attributes (dw_die_ref die, tree decl)
11027 {
11028   expanded_location s = expand_location (DECL_SOURCE_LOCATION (decl));
11029 
11030   add_AT_file (die, DW_AT_decl_file, lookup_filename (s.file));
11031   add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_decl_line, s.line);
11032 }
11033 
11034 /* Add a DW_AT_name attribute and source coordinate attribute for the
11035    given decl, but only if it actually has a name.  */
11036 
11037 static void
add_name_and_src_coords_attributes(dw_die_ref die,tree decl)11038 add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (dw_die_ref die, tree decl)
11039 {
11040   tree decl_name;
11041 
11042   decl_name = DECL_NAME (decl);
11043   if (decl_name != NULL && IDENTIFIER_POINTER (decl_name) != NULL)
11044     {
11045       add_name_attribute (die, dwarf2_name (decl, 0));
11046       if (! DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl))
11047 	add_src_coords_attributes (die, decl);
11048 
11049       if ((TREE_CODE (decl) == FUNCTION_DECL || TREE_CODE (decl) == VAR_DECL)
11050 	  && TREE_PUBLIC (decl)
11051 	  && DECL_ASSEMBLER_NAME (decl) != DECL_NAME (decl)
11052 	  && !DECL_ABSTRACT (decl)
11053 	  && !(TREE_CODE (decl) == VAR_DECL && DECL_REGISTER (decl)))
11054 	add_AT_string (die, DW_AT_MIPS_linkage_name,
11055 		       IDENTIFIER_POINTER (DECL_ASSEMBLER_NAME (decl)));
11056     }
11057 
11058 #ifdef VMS_DEBUGGING_INFO
11059   /* Get the function's name, as described by its RTL.  This may be different
11060      from the DECL_NAME name used in the source file.  */
11061   if (TREE_CODE (decl) == FUNCTION_DECL && TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (decl))
11062     {
11063       add_AT_addr (die, DW_AT_VMS_rtnbeg_pd_address,
11064 		   XEXP (DECL_RTL (decl), 0));
11065       VEC_safe_push (tree, gc, used_rtx_array, XEXP (DECL_RTL (decl), 0));
11066     }
11067 #endif
11068 }
11069 
11070 /* Push a new declaration scope.  */
11071 
11072 static void
push_decl_scope(tree scope)11073 push_decl_scope (tree scope)
11074 {
11075   VEC_safe_push (tree, gc, decl_scope_table, scope);
11076 }
11077 
11078 /* Pop a declaration scope.  */
11079 
11080 static inline void
pop_decl_scope(void)11081 pop_decl_scope (void)
11082 {
11083   VEC_pop (tree, decl_scope_table);
11084 }
11085 
11086 /* Return the DIE for the scope that immediately contains this type.
11087    Non-named types get global scope.  Named types nested in other
11088    types get their containing scope if it's open, or global scope
11089    otherwise.  All other types (i.e. function-local named types) get
11090    the current active scope.  */
11091 
11092 static dw_die_ref
scope_die_for(tree t,dw_die_ref context_die)11093 scope_die_for (tree t, dw_die_ref context_die)
11094 {
11095   dw_die_ref scope_die = NULL;
11096   tree containing_scope;
11097   int i;
11098 
11099   /* Non-types always go in the current scope.  */
11100   gcc_assert (TYPE_P (t));
11101 
11102   containing_scope = TYPE_CONTEXT (t);
11103 
11104   /* Use the containing namespace if it was passed in (for a declaration).  */
11105   if (containing_scope && TREE_CODE (containing_scope) == NAMESPACE_DECL)
11106     {
11107       if (context_die == lookup_decl_die (containing_scope))
11108 	/* OK */;
11109       else
11110 	containing_scope = NULL_TREE;
11111     }
11112 
11113   /* Ignore function type "scopes" from the C frontend.  They mean that
11114      a tagged type is local to a parmlist of a function declarator, but
11115      that isn't useful to DWARF.  */
11116   if (containing_scope && TREE_CODE (containing_scope) == FUNCTION_TYPE)
11117     containing_scope = NULL_TREE;
11118 
11119   if (containing_scope == NULL_TREE)
11120     scope_die = comp_unit_die;
11121   else if (TYPE_P (containing_scope))
11122     {
11123       /* For types, we can just look up the appropriate DIE.  But
11124 	 first we check to see if we're in the middle of emitting it
11125 	 so we know where the new DIE should go.  */
11126       for (i = VEC_length (tree, decl_scope_table) - 1; i >= 0; --i)
11127 	if (VEC_index (tree, decl_scope_table, i) == containing_scope)
11128 	  break;
11129 
11130       if (i < 0)
11131 	{
11132 	  gcc_assert (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE
11133 		      || TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (containing_scope));
11134 
11135 	  /* If none of the current dies are suitable, we get file scope.  */
11136 	  scope_die = comp_unit_die;
11137 	}
11138       else
11139 	scope_die = lookup_type_die (containing_scope);
11140     }
11141   else
11142     scope_die = context_die;
11143 
11144   return scope_die;
11145 }
11146 
11147 /* Returns nonzero if CONTEXT_DIE is internal to a function.  */
11148 
11149 static inline int
local_scope_p(dw_die_ref context_die)11150 local_scope_p (dw_die_ref context_die)
11151 {
11152   for (; context_die; context_die = context_die->die_parent)
11153     if (context_die->die_tag == DW_TAG_inlined_subroutine
11154 	|| context_die->die_tag == DW_TAG_subprogram)
11155       return 1;
11156 
11157   return 0;
11158 }
11159 
11160 /* Returns nonzero if CONTEXT_DIE is a class or namespace, for deciding
11161    whether or not to treat a DIE in this context as a declaration.  */
11162 
11163 static inline int
class_or_namespace_scope_p(dw_die_ref context_die)11164 class_or_namespace_scope_p (dw_die_ref context_die)
11165 {
11166   return (context_die
11167 	  && (context_die->die_tag == DW_TAG_structure_type
11168 	      || context_die->die_tag == DW_TAG_union_type
11169 	      || context_die->die_tag == DW_TAG_namespace));
11170 }
11171 
11172 /* Many forms of DIEs require a "type description" attribute.  This
11173    routine locates the proper "type descriptor" die for the type given
11174    by 'type', and adds a DW_AT_type attribute below the given die.  */
11175 
11176 static void
add_type_attribute(dw_die_ref object_die,tree type,int decl_const,int decl_volatile,dw_die_ref context_die)11177 add_type_attribute (dw_die_ref object_die, tree type, int decl_const,
11178 		    int decl_volatile, dw_die_ref context_die)
11179 {
11180   enum tree_code code  = TREE_CODE (type);
11181   dw_die_ref type_die  = NULL;
11182 
11183 /* APPLE LOCAL begin radar 5847213 */
11184   /* APPLE LOCAL begin radar 5811943 - Fix type of pointers to blocks  */
11185   /* APPLE LOCAL - radar 6113240 */
11186   /* APPLE LOCAL begin radar 6300081  */
11187   if (code == BLOCK_POINTER_TYPE && generic_block_literal_struct_type)
11188     {
11189       type = build_pointer_type (generic_block_literal_struct_type);
11190       code = TREE_CODE (type);
11191     }
11192   /* APPLE LOCAL end radar 6300081  */
11193   /* APPLE LOCAL end radar 5811943 - Fix type of pointers to Blocks  */
11194 /* APPLE LOCAL end radar 5847213 */
11195 
11196   /* ??? If this type is an unnamed subrange type of an integral or
11197      floating-point type, use the inner type.  This is because we have no
11198      support for unnamed types in base_type_die.  This can happen if this is
11199      an Ada subrange type.  Correct solution is emit a subrange type die.  */
11200   if ((code == INTEGER_TYPE || code == REAL_TYPE)
11201       && TREE_TYPE (type) != 0 && TYPE_NAME (type) == 0)
11202     type = TREE_TYPE (type), code = TREE_CODE (type);
11203 
11204   if (code == ERROR_MARK
11205       /* Handle a special case.  For functions whose return type is void, we
11206 	 generate *no* type attribute.  (Note that no object may have type
11207 	 `void', so this only applies to function return types).  */
11208       || code == VOID_TYPE)
11209     return;
11210 
11211   type_die = modified_type_die (type,
11212 				decl_const || TYPE_READONLY (type),
11213 				decl_volatile || TYPE_VOLATILE (type),
11214 				context_die);
11215 
11216   if (type_die != NULL)
11217     add_AT_die_ref (object_die, DW_AT_type, type_die);
11218 }
11219 
11220 /* Given an object die, add the calling convention attribute for the
11221    function call type.  */
11222 static void
add_calling_convention_attribute(dw_die_ref subr_die,tree type)11223 add_calling_convention_attribute (dw_die_ref subr_die, tree type)
11224 {
11225   enum dwarf_calling_convention value = DW_CC_normal;
11226 
11227   value = targetm.dwarf_calling_convention (type);
11228 
11229   /* Only add the attribute if the backend requests it, and
11230      is not DW_CC_normal.  */
11231   if (value && (value != DW_CC_normal))
11232     add_AT_unsigned (subr_die, DW_AT_calling_convention, value);
11233 }
11234 
11235 /* Given a tree pointer to a struct, class, union, or enum type node, return
11236    a pointer to the (string) tag name for the given type, or zero if the type
11237    was declared without a tag.  */
11238 
11239 static const char *
type_tag(tree type)11240 type_tag (tree type)
11241 {
11242   const char *name = 0;
11243 
11244   if (TYPE_NAME (type) != 0)
11245     {
11246       tree t = 0;
11247 
11248       /* Find the IDENTIFIER_NODE for the type name.  */
11249       if (TREE_CODE (TYPE_NAME (type)) == IDENTIFIER_NODE)
11250 	t = TYPE_NAME (type);
11251 
11252       /* The g++ front end makes the TYPE_NAME of *each* tagged type point to
11253 	 a TYPE_DECL node, regardless of whether or not a `typedef' was
11254 	 involved.  */
11255       else if (TREE_CODE (TYPE_NAME (type)) == TYPE_DECL
11256 	       && ! DECL_IGNORED_P (TYPE_NAME (type)))
11257 	t = DECL_NAME (TYPE_NAME (type));
11258 
11259       /* Now get the name as a string, or invent one.  */
11260       if (t != 0)
11261 	name = IDENTIFIER_POINTER (t);
11262     }
11263 
11264   return (name == 0 || *name == '\0') ? 0 : name;
11265 }
11266 
11267 /* Return the type associated with a data member, make a special check
11268    for bit field types.  */
11269 
11270 static inline tree
member_declared_type(tree member)11271 member_declared_type (tree member)
11272 {
11273   return (DECL_BIT_FIELD_TYPE (member)
11274 	  ? DECL_BIT_FIELD_TYPE (member) : TREE_TYPE (member));
11275 }
11276 
11277 /* Get the decl's label, as described by its RTL. This may be different
11278    from the DECL_NAME name used in the source file.  */
11279 
11280 #if 0
11281 static const char *
11282 decl_start_label (tree decl)
11283 {
11284   rtx x;
11285   const char *fnname;
11286 
11287   x = DECL_RTL (decl);
11288   gcc_assert (MEM_P (x));
11289 
11290   x = XEXP (x, 0);
11291   gcc_assert (GET_CODE (x) == SYMBOL_REF);
11292 
11293   fnname = XSTR (x, 0);
11294   return fnname;
11295 }
11296 #endif
11297 
11298 /* These routines generate the internal representation of the DIE's for
11299    the compilation unit.  Debugging information is collected by walking
11300    the declaration trees passed in from dwarf2out_decl().  */
11301 
11302 static void
gen_array_type_die(tree type,dw_die_ref context_die)11303 gen_array_type_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die)
11304 {
11305   dw_die_ref scope_die = scope_die_for (type, context_die);
11306   dw_die_ref array_die;
11307   tree element_type;
11308 
11309   /* ??? The SGI dwarf reader fails for array of array of enum types unless
11310      the inner array type comes before the outer array type.  Thus we must
11311      call gen_type_die before we call new_die.  See below also.  */
11312 #ifdef MIPS_DEBUGGING_INFO
11313   gen_type_die (TREE_TYPE (type), context_die);
11314 #endif
11315 
11316   array_die = new_die (DW_TAG_array_type, scope_die, type);
11317   add_name_attribute (array_die, type_tag (type));
11318   equate_type_number_to_die (type, array_die);
11319 
11320   if (TREE_CODE (type) == VECTOR_TYPE)
11321     {
11322       /* The frontend feeds us a representation for the vector as a struct
11323 	 containing an array.  Pull out the array type.  */
11324       type = TREE_TYPE (TYPE_FIELDS (TYPE_DEBUG_REPRESENTATION_TYPE (type)));
11325       add_AT_flag (array_die, DW_AT_GNU_vector, 1);
11326     }
11327 
11328 #if 0
11329   /* We default the array ordering.  SDB will probably do
11330      the right things even if DW_AT_ordering is not present.  It's not even
11331      an issue until we start to get into multidimensional arrays anyway.  If
11332      SDB is ever caught doing the Wrong Thing for multi-dimensional arrays,
11333      then we'll have to put the DW_AT_ordering attribute back in.  (But if
11334      and when we find out that we need to put these in, we will only do so
11335      for multidimensional arrays.  */
11336   add_AT_unsigned (array_die, DW_AT_ordering, DW_ORD_row_major);
11337 #endif
11338 
11339 #ifdef MIPS_DEBUGGING_INFO
11340   /* The SGI compilers handle arrays of unknown bound by setting
11341      AT_declaration and not emitting any subrange DIEs.  */
11342   if (! TYPE_DOMAIN (type))
11343     add_AT_flag (array_die, DW_AT_declaration, 1);
11344   else
11345 #endif
11346     add_subscript_info (array_die, type);
11347 
11348   /* Add representation of the type of the elements of this array type.  */
11349   element_type = TREE_TYPE (type);
11350 
11351   /* ??? The SGI dwarf reader fails for multidimensional arrays with a
11352      const enum type.  E.g. const enum machine_mode insn_operand_mode[2][10].
11353      We work around this by disabling this feature.  See also
11354      add_subscript_info.  */
11355 #ifndef MIPS_DEBUGGING_INFO
11356   while (TREE_CODE (element_type) == ARRAY_TYPE)
11357     element_type = TREE_TYPE (element_type);
11358 
11359   gen_type_die (element_type, context_die);
11360 #endif
11361 
11362   add_type_attribute (array_die, element_type, 0, 0, context_die);
11363 
11364   if (get_AT (array_die, DW_AT_name))
11365     add_pubtype (type, array_die);
11366 }
11367 
11368 #if 0
11369 static void
11370 gen_entry_point_die (tree decl, dw_die_ref context_die)
11371 {
11372   tree origin = decl_ultimate_origin (decl);
11373   dw_die_ref decl_die = new_die (DW_TAG_entry_point, context_die, decl);
11374 
11375   if (origin != NULL)
11376     add_abstract_origin_attribute (decl_die, origin);
11377   else
11378     {
11379       add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (decl_die, decl);
11380       add_type_attribute (decl_die, TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (decl)),
11381 			  0, 0, context_die);
11382     }
11383 
11384   if (DECL_ABSTRACT (decl))
11385     equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, decl_die);
11386   else
11387     add_AT_lbl_id (decl_die, DW_AT_low_pc, decl_start_label (decl));
11388 }
11389 #endif
11390 
11391 /* Walk through the list of incomplete types again, trying once more to
11392    emit full debugging info for them.  */
11393 
11394 static void
retry_incomplete_types(void)11395 retry_incomplete_types (void)
11396 {
11397   int i;
11398 
11399   for (i = VEC_length (tree, incomplete_types) - 1; i >= 0; i--)
11400     gen_type_die (VEC_index (tree, incomplete_types, i), comp_unit_die);
11401 }
11402 
11403 /* Generate a DIE to represent an inlined instance of an enumeration type.  */
11404 
11405 static void
gen_inlined_enumeration_type_die(tree type,dw_die_ref context_die)11406 gen_inlined_enumeration_type_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die)
11407 {
11408   dw_die_ref type_die = new_die (DW_TAG_enumeration_type, context_die, type);
11409 
11410   /* We do not check for TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type) being set, as the type may
11411      be incomplete and such types are not marked.  */
11412   add_abstract_origin_attribute (type_die, type);
11413 }
11414 
11415 /* Generate a DIE to represent an inlined instance of a structure type.  */
11416 
11417 static void
gen_inlined_structure_type_die(tree type,dw_die_ref context_die)11418 gen_inlined_structure_type_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die)
11419 {
11420   dw_die_ref type_die = new_die (DW_TAG_structure_type, context_die, type);
11421 
11422   /* We do not check for TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type) being set, as the type may
11423      be incomplete and such types are not marked.  */
11424   add_abstract_origin_attribute (type_die, type);
11425 }
11426 
11427 /* Generate a DIE to represent an inlined instance of a union type.  */
11428 
11429 static void
gen_inlined_union_type_die(tree type,dw_die_ref context_die)11430 gen_inlined_union_type_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die)
11431 {
11432   dw_die_ref type_die = new_die (DW_TAG_union_type, context_die, type);
11433 
11434   /* We do not check for TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type) being set, as the type may
11435      be incomplete and such types are not marked.  */
11436   add_abstract_origin_attribute (type_die, type);
11437 }
11438 
11439 /* Generate a DIE to represent an enumeration type.  Note that these DIEs
11440    include all of the information about the enumeration values also. Each
11441    enumerated type name/value is listed as a child of the enumerated type
11442    DIE.  */
11443 
11444 static dw_die_ref
gen_enumeration_type_die(tree type,dw_die_ref context_die)11445 gen_enumeration_type_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die)
11446 {
11447   dw_die_ref type_die = lookup_type_die (type);
11448 
11449   if (type_die == NULL)
11450     {
11451       type_die = new_die (DW_TAG_enumeration_type,
11452 			  scope_die_for (type, context_die), type);
11453       equate_type_number_to_die (type, type_die);
11454       add_name_attribute (type_die, type_tag (type));
11455     }
11456   else if (! TYPE_SIZE (type))
11457     return type_die;
11458   else
11459     remove_AT (type_die, DW_AT_declaration);
11460 
11461   /* Handle a GNU C/C++ extension, i.e. incomplete enum types.  If the
11462      given enum type is incomplete, do not generate the DW_AT_byte_size
11463      attribute or the DW_AT_element_list attribute.  */
11464   if (TYPE_SIZE (type))
11465     {
11466       tree link;
11467 
11468       TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type) = 1;
11469       add_byte_size_attribute (type_die, type);
11470       if (TYPE_STUB_DECL (type) != NULL_TREE)
11471 	add_src_coords_attributes (type_die, TYPE_STUB_DECL (type));
11472 
11473       /* If the first reference to this type was as the return type of an
11474 	 inline function, then it may not have a parent.  Fix this now.  */
11475       if (type_die->die_parent == NULL)
11476 	add_child_die (scope_die_for (type, context_die), type_die);
11477 
11478       for (link = TYPE_VALUES (type);
11479 	   link != NULL; link = TREE_CHAIN (link))
11480 	{
11481 	  dw_die_ref enum_die = new_die (DW_TAG_enumerator, type_die, link);
11482 	  tree value = TREE_VALUE (link);
11483 
11484 	  add_name_attribute (enum_die,
11485 			      IDENTIFIER_POINTER (TREE_PURPOSE (link)));
11486 
11487 	  if (host_integerp (value, TYPE_UNSIGNED (TREE_TYPE (value))))
11488 	    /* DWARF2 does not provide a way of indicating whether or
11489 	       not enumeration constants are signed or unsigned.  GDB
11490 	       always assumes the values are signed, so we output all
11491 	       values as if they were signed.  That means that
11492 	       enumeration constants with very large unsigned values
11493 	       will appear to have negative values in the debugger.  */
11494 	    add_AT_int (enum_die, DW_AT_const_value,
11495 			tree_low_cst (value, tree_int_cst_sgn (value) > 0));
11496 	}
11497     }
11498   else
11499     add_AT_flag (type_die, DW_AT_declaration, 1);
11500 
11501   if (get_AT (type_die, DW_AT_name))
11502     add_pubtype (type, type_die);
11503 
11504   return type_die;
11505 }
11506 
11507 /* Generate a DIE to represent either a real live formal parameter decl or to
11508    represent just the type of some formal parameter position in some function
11509    type.
11510 
11511    Note that this routine is a bit unusual because its argument may be a
11512    ..._DECL node (i.e. either a PARM_DECL or perhaps a VAR_DECL which
11513    represents an inlining of some PARM_DECL) or else some sort of a ..._TYPE
11514    node.  If it's the former then this function is being called to output a
11515    DIE to represent a formal parameter object (or some inlining thereof).  If
11516    it's the latter, then this function is only being called to output a
11517    DW_TAG_formal_parameter DIE to stand as a placeholder for some formal
11518    argument type of some subprogram type.  */
11519 
11520 static dw_die_ref
gen_formal_parameter_die(tree node,dw_die_ref context_die)11521 gen_formal_parameter_die (tree node, dw_die_ref context_die)
11522 {
11523   dw_die_ref parm_die
11524     = new_die (DW_TAG_formal_parameter, context_die, node);
11525   tree origin;
11526 
11527   switch (TREE_CODE_CLASS (TREE_CODE (node)))
11528     {
11529     case tcc_declaration:
11530       origin = decl_ultimate_origin (node);
11531       if (origin != NULL)
11532 	add_abstract_origin_attribute (parm_die, origin);
11533       else
11534 	{
11535 	  add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (parm_die, node);
11536 	  add_type_attribute (parm_die, TREE_TYPE (node),
11537 			      TREE_READONLY (node),
11538 			      TREE_THIS_VOLATILE (node),
11539 			      context_die);
11540 	  if (DECL_ARTIFICIAL (node))
11541 	    add_AT_flag (parm_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
11542 	}
11543 
11544       equate_decl_number_to_die (node, parm_die);
11545       if (! DECL_ABSTRACT (node))
11546 	add_location_or_const_value_attribute (parm_die, node, DW_AT_location);
11547 
11548       break;
11549 
11550     case tcc_type:
11551       /* We were called with some kind of a ..._TYPE node.  */
11552       add_type_attribute (parm_die, node, 0, 0, context_die);
11553       break;
11554 
11555     default:
11556       gcc_unreachable ();
11557     }
11558 
11559   return parm_die;
11560 }
11561 
11562 /* Generate a special type of DIE used as a stand-in for a trailing ellipsis
11563    at the end of an (ANSI prototyped) formal parameters list.  */
11564 
11565 static void
gen_unspecified_parameters_die(tree decl_or_type,dw_die_ref context_die)11566 gen_unspecified_parameters_die (tree decl_or_type, dw_die_ref context_die)
11567 {
11568   new_die (DW_TAG_unspecified_parameters, context_die, decl_or_type);
11569 }
11570 
11571 /* Generate a list of nameless DW_TAG_formal_parameter DIEs (and perhaps a
11572    DW_TAG_unspecified_parameters DIE) to represent the types of the formal
11573    parameters as specified in some function type specification (except for
11574    those which appear as part of a function *definition*).  */
11575 
11576 static void
gen_formal_types_die(tree function_or_method_type,dw_die_ref context_die)11577 gen_formal_types_die (tree function_or_method_type, dw_die_ref context_die)
11578 {
11579   tree link;
11580   tree formal_type = NULL;
11581   tree first_parm_type;
11582   tree arg;
11583 
11584   if (TREE_CODE (function_or_method_type) == FUNCTION_DECL)
11585     {
11586       arg = DECL_ARGUMENTS (function_or_method_type);
11587       function_or_method_type = TREE_TYPE (function_or_method_type);
11588     }
11589   else
11590     arg = NULL_TREE;
11591 
11592   first_parm_type = TYPE_ARG_TYPES (function_or_method_type);
11593 
11594   /* Make our first pass over the list of formal parameter types and output a
11595      DW_TAG_formal_parameter DIE for each one.  */
11596   for (link = first_parm_type; link; )
11597     {
11598       dw_die_ref parm_die;
11599 
11600       formal_type = TREE_VALUE (link);
11601       if (formal_type == void_type_node)
11602 	break;
11603 
11604       /* Output a (nameless) DIE to represent the formal parameter itself.  */
11605       parm_die = gen_formal_parameter_die (formal_type, context_die);
11606       if ((TREE_CODE (function_or_method_type) == METHOD_TYPE
11607 	   && link == first_parm_type)
11608 	  || (arg && DECL_ARTIFICIAL (arg)))
11609 	add_AT_flag (parm_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
11610 
11611       link = TREE_CHAIN (link);
11612       if (arg)
11613 	arg = TREE_CHAIN (arg);
11614     }
11615 
11616   /* If this function type has an ellipsis, add a
11617      DW_TAG_unspecified_parameters DIE to the end of the parameter list.  */
11618   if (formal_type != void_type_node)
11619     gen_unspecified_parameters_die (function_or_method_type, context_die);
11620 
11621   /* Make our second (and final) pass over the list of formal parameter types
11622      and output DIEs to represent those types (as necessary).  */
11623   for (link = TYPE_ARG_TYPES (function_or_method_type);
11624        link && TREE_VALUE (link);
11625        link = TREE_CHAIN (link))
11626     gen_type_die (TREE_VALUE (link), context_die);
11627 }
11628 
11629 /* We want to generate the DIE for TYPE so that we can generate the
11630    die for MEMBER, which has been defined; we will need to refer back
11631    to the member declaration nested within TYPE.  If we're trying to
11632    generate minimal debug info for TYPE, processing TYPE won't do the
11633    trick; we need to attach the member declaration by hand.  */
11634 
11635 static void
gen_type_die_for_member(tree type,tree member,dw_die_ref context_die)11636 gen_type_die_for_member (tree type, tree member, dw_die_ref context_die)
11637 {
11638   gen_type_die (type, context_die);
11639 
11640   /* If we're trying to avoid duplicate debug info, we may not have
11641      emitted the member decl for this function.  Emit it now.  */
11642   if (TYPE_DECL_SUPPRESS_DEBUG (TYPE_STUB_DECL (type))
11643       && ! lookup_decl_die (member))
11644     {
11645       dw_die_ref type_die;
11646       gcc_assert (!decl_ultimate_origin (member));
11647 
11648       push_decl_scope (type);
11649       type_die = lookup_type_die (type);
11650       if (TREE_CODE (member) == FUNCTION_DECL)
11651 	gen_subprogram_die (member, type_die);
11652       else if (TREE_CODE (member) == FIELD_DECL)
11653 	{
11654 	  /* Ignore the nameless fields that are used to skip bits but handle
11655 	     C++ anonymous unions and structs.  */
11656 	  if (DECL_NAME (member) != NULL_TREE
11657 	      || TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (member)) == UNION_TYPE
11658 	      || TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (member)) == RECORD_TYPE)
11659 	    {
11660 	      gen_type_die (member_declared_type (member), type_die);
11661 	      gen_field_die (member, type_die);
11662 	    }
11663 	}
11664       else
11665 	gen_variable_die (member, type_die);
11666 
11667       pop_decl_scope ();
11668     }
11669 }
11670 
11671 /* Generate the DWARF2 info for the "abstract" instance of a function which we
11672    may later generate inlined and/or out-of-line instances of.  */
11673 
11674 static void
dwarf2out_abstract_function(tree decl)11675 dwarf2out_abstract_function (tree decl)
11676 {
11677   dw_die_ref old_die;
11678   tree save_fn;
11679   struct function *save_cfun;
11680   tree context;
11681   int was_abstract = DECL_ABSTRACT (decl);
11682 
11683   /* Make sure we have the actual abstract inline, not a clone.  */
11684   decl = DECL_ORIGIN (decl);
11685 
11686   old_die = lookup_decl_die (decl);
11687   if (old_die && get_AT (old_die, DW_AT_inline))
11688     /* We've already generated the abstract instance.  */
11689     return;
11690 
11691   /* Be sure we've emitted the in-class declaration DIE (if any) first, so
11692      we don't get confused by DECL_ABSTRACT.  */
11693   if (debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
11694     {
11695       context = decl_class_context (decl);
11696       if (context)
11697 	gen_type_die_for_member
11698 	  (context, decl, decl_function_context (decl) ? NULL : comp_unit_die);
11699     }
11700 
11701   /* Pretend we've just finished compiling this function.  */
11702   save_fn = current_function_decl;
11703   save_cfun = cfun;
11704   current_function_decl = decl;
11705   cfun = DECL_STRUCT_FUNCTION (decl);
11706 
11707   set_decl_abstract_flags (decl, 1);
11708   dwarf2out_decl (decl);
11709   if (! was_abstract)
11710     set_decl_abstract_flags (decl, 0);
11711 
11712   current_function_decl = save_fn;
11713   cfun = save_cfun;
11714 }
11715 
11716 /* Helper function of premark_used_types() which gets called through
11717    htab_traverse_resize().
11718 
11719    Marks the DIE of a given type in *SLOT as perennial, so it never gets
11720    marked as unused by prune_unused_types.  */
11721 static int
premark_used_types_helper(void ** slot,void * data ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)11722 premark_used_types_helper (void **slot, void *data ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
11723 {
11724   tree type;
11725   dw_die_ref die;
11726 
11727   type = *slot;
11728   die = lookup_type_die (type);
11729   if (die != NULL)
11730     die->die_perennial_p = 1;
11731   return 1;
11732 }
11733 
11734 /* Mark all members of used_types_hash as perennial.  */
11735 static void
premark_used_types(void)11736 premark_used_types (void)
11737 {
11738   if (cfun && cfun->used_types_hash)
11739     htab_traverse (cfun->used_types_hash, premark_used_types_helper, NULL);
11740 }
11741 
11742 /* Generate a DIE to represent a declared function (either file-scope or
11743    block-local).  */
11744 
11745 static void
gen_subprogram_die(tree decl,dw_die_ref context_die)11746 gen_subprogram_die (tree decl, dw_die_ref context_die)
11747 {
11748   char label_id[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
11749   tree origin = decl_ultimate_origin (decl);
11750   dw_die_ref subr_die;
11751   tree fn_arg_types;
11752   tree outer_scope;
11753   dw_die_ref old_die = lookup_decl_die (decl);
11754   int declaration = (current_function_decl != decl
11755 		     || class_or_namespace_scope_p (context_die));
11756 
11757   premark_used_types ();
11758 
11759   /* It is possible to have both DECL_ABSTRACT and DECLARATION be true if we
11760      started to generate the abstract instance of an inline, decided to output
11761      its containing class, and proceeded to emit the declaration of the inline
11762      from the member list for the class.  If so, DECLARATION takes priority;
11763      we'll get back to the abstract instance when done with the class.  */
11764 
11765   /* The class-scope declaration DIE must be the primary DIE.  */
11766   if (origin && declaration && class_or_namespace_scope_p (context_die))
11767     {
11768       origin = NULL;
11769       gcc_assert (!old_die);
11770     }
11771 
11772   /* Now that the C++ front end lazily declares artificial member fns, we
11773      might need to retrofit the declaration into its class.  */
11774   if (!declaration && !origin && !old_die
11775       && DECL_CONTEXT (decl) && TYPE_P (DECL_CONTEXT (decl))
11776       && !class_or_namespace_scope_p (context_die)
11777       && debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
11778     old_die = force_decl_die (decl);
11779 
11780   if (origin != NULL)
11781     {
11782       gcc_assert (!declaration || local_scope_p (context_die));
11783 
11784       /* Fixup die_parent for the abstract instance of a nested
11785 	 inline function.  */
11786       if (old_die && old_die->die_parent == NULL)
11787 	add_child_die (context_die, old_die);
11788 
11789       subr_die = new_die (DW_TAG_subprogram, context_die, decl);
11790       add_abstract_origin_attribute (subr_die, origin);
11791     }
11792   else if (old_die)
11793     {
11794       expanded_location s = expand_location (DECL_SOURCE_LOCATION (decl));
11795       struct dwarf_file_data * file_index = lookup_filename (s.file);
11796 
11797       if (!get_AT_flag (old_die, DW_AT_declaration)
11798 	  /* We can have a normal definition following an inline one in the
11799 	     case of redefinition of GNU C extern inlines.
11800 	     It seems reasonable to use AT_specification in this case.  */
11801 	  && !get_AT (old_die, DW_AT_inline))
11802 	{
11803 	  /* Detect and ignore this case, where we are trying to output
11804 	     something we have already output.  */
11805 	  return;
11806 	}
11807 
11808       /* If the definition comes from the same place as the declaration,
11809 	 maybe use the old DIE.  We always want the DIE for this function
11810 	 that has the *_pc attributes to be under comp_unit_die so the
11811 	 debugger can find it.  We also need to do this for abstract
11812 	 instances of inlines, since the spec requires the out-of-line copy
11813 	 to have the same parent.  For local class methods, this doesn't
11814 	 apply; we just use the old DIE.  */
11815       if ((old_die->die_parent == comp_unit_die || context_die == NULL)
11816 	  && (DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl)
11817 	      || (get_AT_file (old_die, DW_AT_decl_file) == file_index
11818 		  && (get_AT_unsigned (old_die, DW_AT_decl_line)
11819 		      == (unsigned) s.line))))
11820 	{
11821 	  subr_die = old_die;
11822 
11823 	  /* Clear out the declaration attribute and the formal parameters.
11824 	     Do not remove all children, because it is possible that this
11825 	     declaration die was forced using force_decl_die(). In such
11826 	     cases die that forced declaration die (e.g. TAG_imported_module)
11827 	     is one of the children that we do not want to remove.  */
11828 	  remove_AT (subr_die, DW_AT_declaration);
11829 	  remove_child_TAG (subr_die, DW_TAG_formal_parameter);
11830 	}
11831       else
11832 	{
11833 	  subr_die = new_die (DW_TAG_subprogram, context_die, decl);
11834 	  add_AT_specification (subr_die, old_die);
11835 	  if (get_AT_file (old_die, DW_AT_decl_file) != file_index)
11836 	    add_AT_file (subr_die, DW_AT_decl_file, file_index);
11837 	  if (get_AT_unsigned (old_die, DW_AT_decl_line) != (unsigned) s.line)
11838 	    add_AT_unsigned (subr_die, DW_AT_decl_line, s.line);
11839 	}
11840     }
11841   else
11842     {
11843       subr_die = new_die (DW_TAG_subprogram, context_die, decl);
11844 
11845       if (TREE_PUBLIC (decl))
11846 	add_AT_flag (subr_die, DW_AT_external, 1);
11847 
11848       add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (subr_die, decl);
11849       if (debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
11850 	{
11851 	  add_prototyped_attribute (subr_die, TREE_TYPE (decl));
11852 	  add_type_attribute (subr_die, TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (decl)),
11853 			      0, 0, context_die);
11854 	}
11855 
11856       add_pure_or_virtual_attribute (subr_die, decl);
11857       if (DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl))
11858 	add_AT_flag (subr_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
11859 
11860       if (TREE_PROTECTED (decl))
11861 	add_AT_unsigned (subr_die, DW_AT_accessibility, DW_ACCESS_protected);
11862       else if (TREE_PRIVATE (decl))
11863 	add_AT_unsigned (subr_die, DW_AT_accessibility, DW_ACCESS_private);
11864     }
11865 
11866   if (declaration)
11867     {
11868       if (!old_die || !get_AT (old_die, DW_AT_inline))
11869 	{
11870 	  add_AT_flag (subr_die, DW_AT_declaration, 1);
11871 
11872 	  /* The first time we see a member function, it is in the context of
11873 	     the class to which it belongs.  We make sure of this by emitting
11874 	     the class first.  The next time is the definition, which is
11875 	     handled above.  The two may come from the same source text.
11876 
11877 	     Note that force_decl_die() forces function declaration die. It is
11878 	     later reused to represent definition.  */
11879 	  equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, subr_die);
11880 	}
11881     }
11882   else if (DECL_ABSTRACT (decl))
11883     {
11884       if (DECL_DECLARED_INLINE_P (decl))
11885 	{
11886           if (cgraph_function_possibly_inlined_p (decl))
11887 	    add_AT_unsigned (subr_die, DW_AT_inline, DW_INL_declared_inlined);
11888 	  else
11889 	    add_AT_unsigned (subr_die, DW_AT_inline, DW_INL_declared_not_inlined);
11890 	}
11891       else
11892 	{
11893 	  if (cgraph_function_possibly_inlined_p (decl))
11894             add_AT_unsigned (subr_die, DW_AT_inline, DW_INL_inlined);
11895 	  else
11896             add_AT_unsigned (subr_die, DW_AT_inline, DW_INL_not_inlined);
11897 	}
11898 
11899       equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, subr_die);
11900     }
11901   else if (!DECL_EXTERNAL (decl))
11902     {
11903       HOST_WIDE_INT cfa_fb_offset;
11904 
11905       if (!old_die || !get_AT (old_die, DW_AT_inline))
11906 	equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, subr_die);
11907 
11908       if (!flag_reorder_blocks_and_partition)
11909 	{
11910 	  ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label_id, FUNC_BEGIN_LABEL,
11911 				       current_function_funcdef_no);
11912 	  add_AT_lbl_id (subr_die, DW_AT_low_pc, label_id);
11913 	  ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label_id, FUNC_END_LABEL,
11914 				       current_function_funcdef_no);
11915 	  add_AT_lbl_id (subr_die, DW_AT_high_pc, label_id);
11916 
11917 	  add_pubname (decl, subr_die);
11918 	  add_arange (decl, subr_die);
11919 	}
11920       else
11921 	{  /* Do nothing for now; maybe need to duplicate die, one for
11922 	      hot section and ond for cold section, then use the hot/cold
11923 	      section begin/end labels to generate the aranges...  */
11924 	  /*
11925 	    add_AT_lbl_id (subr_die, DW_AT_low_pc, hot_section_label);
11926 	    add_AT_lbl_id (subr_die, DW_AT_high_pc, hot_section_end_label);
11927 	    add_AT_lbl_id (subr_die, DW_AT_lo_user, unlikely_section_label);
11928 	    add_AT_lbl_id (subr_die, DW_AT_hi_user, cold_section_end_label);
11929 
11930 	    add_pubname (decl, subr_die);
11931 	    add_arange (decl, subr_die);
11932 	    add_arange (decl, subr_die);
11933 	   */
11934 	}
11935 
11936 #ifdef MIPS_DEBUGGING_INFO
11937       /* Add a reference to the FDE for this routine.  */
11938       add_AT_fde_ref (subr_die, DW_AT_MIPS_fde, current_funcdef_fde);
11939 #endif
11940 
11941       cfa_fb_offset = CFA_FRAME_BASE_OFFSET (decl);
11942 
11943       /* We define the "frame base" as the function's CFA.  This is more
11944 	 convenient for several reasons: (1) It's stable across the prologue
11945 	 and epilogue, which makes it better than just a frame pointer,
11946 	 (2) With dwarf3, there exists a one-byte encoding that allows us
11947 	 to reference the .debug_frame data by proxy, but failing that,
11948 	 (3) We can at least reuse the code inspection and interpretation
11949 	 code that determines the CFA position at various points in the
11950 	 function.  */
11951       /* ??? Use some command-line or configury switch to enable the use
11952 	 of dwarf3 DW_OP_call_frame_cfa.  At present there are no dwarf
11953 	 consumers that understand it; fall back to "pure" dwarf2 and
11954 	 convert the CFA data into a location list.  */
11955       {
11956 	dw_loc_list_ref list = convert_cfa_to_fb_loc_list (cfa_fb_offset);
11957 	if (list->dw_loc_next)
11958 	  add_AT_loc_list (subr_die, DW_AT_frame_base, list);
11959 	else
11960 	  add_AT_loc (subr_die, DW_AT_frame_base, list->expr);
11961       }
11962 
11963       /* Compute a displacement from the "steady-state frame pointer" to
11964 	 the CFA.  The former is what all stack slots and argument slots
11965 	 will reference in the rtl; the later is what we've told the
11966 	 debugger about.  We'll need to adjust all frame_base references
11967 	 by this displacement.  */
11968       compute_frame_pointer_to_fb_displacement (cfa_fb_offset);
11969 
11970       if (cfun->static_chain_decl)
11971 	add_AT_location_description (subr_die, DW_AT_static_link,
11972 		 loc_descriptor_from_tree (cfun->static_chain_decl));
11973     }
11974 
11975   /* Now output descriptions of the arguments for this function. This gets
11976      (unnecessarily?) complex because of the fact that the DECL_ARGUMENT list
11977      for a FUNCTION_DECL doesn't indicate cases where there was a trailing
11978      `...' at the end of the formal parameter list.  In order to find out if
11979      there was a trailing ellipsis or not, we must instead look at the type
11980      associated with the FUNCTION_DECL.  This will be a node of type
11981      FUNCTION_TYPE. If the chain of type nodes hanging off of this
11982      FUNCTION_TYPE node ends with a void_type_node then there should *not* be
11983      an ellipsis at the end.  */
11984 
11985   /* In the case where we are describing a mere function declaration, all we
11986      need to do here (and all we *can* do here) is to describe the *types* of
11987      its formal parameters.  */
11988   if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
11989     ;
11990   else if (declaration)
11991     gen_formal_types_die (decl, subr_die);
11992   else
11993     {
11994       /* Generate DIEs to represent all known formal parameters.  */
11995       tree arg_decls = DECL_ARGUMENTS (decl);
11996       tree parm;
11997 
11998       /* When generating DIEs, generate the unspecified_parameters DIE
11999 	 instead if we come across the arg "__builtin_va_alist" */
12000       for (parm = arg_decls; parm; parm = TREE_CHAIN (parm))
12001 	if (TREE_CODE (parm) == PARM_DECL)
12002 	  {
12003 	    if (DECL_NAME (parm)
12004 		&& !strcmp (IDENTIFIER_POINTER (DECL_NAME (parm)),
12005 			    "__builtin_va_alist"))
12006 	      gen_unspecified_parameters_die (parm, subr_die);
12007 	    else
12008 	      gen_decl_die (parm, subr_die);
12009 	  }
12010 
12011       /* Decide whether we need an unspecified_parameters DIE at the end.
12012 	 There are 2 more cases to do this for: 1) the ansi ... declaration -
12013 	 this is detectable when the end of the arg list is not a
12014 	 void_type_node 2) an unprototyped function declaration (not a
12015 	 definition).  This just means that we have no info about the
12016 	 parameters at all.  */
12017       fn_arg_types = TYPE_ARG_TYPES (TREE_TYPE (decl));
12018       if (fn_arg_types != NULL)
12019 	{
12020 	  /* This is the prototyped case, check for....  */
12021 	  if (TREE_VALUE (tree_last (fn_arg_types)) != void_type_node)
12022 	    gen_unspecified_parameters_die (decl, subr_die);
12023 	}
12024       else if (DECL_INITIAL (decl) == NULL_TREE)
12025 	gen_unspecified_parameters_die (decl, subr_die);
12026     }
12027 
12028   /* Output Dwarf info for all of the stuff within the body of the function
12029      (if it has one - it may be just a declaration).  */
12030   outer_scope = DECL_INITIAL (decl);
12031 
12032   /* OUTER_SCOPE is a pointer to the outermost BLOCK node created to represent
12033      a function.  This BLOCK actually represents the outermost binding contour
12034      for the function, i.e. the contour in which the function's formal
12035      parameters and labels get declared. Curiously, it appears that the front
12036      end doesn't actually put the PARM_DECL nodes for the current function onto
12037      the BLOCK_VARS list for this outer scope, but are strung off of the
12038      DECL_ARGUMENTS list for the function instead.
12039 
12040      The BLOCK_VARS list for the `outer_scope' does provide us with a list of
12041      the LABEL_DECL nodes for the function however, and we output DWARF info
12042      for those in decls_for_scope.  Just within the `outer_scope' there will be
12043      a BLOCK node representing the function's outermost pair of curly braces,
12044      and any blocks used for the base and member initializers of a C++
12045      constructor function.  */
12046   if (! declaration && TREE_CODE (outer_scope) != ERROR_MARK)
12047     {
12048       /* Emit a DW_TAG_variable DIE for a named return value.  */
12049       if (DECL_NAME (DECL_RESULT (decl)))
12050 	gen_decl_die (DECL_RESULT (decl), subr_die);
12051 
12052       current_function_has_inlines = 0;
12053       decls_for_scope (outer_scope, subr_die, 0);
12054 
12055 #if 0 && defined (MIPS_DEBUGGING_INFO)
12056       if (current_function_has_inlines)
12057 	{
12058 	  add_AT_flag (subr_die, DW_AT_MIPS_has_inlines, 1);
12059 	  if (! comp_unit_has_inlines)
12060 	    {
12061 	      add_AT_flag (comp_unit_die, DW_AT_MIPS_has_inlines, 1);
12062 	      comp_unit_has_inlines = 1;
12063 	    }
12064 	}
12065 #endif
12066     }
12067   /* Add the calling convention attribute if requested.  */
12068   add_calling_convention_attribute (subr_die, TREE_TYPE (decl));
12069 
12070 }
12071 
12072 /* Generate a DIE to represent a declared data object.  */
12073 
12074 static void
gen_variable_die(tree decl,dw_die_ref context_die)12075 gen_variable_die (tree decl, dw_die_ref context_die)
12076 {
12077   tree origin = decl_ultimate_origin (decl);
12078   dw_die_ref var_die = new_die (DW_TAG_variable, context_die, decl);
12079 
12080   dw_die_ref old_die = lookup_decl_die (decl);
12081   int declaration = (DECL_EXTERNAL (decl)
12082 		     /* If DECL is COMDAT and has not actually been
12083 			emitted, we cannot take its address; there
12084 			might end up being no definition anywhere in
12085 			the program.  For example, consider the C++
12086 			test case:
12087 
12088                           template <class T>
12089                           struct S { static const int i = 7; };
12090 
12091                           template <class T>
12092                           const int S<T>::i;
12093 
12094                           int f() { return S<int>::i; }
12095 
12096 			Here, S<int>::i is not DECL_EXTERNAL, but no
12097 			definition is required, so the compiler will
12098 			not emit a definition.  */
12099 		     || (TREE_CODE (decl) == VAR_DECL
12100 			 && DECL_COMDAT (decl) && !TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (decl))
12101 		     || class_or_namespace_scope_p (context_die));
12102 
12103   if (origin != NULL)
12104     add_abstract_origin_attribute (var_die, origin);
12105 
12106   /* Loop unrolling can create multiple blocks that refer to the same
12107      static variable, so we must test for the DW_AT_declaration flag.
12108 
12109      ??? Loop unrolling/reorder_blocks should perhaps be rewritten to
12110      copy decls and set the DECL_ABSTRACT flag on them instead of
12111      sharing them.
12112 
12113      ??? Duplicated blocks have been rewritten to use .debug_ranges.
12114 
12115      ??? The declare_in_namespace support causes us to get two DIEs for one
12116      variable, both of which are declarations.  We want to avoid considering
12117      one to be a specification, so we must test that this DIE is not a
12118      declaration.  */
12119   else if (old_die && TREE_STATIC (decl) && ! declaration
12120 	   && get_AT_flag (old_die, DW_AT_declaration) == 1)
12121     {
12122       /* This is a definition of a C++ class level static.  */
12123       add_AT_specification (var_die, old_die);
12124       if (DECL_NAME (decl))
12125 	{
12126 	  expanded_location s = expand_location (DECL_SOURCE_LOCATION (decl));
12127 	  struct dwarf_file_data * file_index = lookup_filename (s.file);
12128 
12129 	  if (get_AT_file (old_die, DW_AT_decl_file) != file_index)
12130 	    add_AT_file (var_die, DW_AT_decl_file, file_index);
12131 
12132 	  if (get_AT_unsigned (old_die, DW_AT_decl_line) != (unsigned) s.line)
12133 
12134 	    add_AT_unsigned (var_die, DW_AT_decl_line, s.line);
12135 	}
12136     }
12137   else
12138     {
12139       add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (var_die, decl);
12140       add_type_attribute (var_die, TREE_TYPE (decl), TREE_READONLY (decl),
12141 			  TREE_THIS_VOLATILE (decl), context_die);
12142 
12143       if (TREE_PUBLIC (decl))
12144 	add_AT_flag (var_die, DW_AT_external, 1);
12145 
12146       if (DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl))
12147 	add_AT_flag (var_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
12148 
12149       if (TREE_PROTECTED (decl))
12150 	add_AT_unsigned (var_die, DW_AT_accessibility, DW_ACCESS_protected);
12151       else if (TREE_PRIVATE (decl))
12152 	add_AT_unsigned (var_die, DW_AT_accessibility, DW_ACCESS_private);
12153     }
12154 
12155   if (declaration)
12156     add_AT_flag (var_die, DW_AT_declaration, 1);
12157 
12158   if (DECL_ABSTRACT (decl) || declaration)
12159     equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, var_die);
12160 
12161   if (! declaration && ! DECL_ABSTRACT (decl))
12162     {
12163       add_location_or_const_value_attribute (var_die, decl, DW_AT_location);
12164       add_pubname (decl, var_die);
12165     }
12166   else
12167     tree_add_const_value_attribute (var_die, decl);
12168 }
12169 
12170 /* Generate a DIE to represent a label identifier.  */
12171 
12172 static void
gen_label_die(tree decl,dw_die_ref context_die)12173 gen_label_die (tree decl, dw_die_ref context_die)
12174 {
12175   tree origin = decl_ultimate_origin (decl);
12176   dw_die_ref lbl_die = new_die (DW_TAG_label, context_die, decl);
12177   rtx insn;
12178   char label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
12179 
12180   if (origin != NULL)
12181     add_abstract_origin_attribute (lbl_die, origin);
12182   else
12183     add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (lbl_die, decl);
12184 
12185   if (DECL_ABSTRACT (decl))
12186     equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, lbl_die);
12187   else
12188     {
12189       insn = DECL_RTL_IF_SET (decl);
12190 
12191       /* Deleted labels are programmer specified labels which have been
12192 	 eliminated because of various optimizations.  We still emit them
12193 	 here so that it is possible to put breakpoints on them.  */
12194       if (insn
12195 	  && (LABEL_P (insn)
12196 	      || ((NOTE_P (insn)
12197 	           && NOTE_LINE_NUMBER (insn) == NOTE_INSN_DELETED_LABEL))))
12198 	{
12199 	  /* When optimization is enabled (via -O) some parts of the compiler
12200 	     (e.g. jump.c and cse.c) may try to delete CODE_LABEL insns which
12201 	     represent source-level labels which were explicitly declared by
12202 	     the user.  This really shouldn't be happening though, so catch
12203 	     it if it ever does happen.  */
12204 	  gcc_assert (!INSN_DELETED_P (insn));
12205 
12206 	  ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, "L", CODE_LABEL_NUMBER (insn));
12207 	  add_AT_lbl_id (lbl_die, DW_AT_low_pc, label);
12208 	}
12209     }
12210 }
12211 
12212 /* A helper function for gen_inlined_subroutine_die.  Add source coordinate
12213    attributes to the DIE for a block STMT, to describe where the inlined
12214    function was called from.  This is similar to add_src_coords_attributes.  */
12215 
12216 static inline void
add_call_src_coords_attributes(tree stmt,dw_die_ref die)12217 add_call_src_coords_attributes (tree stmt, dw_die_ref die)
12218 {
12219   expanded_location s = expand_location (BLOCK_SOURCE_LOCATION (stmt));
12220 
12221   add_AT_file (die, DW_AT_call_file, lookup_filename (s.file));
12222   add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_call_line, s.line);
12223 }
12224 
12225 /* A helper function for gen_lexical_block_die and gen_inlined_subroutine_die.
12226    Add low_pc and high_pc attributes to the DIE for a block STMT.  */
12227 
12228 static inline void
add_high_low_attributes(tree stmt,dw_die_ref die)12229 add_high_low_attributes (tree stmt, dw_die_ref die)
12230 {
12231   char label[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
12232 
12233   if (BLOCK_FRAGMENT_CHAIN (stmt))
12234     {
12235       tree chain;
12236 
12237       add_AT_range_list (die, DW_AT_ranges, add_ranges (stmt));
12238 
12239       chain = BLOCK_FRAGMENT_CHAIN (stmt);
12240       do
12241 	{
12242 	  add_ranges (chain);
12243 	  chain = BLOCK_FRAGMENT_CHAIN (chain);
12244 	}
12245       while (chain);
12246       add_ranges (NULL);
12247     }
12248   else
12249     {
12250       ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, BLOCK_BEGIN_LABEL,
12251 				   BLOCK_NUMBER (stmt));
12252       add_AT_lbl_id (die, DW_AT_low_pc, label);
12253       ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (label, BLOCK_END_LABEL,
12254 				   BLOCK_NUMBER (stmt));
12255       add_AT_lbl_id (die, DW_AT_high_pc, label);
12256     }
12257 }
12258 
12259 /* Generate a DIE for a lexical block.  */
12260 
12261 static void
gen_lexical_block_die(tree stmt,dw_die_ref context_die,int depth)12262 gen_lexical_block_die (tree stmt, dw_die_ref context_die, int depth)
12263 {
12264   dw_die_ref stmt_die = new_die (DW_TAG_lexical_block, context_die, stmt);
12265 
12266   if (! BLOCK_ABSTRACT (stmt))
12267     add_high_low_attributes (stmt, stmt_die);
12268 
12269   decls_for_scope (stmt, stmt_die, depth);
12270 }
12271 
12272 /* Generate a DIE for an inlined subprogram.  */
12273 
12274 static void
gen_inlined_subroutine_die(tree stmt,dw_die_ref context_die,int depth)12275 gen_inlined_subroutine_die (tree stmt, dw_die_ref context_die, int depth)
12276 {
12277   tree decl = block_ultimate_origin (stmt);
12278 
12279   /* Emit info for the abstract instance first, if we haven't yet.  We
12280      must emit this even if the block is abstract, otherwise when we
12281      emit the block below (or elsewhere), we may end up trying to emit
12282      a die whose origin die hasn't been emitted, and crashing.  */
12283   dwarf2out_abstract_function (decl);
12284 
12285   if (! BLOCK_ABSTRACT (stmt))
12286     {
12287       dw_die_ref subr_die
12288 	= new_die (DW_TAG_inlined_subroutine, context_die, stmt);
12289 
12290       add_abstract_origin_attribute (subr_die, decl);
12291       add_high_low_attributes (stmt, subr_die);
12292       add_call_src_coords_attributes (stmt, subr_die);
12293 
12294       decls_for_scope (stmt, subr_die, depth);
12295       current_function_has_inlines = 1;
12296     }
12297   else
12298     /* We may get here if we're the outer block of function A that was
12299        inlined into function B that was inlined into function C.  When
12300        generating debugging info for C, dwarf2out_abstract_function(B)
12301        would mark all inlined blocks as abstract, including this one.
12302        So, we wouldn't (and shouldn't) expect labels to be generated
12303        for this one.  Instead, just emit debugging info for
12304        declarations within the block.  This is particularly important
12305        in the case of initializers of arguments passed from B to us:
12306        if they're statement expressions containing declarations, we
12307        wouldn't generate dies for their abstract variables, and then,
12308        when generating dies for the real variables, we'd die (pun
12309        intended :-)  */
12310     gen_lexical_block_die (stmt, context_die, depth);
12311 }
12312 
12313 /* Generate a DIE for a field in a record, or structure.  */
12314 
12315 static void
gen_field_die(tree decl,dw_die_ref context_die)12316 gen_field_die (tree decl, dw_die_ref context_die)
12317 {
12318   dw_die_ref decl_die;
12319 
12320   if (TREE_TYPE (decl) == error_mark_node)
12321     return;
12322 
12323   decl_die = new_die (DW_TAG_member, context_die, decl);
12324   add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (decl_die, decl);
12325   add_type_attribute (decl_die, member_declared_type (decl),
12326 		      TREE_READONLY (decl), TREE_THIS_VOLATILE (decl),
12327 		      context_die);
12328 
12329   if (DECL_BIT_FIELD_TYPE (decl))
12330     {
12331       add_byte_size_attribute (decl_die, decl);
12332       add_bit_size_attribute (decl_die, decl);
12333       add_bit_offset_attribute (decl_die, decl);
12334     }
12335 
12336   if (TREE_CODE (DECL_FIELD_CONTEXT (decl)) != UNION_TYPE)
12337     add_data_member_location_attribute (decl_die, decl);
12338 
12339   if (DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl))
12340     add_AT_flag (decl_die, DW_AT_artificial, 1);
12341 
12342   if (TREE_PROTECTED (decl))
12343     add_AT_unsigned (decl_die, DW_AT_accessibility, DW_ACCESS_protected);
12344   else if (TREE_PRIVATE (decl))
12345     add_AT_unsigned (decl_die, DW_AT_accessibility, DW_ACCESS_private);
12346 
12347   /* Equate decl number to die, so that we can look up this decl later on.  */
12348   equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, decl_die);
12349 }
12350 
12351 #if 0
12352 /* Don't generate either pointer_type DIEs or reference_type DIEs here.
12353    Use modified_type_die instead.
12354    We keep this code here just in case these types of DIEs may be needed to
12355    represent certain things in other languages (e.g. Pascal) someday.  */
12356 
12357 static void
12358 gen_pointer_type_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die)
12359 {
12360   dw_die_ref ptr_die
12361     = new_die (DW_TAG_pointer_type, scope_die_for (type, context_die), type);
12362 
12363   equate_type_number_to_die (type, ptr_die);
12364   add_type_attribute (ptr_die, TREE_TYPE (type), 0, 0, context_die);
12365   add_AT_unsigned (mod_type_die, DW_AT_byte_size, PTR_SIZE);
12366 }
12367 
12368 /* Don't generate either pointer_type DIEs or reference_type DIEs here.
12369    Use modified_type_die instead.
12370    We keep this code here just in case these types of DIEs may be needed to
12371    represent certain things in other languages (e.g. Pascal) someday.  */
12372 
12373 static void
12374 gen_reference_type_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die)
12375 {
12376   dw_die_ref ref_die
12377     = new_die (DW_TAG_reference_type, scope_die_for (type, context_die), type);
12378 
12379   equate_type_number_to_die (type, ref_die);
12380   add_type_attribute (ref_die, TREE_TYPE (type), 0, 0, context_die);
12381   add_AT_unsigned (mod_type_die, DW_AT_byte_size, PTR_SIZE);
12382 }
12383 #endif
12384 
12385 /* Generate a DIE for a pointer to a member type.  */
12386 
12387 static void
gen_ptr_to_mbr_type_die(tree type,dw_die_ref context_die)12388 gen_ptr_to_mbr_type_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die)
12389 {
12390   dw_die_ref ptr_die
12391     = new_die (DW_TAG_ptr_to_member_type,
12392 	       scope_die_for (type, context_die), type);
12393 
12394   equate_type_number_to_die (type, ptr_die);
12395   add_AT_die_ref (ptr_die, DW_AT_containing_type,
12396 		  lookup_type_die (TYPE_OFFSET_BASETYPE (type)));
12397   add_type_attribute (ptr_die, TREE_TYPE (type), 0, 0, context_die);
12398 }
12399 
12400 /* Generate the DIE for the compilation unit.  */
12401 
12402 static dw_die_ref
gen_compile_unit_die(const char * filename)12403 gen_compile_unit_die (const char *filename)
12404 {
12405   dw_die_ref die;
12406   char producer[250];
12407   const char *language_string = lang_hooks.name;
12408   int language;
12409 
12410   die = new_die (DW_TAG_compile_unit, NULL, NULL);
12411 
12412   if (filename)
12413     {
12414       add_name_attribute (die, filename);
12415       /* Don't add cwd for <built-in>.  */
12416       if (filename[0] != DIR_SEPARATOR && filename[0] != '<')
12417 	add_comp_dir_attribute (die);
12418     }
12419 
12420   sprintf (producer, "%s %s", language_string, version_string);
12421 
12422 #ifdef MIPS_DEBUGGING_INFO
12423   /* The MIPS/SGI compilers place the 'cc' command line options in the producer
12424      string.  The SGI debugger looks for -g, -g1, -g2, or -g3; if they do
12425      not appear in the producer string, the debugger reaches the conclusion
12426      that the object file is stripped and has no debugging information.
12427      To get the MIPS/SGI debugger to believe that there is debugging
12428      information in the object file, we add a -g to the producer string.  */
12429   if (debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
12430     strcat (producer, " -g");
12431 #endif
12432 
12433   add_AT_string (die, DW_AT_producer, producer);
12434 
12435   if (strcmp (language_string, "GNU C++") == 0)
12436     language = DW_LANG_C_plus_plus;
12437   else if (strcmp (language_string, "GNU Ada") == 0)
12438     language = DW_LANG_Ada95;
12439   else if (strcmp (language_string, "GNU F77") == 0)
12440     language = DW_LANG_Fortran77;
12441   else if (strcmp (language_string, "GNU F95") == 0)
12442     language = DW_LANG_Fortran95;
12443   else if (strcmp (language_string, "GNU Pascal") == 0)
12444     language = DW_LANG_Pascal83;
12445   else if (strcmp (language_string, "GNU Java") == 0)
12446     language = DW_LANG_Java;
12447   else if (strcmp (language_string, "GNU Objective-C") == 0)
12448     language = DW_LANG_ObjC;
12449   else if (strcmp (language_string, "GNU Objective-C++") == 0)
12450     language = DW_LANG_ObjC_plus_plus;
12451   else
12452     language = DW_LANG_C89;
12453 
12454   add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_language, language);
12455   return die;
12456 }
12457 
12458 /* Generate the DIE for a base class.  */
12459 
12460 static void
gen_inheritance_die(tree binfo,tree access,dw_die_ref context_die)12461 gen_inheritance_die (tree binfo, tree access, dw_die_ref context_die)
12462 {
12463   dw_die_ref die = new_die (DW_TAG_inheritance, context_die, binfo);
12464 
12465   add_type_attribute (die, BINFO_TYPE (binfo), 0, 0, context_die);
12466   add_data_member_location_attribute (die, binfo);
12467 
12468   if (BINFO_VIRTUAL_P (binfo))
12469     add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_virtuality, DW_VIRTUALITY_virtual);
12470 
12471   if (access == access_public_node)
12472     add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_accessibility, DW_ACCESS_public);
12473   else if (access == access_protected_node)
12474     add_AT_unsigned (die, DW_AT_accessibility, DW_ACCESS_protected);
12475 }
12476 
12477 /* Generate a DIE for a class member.  */
12478 
12479 static void
gen_member_die(tree type,dw_die_ref context_die)12480 gen_member_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die)
12481 {
12482   tree member;
12483   tree binfo = TYPE_BINFO (type);
12484   dw_die_ref child;
12485 
12486   /* If this is not an incomplete type, output descriptions of each of its
12487      members. Note that as we output the DIEs necessary to represent the
12488      members of this record or union type, we will also be trying to output
12489      DIEs to represent the *types* of those members. However the `type'
12490      function (above) will specifically avoid generating type DIEs for member
12491      types *within* the list of member DIEs for this (containing) type except
12492      for those types (of members) which are explicitly marked as also being
12493      members of this (containing) type themselves.  The g++ front- end can
12494      force any given type to be treated as a member of some other (containing)
12495      type by setting the TYPE_CONTEXT of the given (member) type to point to
12496      the TREE node representing the appropriate (containing) type.  */
12497 
12498   /* First output info about the base classes.  */
12499   if (binfo)
12500     {
12501       VEC(tree,gc) *accesses = BINFO_BASE_ACCESSES (binfo);
12502       int i;
12503       tree base;
12504 
12505       for (i = 0; BINFO_BASE_ITERATE (binfo, i, base); i++)
12506 	gen_inheritance_die (base,
12507 			     (accesses ? VEC_index (tree, accesses, i)
12508 			      : access_public_node), context_die);
12509     }
12510 
12511   /* Now output info about the data members and type members.  */
12512   for (member = TYPE_FIELDS (type); member; member = TREE_CHAIN (member))
12513     {
12514       /* If we thought we were generating minimal debug info for TYPE
12515 	 and then changed our minds, some of the member declarations
12516 	 may have already been defined.  Don't define them again, but
12517 	 do put them in the right order.  */
12518 
12519       child = lookup_decl_die (member);
12520       if (child)
12521 	splice_child_die (context_die, child);
12522       else
12523 	gen_decl_die (member, context_die);
12524     }
12525 
12526   /* Now output info about the function members (if any).  */
12527   for (member = TYPE_METHODS (type); member; member = TREE_CHAIN (member))
12528     {
12529       /* Don't include clones in the member list.  */
12530       if (DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (member))
12531 	continue;
12532 
12533       child = lookup_decl_die (member);
12534       if (child)
12535 	splice_child_die (context_die, child);
12536       else
12537 	gen_decl_die (member, context_die);
12538     }
12539 }
12540 
12541 /* Generate a DIE for a structure or union type.  If TYPE_DECL_SUPPRESS_DEBUG
12542    is set, we pretend that the type was never defined, so we only get the
12543    member DIEs needed by later specification DIEs.  */
12544 
12545 static void
gen_struct_or_union_type_die(tree type,dw_die_ref context_die,enum debug_info_usage usage)12546 gen_struct_or_union_type_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die,
12547 				enum debug_info_usage usage)
12548 {
12549   dw_die_ref type_die = lookup_type_die (type);
12550   dw_die_ref scope_die = 0;
12551   int nested = 0;
12552   int complete = (TYPE_SIZE (type)
12553 		  && (! TYPE_STUB_DECL (type)
12554 		      || ! TYPE_DECL_SUPPRESS_DEBUG (TYPE_STUB_DECL (type))));
12555   int ns_decl = (context_die && context_die->die_tag == DW_TAG_namespace);
12556   complete = complete && should_emit_struct_debug (type, usage);
12557 
12558   if (type_die && ! complete)
12559     return;
12560 
12561   if (TYPE_CONTEXT (type) != NULL_TREE
12562       && (AGGREGATE_TYPE_P (TYPE_CONTEXT (type))
12563 	  || TREE_CODE (TYPE_CONTEXT (type)) == NAMESPACE_DECL))
12564     nested = 1;
12565 
12566   scope_die = scope_die_for (type, context_die);
12567 
12568   if (! type_die || (nested && scope_die == comp_unit_die))
12569     /* First occurrence of type or toplevel definition of nested class.  */
12570     {
12571       dw_die_ref old_die = type_die;
12572 
12573       type_die = new_die (TREE_CODE (type) == RECORD_TYPE
12574 			  ? DW_TAG_structure_type : DW_TAG_union_type,
12575 			  scope_die, type);
12576       equate_type_number_to_die (type, type_die);
12577       if (old_die)
12578 	add_AT_specification (type_die, old_die);
12579       else
12580 	add_name_attribute (type_die, type_tag (type));
12581       /* APPLE LOCAL begin radar 5811943 - Fix type of pointers to Blocks  */
12582       if (TYPE_BLOCK_IMPL_STRUCT (type))
12583 	add_AT_flag (type_die, DW_AT_APPLE_block, 1);
12584       /* APPLE LOCAL end radar 5811943 - Fix type of pointers to Blocks  */
12585      }
12586   else
12587     remove_AT (type_die, DW_AT_declaration);
12588 
12589   /* If this type has been completed, then give it a byte_size attribute and
12590      then give a list of members.  */
12591   if (complete && !ns_decl)
12592     {
12593       /* Prevent infinite recursion in cases where the type of some member of
12594 	 this type is expressed in terms of this type itself.  */
12595       TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type) = 1;
12596       add_byte_size_attribute (type_die, type);
12597       if (TYPE_STUB_DECL (type) != NULL_TREE)
12598 	add_src_coords_attributes (type_die, TYPE_STUB_DECL (type));
12599 
12600       /* If the first reference to this type was as the return type of an
12601 	 inline function, then it may not have a parent.  Fix this now.  */
12602       if (type_die->die_parent == NULL)
12603 	add_child_die (scope_die, type_die);
12604 
12605       push_decl_scope (type);
12606       gen_member_die (type, type_die);
12607       pop_decl_scope ();
12608 
12609       /* GNU extension: Record what type our vtable lives in.  */
12610       if (TYPE_VFIELD (type))
12611 	{
12612 	  tree vtype = DECL_FCONTEXT (TYPE_VFIELD (type));
12613 
12614 	  gen_type_die (vtype, context_die);
12615 	  add_AT_die_ref (type_die, DW_AT_containing_type,
12616 			  lookup_type_die (vtype));
12617 	}
12618     }
12619   else
12620     {
12621       add_AT_flag (type_die, DW_AT_declaration, 1);
12622 
12623       /* We don't need to do this for function-local types.  */
12624       if (TYPE_STUB_DECL (type)
12625 	  && ! decl_function_context (TYPE_STUB_DECL (type)))
12626 	VEC_safe_push (tree, gc, incomplete_types, type);
12627     }
12628 
12629   if (get_AT (type_die, DW_AT_name))
12630     add_pubtype (type, type_die);
12631 }
12632 
12633 /* Generate a DIE for a subroutine _type_.  */
12634 
12635 static void
gen_subroutine_type_die(tree type,dw_die_ref context_die)12636 gen_subroutine_type_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die)
12637 {
12638   tree return_type = TREE_TYPE (type);
12639   dw_die_ref subr_die
12640     = new_die (DW_TAG_subroutine_type,
12641 	       scope_die_for (type, context_die), type);
12642 
12643   equate_type_number_to_die (type, subr_die);
12644   add_prototyped_attribute (subr_die, type);
12645   add_type_attribute (subr_die, return_type, 0, 0, context_die);
12646   gen_formal_types_die (type, subr_die);
12647 
12648   if (get_AT (subr_die, DW_AT_name))
12649     add_pubtype (type, subr_die);
12650 }
12651 
12652 /* Generate a DIE for a type definition.  */
12653 
12654 static void
gen_typedef_die(tree decl,dw_die_ref context_die)12655 gen_typedef_die (tree decl, dw_die_ref context_die)
12656 {
12657   dw_die_ref type_die;
12658   tree origin;
12659 
12660   if (TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (decl))
12661     return;
12662 
12663   TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (decl) = 1;
12664   type_die = new_die (DW_TAG_typedef, context_die, decl);
12665   origin = decl_ultimate_origin (decl);
12666   if (origin != NULL)
12667     add_abstract_origin_attribute (type_die, origin);
12668   else
12669     {
12670       tree type;
12671 
12672       add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (type_die, decl);
12673       if (DECL_ORIGINAL_TYPE (decl))
12674 	{
12675 	  type = DECL_ORIGINAL_TYPE (decl);
12676 
12677 	  gcc_assert (type != TREE_TYPE (decl));
12678 	  equate_type_number_to_die (TREE_TYPE (decl), type_die);
12679 	}
12680       else
12681 	type = TREE_TYPE (decl);
12682 
12683       add_type_attribute (type_die, type, TREE_READONLY (decl),
12684 			  TREE_THIS_VOLATILE (decl), context_die);
12685     }
12686 
12687   if (DECL_ABSTRACT (decl))
12688     equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, type_die);
12689 
12690   if (get_AT (type_die, DW_AT_name))
12691     add_pubtype (decl, type_die);
12692 }
12693 
12694 /* Generate a type description DIE.  */
12695 
12696 static void
gen_type_die_with_usage(tree type,dw_die_ref context_die,enum debug_info_usage usage)12697 gen_type_die_with_usage (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die,
12698 				enum debug_info_usage usage)
12699 {
12700   int need_pop;
12701 
12702   if (type == NULL_TREE || type == error_mark_node)
12703     return;
12704 
12705   if (TYPE_NAME (type) && TREE_CODE (TYPE_NAME (type)) == TYPE_DECL
12706       && DECL_ORIGINAL_TYPE (TYPE_NAME (type)))
12707     {
12708       if (TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type))
12709 	return;
12710 
12711       /* Prevent broken recursion; we can't hand off to the same type.  */
12712       gcc_assert (DECL_ORIGINAL_TYPE (TYPE_NAME (type)) != type);
12713 
12714       TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type) = 1;
12715       gen_decl_die (TYPE_NAME (type), context_die);
12716       return;
12717     }
12718 
12719   /* We are going to output a DIE to represent the unqualified version
12720      of this type (i.e. without any const or volatile qualifiers) so
12721      get the main variant (i.e. the unqualified version) of this type
12722      now.  (Vectors are special because the debugging info is in the
12723      cloned type itself).  */
12724   if (TREE_CODE (type) != VECTOR_TYPE)
12725     type = type_main_variant (type);
12726 
12727   if (TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type))
12728     return;
12729 
12730   switch (TREE_CODE (type))
12731     {
12732     case ERROR_MARK:
12733       break;
12734 	/* APPLE LOCAL radar 5732232 - blocks */
12735     case BLOCK_POINTER_TYPE:
12736     case POINTER_TYPE:
12737     case REFERENCE_TYPE:
12738       /* We must set TREE_ASM_WRITTEN in case this is a recursive type.  This
12739 	 ensures that the gen_type_die recursion will terminate even if the
12740 	 type is recursive.  Recursive types are possible in Ada.  */
12741       /* ??? We could perhaps do this for all types before the switch
12742 	 statement.  */
12743       TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type) = 1;
12744 
12745       /* For these types, all that is required is that we output a DIE (or a
12746 	 set of DIEs) to represent the "basis" type.  */
12747       gen_type_die_with_usage (TREE_TYPE (type), context_die,
12748 				DINFO_USAGE_IND_USE);
12749       break;
12750 
12751     case OFFSET_TYPE:
12752       /* This code is used for C++ pointer-to-data-member types.
12753 	 Output a description of the relevant class type.  */
12754       gen_type_die_with_usage (TYPE_OFFSET_BASETYPE (type), context_die,
12755 					DINFO_USAGE_IND_USE);
12756 
12757       /* Output a description of the type of the object pointed to.  */
12758       gen_type_die_with_usage (TREE_TYPE (type), context_die,
12759 					DINFO_USAGE_IND_USE);
12760 
12761       /* Now output a DIE to represent this pointer-to-data-member type
12762 	 itself.  */
12763       gen_ptr_to_mbr_type_die (type, context_die);
12764       break;
12765 
12766     case FUNCTION_TYPE:
12767       /* Force out return type (in case it wasn't forced out already).  */
12768       gen_type_die_with_usage (TREE_TYPE (type), context_die,
12769 					DINFO_USAGE_DIR_USE);
12770       gen_subroutine_type_die (type, context_die);
12771       break;
12772 
12773     case METHOD_TYPE:
12774       /* Force out return type (in case it wasn't forced out already).  */
12775       gen_type_die_with_usage (TREE_TYPE (type), context_die,
12776 					DINFO_USAGE_DIR_USE);
12777       gen_subroutine_type_die (type, context_die);
12778       break;
12779 
12780     case ARRAY_TYPE:
12781       gen_array_type_die (type, context_die);
12782       break;
12783 
12784     case VECTOR_TYPE:
12785       gen_array_type_die (type, context_die);
12786       break;
12787 
12788     case ENUMERAL_TYPE:
12789     case RECORD_TYPE:
12790     case UNION_TYPE:
12791     case QUAL_UNION_TYPE:
12792       /* If this is a nested type whose containing class hasn't been written
12793 	 out yet, writing it out will cover this one, too.  This does not apply
12794 	 to instantiations of member class templates; they need to be added to
12795 	 the containing class as they are generated.  FIXME: This hurts the
12796 	 idea of combining type decls from multiple TUs, since we can't predict
12797 	 what set of template instantiations we'll get.  */
12798       if (TYPE_CONTEXT (type)
12799 	  && AGGREGATE_TYPE_P (TYPE_CONTEXT (type))
12800 	  && ! TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (TYPE_CONTEXT (type)))
12801 	{
12802 	  gen_type_die_with_usage (TYPE_CONTEXT (type), context_die, usage);
12803 
12804 	  if (TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type))
12805 	    return;
12806 
12807 	  /* If that failed, attach ourselves to the stub.  */
12808 	  push_decl_scope (TYPE_CONTEXT (type));
12809 	  context_die = lookup_type_die (TYPE_CONTEXT (type));
12810 	  need_pop = 1;
12811 	}
12812       else
12813 	{
12814 	  declare_in_namespace (type, context_die);
12815 	  need_pop = 0;
12816 	}
12817 
12818       if (TREE_CODE (type) == ENUMERAL_TYPE)
12819 	{
12820 	  /* This might have been written out by the call to
12821 	     declare_in_namespace.  */
12822 	  if (!TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type))
12823 	    gen_enumeration_type_die (type, context_die);
12824 	}
12825       else
12826 	gen_struct_or_union_type_die (type, context_die, usage);
12827 
12828       if (need_pop)
12829 	pop_decl_scope ();
12830 
12831       /* Don't set TREE_ASM_WRITTEN on an incomplete struct; we want to fix
12832 	 it up if it is ever completed.  gen_*_type_die will set it for us
12833 	 when appropriate.  */
12834       return;
12835 
12836     case VOID_TYPE:
12837     case INTEGER_TYPE:
12838     case REAL_TYPE:
12839     case COMPLEX_TYPE:
12840     case BOOLEAN_TYPE:
12841       /* No DIEs needed for fundamental types.  */
12842       break;
12843 
12844     case LANG_TYPE:
12845       /* No Dwarf representation currently defined.  */
12846       break;
12847 
12848     default:
12849       gcc_unreachable ();
12850     }
12851 
12852   TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type) = 1;
12853 }
12854 
12855 static void
gen_type_die(tree type,dw_die_ref context_die)12856 gen_type_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die)
12857 {
12858   gen_type_die_with_usage (type, context_die, DINFO_USAGE_DIR_USE);
12859 }
12860 
12861 /* Generate a DIE for a tagged type instantiation.  */
12862 
12863 static void
gen_tagged_type_instantiation_die(tree type,dw_die_ref context_die)12864 gen_tagged_type_instantiation_die (tree type, dw_die_ref context_die)
12865 {
12866   if (type == NULL_TREE || type == error_mark_node)
12867     return;
12868 
12869   /* We are going to output a DIE to represent the unqualified version of
12870      this type (i.e. without any const or volatile qualifiers) so make sure
12871      that we have the main variant (i.e. the unqualified version) of this
12872      type now.  */
12873   gcc_assert (type == type_main_variant (type));
12874 
12875   /* Do not check TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (type) as it may not be set if this is
12876      an instance of an unresolved type.  */
12877 
12878   switch (TREE_CODE (type))
12879     {
12880     case ERROR_MARK:
12881       break;
12882 
12883     case ENUMERAL_TYPE:
12884       gen_inlined_enumeration_type_die (type, context_die);
12885       break;
12886 
12887     case RECORD_TYPE:
12888       gen_inlined_structure_type_die (type, context_die);
12889       break;
12890 
12891     case UNION_TYPE:
12892     case QUAL_UNION_TYPE:
12893       gen_inlined_union_type_die (type, context_die);
12894       break;
12895 
12896     default:
12897       gcc_unreachable ();
12898     }
12899 }
12900 
12901 /* Generate a DW_TAG_lexical_block DIE followed by DIEs to represent all of the
12902    things which are local to the given block.  */
12903 
12904 static void
gen_block_die(tree stmt,dw_die_ref context_die,int depth)12905 gen_block_die (tree stmt, dw_die_ref context_die, int depth)
12906 {
12907   int must_output_die = 0;
12908   tree origin;
12909   tree decl;
12910   enum tree_code origin_code;
12911 
12912   /* Ignore blocks that are NULL.  */
12913   if (stmt == NULL_TREE)
12914     return;
12915 
12916   /* If the block is one fragment of a non-contiguous block, do not
12917      process the variables, since they will have been done by the
12918      origin block.  Do process subblocks.  */
12919   if (BLOCK_FRAGMENT_ORIGIN (stmt))
12920     {
12921       tree sub;
12922 
12923       for (sub = BLOCK_SUBBLOCKS (stmt); sub; sub = BLOCK_CHAIN (sub))
12924 	gen_block_die (sub, context_die, depth + 1);
12925 
12926       return;
12927     }
12928 
12929   /* Determine the "ultimate origin" of this block.  This block may be an
12930      inlined instance of an inlined instance of inline function, so we have
12931      to trace all of the way back through the origin chain to find out what
12932      sort of node actually served as the original seed for the creation of
12933      the current block.  */
12934   origin = block_ultimate_origin (stmt);
12935   origin_code = (origin != NULL) ? TREE_CODE (origin) : ERROR_MARK;
12936 
12937   /* Determine if we need to output any Dwarf DIEs at all to represent this
12938      block.  */
12939   if (origin_code == FUNCTION_DECL)
12940     /* The outer scopes for inlinings *must* always be represented.  We
12941        generate DW_TAG_inlined_subroutine DIEs for them.  (See below.) */
12942     must_output_die = 1;
12943   else
12944     {
12945       /* In the case where the current block represents an inlining of the
12946 	 "body block" of an inline function, we must *NOT* output any DIE for
12947 	 this block because we have already output a DIE to represent the whole
12948 	 inlined function scope and the "body block" of any function doesn't
12949 	 really represent a different scope according to ANSI C rules.  So we
12950 	 check here to make sure that this block does not represent a "body
12951 	 block inlining" before trying to set the MUST_OUTPUT_DIE flag.  */
12952       if (! is_body_block (origin ? origin : stmt))
12953 	{
12954 	  /* Determine if this block directly contains any "significant"
12955 	     local declarations which we will need to output DIEs for.  */
12956 	  if (debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
12957 	    /* We are not in terse mode so *any* local declaration counts
12958 	       as being a "significant" one.  */
12959 	    must_output_die = (BLOCK_VARS (stmt) != NULL
12960 			       && (TREE_USED (stmt)
12961 				   || TREE_ASM_WRITTEN (stmt)
12962 				   || BLOCK_ABSTRACT (stmt)));
12963 	  else
12964 	    /* We are in terse mode, so only local (nested) function
12965 	       definitions count as "significant" local declarations.  */
12966 	    for (decl = BLOCK_VARS (stmt);
12967 		 decl != NULL; decl = TREE_CHAIN (decl))
12968 	      if (TREE_CODE (decl) == FUNCTION_DECL
12969 		  && DECL_INITIAL (decl))
12970 		{
12971 		  must_output_die = 1;
12972 		  break;
12973 		}
12974 	}
12975     }
12976 
12977   /* It would be a waste of space to generate a Dwarf DW_TAG_lexical_block
12978      DIE for any block which contains no significant local declarations at
12979      all.  Rather, in such cases we just call `decls_for_scope' so that any
12980      needed Dwarf info for any sub-blocks will get properly generated. Note
12981      that in terse mode, our definition of what constitutes a "significant"
12982      local declaration gets restricted to include only inlined function
12983      instances and local (nested) function definitions.  */
12984   if (must_output_die)
12985     {
12986       if (origin_code == FUNCTION_DECL)
12987 	gen_inlined_subroutine_die (stmt, context_die, depth);
12988       else
12989 	gen_lexical_block_die (stmt, context_die, depth);
12990     }
12991   else
12992     decls_for_scope (stmt, context_die, depth);
12993 }
12994 
12995 /* Generate all of the decls declared within a given scope and (recursively)
12996    all of its sub-blocks.  */
12997 
12998 static void
decls_for_scope(tree stmt,dw_die_ref context_die,int depth)12999 decls_for_scope (tree stmt, dw_die_ref context_die, int depth)
13000 {
13001   tree decl;
13002   tree subblocks;
13003 
13004   /* Ignore NULL blocks.  */
13005   if (stmt == NULL_TREE)
13006     return;
13007 
13008   if (TREE_USED (stmt))
13009     {
13010       /* Output the DIEs to represent all of the data objects and typedefs
13011 	 declared directly within this block but not within any nested
13012 	 sub-blocks.  Also, nested function and tag DIEs have been
13013 	 generated with a parent of NULL; fix that up now.  */
13014       for (decl = BLOCK_VARS (stmt); decl != NULL; decl = TREE_CHAIN (decl))
13015 	{
13016 	  dw_die_ref die;
13017 
13018 	  if (TREE_CODE (decl) == FUNCTION_DECL)
13019 	    die = lookup_decl_die (decl);
13020 	  else if (TREE_CODE (decl) == TYPE_DECL && TYPE_DECL_IS_STUB (decl))
13021 	    die = lookup_type_die (TREE_TYPE (decl));
13022 	  else
13023 	    die = NULL;
13024 
13025 	  if (die != NULL && die->die_parent == NULL)
13026 	    add_child_die (context_die, die);
13027 	  /* Do not produce debug information for static variables since
13028 	     these might be optimized out.  We are called for these later
13029 	     in cgraph_varpool_analyze_pending_decls. */
13030 	  if (TREE_CODE (decl) == VAR_DECL && TREE_STATIC (decl))
13031 	    ;
13032 	  else
13033 	    gen_decl_die (decl, context_die);
13034 	}
13035     }
13036 
13037   /* If we're at -g1, we're not interested in subblocks.  */
13038   if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
13039     return;
13040 
13041   /* Output the DIEs to represent all sub-blocks (and the items declared
13042      therein) of this block.  */
13043   for (subblocks = BLOCK_SUBBLOCKS (stmt);
13044        subblocks != NULL;
13045        subblocks = BLOCK_CHAIN (subblocks))
13046     gen_block_die (subblocks, context_die, depth + 1);
13047 }
13048 
13049 /* Is this a typedef we can avoid emitting?  */
13050 
13051 static inline int
is_redundant_typedef(tree decl)13052 is_redundant_typedef (tree decl)
13053 {
13054   if (TYPE_DECL_IS_STUB (decl))
13055     return 1;
13056 
13057   if (DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl)
13058       && DECL_CONTEXT (decl)
13059       && is_tagged_type (DECL_CONTEXT (decl))
13060       && TREE_CODE (TYPE_NAME (DECL_CONTEXT (decl))) == TYPE_DECL
13061       && DECL_NAME (decl) == DECL_NAME (TYPE_NAME (DECL_CONTEXT (decl))))
13062     /* Also ignore the artificial member typedef for the class name.  */
13063     return 1;
13064 
13065   return 0;
13066 }
13067 
13068 /* Returns the DIE for decl.  A DIE will always be returned.  */
13069 
13070 static dw_die_ref
force_decl_die(tree decl)13071 force_decl_die (tree decl)
13072 {
13073   dw_die_ref decl_die;
13074   unsigned saved_external_flag;
13075   tree save_fn = NULL_TREE;
13076   decl_die = lookup_decl_die (decl);
13077   if (!decl_die)
13078     {
13079       dw_die_ref context_die;
13080       tree decl_context = DECL_CONTEXT (decl);
13081       if (decl_context)
13082 	{
13083 	  /* Find die that represents this context.  */
13084 	  if (TYPE_P (decl_context))
13085 	    context_die = force_type_die (decl_context);
13086 	  else
13087 	    context_die = force_decl_die (decl_context);
13088 	}
13089       else
13090 	context_die = comp_unit_die;
13091 
13092       decl_die = lookup_decl_die (decl);
13093       if (decl_die)
13094 	return decl_die;
13095 
13096       switch (TREE_CODE (decl))
13097 	{
13098 	case FUNCTION_DECL:
13099 	  /* Clear current_function_decl, so that gen_subprogram_die thinks
13100 	     that this is a declaration. At this point, we just want to force
13101 	     declaration die.  */
13102 	  save_fn = current_function_decl;
13103 	  current_function_decl = NULL_TREE;
13104 	  gen_subprogram_die (decl, context_die);
13105 	  current_function_decl = save_fn;
13106 	  break;
13107 
13108 	case VAR_DECL:
13109 	  /* Set external flag to force declaration die. Restore it after
13110 	   gen_decl_die() call.  */
13111 	  saved_external_flag = DECL_EXTERNAL (decl);
13112 	  DECL_EXTERNAL (decl) = 1;
13113 	  gen_decl_die (decl, context_die);
13114 	  DECL_EXTERNAL (decl) = saved_external_flag;
13115 	  break;
13116 
13117 	case NAMESPACE_DECL:
13118 	  dwarf2out_decl (decl);
13119 	  break;
13120 
13121 	default:
13122 	  gcc_unreachable ();
13123 	}
13124 
13125       /* We should be able to find the DIE now.  */
13126       if (!decl_die)
13127 	decl_die = lookup_decl_die (decl);
13128       gcc_assert (decl_die);
13129     }
13130 
13131   return decl_die;
13132 }
13133 
13134 /* Returns the DIE for TYPE, that must not be a base type.  A DIE is
13135    always returned.  */
13136 
13137 static dw_die_ref
force_type_die(tree type)13138 force_type_die (tree type)
13139 {
13140   dw_die_ref type_die;
13141 
13142   type_die = lookup_type_die (type);
13143   if (!type_die)
13144     {
13145       dw_die_ref context_die;
13146       if (TYPE_CONTEXT (type))
13147 	{
13148 	  if (TYPE_P (TYPE_CONTEXT (type)))
13149 	    context_die = force_type_die (TYPE_CONTEXT (type));
13150 	  else
13151 	    context_die = force_decl_die (TYPE_CONTEXT (type));
13152 	}
13153       else
13154 	context_die = comp_unit_die;
13155 
13156       type_die = lookup_type_die (type);
13157       if (type_die)
13158 	return type_die;
13159       gen_type_die (type, context_die);
13160       type_die = lookup_type_die (type);
13161       gcc_assert (type_die);
13162     }
13163   return type_die;
13164 }
13165 
13166 /* Force out any required namespaces to be able to output DECL,
13167    and return the new context_die for it, if it's changed.  */
13168 
13169 static dw_die_ref
setup_namespace_context(tree thing,dw_die_ref context_die)13170 setup_namespace_context (tree thing, dw_die_ref context_die)
13171 {
13172   tree context = (DECL_P (thing)
13173 		  ? DECL_CONTEXT (thing) : TYPE_CONTEXT (thing));
13174   if (context && TREE_CODE (context) == NAMESPACE_DECL)
13175     /* Force out the namespace.  */
13176     context_die = force_decl_die (context);
13177 
13178   return context_die;
13179 }
13180 
13181 /* Emit a declaration DIE for THING (which is either a DECL or a tagged
13182    type) within its namespace, if appropriate.
13183 
13184    For compatibility with older debuggers, namespace DIEs only contain
13185    declarations; all definitions are emitted at CU scope.  */
13186 
13187 static void
declare_in_namespace(tree thing,dw_die_ref context_die)13188 declare_in_namespace (tree thing, dw_die_ref context_die)
13189 {
13190   dw_die_ref ns_context;
13191 
13192   if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
13193     return;
13194 
13195   /* If this decl is from an inlined function, then don't try to emit it in its
13196      namespace, as we will get confused.  It would have already been emitted
13197      when the abstract instance of the inline function was emitted anyways.  */
13198   if (DECL_P (thing) && DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (thing))
13199     return;
13200 
13201   ns_context = setup_namespace_context (thing, context_die);
13202 
13203   if (ns_context != context_die)
13204     {
13205       if (DECL_P (thing))
13206 	gen_decl_die (thing, ns_context);
13207       else
13208 	gen_type_die (thing, ns_context);
13209     }
13210 }
13211 
13212 /* Generate a DIE for a namespace or namespace alias.  */
13213 
13214 static void
gen_namespace_die(tree decl)13215 gen_namespace_die (tree decl)
13216 {
13217   dw_die_ref context_die = setup_namespace_context (decl, comp_unit_die);
13218 
13219   /* Namespace aliases have a DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN of the namespace
13220      they are an alias of.  */
13221   if (DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (decl) == NULL)
13222     {
13223       /* Output a real namespace.  */
13224       dw_die_ref namespace_die
13225 	= new_die (DW_TAG_namespace, context_die, decl);
13226       add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (namespace_die, decl);
13227       equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, namespace_die);
13228     }
13229   else
13230     {
13231       /* Output a namespace alias.  */
13232 
13233       /* Force out the namespace we are an alias of, if necessary.  */
13234       dw_die_ref origin_die
13235 	= force_decl_die (DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (decl));
13236 
13237       /* Now create the namespace alias DIE.  */
13238       dw_die_ref namespace_die
13239 	= new_die (DW_TAG_imported_declaration, context_die, decl);
13240       add_name_and_src_coords_attributes (namespace_die, decl);
13241       add_AT_die_ref (namespace_die, DW_AT_import, origin_die);
13242       equate_decl_number_to_die (decl, namespace_die);
13243     }
13244 }
13245 
13246 /* Generate Dwarf debug information for a decl described by DECL.  */
13247 
13248 static void
gen_decl_die(tree decl,dw_die_ref context_die)13249 gen_decl_die (tree decl, dw_die_ref context_die)
13250 {
13251   tree origin;
13252 
13253   if (DECL_P (decl) && DECL_IGNORED_P (decl))
13254     return;
13255 
13256   switch (TREE_CODE (decl))
13257     {
13258     case ERROR_MARK:
13259       break;
13260 
13261     case CONST_DECL:
13262       /* The individual enumerators of an enum type get output when we output
13263 	 the Dwarf representation of the relevant enum type itself.  */
13264       break;
13265 
13266     case FUNCTION_DECL:
13267       /* Don't output any DIEs to represent mere function declarations,
13268 	 unless they are class members or explicit block externs.  */
13269       if (DECL_INITIAL (decl) == NULL_TREE && DECL_CONTEXT (decl) == NULL_TREE
13270 	  && (current_function_decl == NULL_TREE || DECL_ARTIFICIAL (decl)))
13271 	break;
13272 
13273 #if 0
13274       /* FIXME */
13275       /* This doesn't work because the C frontend sets DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN
13276 	 on local redeclarations of global functions.  That seems broken.  */
13277       if (current_function_decl != decl)
13278 	/* This is only a declaration.  */;
13279 #endif
13280 
13281       /* If we're emitting a clone, emit info for the abstract instance.  */
13282       if (DECL_ORIGIN (decl) != decl)
13283 	dwarf2out_abstract_function (DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN (decl));
13284 
13285       /* If we're emitting an out-of-line copy of an inline function,
13286 	 emit info for the abstract instance and set up to refer to it.  */
13287       else if (cgraph_function_possibly_inlined_p (decl)
13288 	       && ! DECL_ABSTRACT (decl)
13289 	       && ! class_or_namespace_scope_p (context_die)
13290 	       /* dwarf2out_abstract_function won't emit a die if this is just
13291 		  a declaration.  We must avoid setting DECL_ABSTRACT_ORIGIN in
13292 		  that case, because that works only if we have a die.  */
13293 	       && DECL_INITIAL (decl) != NULL_TREE)
13294 	{
13295 	  dwarf2out_abstract_function (decl);
13296 	  set_decl_origin_self (decl);
13297 	}
13298 
13299       /* Otherwise we're emitting the primary DIE for this decl.  */
13300       else if (debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
13301 	{
13302 	  /* Before we describe the FUNCTION_DECL itself, make sure that we
13303 	     have described its return type.  */
13304 	  gen_type_die (TREE_TYPE (TREE_TYPE (decl)), context_die);
13305 
13306 	  /* And its virtual context.  */
13307 	  if (DECL_VINDEX (decl) != NULL_TREE)
13308 	    gen_type_die (DECL_CONTEXT (decl), context_die);
13309 
13310 	  /* And its containing type.  */
13311 	  origin = decl_class_context (decl);
13312 	  if (origin != NULL_TREE)
13313 	    gen_type_die_for_member (origin, decl, context_die);
13314 
13315 	  /* And its containing namespace.  */
13316 	  declare_in_namespace (decl, context_die);
13317 	}
13318 
13319       /* Now output a DIE to represent the function itself.  */
13320       gen_subprogram_die (decl, context_die);
13321       break;
13322 
13323     case TYPE_DECL:
13324       /* If we are in terse mode, don't generate any DIEs to represent any
13325 	 actual typedefs.  */
13326       if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
13327 	break;
13328 
13329       /* In the special case of a TYPE_DECL node representing the declaration
13330 	 of some type tag, if the given TYPE_DECL is marked as having been
13331 	 instantiated from some other (original) TYPE_DECL node (e.g. one which
13332 	 was generated within the original definition of an inline function) we
13333 	 have to generate a special (abbreviated) DW_TAG_structure_type,
13334 	 DW_TAG_union_type, or DW_TAG_enumeration_type DIE here.  */
13335       if (TYPE_DECL_IS_STUB (decl) && decl_ultimate_origin (decl) != NULL_TREE
13336 	  && is_tagged_type (TREE_TYPE (decl)))
13337 	{
13338 	  gen_tagged_type_instantiation_die (TREE_TYPE (decl), context_die);
13339 	  break;
13340 	}
13341 
13342       if (is_redundant_typedef (decl))
13343 	gen_type_die (TREE_TYPE (decl), context_die);
13344       else
13345 	/* Output a DIE to represent the typedef itself.  */
13346 	gen_typedef_die (decl, context_die);
13347       break;
13348 
13349     case LABEL_DECL:
13350       if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_NORMAL)
13351 	gen_label_die (decl, context_die);
13352       break;
13353 
13354     case VAR_DECL:
13355     case RESULT_DECL:
13356       /* If we are in terse mode, don't generate any DIEs to represent any
13357 	 variable declarations or definitions.  */
13358       if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
13359 	break;
13360 
13361       /* Output any DIEs that are needed to specify the type of this data
13362 	 object.  */
13363       gen_type_die (TREE_TYPE (decl), context_die);
13364 
13365       /* And its containing type.  */
13366       origin = decl_class_context (decl);
13367       if (origin != NULL_TREE)
13368 	gen_type_die_for_member (origin, decl, context_die);
13369 
13370       /* And its containing namespace.  */
13371       declare_in_namespace (decl, context_die);
13372 
13373       /* Now output the DIE to represent the data object itself.  This gets
13374 	 complicated because of the possibility that the VAR_DECL really
13375 	 represents an inlined instance of a formal parameter for an inline
13376 	 function.  */
13377       origin = decl_ultimate_origin (decl);
13378       if (origin != NULL_TREE && TREE_CODE (origin) == PARM_DECL)
13379 	gen_formal_parameter_die (decl, context_die);
13380       else
13381 	gen_variable_die (decl, context_die);
13382       break;
13383 
13384     case FIELD_DECL:
13385       /* Ignore the nameless fields that are used to skip bits but handle C++
13386 	 anonymous unions and structs.  */
13387       if (DECL_NAME (decl) != NULL_TREE
13388 	  || TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (decl)) == UNION_TYPE
13389 	  || TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (decl)) == RECORD_TYPE)
13390 	{
13391 	  gen_type_die (member_declared_type (decl), context_die);
13392 	  gen_field_die (decl, context_die);
13393 	}
13394       break;
13395 
13396     case PARM_DECL:
13397       gen_type_die (TREE_TYPE (decl), context_die);
13398       gen_formal_parameter_die (decl, context_die);
13399       break;
13400 
13401     case NAMESPACE_DECL:
13402       gen_namespace_die (decl);
13403       break;
13404 
13405     default:
13406       /* Probably some frontend-internal decl.  Assume we don't care.  */
13407       gcc_assert ((int)TREE_CODE (decl) > NUM_TREE_CODES);
13408       break;
13409     }
13410 }
13411 
13412 /* Output debug information for global decl DECL.  Called from toplev.c after
13413    compilation proper has finished.  */
13414 
13415 static void
dwarf2out_global_decl(tree decl)13416 dwarf2out_global_decl (tree decl)
13417 {
13418   /* Output DWARF2 information for file-scope tentative data object
13419      declarations, file-scope (extern) function declarations (which had no
13420      corresponding body) and file-scope tagged type declarations and
13421      definitions which have not yet been forced out.  */
13422   if (TREE_CODE (decl) != FUNCTION_DECL || !DECL_INITIAL (decl))
13423     dwarf2out_decl (decl);
13424 }
13425 
13426 /* Output debug information for type decl DECL.  Called from toplev.c
13427    and from language front ends (to record built-in types).  */
13428 static void
dwarf2out_type_decl(tree decl,int local)13429 dwarf2out_type_decl (tree decl, int local)
13430 {
13431   if (!local)
13432     dwarf2out_decl (decl);
13433 }
13434 
13435 /* Output debug information for imported module or decl.  */
13436 
13437 static void
dwarf2out_imported_module_or_decl(tree decl,tree context)13438 dwarf2out_imported_module_or_decl (tree decl, tree context)
13439 {
13440   dw_die_ref imported_die, at_import_die;
13441   dw_die_ref scope_die;
13442   expanded_location xloc;
13443 
13444   if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
13445     return;
13446 
13447   gcc_assert (decl);
13448 
13449   /* To emit DW_TAG_imported_module or DW_TAG_imported_decl, we need two DIEs.
13450      We need decl DIE for reference and scope die. First, get DIE for the decl
13451      itself.  */
13452 
13453   /* Get the scope die for decl context. Use comp_unit_die for global module
13454      or decl. If die is not found for non globals, force new die.  */
13455   if (!context)
13456     scope_die = comp_unit_die;
13457   else if (TYPE_P (context))
13458     {
13459       if (!should_emit_struct_debug (context, DINFO_USAGE_DIR_USE))
13460 	return;
13461     scope_die = force_type_die (context);
13462     }
13463   else
13464     scope_die = force_decl_die (context);
13465 
13466   /* For TYPE_DECL or CONST_DECL, lookup TREE_TYPE.  */
13467   if (TREE_CODE (decl) == TYPE_DECL || TREE_CODE (decl) == CONST_DECL)
13468     {
13469       if (is_base_type (TREE_TYPE (decl)))
13470 	at_import_die = base_type_die (TREE_TYPE (decl));
13471       else
13472 	at_import_die = force_type_die (TREE_TYPE (decl));
13473     }
13474   else
13475     {
13476       at_import_die = lookup_decl_die (decl);
13477       if (!at_import_die)
13478 	{
13479 	  /* If we're trying to avoid duplicate debug info, we may not have
13480 	     emitted the member decl for this field.  Emit it now.  */
13481 	  if (TREE_CODE (decl) == FIELD_DECL)
13482 	    {
13483 	      tree type = DECL_CONTEXT (decl);
13484 	      dw_die_ref type_context_die;
13485 
13486 	      if (TYPE_CONTEXT (type))
13487 		if (TYPE_P (TYPE_CONTEXT (type)))
13488 		  {
13489 		    if (!should_emit_struct_debug (TYPE_CONTEXT (type),
13490 						   DINFO_USAGE_DIR_USE))
13491 		      return;
13492 		  type_context_die = force_type_die (TYPE_CONTEXT (type));
13493 		  }
13494 	      else
13495 		type_context_die = force_decl_die (TYPE_CONTEXT (type));
13496 	      else
13497 		type_context_die = comp_unit_die;
13498 	      gen_type_die_for_member (type, decl, type_context_die);
13499 	    }
13500 	  at_import_die = force_decl_die (decl);
13501 	}
13502     }
13503 
13504   /* OK, now we have DIEs for decl as well as scope. Emit imported die.  */
13505   if (TREE_CODE (decl) == NAMESPACE_DECL)
13506     imported_die = new_die (DW_TAG_imported_module, scope_die, context);
13507   else
13508     imported_die = new_die (DW_TAG_imported_declaration, scope_die, context);
13509 
13510   xloc = expand_location (input_location);
13511   add_AT_file (imported_die, DW_AT_decl_file, lookup_filename (xloc.file));
13512   add_AT_unsigned (imported_die, DW_AT_decl_line, xloc.line);
13513   add_AT_die_ref (imported_die, DW_AT_import, at_import_die);
13514 }
13515 
13516 /* Write the debugging output for DECL.  */
13517 
13518 void
dwarf2out_decl(tree decl)13519 dwarf2out_decl (tree decl)
13520 {
13521   dw_die_ref context_die = comp_unit_die;
13522 
13523   switch (TREE_CODE (decl))
13524     {
13525     case ERROR_MARK:
13526       return;
13527 
13528     case FUNCTION_DECL:
13529       /* What we would really like to do here is to filter out all mere
13530 	 file-scope declarations of file-scope functions which are never
13531 	 referenced later within this translation unit (and keep all of ones
13532 	 that *are* referenced later on) but we aren't clairvoyant, so we have
13533 	 no idea which functions will be referenced in the future (i.e. later
13534 	 on within the current translation unit). So here we just ignore all
13535 	 file-scope function declarations which are not also definitions.  If
13536 	 and when the debugger needs to know something about these functions,
13537 	 it will have to hunt around and find the DWARF information associated
13538 	 with the definition of the function.
13539 
13540 	 We can't just check DECL_EXTERNAL to find out which FUNCTION_DECL
13541 	 nodes represent definitions and which ones represent mere
13542 	 declarations.  We have to check DECL_INITIAL instead. That's because
13543 	 the C front-end supports some weird semantics for "extern inline"
13544 	 function definitions.  These can get inlined within the current
13545 	 translation unit (and thus, we need to generate Dwarf info for their
13546 	 abstract instances so that the Dwarf info for the concrete inlined
13547 	 instances can have something to refer to) but the compiler never
13548 	 generates any out-of-lines instances of such things (despite the fact
13549 	 that they *are* definitions).
13550 
13551 	 The important point is that the C front-end marks these "extern
13552 	 inline" functions as DECL_EXTERNAL, but we need to generate DWARF for
13553 	 them anyway. Note that the C++ front-end also plays some similar games
13554 	 for inline function definitions appearing within include files which
13555 	 also contain `#pragma interface' pragmas.  */
13556       if (DECL_INITIAL (decl) == NULL_TREE)
13557 	return;
13558 
13559       /* If we're a nested function, initially use a parent of NULL; if we're
13560 	 a plain function, this will be fixed up in decls_for_scope.  If
13561 	 we're a method, it will be ignored, since we already have a DIE.  */
13562       if (decl_function_context (decl)
13563 	  /* But if we're in terse mode, we don't care about scope.  */
13564 	  && debug_info_level > DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
13565 	context_die = NULL;
13566       break;
13567 
13568     case VAR_DECL:
13569       /* Ignore this VAR_DECL if it refers to a file-scope extern data object
13570 	 declaration and if the declaration was never even referenced from
13571 	 within this entire compilation unit.  We suppress these DIEs in
13572 	 order to save space in the .debug section (by eliminating entries
13573 	 which are probably useless).  Note that we must not suppress
13574 	 block-local extern declarations (whether used or not) because that
13575 	 would screw-up the debugger's name lookup mechanism and cause it to
13576 	 miss things which really ought to be in scope at a given point.  */
13577       if (DECL_EXTERNAL (decl) && !TREE_USED (decl))
13578 	return;
13579 
13580       /* For local statics lookup proper context die.  */
13581       if (TREE_STATIC (decl) && decl_function_context (decl))
13582 	context_die = lookup_decl_die (DECL_CONTEXT (decl));
13583 
13584       /* If we are in terse mode, don't generate any DIEs to represent any
13585 	 variable declarations or definitions.  */
13586       if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
13587 	return;
13588       break;
13589 
13590     case NAMESPACE_DECL:
13591       if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
13592 	return;
13593       if (lookup_decl_die (decl) != NULL)
13594         return;
13595       break;
13596 
13597     case TYPE_DECL:
13598       /* Don't emit stubs for types unless they are needed by other DIEs.  */
13599       if (TYPE_DECL_SUPPRESS_DEBUG (decl))
13600 	return;
13601 
13602       /* Don't bother trying to generate any DIEs to represent any of the
13603 	 normal built-in types for the language we are compiling.  */
13604       if (DECL_IS_BUILTIN (decl))
13605 	{
13606 	  /* OK, we need to generate one for `bool' so GDB knows what type
13607 	     comparisons have.  */
13608 	  if (is_cxx ()
13609 	      && TREE_CODE (TREE_TYPE (decl)) == BOOLEAN_TYPE
13610 	      && ! DECL_IGNORED_P (decl))
13611 	    modified_type_die (TREE_TYPE (decl), 0, 0, NULL);
13612 
13613 	  return;
13614 	}
13615 
13616       /* If we are in terse mode, don't generate any DIEs for types.  */
13617       if (debug_info_level <= DINFO_LEVEL_TERSE)
13618 	return;
13619 
13620       /* If we're a function-scope tag, initially use a parent of NULL;
13621 	 this will be fixed up in decls_for_scope.  */
13622       if (decl_function_context (decl))
13623 	context_die = NULL;
13624 
13625       break;
13626 
13627     default:
13628       return;
13629     }
13630 
13631   gen_decl_die (decl, context_die);
13632 }
13633 
13634 /* Output a marker (i.e. a label) for the beginning of the generated code for
13635    a lexical block.  */
13636 
13637 static void
dwarf2out_begin_block(unsigned int line ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,unsigned int blocknum)13638 dwarf2out_begin_block (unsigned int line ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
13639 		       unsigned int blocknum)
13640 {
13641   switch_to_section (current_function_section ());
13642   ASM_OUTPUT_DEBUG_LABEL (asm_out_file, BLOCK_BEGIN_LABEL, blocknum);
13643 }
13644 
13645 /* Output a marker (i.e. a label) for the end of the generated code for a
13646    lexical block.  */
13647 
13648 static void
dwarf2out_end_block(unsigned int line ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,unsigned int blocknum)13649 dwarf2out_end_block (unsigned int line ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, unsigned int blocknum)
13650 {
13651   switch_to_section (current_function_section ());
13652   ASM_OUTPUT_DEBUG_LABEL (asm_out_file, BLOCK_END_LABEL, blocknum);
13653 }
13654 
13655 /* Returns nonzero if it is appropriate not to emit any debugging
13656    information for BLOCK, because it doesn't contain any instructions.
13657 
13658    Don't allow this for blocks with nested functions or local classes
13659    as we would end up with orphans, and in the presence of scheduling
13660    we may end up calling them anyway.  */
13661 
13662 static bool
dwarf2out_ignore_block(tree block)13663 dwarf2out_ignore_block (tree block)
13664 {
13665   tree decl;
13666 
13667   for (decl = BLOCK_VARS (block); decl; decl = TREE_CHAIN (decl))
13668     if (TREE_CODE (decl) == FUNCTION_DECL
13669 	|| (TREE_CODE (decl) == TYPE_DECL && TYPE_DECL_IS_STUB (decl)))
13670       return 0;
13671 
13672   return 1;
13673 }
13674 
13675 /* Hash table routines for file_hash.  */
13676 
13677 static int
file_table_eq(const void * p1_p,const void * p2_p)13678 file_table_eq (const void *p1_p, const void *p2_p)
13679 {
13680   const struct dwarf_file_data * p1 = p1_p;
13681   const char * p2 = p2_p;
13682   return strcmp (p1->filename, p2) == 0;
13683 }
13684 
13685 static hashval_t
file_table_hash(const void * p_p)13686 file_table_hash (const void *p_p)
13687 {
13688   const struct dwarf_file_data * p = p_p;
13689   return htab_hash_string (p->filename);
13690 }
13691 
13692 /* Lookup FILE_NAME (in the list of filenames that we know about here in
13693    dwarf2out.c) and return its "index".  The index of each (known) filename is
13694    just a unique number which is associated with only that one filename.  We
13695    need such numbers for the sake of generating labels (in the .debug_sfnames
13696    section) and references to those files numbers (in the .debug_srcinfo
13697    and.debug_macinfo sections).  If the filename given as an argument is not
13698    found in our current list, add it to the list and assign it the next
13699    available unique index number.  In order to speed up searches, we remember
13700    the index of the filename was looked up last.  This handles the majority of
13701    all searches.  */
13702 
13703 static struct dwarf_file_data *
lookup_filename(const char * file_name)13704 lookup_filename (const char *file_name)
13705 {
13706   void ** slot;
13707   struct dwarf_file_data * created;
13708 
13709   /* Check to see if the file name that was searched on the previous
13710      call matches this file name.  If so, return the index.  */
13711   if (file_table_last_lookup
13712       && (file_name == file_table_last_lookup->filename
13713 	  || strcmp (file_table_last_lookup->filename, file_name) == 0))
13714     return file_table_last_lookup;
13715 
13716   /* Didn't match the previous lookup, search the table.  */
13717   slot = htab_find_slot_with_hash (file_table, file_name,
13718 				   htab_hash_string (file_name), INSERT);
13719   if (*slot)
13720     return *slot;
13721 
13722   created = ggc_alloc (sizeof (struct dwarf_file_data));
13723   created->filename = file_name;
13724   created->emitted_number = 0;
13725   *slot = created;
13726   return created;
13727 }
13728 
13729 /* If the assembler will construct the file table, then translate the compiler
13730    internal file table number into the assembler file table number, and emit
13731    a .file directive if we haven't already emitted one yet.  The file table
13732    numbers are different because we prune debug info for unused variables and
13733    types, which may include filenames.  */
13734 
13735 static int
maybe_emit_file(struct dwarf_file_data * fd)13736 maybe_emit_file (struct dwarf_file_data * fd)
13737 {
13738   if (! fd->emitted_number)
13739     {
13740       if (last_emitted_file)
13741 	fd->emitted_number = last_emitted_file->emitted_number + 1;
13742       else
13743 	fd->emitted_number = 1;
13744       last_emitted_file = fd;
13745 
13746       if (DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO)
13747 	{
13748 	  fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.file %u ", fd->emitted_number);
13749 	  output_quoted_string (asm_out_file, fd->filename);
13750 	  fputc ('\n', asm_out_file);
13751 	}
13752     }
13753 
13754   return fd->emitted_number;
13755 }
13756 
13757 /* Called by the final INSN scan whenever we see a var location.  We
13758    use it to drop labels in the right places, and throw the location in
13759    our lookup table.  */
13760 
13761 static void
dwarf2out_var_location(rtx loc_note)13762 dwarf2out_var_location (rtx loc_note)
13763 {
13764   char loclabel[MAX_ARTIFICIAL_LABEL_BYTES];
13765   struct var_loc_node *newloc;
13766   rtx prev_insn;
13767   static rtx last_insn;
13768   static const char *last_label;
13769   tree decl;
13770 
13771   if (!DECL_P (NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_DECL (loc_note)))
13772     return;
13773   prev_insn = PREV_INSN (loc_note);
13774 
13775   newloc = ggc_alloc_cleared (sizeof (struct var_loc_node));
13776   /* If the insn we processed last time is the previous insn
13777      and it is also a var location note, use the label we emitted
13778      last time.  */
13779   if (last_insn != NULL_RTX
13780       && last_insn == prev_insn
13781       && NOTE_P (prev_insn)
13782       && NOTE_LINE_NUMBER (prev_insn) == NOTE_INSN_VAR_LOCATION)
13783     {
13784       newloc->label = last_label;
13785     }
13786   else
13787     {
13788       ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (loclabel, "LVL", loclabel_num);
13789       ASM_OUTPUT_DEBUG_LABEL (asm_out_file, "LVL", loclabel_num);
13790       loclabel_num++;
13791       newloc->label = ggc_strdup (loclabel);
13792     }
13793   newloc->var_loc_note = loc_note;
13794   newloc->next = NULL;
13795 
13796   if (cfun && in_cold_section_p)
13797     newloc->section_label = cfun->cold_section_label;
13798   else
13799     newloc->section_label = text_section_label;
13800 
13801   last_insn = loc_note;
13802   last_label = newloc->label;
13803   decl = NOTE_VAR_LOCATION_DECL (loc_note);
13804   add_var_loc_to_decl (decl, newloc);
13805 }
13806 
13807 /* We need to reset the locations at the beginning of each
13808    function. We can't do this in the end_function hook, because the
13809    declarations that use the locations won't have been output when
13810    that hook is called.  Also compute have_multiple_function_sections here.  */
13811 
13812 static void
dwarf2out_begin_function(tree fun)13813 dwarf2out_begin_function (tree fun)
13814 {
13815   htab_empty (decl_loc_table);
13816 
13817   if (function_section (fun) != text_section)
13818     have_multiple_function_sections = true;
13819 }
13820 
13821 /* Output a label to mark the beginning of a source code line entry
13822    and record information relating to this source line, in
13823    'line_info_table' for later output of the .debug_line section.  */
13824 
13825 static void
dwarf2out_source_line(unsigned int line,const char * filename)13826 dwarf2out_source_line (unsigned int line, const char *filename)
13827 {
13828   if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_NORMAL
13829       && line != 0)
13830     {
13831       int file_num = maybe_emit_file (lookup_filename (filename));
13832 
13833       switch_to_section (current_function_section ());
13834 
13835       /* If requested, emit something human-readable.  */
13836       if (flag_debug_asm)
13837 	fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t%s %s:%d\n", ASM_COMMENT_START,
13838 		 filename, line);
13839 
13840       if (DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO)
13841 	{
13842 	  /* Emit the .loc directive understood by GNU as.  */
13843 	  fprintf (asm_out_file, "\t.loc %d %d 0\n", file_num, line);
13844 
13845 	  /* Indicate that line number info exists.  */
13846 	  line_info_table_in_use++;
13847 	}
13848       else if (function_section (current_function_decl) != text_section)
13849 	{
13850 	  dw_separate_line_info_ref line_info;
13851 	  targetm.asm_out.internal_label (asm_out_file,
13852 					  SEPARATE_LINE_CODE_LABEL,
13853 					  separate_line_info_table_in_use);
13854 
13855 	  /* Expand the line info table if necessary.  */
13856 	  if (separate_line_info_table_in_use
13857 	      == separate_line_info_table_allocated)
13858 	    {
13859 	      separate_line_info_table_allocated += LINE_INFO_TABLE_INCREMENT;
13860 	      separate_line_info_table
13861 		= ggc_realloc (separate_line_info_table,
13862 			       separate_line_info_table_allocated
13863 			       * sizeof (dw_separate_line_info_entry));
13864 	      memset (separate_line_info_table
13865 		       + separate_line_info_table_in_use,
13866 		      0,
13867 		      (LINE_INFO_TABLE_INCREMENT
13868 		       * sizeof (dw_separate_line_info_entry)));
13869 	    }
13870 
13871 	  /* Add the new entry at the end of the line_info_table.  */
13872 	  line_info
13873 	    = &separate_line_info_table[separate_line_info_table_in_use++];
13874 	  line_info->dw_file_num = file_num;
13875 	  line_info->dw_line_num = line;
13876 	  line_info->function = current_function_funcdef_no;
13877 	}
13878       else
13879 	{
13880 	  dw_line_info_ref line_info;
13881 
13882 	  targetm.asm_out.internal_label (asm_out_file, LINE_CODE_LABEL,
13883 				     line_info_table_in_use);
13884 
13885 	  /* Expand the line info table if necessary.  */
13886 	  if (line_info_table_in_use == line_info_table_allocated)
13887 	    {
13888 	      line_info_table_allocated += LINE_INFO_TABLE_INCREMENT;
13889 	      line_info_table
13890 		= ggc_realloc (line_info_table,
13891 			       (line_info_table_allocated
13892 				* sizeof (dw_line_info_entry)));
13893 	      memset (line_info_table + line_info_table_in_use, 0,
13894 		      LINE_INFO_TABLE_INCREMENT * sizeof (dw_line_info_entry));
13895 	    }
13896 
13897 	  /* Add the new entry at the end of the line_info_table.  */
13898 	  line_info = &line_info_table[line_info_table_in_use++];
13899 	  line_info->dw_file_num = file_num;
13900 	  line_info->dw_line_num = line;
13901 	}
13902     }
13903 }
13904 
13905 /* Record the beginning of a new source file.  */
13906 
13907 static void
dwarf2out_start_source_file(unsigned int lineno,const char * filename)13908 dwarf2out_start_source_file (unsigned int lineno, const char *filename)
13909 {
13910   if (flag_eliminate_dwarf2_dups)
13911     {
13912       /* Record the beginning of the file for break_out_includes.  */
13913       dw_die_ref bincl_die;
13914 
13915       bincl_die = new_die (DW_TAG_GNU_BINCL, comp_unit_die, NULL);
13916       add_AT_string (bincl_die, DW_AT_name, filename);
13917     }
13918 
13919   if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_VERBOSE)
13920     {
13921       int file_num = maybe_emit_file (lookup_filename (filename));
13922 
13923       switch_to_section (debug_macinfo_section);
13924       dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_MACINFO_start_file, "Start new file");
13925       dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (lineno, "Included from line number %d",
13926 				   lineno);
13927 
13928       dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (file_num, "file %s", filename);
13929     }
13930 }
13931 
13932 /* Record the end of a source file.  */
13933 
13934 static void
dwarf2out_end_source_file(unsigned int lineno ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)13935 dwarf2out_end_source_file (unsigned int lineno ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
13936 {
13937   if (flag_eliminate_dwarf2_dups)
13938     /* Record the end of the file for break_out_includes.  */
13939     new_die (DW_TAG_GNU_EINCL, comp_unit_die, NULL);
13940 
13941   if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_VERBOSE)
13942     {
13943       switch_to_section (debug_macinfo_section);
13944       dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_MACINFO_end_file, "End file");
13945     }
13946 }
13947 
13948 /* Called from debug_define in toplev.c.  The `buffer' parameter contains
13949    the tail part of the directive line, i.e. the part which is past the
13950    initial whitespace, #, whitespace, directive-name, whitespace part.  */
13951 
13952 static void
dwarf2out_define(unsigned int lineno ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,const char * buffer ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)13953 dwarf2out_define (unsigned int lineno ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
13954 		  const char *buffer ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
13955 {
13956   if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_VERBOSE)
13957     {
13958       switch_to_section (debug_macinfo_section);
13959       dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_MACINFO_define, "Define macro");
13960       dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (lineno, "At line number %d", lineno);
13961       dw2_asm_output_nstring (buffer, -1, "The macro");
13962     }
13963 }
13964 
13965 /* Called from debug_undef in toplev.c.  The `buffer' parameter contains
13966    the tail part of the directive line, i.e. the part which is past the
13967    initial whitespace, #, whitespace, directive-name, whitespace part.  */
13968 
13969 static void
dwarf2out_undef(unsigned int lineno ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,const char * buffer ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)13970 dwarf2out_undef (unsigned int lineno ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
13971 		 const char *buffer ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
13972 {
13973   if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_VERBOSE)
13974     {
13975       switch_to_section (debug_macinfo_section);
13976       dw2_asm_output_data (1, DW_MACINFO_undef, "Undefine macro");
13977       dw2_asm_output_data_uleb128 (lineno, "At line number %d", lineno);
13978       dw2_asm_output_nstring (buffer, -1, "The macro");
13979     }
13980 }
13981 
13982 /* Set up for Dwarf output at the start of compilation.  */
13983 
13984 static void
dwarf2out_init(const char * filename ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)13985 dwarf2out_init (const char *filename ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
13986 {
13987   /* Allocate the file_table.  */
13988   file_table = htab_create_ggc (50, file_table_hash,
13989 				file_table_eq, NULL);
13990 
13991   /* Allocate the decl_die_table.  */
13992   decl_die_table = htab_create_ggc (10, decl_die_table_hash,
13993 				    decl_die_table_eq, NULL);
13994 
13995   /* Allocate the decl_loc_table.  */
13996   decl_loc_table = htab_create_ggc (10, decl_loc_table_hash,
13997 				    decl_loc_table_eq, NULL);
13998 
13999   /* Allocate the initial hunk of the decl_scope_table.  */
14000   decl_scope_table = VEC_alloc (tree, gc, 256);
14001 
14002   /* Allocate the initial hunk of the abbrev_die_table.  */
14003   abbrev_die_table = ggc_alloc_cleared (ABBREV_DIE_TABLE_INCREMENT
14004 					* sizeof (dw_die_ref));
14005   abbrev_die_table_allocated = ABBREV_DIE_TABLE_INCREMENT;
14006   /* Zero-th entry is allocated, but unused.  */
14007   abbrev_die_table_in_use = 1;
14008 
14009   /* Allocate the initial hunk of the line_info_table.  */
14010   line_info_table = ggc_alloc_cleared (LINE_INFO_TABLE_INCREMENT
14011 				       * sizeof (dw_line_info_entry));
14012   line_info_table_allocated = LINE_INFO_TABLE_INCREMENT;
14013 
14014   /* Zero-th entry is allocated, but unused.  */
14015   line_info_table_in_use = 1;
14016 
14017   /* Allocate the pubtypes and pubnames vectors.  */
14018   pubname_table = VEC_alloc (pubname_entry, gc, 32);
14019   pubtype_table = VEC_alloc (pubname_entry, gc, 32);
14020 
14021   /* Generate the initial DIE for the .debug section.  Note that the (string)
14022      value given in the DW_AT_name attribute of the DW_TAG_compile_unit DIE
14023      will (typically) be a relative pathname and that this pathname should be
14024      taken as being relative to the directory from which the compiler was
14025      invoked when the given (base) source file was compiled.  We will fill
14026      in this value in dwarf2out_finish.  */
14027   comp_unit_die = gen_compile_unit_die (NULL);
14028 
14029   incomplete_types = VEC_alloc (tree, gc, 64);
14030 
14031   used_rtx_array = VEC_alloc (rtx, gc, 32);
14032 
14033   debug_info_section = get_section (DEBUG_INFO_SECTION,
14034 				    SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
14035   debug_abbrev_section = get_section (DEBUG_ABBREV_SECTION,
14036 				      SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
14037   debug_aranges_section = get_section (DEBUG_ARANGES_SECTION,
14038 				       SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
14039   debug_macinfo_section = get_section (DEBUG_MACINFO_SECTION,
14040 				       SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
14041   debug_line_section = get_section (DEBUG_LINE_SECTION,
14042 				    SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
14043   debug_loc_section = get_section (DEBUG_LOC_SECTION,
14044 				   SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
14045   debug_pubnames_section = get_section (DEBUG_PUBNAMES_SECTION,
14046 					SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
14047 #ifdef DEBUG_PUBTYPES_SECTION
14048   debug_pubtypes_section = get_section (DEBUG_PUBTYPES_SECTION,
14049 					SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
14050 #endif
14051   debug_str_section = get_section (DEBUG_STR_SECTION,
14052 				   DEBUG_STR_SECTION_FLAGS, NULL);
14053   debug_ranges_section = get_section (DEBUG_RANGES_SECTION,
14054 				      SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
14055   debug_frame_section = get_section (DEBUG_FRAME_SECTION,
14056 				     SECTION_DEBUG, NULL);
14057 
14058   ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (text_end_label, TEXT_END_LABEL, 0);
14059   ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (abbrev_section_label,
14060 			       DEBUG_ABBREV_SECTION_LABEL, 0);
14061   ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (text_section_label, TEXT_SECTION_LABEL, 0);
14062   ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (cold_text_section_label,
14063 			       COLD_TEXT_SECTION_LABEL, 0);
14064   ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (cold_end_label, COLD_END_LABEL, 0);
14065 
14066   ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (debug_info_section_label,
14067 			       DEBUG_INFO_SECTION_LABEL, 0);
14068   ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (debug_line_section_label,
14069 			       DEBUG_LINE_SECTION_LABEL, 0);
14070   ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (ranges_section_label,
14071 			       DEBUG_RANGES_SECTION_LABEL, 0);
14072   switch_to_section (debug_abbrev_section);
14073   ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, abbrev_section_label);
14074   switch_to_section (debug_info_section);
14075   ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, debug_info_section_label);
14076   switch_to_section (debug_line_section);
14077   ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, debug_line_section_label);
14078 
14079   if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_VERBOSE)
14080     {
14081       switch_to_section (debug_macinfo_section);
14082       ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (macinfo_section_label,
14083 				   DEBUG_MACINFO_SECTION_LABEL, 0);
14084       ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, macinfo_section_label);
14085     }
14086 
14087   switch_to_section (text_section);
14088   ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, text_section_label);
14089   if (flag_reorder_blocks_and_partition)
14090     {
14091       switch_to_section (unlikely_text_section ());
14092       ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, cold_text_section_label);
14093     }
14094 }
14095 
14096 /* A helper function for dwarf2out_finish called through
14097    ht_forall.  Emit one queued .debug_str string.  */
14098 
14099 static int
output_indirect_string(void ** h,void * v ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)14100 output_indirect_string (void **h, void *v ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
14101 {
14102   struct indirect_string_node *node = (struct indirect_string_node *) *h;
14103 
14104   if (node->form == DW_FORM_strp)
14105     {
14106       switch_to_section (debug_str_section);
14107       ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, node->label);
14108       assemble_string (node->str, strlen (node->str) + 1);
14109     }
14110 
14111   return 1;
14112 }
14113 
14114 #if ENABLE_ASSERT_CHECKING
14115 /* Verify that all marks are clear.  */
14116 
14117 static void
verify_marks_clear(dw_die_ref die)14118 verify_marks_clear (dw_die_ref die)
14119 {
14120   dw_die_ref c;
14121 
14122   gcc_assert (! die->die_mark);
14123   FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, verify_marks_clear (c));
14124 }
14125 #endif /* ENABLE_ASSERT_CHECKING */
14126 
14127 /* Clear the marks for a die and its children.
14128    Be cool if the mark isn't set.  */
14129 
14130 static void
prune_unmark_dies(dw_die_ref die)14131 prune_unmark_dies (dw_die_ref die)
14132 {
14133   dw_die_ref c;
14134 
14135   if (die->die_mark)
14136     die->die_mark = 0;
14137   FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, prune_unmark_dies (c));
14138 }
14139 
14140 /* Given DIE that we're marking as used, find any other dies
14141    it references as attributes and mark them as used.  */
14142 
14143 static void
prune_unused_types_walk_attribs(dw_die_ref die)14144 prune_unused_types_walk_attribs (dw_die_ref die)
14145 {
14146   dw_attr_ref a;
14147   unsigned ix;
14148 
14149   for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (dw_attr_node, die->die_attr, ix, a); ix++)
14150     {
14151       if (a->dw_attr_val.val_class == dw_val_class_die_ref)
14152 	{
14153 	  /* A reference to another DIE.
14154 	     Make sure that it will get emitted.  */
14155 	  prune_unused_types_mark (a->dw_attr_val.v.val_die_ref.die, 1);
14156 	}
14157       /* Set the string's refcount to 0 so that prune_unused_types_mark
14158 	 accounts properly for it.  */
14159       if (AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_str)
14160 	a->dw_attr_val.v.val_str->refcount = 0;
14161     }
14162 }
14163 
14164 
14165 /* Mark DIE as being used.  If DOKIDS is true, then walk down
14166    to DIE's children.  */
14167 
14168 static void
prune_unused_types_mark(dw_die_ref die,int dokids)14169 prune_unused_types_mark (dw_die_ref die, int dokids)
14170 {
14171   dw_die_ref c;
14172 
14173   if (die->die_mark == 0)
14174     {
14175       /* We haven't done this node yet.  Mark it as used.  */
14176       die->die_mark = 1;
14177 
14178       /* We also have to mark its parents as used.
14179 	 (But we don't want to mark our parents' kids due to this.)  */
14180       if (die->die_parent)
14181 	prune_unused_types_mark (die->die_parent, 0);
14182 
14183       /* Mark any referenced nodes.  */
14184       prune_unused_types_walk_attribs (die);
14185 
14186       /* If this node is a specification,
14187          also mark the definition, if it exists.  */
14188       if (get_AT_flag (die, DW_AT_declaration) && die->die_definition)
14189         prune_unused_types_mark (die->die_definition, 1);
14190     }
14191 
14192   if (dokids && die->die_mark != 2)
14193     {
14194       /* We need to walk the children, but haven't done so yet.
14195 	 Remember that we've walked the kids.  */
14196       die->die_mark = 2;
14197 
14198       /* If this is an array type, we need to make sure our
14199 	 kids get marked, even if they're types.  */
14200       if (die->die_tag == DW_TAG_array_type)
14201 	FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, prune_unused_types_mark (c, 1));
14202       else
14203 	FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, prune_unused_types_walk (c));
14204     }
14205 }
14206 
14207 
14208 /* Walk the tree DIE and mark types that we actually use.  */
14209 
14210 static void
prune_unused_types_walk(dw_die_ref die)14211 prune_unused_types_walk (dw_die_ref die)
14212 {
14213   dw_die_ref c;
14214 
14215   /* Don't do anything if this node is already marked.  */
14216   if (die->die_mark)
14217     return;
14218 
14219   switch (die->die_tag) {
14220   case DW_TAG_const_type:
14221   case DW_TAG_packed_type:
14222   case DW_TAG_pointer_type:
14223   case DW_TAG_reference_type:
14224   case DW_TAG_volatile_type:
14225   case DW_TAG_typedef:
14226   case DW_TAG_array_type:
14227   case DW_TAG_structure_type:
14228   case DW_TAG_union_type:
14229   case DW_TAG_class_type:
14230   case DW_TAG_friend:
14231   case DW_TAG_variant_part:
14232   case DW_TAG_enumeration_type:
14233   case DW_TAG_subroutine_type:
14234   case DW_TAG_string_type:
14235   case DW_TAG_set_type:
14236   case DW_TAG_subrange_type:
14237   case DW_TAG_ptr_to_member_type:
14238   case DW_TAG_file_type:
14239     if (die->die_perennial_p)
14240       break;
14241 
14242     /* It's a type node --- don't mark it.  */
14243     return;
14244 
14245   default:
14246     /* Mark everything else.  */
14247     break;
14248   }
14249 
14250   die->die_mark = 1;
14251 
14252   /* Now, mark any dies referenced from here.  */
14253   prune_unused_types_walk_attribs (die);
14254 
14255   /* Mark children.  */
14256   FOR_EACH_CHILD (die, c, prune_unused_types_walk (c));
14257 }
14258 
14259 /* Increment the string counts on strings referred to from DIE's
14260    attributes.  */
14261 
14262 static void
prune_unused_types_update_strings(dw_die_ref die)14263 prune_unused_types_update_strings (dw_die_ref die)
14264 {
14265   dw_attr_ref a;
14266   unsigned ix;
14267 
14268   for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (dw_attr_node, die->die_attr, ix, a); ix++)
14269     if (AT_class (a) == dw_val_class_str)
14270       {
14271 	struct indirect_string_node *s = a->dw_attr_val.v.val_str;
14272 	s->refcount++;
14273 	/* Avoid unnecessarily putting strings that are used less than
14274 	   twice in the hash table.  */
14275 	if (s->refcount
14276 	    == ((DEBUG_STR_SECTION_FLAGS & SECTION_MERGE) ? 1 : 2))
14277 	  {
14278 	    void ** slot;
14279 	    slot = htab_find_slot_with_hash (debug_str_hash, s->str,
14280 					     htab_hash_string (s->str),
14281 					     INSERT);
14282 	    gcc_assert (*slot == NULL);
14283 	    *slot = s;
14284 	  }
14285       }
14286 }
14287 
14288 /* Remove from the tree DIE any dies that aren't marked.  */
14289 
14290 static void
prune_unused_types_prune(dw_die_ref die)14291 prune_unused_types_prune (dw_die_ref die)
14292 {
14293   dw_die_ref c;
14294 
14295   gcc_assert (die->die_mark);
14296   prune_unused_types_update_strings (die);
14297 
14298   if (! die->die_child)
14299     return;
14300 
14301   c = die->die_child;
14302   do {
14303     dw_die_ref prev = c;
14304     for (c = c->die_sib; ! c->die_mark; c = c->die_sib)
14305       if (c == die->die_child)
14306 	{
14307 	  /* No marked children between 'prev' and the end of the list.  */
14308 	  if (prev == c)
14309 	    /* No marked children at all.  */
14310 	    die->die_child = NULL;
14311 	  else
14312 	    {
14313 	      prev->die_sib = c->die_sib;
14314 	      die->die_child = prev;
14315 	    }
14316 	  return;
14317 	}
14318 
14319     if (c != prev->die_sib)
14320       prev->die_sib = c;
14321     prune_unused_types_prune (c);
14322   } while (c != die->die_child);
14323 }
14324 
14325 
14326 /* Remove dies representing declarations that we never use.  */
14327 
14328 static void
prune_unused_types(void)14329 prune_unused_types (void)
14330 {
14331   unsigned int i;
14332   limbo_die_node *node;
14333   pubname_ref pub;
14334 
14335 #if ENABLE_ASSERT_CHECKING
14336   /* All the marks should already be clear.  */
14337   verify_marks_clear (comp_unit_die);
14338   for (node = limbo_die_list; node; node = node->next)
14339     verify_marks_clear (node->die);
14340 #endif /* ENABLE_ASSERT_CHECKING */
14341 
14342   /* Set the mark on nodes that are actually used.  */
14343   prune_unused_types_walk (comp_unit_die);
14344   for (node = limbo_die_list; node; node = node->next)
14345     prune_unused_types_walk (node->die);
14346 
14347   /* Also set the mark on nodes referenced from the
14348      pubname_table or arange_table.  */
14349   for (i = 0; VEC_iterate (pubname_entry, pubname_table, i, pub); i++)
14350     prune_unused_types_mark (pub->die, 1);
14351   for (i = 0; i < arange_table_in_use; i++)
14352     prune_unused_types_mark (arange_table[i], 1);
14353 
14354   /* Get rid of nodes that aren't marked; and update the string counts.  */
14355   if (debug_str_hash)
14356     htab_empty (debug_str_hash);
14357   prune_unused_types_prune (comp_unit_die);
14358   for (node = limbo_die_list; node; node = node->next)
14359     prune_unused_types_prune (node->die);
14360 
14361   /* Leave the marks clear.  */
14362   prune_unmark_dies (comp_unit_die);
14363   for (node = limbo_die_list; node; node = node->next)
14364     prune_unmark_dies (node->die);
14365 }
14366 
14367 /* Set the parameter to true if there are any relative pathnames in
14368    the file table.  */
14369 static int
file_table_relative_p(void ** slot,void * param)14370 file_table_relative_p (void ** slot, void *param)
14371 {
14372   bool *p = param;
14373   struct dwarf_file_data *d = *slot;
14374   if (d->emitted_number && d->filename[0] != DIR_SEPARATOR)
14375     {
14376       *p = true;
14377       return 0;
14378     }
14379   return 1;
14380 }
14381 
14382 /* Output stuff that dwarf requires at the end of every file,
14383    and generate the DWARF-2 debugging info.  */
14384 
14385 static void
dwarf2out_finish(const char * filename)14386 dwarf2out_finish (const char *filename)
14387 {
14388   limbo_die_node *node, *next_node;
14389   dw_die_ref die = 0;
14390 
14391   /* Add the name for the main input file now.  We delayed this from
14392      dwarf2out_init to avoid complications with PCH.  */
14393   add_name_attribute (comp_unit_die, filename);
14394   if (filename[0] != DIR_SEPARATOR)
14395     add_comp_dir_attribute (comp_unit_die);
14396   else if (get_AT (comp_unit_die, DW_AT_comp_dir) == NULL)
14397     {
14398       bool p = false;
14399       htab_traverse (file_table, file_table_relative_p, &p);
14400       if (p)
14401 	add_comp_dir_attribute (comp_unit_die);
14402     }
14403 
14404   /* Traverse the limbo die list, and add parent/child links.  The only
14405      dies without parents that should be here are concrete instances of
14406      inline functions, and the comp_unit_die.  We can ignore the comp_unit_die.
14407      For concrete instances, we can get the parent die from the abstract
14408      instance.  */
14409   for (node = limbo_die_list; node; node = next_node)
14410     {
14411       next_node = node->next;
14412       die = node->die;
14413 
14414       if (die->die_parent == NULL)
14415 	{
14416 	  dw_die_ref origin = get_AT_ref (die, DW_AT_abstract_origin);
14417 
14418 	  if (origin)
14419 	    add_child_die (origin->die_parent, die);
14420 	  else if (die == comp_unit_die)
14421 	    ;
14422 	  else if (errorcount > 0 || sorrycount > 0)
14423 	    /* It's OK to be confused by errors in the input.  */
14424 	    add_child_die (comp_unit_die, die);
14425 	  else
14426 	    {
14427 	      /* In certain situations, the lexical block containing a
14428 		 nested function can be optimized away, which results
14429 		 in the nested function die being orphaned.  Likewise
14430 		 with the return type of that nested function.  Force
14431 		 this to be a child of the containing function.
14432 
14433 		 It may happen that even the containing function got fully
14434 		 inlined and optimized out.  In that case we are lost and
14435 		 assign the empty child.  This should not be big issue as
14436 		 the function is likely unreachable too.  */
14437 	      tree context = NULL_TREE;
14438 
14439 	      gcc_assert (node->created_for);
14440 
14441 	      if (DECL_P (node->created_for))
14442 		context = DECL_CONTEXT (node->created_for);
14443 	      else if (TYPE_P (node->created_for))
14444 		context = TYPE_CONTEXT (node->created_for);
14445 
14446 	      gcc_assert (context
14447 			  && (TREE_CODE (context) == FUNCTION_DECL
14448 			      || TREE_CODE (context) == NAMESPACE_DECL));
14449 
14450 	      origin = lookup_decl_die (context);
14451 	      if (origin)
14452 	        add_child_die (origin, die);
14453 	      else
14454 	        add_child_die (comp_unit_die, die);
14455 	    }
14456 	}
14457     }
14458 
14459   limbo_die_list = NULL;
14460 
14461   /* Walk through the list of incomplete types again, trying once more to
14462      emit full debugging info for them.  */
14463   retry_incomplete_types ();
14464 
14465   if (flag_eliminate_unused_debug_types)
14466     prune_unused_types ();
14467 
14468   /* Generate separate CUs for each of the include files we've seen.
14469      They will go into limbo_die_list.  */
14470   if (flag_eliminate_dwarf2_dups)
14471     break_out_includes (comp_unit_die);
14472 
14473   /* Traverse the DIE's and add add sibling attributes to those DIE's
14474      that have children.  */
14475   add_sibling_attributes (comp_unit_die);
14476   for (node = limbo_die_list; node; node = node->next)
14477     add_sibling_attributes (node->die);
14478 
14479   /* Output a terminator label for the .text section.  */
14480   switch_to_section (text_section);
14481   targetm.asm_out.internal_label (asm_out_file, TEXT_END_LABEL, 0);
14482   if (flag_reorder_blocks_and_partition)
14483     {
14484       switch_to_section (unlikely_text_section ());
14485       targetm.asm_out.internal_label (asm_out_file, COLD_END_LABEL, 0);
14486     }
14487 
14488   /* We can only use the low/high_pc attributes if all of the code was
14489      in .text.  */
14490   if (!have_multiple_function_sections)
14491     {
14492       add_AT_lbl_id (comp_unit_die, DW_AT_low_pc, text_section_label);
14493       add_AT_lbl_id (comp_unit_die, DW_AT_high_pc, text_end_label);
14494     }
14495 
14496   /* If it wasn't, we need to give .debug_loc and .debug_ranges an appropriate
14497      "base address".  Use zero so that these addresses become absolute.  */
14498   else if (have_location_lists || ranges_table_in_use)
14499     add_AT_addr (comp_unit_die, DW_AT_entry_pc, const0_rtx);
14500 
14501   /* Output location list section if necessary.  */
14502   if (have_location_lists)
14503     {
14504       /* Output the location lists info.  */
14505       switch_to_section (debug_loc_section);
14506       ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (loc_section_label,
14507 				   DEBUG_LOC_SECTION_LABEL, 0);
14508       ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, loc_section_label);
14509       output_location_lists (die);
14510     }
14511 
14512   if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_NORMAL)
14513     add_AT_lineptr (comp_unit_die, DW_AT_stmt_list,
14514 		    debug_line_section_label);
14515 
14516   if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_VERBOSE)
14517     add_AT_macptr (comp_unit_die, DW_AT_macro_info, macinfo_section_label);
14518 
14519   /* Output all of the compilation units.  We put the main one last so that
14520      the offsets are available to output_pubnames.  */
14521   for (node = limbo_die_list; node; node = node->next)
14522     output_comp_unit (node->die, 0);
14523 
14524   output_comp_unit (comp_unit_die, 0);
14525 
14526   /* Output the abbreviation table.  */
14527   switch_to_section (debug_abbrev_section);
14528   output_abbrev_section ();
14529 
14530   /* Output public names table if necessary.  */
14531   if (!VEC_empty (pubname_entry, pubname_table))
14532     {
14533       switch_to_section (debug_pubnames_section);
14534       output_pubnames (pubname_table);
14535     }
14536 
14537 #ifdef DEBUG_PUBTYPES_SECTION
14538   /* Output public types table if necessary.  */
14539   if (!VEC_empty (pubname_entry, pubtype_table))
14540     {
14541       switch_to_section (debug_pubtypes_section);
14542       output_pubnames (pubtype_table);
14543     }
14544 #endif
14545 
14546   /* Output the address range information.  We only put functions in the arange
14547      table, so don't write it out if we don't have any.  */
14548   if (fde_table_in_use)
14549     {
14550       switch_to_section (debug_aranges_section);
14551       output_aranges ();
14552     }
14553 
14554   /* Output ranges section if necessary.  */
14555   if (ranges_table_in_use)
14556     {
14557       switch_to_section (debug_ranges_section);
14558       ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (asm_out_file, ranges_section_label);
14559       output_ranges ();
14560     }
14561 
14562   /* Output the source line correspondence table.  We must do this
14563      even if there is no line information.  Otherwise, on an empty
14564      translation unit, we will generate a present, but empty,
14565      .debug_info section.  IRIX 6.5 `nm' will then complain when
14566      examining the file.  This is done late so that any filenames
14567      used by the debug_info section are marked as 'used'.  */
14568   if (! DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO)
14569     {
14570       switch_to_section (debug_line_section);
14571       output_line_info ();
14572     }
14573 
14574   /* Have to end the macro section.  */
14575   if (debug_info_level >= DINFO_LEVEL_VERBOSE)
14576     {
14577       switch_to_section (debug_macinfo_section);
14578       dw2_asm_output_data (1, 0, "End compilation unit");
14579     }
14580 
14581   /* If we emitted any DW_FORM_strp form attribute, output the string
14582      table too.  */
14583   if (debug_str_hash)
14584     htab_traverse (debug_str_hash, output_indirect_string, NULL);
14585 }
14586 #else
14587 
14588 /* This should never be used, but its address is needed for comparisons.  */
14589 const struct gcc_debug_hooks dwarf2_debug_hooks;
14590 
14591 #endif /* DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO */
14592 
14593 #include "gt-dwarf2out.h"
14594